EPA-430/1-76-008
MICROSCOPIC ANALYSIS OF PLANKTON,
PERIPHYTON, AND ACTIVATED SLUDGE
TRAINING MANUAL


U.S. ENVIRONMENTAL PROTECTION AGENCY
OFFICE OF WATER PROGRAM OPERATIONS

-------
                                                  EPA-430/1-76-008
                                                  June 1976
MICROSCOPIC  ANALYSIS OF  PLANKTON,
 PERIPHYTON,  AND ACTIVATED SLUDGE
   This course is offered for professional personnel in
   the fields of water pollution control, limnology, water
   supply and waste treatment.  Primary emphasis is
   given to practice in the identification and enumeration
   of microscopic organisms which may be encountered
   in water and activated sludge. Methods for the
   chemical and instrumental evaluation of plankton are
   compared with the results of microscopic examination
   in an extensive practical exercise.  Problems of
   significance and control are also considered.
  U.S. ENVIRONMENTAL PROTECTION AGENCY
        Office of Water Program Operations
             TRAININGPROGRAM

-------
                                       CONTENTS
Title or Description                                                     Outline Number
The Aquatic Environment                                                       1




Classification of Communities, Ecosystems, and Trophic Levels                  2




Limnology and Ecology of Plankton                                              3




Biology of Zooplankton Communities                                             4




Optics and the Microscope                                                      5




Structure and Function of Cells                                                  6




Types of Algae                                                                 7




Blue-Green Algae                                                              8




Green and Other Pigmented Flagellates                                          9




Filamentous Green Algae                                                      10




Coccoid Green Algae                                                           11




Diatoms                                                                       12




Filamentous Bacteria                                                          13




Fungi and the "Sewage Fungus" Community                                      14




Protozoa, Nematodes, and Rotifers           ,                    .              15




Activated Sludge Protozoa                                                      16




Free-Living Amoebae and Nematodes                                           17




Animal Plankton                                                              18




Techniques of Plankton Sampling Programs                                      19




Preparation and Enumeration of Plankton in the Laboratory                       20




Attached Growths                                                     .21




Determination of Plankton Productivity                                          22




Algal  Growth Potential Test                                                    23




Algae and Actinomycetes in Water Supplies                                      24




Algae as  Indicators of Pollution                                                 25




Odor Production by Algae and Other Organisms              .                    26

-------
Title or Description                                                     Outline Number
Plankton in Oligotrophic Lakes                                                 27

Biological Integrity of Stream Communities                                     28

Ecology Primer                                                               29

Global Deterioration and Our Environmental Crisis                              30

The Effects of Pollution on Lakes                                               31

Application of Biological Data                                                  32

Significance of "Limiting Factors" to Population Variation                       33

Algae and Cultural Eutrophication                                              34

Control of Plankton in Surface Waters                                          35

Control of Interference Organisms in Water Supplies                             36

The Biology of Pipes.  Conduits, and Canals                                   .37

San Francisco Experience with Nuisance Organisms                             38

Laboratory:  Identification of Diatoms                                          39

Preparation of Permanent Diatom Mounts                                       40

Laboratory;  Identification of Animal  Plankton                                   41

Laboratory:  Proportional Counting of Plankton                                  42

Calibration and Use of Plankton Counting Equipment                             43

Laboratory:  Fundamentals of Quantitative Counting                              44

Key to Selected Groups of Freshwater Animals                                  45

Key to Algae of Importance in Water Pollution                                   46

A Key for the Initial Separation of Some Common                         .47
Plankton Organisms

Classification - Finder for Names of Aquatic                                    48
Organisms in Water Supplies and Polluted Waters   >  -      •      :

-------
                                    THE AQUATIC ENVIRONMENT

                              Part 1:   The Nature and Behavior of Water
I  INTRODUCTION

The earth is physically divisible into the
lithosphere or land masses,  and the
hydrosphere which includes the oceans,
lakes,  streams,  and subterranean waters.

A  Upon the hydrospere are based a number
   of sciences which represent different
   approaches.  Hydrology is the general
   science of water itself with its various
   special fields such as  hydrography,
   hydraulics,  etc.  These in turn merge
   into physical chemistry and chemistry.

B Limnology and oceanography combine
   aspects of all of these, and deal not only
   with the physical liquid water and its
   various naturally occurring solutions and
      forms, but also with living organisms
      and the infinite interactions that occur
      between them and their environment.

      Water quality management, including
      pollution control,  thus looks to all
      branches of aquatic science in efforts
      to coordinate and improve man's
      relationship with his aquatic environment.
  H   SOME FACTS ABOUT WATER

   A  Water is the only abundant liquid on our
      planet.   It has many properties most
      unusual for liquids, upon which depend
      most of the familiar aspects of the world
      about us as we know it.  (See Table  1)
                                                TABLE i
                                      UNIQUE PROPERTIES OF WATER
                           Property
          Significance
                   Highest heat capacity (specific heat) of any
                   solid or liquid (except NHj)
 Stabilizes temperatures of organisms and
 geographical regions
                   Highest latent heat of fusion (except NHj
 Thermostatic effect at freezing point
                   Highest heat of evaporation of any substance
 Important In heat and water transfer of
 atmosphere
                   The only substance that has its maximum
                   density as a liquid (40 C)
 Fresh and brackish waters have maximum
 density above freezing point.  This is
 important in vertical circulation pattern
 In lakes.
                   Highest surface tension of any liquid
 Controls surface and drop phenomena,
 important In cellular physiology
                   Dissolves more substances In greater
                   quantity than any other liquid
. Makes complex biological system possible.
 Important for transportation of materials
 in solution.
                   Pure water has the highest dl-electrlc
                   constant of any liquid
 Leads to high dissociation of Inorganic
 substances in solution
                   Very little electrolytic dissociation
 Neutral, yet contains both H+ and OH ions
                   Relatively transparent
 Absorbs much energy In infra red and ultra
 violet ranges, but little In visible range.
 Hence "colorless"
 '8l.21f. 10.75
                                                                                                  1-1

-------
The Aquatic Environment
B  Physical Factors of Significance

   1  Water substance

      Water is not simply "HgO" but in
      reality is a mixture of some 33
      different substances involving three
      isotopes each of hydrogen and oxygen
      (ordinary hydrogen H1, deuterium H2,
      and tritium H3; ordinary oxygen O16,
      oxygen 17, and oxygen 18) plus  15
      known types of ions.  The molecules
      of a water mass tend to associate
      themselves as polymers rather than
      to .remain as discrete units.
      (See Figure 1)
     SUBSTANCE OF PURE WATER
                 TABLE 2

 EFFECTS OF TEMPERATURE ON DENSITY
        OF PURE WATER AND ICE*
Temperature (°C) Density
Water Ice**
-10
- 8
- 6
- 4
- 2
0
2
4
6
8
10
20
40
60
80
- 100
.99815
.99869
.99912
. 99945
.99970
.99987 	
.99997
1.00000
.99997
.99988
.99973
.99823
.99225
.98324
.97183
.95838
.9397
.9360
.9020
.9277
.9229
.9168










                   Fl(ur* 1
 *  Tabular values for density, etc., represent
    estimates by various workers rather than
    absolute values,  due to the variability of
    water.

**  Regular ice is known as "ice  I".  Four or
    more other "forms" of ice are known to
    exist (ice II, ice HI,  etc.), having densities
    at 1 atm. pressure ranging from 1.1595
    to 1.67.  These are of extremely restricted
    occurrence and may be ignored in most
    routine operations.
   2  Density

     a  Temperature and density:  Ice.
        Water is the only known substance
        in which the solid state will float
        on the liquid state.  (See Table 2)
           This ensures that ice usually
           forms on top of a body of water
           and tends to insulate the remain-
           ing water mass from further loss
           of heat. Did ice sink, there
           could be little or no carryover of
           aquatic life from season to season
           in the higher latitudes.  Frazil or
           needle ice forms cplloidally at a
           few thousandths of a degree
           below 0° c.   It is adhesive and
           may build up on submerged objects
           as "anchor ice", but it is still
           typical ice (ice I).
 1-2

-------
                                                      The Aquatic Environment
1) Seasonal increase in solar
   radiation annually warms
   surface waters in summer
   while other factors result in
   winter  cooling.  The density
   differences resulting establish
   two classic layers:  the epilimnion
   or surface layer, and the
   hypolimnion or lower layer, and
   in between is the thermocline
   or shear-plane.

2) While for certain theoretical
   purposes a "thermocline" is
   defined as a zone in which the
   temperature changes one
   degree centigrade for each
   meter of depth,  in practice,
   any transitional layer between
   two relatively stable masses
   of water of different temper-
   atures  may be regarded as a
   thermocline.

3) Obviously the greater the
   temperature differences
   between epilimnion and -
   hypolimnion and the sharper
   the  gradient in the thermocline,
   the  more stable will the
   situation be.

4) From information given above,
   it should be evident that while
   the  temperature of the
   hypolimnion rarely drops
   much below 4°  C, the
   epilimnion may range from
   0° C upward.

5) When epilimnion and hypolimnion
   achieve the same temperature,
   stratification no longer exists.
   The entire body of water behaves
   hydrologically as a unit,  and
   tends to assume uniform chemical
   and physical characteristics.
   Even a light breeze may then
   cause the entire body of water
   to circulate.  Such events are called
   overturns, and usually result in
   water quality changes of consider-
   able physical,  chemical, and
   biological significance.
        Mineral-rich water from the
        hypolimnion, for example,
        is mixed with oxygenated
        water from the epilimnion.
        This usually triggers a
        sudden growth or "bloom"
        of plankton organisms.

     6) When stratification is  present,
        however,  each layer behaves
        relatively independently, and
        significant quality differences
        may develop.

     7) Thermal stratification as
        described above has no
        reference to the size of the
        water mass; it is found in
        oceans and puddles.

  b  The relative densities of  the
     various isotopes of water
     influence its molecular com-
     position.  For example, the
     lighter O16 tends to go off
     first in the process of evaporation,
     leading to the relative enrichment
     of air by O16 and the enrichment
     of water by O17 and Olg.   This
     can lead to a measurably  higher
     O^g content in warmer climates.
     Also, the temperature of water
     in past geologic  ages can be
     closely estimated from the ratio
     °f Oig  in the carbonate of mollusc
     shells.

  c  Dissolved and/or suspended solids
     may also affect the density of
     natural water masses (see Table 3)

            TABLE 3
EFFECTS OF DISSOLVED SOLIDS
            ON DENSITY
Dissolved Solids
(Grams per liter)
0
1
2
3
10
35 (mean for sea water)
Density
(at 40 C)
1.00000
1.00085
1.00169
1.00251
1.00818
1.02822
                                                                              1-3

-------
The Aquatic Environment
      d Types of density stratification

        1) Density differences produce
           stratification which may be
           permanent, transient, or
           seasonal.

        2) Permanent stratification
           exists for example where
           there is a heavy mass of
           brine in the deeper areas of
           a basin which does not respond
           to seasonal or other changing
           conditions.

        3) Transient stratification may
           occur with the recurrent
           influx of tidal water in an
           estuary for example,  or the
           occasional influx of cold
           muddy water into a deep lake
           or reservoir.

        4) Seasonal stratification is
           typically thermal in nature,
           and involves the annual
           establishment of the epilimnion,
           hypolimnion, and thermocline
           as described above.

        5) Density stratification is not
           limited to two-layered systems;
           three,  four,  or even more
           layers may be encountered in
           larger bodies of water.

      e A "plunge line" (sometimes called
        "thermal line") may develop at
        the mouth of a stream.   Heavier
        water flowing into a lake or
        reservoir plunges below the
        lighter water mass of the epiliminium
        to flow along at a lower level.  Such
        a line is usually marked by an
        accumulation of floating  debris.

      f  Stratification may be modified
        or entirely suppressed in some
        cases when deemed expedient, by
        means of a simple air'lift.

      The viscosity of water is greater at
      lower temperatures (see Table 4).
        This is important not only in situations
        involving the control of flowing water
        as in a sand filter,  but also since
        overcoming resistance to flow gen-
        erates heat, it is significant in the
        heating of water by internal friction
        from wave and current action.
        Living organisms more easily support
        themselves in the more viscous1
        (and also denser) cold waters of the
        arctic than in the less viscous warm
        waters of the tropics.  (See Table 4).

                   TABLE 4

VISCOSITY OF WATER (In millipoises at 1 atm)
Temp, o c
-1 n
- 5
0
5
10
30
100
Dissolved solids in g/L
0
OC f\
21.4
17.94
15.19
13.10
8.00
2.84
5



18.1
15.3
13.2
8. 1
	
10



18.24
15.5
13.4
8.2
	
30



18.7
16.0
13.8
8.6
	
     4  Surface tension has biological as well
        as physical significance.  Organisms
        whose body surfaces cannot be wet by
        water can either ride on the surface
        film or in some instances may be
        "trapped" on the surface film  and be
        unable to re-enter the water.

     5  Heat or energy

        Incident solar  radiation is the  prime
        source of energy for virtually  all
        organic and most inorganic processes
        on earth.  For the earth as a whole,
        the total amount (of energy) received
        annually must  exactly balance  that
        lost by reflection and radiation into
        space if climatic and related con-
        ditions are to remain relatively
        constant over geologic time.
  1-4

-------
                                                            The Aquatic Environment
  a  For a given body of water,
     immediate sources of energy
     include in addition to solar
     irradiation:  terrestrial heat,
     transformation  of kinetic energy
     (wave and current action) to heat,
     chemical and biochemical
     reactions,  convection from the
     atmosphere, and condensation of
     water vapor.  -

  b  The proportion of light  reflected
     depends on the angle  of incidence,
     the temperature, color, and other
     qualities of the water; and the
     presence or absence  of films
     of lighter liquids such as oil.
     In general,  as the depth increases
     arithmetically, the light tends to
     decrease geometrically.  Blues,
     greens,  and yellows tend to
     penetrate most deeply while ultra
     violet, violets, and orange-reds
     are most quickly absorbed.  On
     the order of 90% of the  total
     illumination which penetrates the
     surface  film is absorbed in the
     first 10  meters of even the  clearest
     water, thus tending to warm the
     upper layers.

6 Water movements

  a  Waves or rhythmic movement

     1)  The best known  are traveling
         waves caused by wind.   These are
         effective only against objects near
         the surface.  They have  little
         effect on the movement of large
         masses of water.

     2)  Seiches

         Standing waves or seiches occur
         in lakes,  estuaries,  and other
         enclosed bodies of water, but are
         seldom large enough to be
         observed. An "internal wave or
         seich" is an oscillation in a
         submersed mass of water such
         as a hypolimnion, accompanied
         by compensating oscillation in the
         overlying water so that no
      significant change in surface
      level is detected.  Shifts in
      submerged water masses of
      this type can have severe effects
      on the biota  and also on human
      water uses where withdrawals
      are  confined to a given depth.
      Descriptions and analyses of
      many other types and sub-types
      of waves and wave-like movements
      may be found in the literature.

b  Tides

   1) Tides are the longest waves
      known, and are responsible  for
      the once or twice a day rythmic
      rise and fall of the ocean level
      on most shores around the world.

   2) While part and parcel of the
      same phenomenon,  it is often
      convenient to refer to the rise
      and fall of the water level as
      "tide, " and to the resulting
      currents as  "tidal currents. "

   3) Tides are basically caused by the
      attraction of the  sun and moon on
      water masses, large and small;
      however, it  is only in the oceans
      and possibly certain of the larger
      lakes that true tidal action has
      been demonstrated.  The patterns
      of tidal action are enormously
      complicated by local topography,
      interaction with seiches, and other
      factors.  The literature on tides
      is very large.

c  Currents (except tidal currents)
   are steady arythmic water movements
   which have had major study only in
   oceanography although they are
   most often observed in rivers and
   streams.   They are primarily
   concerned with the translocation of
   water masses.  They may be generated
   internally by virtue of density changes,
   or externally by wind or terrestrial
   topography.  Turbulence phenomena
   or eddy currents are largely respon-
   sible for lateral mixing in a current.
   These are of far more importance
   in the economy of a body of water than
   mere laminar flow.
                                                                                    1-5

-------
The Aquatic Environment
       d Coriolis force is a result of inter-
         action between the rotation of the
         earth, .and the movement of masses
         or bodies on the earth.  The net
         result is a slight tendency for moving
         objects to veer to the right in the
         northern hemisphere, and to the
         left in the southern hemisphere.
         While the result in fresh waters is
         usually negligible, it may be con-
         siderable in marine waters. For
         example, other factors permitting,
         there is a tendency in estuaries for
         fresh waters to move toward the
         ocean faster along the right bank,
         while salt tidal waters tend to
         intrude farther inland along the.
         left bank.  Effects are even more
         dramatic in the open oceans.

       e Langmuir circulation (or L. spirals)
         is the interlocking rotation of
         somewhat cylindrical masses of
         surface water under the influence
         of wind action.  The axes of the
         cylinders are parallel to the
         direction of the wind.
                               To somewhat oversimplify the
                               concept,  a series of adjoining cells
                               might be thought of as chains of
                               interlocking gears in which at every
                               other contact the teeth are rising
                               while at the alternate contacts, they
                               are sinking (Figure 2).

                               The result is elongated masses of
                               water rising or sinking together.
                               This produces the familiar "wind
                               rows" of foam, flotsam and jetsam,
                               or plankton often seen streaking
                               windblown lakes or oceans. Certain
                               zoo-plankton struggling to maintain
                               a position near the surface tend to
                               collect in the down current between
                               two Langmuir cells, causing such
                               an area to be called the "red dance",
                               while the clear upwelling water
                               between is the "blue dance".

                               This phenomenon may be important
                               in water or plankton sampling on
                               a windy day.
               b
                                      b
_WATER
SURFACE
             WATER
             RISING
WATER
SINKING
                  Figure 2,  Langmuire  Spirals
                  b.  Blue  dance,  water  rising, r.  Red
                  dance,  water  sinking, floating  or
                  swimming objects  concentrated.
  1-6

-------
                                                             The Aquatic Environment
6   The pH of pure water has been deter-
    mined between 5. 7 and 7. 01 by various
    workers. The latter value is most
    widely accepted at the present time.
    Natural waters of course vary widely
    according to circumstances.

The elements of hydrology mentioned
above represent a selection of some of
the more conspicuous physical factors
involved in working with  water quality.
Othsr items not  specifically mentioned
include:  molecular structure of waters,
interaction of water and radiation,
internal pressure, acoustical charac-
teristics,  pressure-volume-temperature
relationships, refractivity, luminescence,
color,  dielectrical characteristics and
phenomena,1 solubility, action and inter-
actions of gases, liquids and solids,
water vapor, phenomena of hydrostatics
and hydrodynamics in general.
REFERENCES

1  Buswell, A. M.  and Rodebush, W. H.
       Water. Sci. Am.  April 1956.

2  Dorsey, N. Ernest.  Properties of
       Ordinary Water - Substance.
       Reinhold Publ.  Corp.  New York.
       pp. 1-673.  1940.

3  Fowle, Frederick E.  Smithsonian
       Physical Tables.  Smithsonian
       Miscellaneous Collection, 71(1),
       7th revised ed.,  1929.

4  Hutcheson, George E.  A Treatise on
       Limnology.  John Wiley Company.
       1957.
                                                                                1-7

-------
                    Part 2:  The Aquatic Environment as an Ecosystem
 I  INTRODUCTION

 Part 1 introduced the lithosphere and the
 hydrosphere.  Part 2 will deal with certain
 general aspects of the biosphere, or the
 sphere of life on this earth, which photo-
 graphs from space have shown is a finite
 globe in infinite space.

 This is the habitat of man and the other
 organisms.  His relationships with the
 aquatic biosphere are our common concern.
II   THE BIOLOGICAL NATURE OF THE
    WORLD WE LIVE IN

 A  We can only imagine what this world
    must have been like before there was life.

 B  The world as we know it is largely shaped
    by the forces of life.

    1  Primitive forms of life created organic
       matter and established soil.

    2  Plants cover the lands and enormously
       influence the forces of erosion.

    3  The nature and rate of erosion affect
       the redistribution of materials
       (and mass) on the surface of the
       earth (topographic changes).

    4  Organisms tie up vast quantities of
       certain chemicals, such as carbon
       and oxygen.

    5  Respiration of plants and animals
       releases carbon dioxide to the
       atmosphere in influential quantities.

    6  CO  affects the heat transmission of
       the atmosphere.

 C  Organisms respond to and in turn affect
    their environment.  Man is one of the
    most influential.
Ill  ECOLOGY IS THE STUDY OF THE
    INTERRELATIONSHIPS BETWEEN   .
    ORGANISMS, AND BETWEEN ORGA-
    NISMS AND THEIR ENVIRONMENT.

 A The ecosystem is the basic functional
    unit of ecology.  Any area of nature that
    includes living organisms and nonliving
    substances interacting to produce an
    exchange of materials between the living
    and nonliving parts constitutes an
    ecosystem. (Odum,  1959)

    1  From a structural standpoint, it is
       convenient to recognize four
       constituents as composing an
       ecosystem (Figure 1).

       a  Abiotic NUTRIENT  MINERALS
          which are the physical stuff of
          which living protoplasm will be
          synthesized.

       b  Autotrophic (self-nourishing) or
          PRODUCER organisms.  These
          are largely the green plants
          (holophytes), but other minor
          groups must also  be included
          (See Figure 2). They assimilate
          the nutrient minerals, by the use
          of considerable energy, and combine
          them into living organic substance.

       c  Heterotrophic (other-nourishing)
          CONSUMERS (holozoic). are chiefly
          the animals.  They ingest (or eat)
          and digest organic matter,  releasing
          considerable energy in the process.

       d Heterotrophic REDUCERS are chiefly
          bacteria  and fungi that return
          complex organic compounds back to
          the original abiotic mineral condition,
          thereby releasing the remaining
          chemical energy.

    2  From a functional standpoint,  an
       ecosystem has two parts (Figure 2)
                                                                                    1-9

-------
The Aquatic Environment
                                CO NSUMERS
        PRO DUCERS
              REDUCERS
                                    NUTRIENT
                                    MINERALS
                                       FIGURE 1
     a  The autotrophic or producer
        organisms, which construct
        organic substance.

     b  The hete rotrophic or consumer and
        reducer organisms which destroy
        organic substance.

   3 Unless the autotrophic and hetero-
     trophic phases of the cycle approximate
     a dynamic equilibrium,  the ecosystem
     and the environment will change.
          «
   Each of these groups includes simple,
   single-celled representatives, persisting
   at lower levels  on the evolutionary stems
   of the higher organisms.  (Figure 2)

   1 These groups span the gaps between the
     higher kingdoms with a multitude of
     transitional forms.  They are collectively
     called the PROTISTA.
    2  Within the protista, two principal sub-
       groups can be defined on the basis of
       relative complexity of structure.

       a The bacteria and blue-green algae,
         lacking a nuclear membrane may
         be considered as the lower protista
         (or Monera).

       b The single- celled algae and
         protozoa are best referred to as
         the Higher Protista.

    Distributed throughout these groups will
    be found most of the traditional "phyla"
    of classic biology.
IV  FUNCTIONING OF THE ECOSYSTEM

 A A food chain is the transfer of food energy
    from plants through a series of organisms
    with repeated eating and being eaten.
    Food chains are not isolated sequences but
    are interconnected.
   1-10

-------
                                                             The Aquatic Environment
RELATIONSHIPS  BETWEEN  FREE  LIVING  AQUATIC  ORGANISMS

          Energy Flows from Left to Right, General Evolutionary Sequence is Upward
     PRODUCERS     |

 Organic Material Produced,
 Usually by Photosynthesis I
       CONSUMERS
   Organic Material Ingested or
          Consumed
       Digested Internally
     REDUCERS

Organic Material Reduced
by Extracellular Digestion
and Intracellular Metabolism
to Mineral Condition
     ENERGY STORED
                             ENERGY RELEASED
                                                             ENERGY RELEASED
Flowering Plants and
Gymnosperms
Club Mosses, Ferns
Liverworts, Mosses
Multicellular Green
Algae
Red Algae
Brown Algae
Arachnids
Insects
Crustaceans
Segmented Worms
Molluscs
Bryozoa
Rotifers
Roundworms
Flat worms
Mammals
Birds
Reptiles
Amphibians
Fishes
Primitive
Chordates
Echinoderms

Coelenterates
Sponges
Basidiomycetes

Fungi Imperfect!
Ascomycetes

Higher Phycomycetes
          DEVELOPMENT OF MULTICELLULAR OR COENOCYTIC STRUCTURE

                H  I  G" H  E  R       P  R  0  T   I~S  T A
  Unicellular Green Algae

  Diatoms


  Pigmented Flagellates
        Protozoa


Amoeboid          Cilliated
Flagellated,
 (non-pigmented)
                   Suctoria
 Lower


   Phycomycetes


   (Chytridiales, et. al. )
                      DEVELOPMENT OF A NUCLEAR MEMBRANE
                                    T  •
                 LOWER      PROTISTA
                                (or:   Monera)
  Blue Green Algae



         Phototropic Bacteria



                Chemotropic Bacteria
                                    Actinomycetes


                               Spirochaetes
                     Saprophytic
                     Bacterial
                     Types
  BI.ECO.pl. 2a. 1.69
                                 FIGURE 2
                                                                                1-11

-------
The Aquatic Environment
B  A food web is the interlocking pattern of
   food chains in an ecosystem.  (Figures  3, 4)
   In complex natural communities, organisms
   whose food is obtained by the same number
   of steps are said to belong to the same
   trophic (feeding) level.

C  Trophic Levels

   1  First - Green plants (producers)
      (Figure 5)  fix biochemical energy and
      svnthesize basic organic substances.
      This is  primary production .
   2  Second - Plant eating animals (herbivores)
      depend on the producer organisms for
      food.

   3  Third - Primary carnivores, animals
      which feed on herbivores.

   4  Fourth - Secondary carnivores feed on
      primary carnivores.

   5  Last -  Ultimate carnivores are the last
      or ultimate level of consumers.
D  Total Assimilation

   The amount of energy which flows through
   a trophic level is distributed between the
   production of biomass (living substance),
   and the demands of respiration (internal
   energy use by living organisms) in a ratio
   of approximately 1:10.
K  Trophic Structure of the Ecosystem

   The interaction of the food chain
   phenomena (with energy loss at each
   transfer) results in various communities
   having definite trophic  structure or energy
   levels.   Trophic structure may be
   measured and described either in terms
   of the standing crop per unit area or in
   terms of energy fixed per unit area per
   unit time at successive trophic levels.
   Trophic structure and function can be
   shown graphically by means of ecological
   pyramids (Figure 5).
        Figure 3. Diagram of the pond ecosystem. Basic units are as follows: I, abiotic substances—basic inorganic and
         organic compounds; IIA, producers—rooted vegetation; IIB, producers—phytoplankton; III-1A, primary consumers
         (herbivores)—bottom forms; Ill-IB, primary consumers (herbivores)-zooplankton;  III-2, secondary consumers (car-
         olvoTesh III-3, tertiary consumers (secondary carnivores); IV, decomposers—bacteria and fungi of decay.
 1-12

-------
                                                         _ The Aquatic Environment
        .••'!• • •• I inht"."
   .-••' /  /  \ YV"..
          1^ °_ .-'.  '. _
         ;     \   "•   '•.  '*•.
         •     «    v   »v   s             	
                              I

                       Death and decay


                        \     /    /

                            Worms  ' " Crabs'- :Vr^^jg^===
.      Mollusks           '
Figure 4. A  MARINE ECOSYSTEM (After Clark,  1954 and Patten,  1966)
                                                                   13

-------
 The Aquatic Environment

(a)
Decomposers I]
r1
Carnivores
Carnivores
| Herbivores
(Secondai
(Primary
\ Producers |


l
1

(c)
f1^"/ /Y /
fO/V //III
I/// y~ / 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1

1


frl
/ / / / 1
i i i i / it


-rl
 Figure 5.  HYPOTHETICAL PYRAMIDS of
 (a) Numbers of individuals, (b) Biomass, and
 (c) Energy (Shading Indicates Energy Loss).
V  BIOTIC COMMUNITIES

 A Plankton are the macroscopic and
   microscopic animals,  plants, bacteria,
   etc., floating free in the open water.
   Many clog filters, cause tastes, odors,
   and other troubles in water supplies.
   Eggs and  larvae of larger forms are
   often present.

   1  Phytoplankton are plant-like.  These
      are the dominant  producers of the
      waters, fresh and salt,  "the grass
      of the seas".

   2  Zooplankton are animal-like.
      Includes many different animal types,
      range in size from minute protozoa
      to gigantic marine jellyfishes.

B  Periphyton (or Aufwuchs) - The communities
   of microscopic organisms associated with
   submerged surfaces  of any type or depth.
    Includes bacteria, algae, protozoa,  and
    other microscopic animals, and often the
    young or embryonic stages of algae and
    other organisms that normally grow up
    to become a part of the benthos (see below).
    Many planktonic types will also adhere
    to surfaces as periphyton, and some
    typical periphyton may break off and
    be collected as plankters.

  C Benthos are the plants and animals living
    on, in, or closely associated with the
    bottom.  They include plants and
    invertebrates.

  D Nekton are the community of strong
    aggressive swimmers of the open  waters,
    often called pellagic.  Certain fishes,
    whales, and invertebrates such as
    shrimps and squids are included here.

  E The marsh community is based on larger
    ''higher" plants, floating and emergent.
    Both marine and freshwater marshes are
    areas of enormous biological production.
    Collectively known as "wetlands",  they
    bridge the gap between the waters  and the
    dry lands.

VI  PRODUCTIVITY

  A The biological resultant  of all physical
    and chemical factors in the quantity of
    life that may actually be present.  The
    ability to produce this "biomass" is
    often referred to as the "productivity"
    of a body of water.  This is neither good
    nor bad per se.  A water of low pro-
    ductivity is a "poor" water biologically,
    and also a relatively "pure" or "clean"
    water; hence desirable as a water  supply
    or a bathing beach.  A productive water
    on the other hand may be a nuisance to
    man or highly desirable.  It is a nuisance
    if foul odors and/or weed-chocked
    waterways result,  it is desirable if
    bumper crops of bass, catfish, or
    oysters are produced.  Open oceans have
    a low level of productivity in general.
   1-14

-------
                                                                   The Aquatic Environment
VII  PERSISTENT CHEMICALS IN THE
     ENVIRONMENT

  Increasingly complex manufacturing processes,
  coupled with rising industrialization, create
  greater amounts of exotic wastes potentially
  toxic to humans and aquatic life.

  They may also be teratogenic (toxicants
  responsible for changes in the embryo with
  resulting birth defects, ex., thalidomide),
  mutagenic (insults which produce mutations,
  ex., radiation), or carcinogenic (insults
  which induce cancer, ex., benz pyrenes)
  in effect.

  A Metals - current levels of cadmium,  lead,
     and other substances whose effects on
     humans and fish and wildlife are not fully
     understood constitute a mounting concern.
     Mercury pollution,  for example, has
     become a serious national problem, yet
     mercury has been present on earth since
     time immemorial.  More research is
     needed, yet we dare not relax our
     standards until definitive  answers have
     been provided.

  B Pesticides

     1  A pesticide and its metabolites may
        move  through  an ecosystem in many
        ways.  Hard (pesticides which are
        persistent, having a long half-life in
        the environment includes the organo-
        chlorines,  ex., DDT) pesticides
        ingested  or otherwise borne by the
        target species will stay in the
        environment, possibly to be recycled
        or concentrated further through the
        natural action of food chains  if the
        species is eaten.   Most of the volume
        of pesticides do not reach their target
        at all.

     2  Biological magnification

        Initially,  low levels of persistent
        pesticides in air, soil,  and water may
        be concentrated at every step up the
        food chain.  Minute aquatic organisms
        and scavengers, which screen water and
        bottom mud having pesticide  levels of a
        few parts per billion, can accumulate
      levels measured in parts per million—a
      thousandfold increase.  The sediments
      including fecal deposits are continuously
      recycled by the bottom animals.

      a Oysters, for instance, will con-
        centrate DDT 70, 000 times higher
        in their tissues than it's concentration
        in surrounding water.  They can
        also partially cleanse themselves
        in water free of DDT.

      b Fish feeding on lower organisms
        build up concentrations  in their
        visceral fat which may reach several
        thousand parts per million and levels
        in their edible flesh of hundreds of
        parts per million.

      c Larger animals, such as fish-eating
        gulls and other birds, can further
        concentrate the chemicals.  A survey
        on organochlorine residues in aquatic
        birds in the Canadian prairie provinces
        showed that California and ring-billed
        gulls were among the most contaminated.
        Since gulls breed in colonies,  breeding
        population changes can be detected and
        related to levels of chemical con-
        tamination.  Ecological research on
        colonial birds to monitor the effects
        of chemical pollution on the environ-
        ment is useful.

C  "Polychlorinated biphenyls" (PCB's).
   PCB's  are used in plasticizers, asphalt,
   ink, paper, and a host of other products.
   Action  has been taken to curtail their
   release to the environment, since their
   effects are similar to hard pesticides.

D  Other compounds which are toxic and
   accumulate in the ecosystem:

   1  Phalate esters - may interfere with
      pesticide analyses

   2  Benzapyrenes
                                                                                         1-15

-------
The Aquatic Environment
REFERENCES                                  5  Odum,  E.P.  Fundamentals of Ecology.
                                                    W. B. Saunders Company,
1  Clarke,  G. L.  Elements of Ecology.                Philadelphia and London.   1959.
     John Wiley & Sons,  New York.  1954.
                                               6  Patten, B.C.   Systems Ecology.
2  Cooke, W.B.   Trickling Filter Ecology.            Bio-Science.  16(9).   1966.
     Ecology 40(2):273-291.   1959.
                                               7  Whittaker, R.H.  New Concepts of
3  Hanson,  E.D.  Animal Diversity.                   Kingdoms.  Science 163:150-160.  1969.
     Prentice-Hall, Inc., New Jersey.  1964.

4  Hedgpeth, J.W.  Aspects of the Estuarine
     Ecosystem.  Amer. Fish.  Soc., Spec.
     Publ. No. 3.  1966.
 1-16

-------
                           Part 3.  The Freshwater Environment
 I  INTRODUCTION

 The freshwater environment as considered
 herein refers to those inland waters not
 detectably diluted by ocean waters, although
 the lower portions of rivers are subject to
 certain tidal flow effects.

 Certain atypical inland waters such as saline
 or alkaline lakes,  springs, etc.,  are  not
 treated, as the main objective here in typical
 inland water.

 All waters have certain basic biological cycles
 and types of  interactions most of which have
 already been presented, hence this outline
 will concentrate on aspects essentially
 peculiar, to fresh inland waters.
H  PRESENT WATER QUALITY AS A
   FUNCTION OF THE EVOLUTION OF
   FRESH WATERS

 A The history of a body of water determines
   its present condition.  Natural waters have
   evolved in the course of geologic time
   into what we know today.

 B Streams

   In the course of their evolution,  streams
   in'general pass through  four stages of
   development which may  be called:  birth,
   youth, maturity, and old age.

   These terms or conditions may be
   employed or considered in two contexts:
   temporal, or spatial.  In terms of geologic
   time,  a given point in a  stream may pass
   through each of the stages described below
   or:  at any given time, these various stages
   of development can be loosely identified
   in successive reaches of a stream traveling
   from its headwaters to base level in ocean
   or major lake.
1  Establishment or birth.  This
   might be a "dry run" or headwater
   stream-bed, before it had eroded
   down to the level of ground water.

   During periods of run-off after a
   rain or snow-me It,  such a  gulley
   would have a flow of water  which
   might range from torrential to a
   mere trickle.  Erosion may proceed
   rapidly as there is no permanent
   aquatic flora or fauna to  stabilize
   streambed materials.  On the other
   hand,  terrestrial grass or  forest
   growth may  retard erosion.  When
   the  run-off has passed, however,
   the  "streambed" is  dry.

2  Youthful streams.   When the
   streambed is eroded below the
   ground water level, spring or
   seepage water enters,  and  the
   stream becomes permanent.  An
   aquatic flora and fauna develops
   and water flows the year round.
   Yout-hful streams typically have a
   relatively steep gradient, rocky beds,
   with rapids, falls, and small pools.

3  Mature streams.  Mature streams
   have wide valleys, a developed
   flood plain,  are deeper,  more
   turbid, and usually  have  warmer
   water, sand, rnud,  silt,  or clay
   bottom materials which shift with
   increase in flow.  In their more
   favorable reaches,  streams in this
   condition are at a peak of biological
   productivity.  Gradients  are moderate,
   riffles or rapids are often separated
   by long pools.

4  In old age,  streams have approached
   geologic base level, usually the
   ocean.  During flood stage  they scour
   their beds and deposit materials on
   the  flood plain which may be very
   broad and flat.  During normal flow
   the  channel is refilled and many
   shifting bars are developed.
                                                                                       1-17

-------
The A quatic Environment
         (Under the influence of man this
         pattern may be broken up, or
         temporarily interrupted.  Thus an
         essentially "youthful" stream might
         take on some  of the characteristics
         of a "mature" stream following soil
         erosion, drganic enrichment, and
         increased surface runoff.  Correction
         of these conditions might likewise be
         followed by at least a partial reversion
         to the "original" condition).

C  Lakes and Reservoirs

   Geological factors which significantly
   affect the nature of  either a stream or
   lake include the following:

   1  The geographical location of the
      drainage basin or watershed.

   2  The size and shape of the drainage
      basin.

   3  The general topography,  i.e.,
      mountainous or plains.

   4  The character of the bedrocks and
      soils.

   5  The character, amount, annual
      distribution, and rate of precipitation.

   6  The natural vegetative cover  of the
      land, is, of course,  responsive to and
      responsible for many  of the above
      factors and is also severely subject
      to the whims of civilization.  This
      is one of the major factors determining
      run-off versus soil absorption, etc.

D  Lakes have a developmental history which
   somewhat parallels  that of  streams.   This
   process is often referred to as natural
   eutrophicatibn.

   1  The methods of formation vary greatly,
      but all influence  the character and
      subsequent history of the lake.

      In glaciated areas, for example, a
      huge block of ice may have been covered
      with till.  The  glacier retreated, the
      ice melted, and the resulting hole
1-18
   became a lake.  Or, the glacier may
   actually scoop out a hole.   Landslides
   may dam valleys, extinct volcanoes may
   collapse, etc., etc.

2  Maturing or natural eutrophication of
   lakes.

   a If not already present shoal areas
     are  developed through erosion
     and  deposition of the shore material
     by wave action and undertow.

   b Currents produce bars across bays
     and  thus cut off irregular areas.

   c Silt  brought in by tributary streams
     settles out in the quiet lake water

   d Algae grow attached to surfaces,
     and  floating free as plankton.  Dead
     organic matter begins to accumulate
     on the bottom.

   e Rooted aquatic plants grow on
     shoals and bars, and in doing so
     cut  off bays and  contribute to the
     filling of the lake.

   f Dissolved carbonates and other
     materials are precipitated in the
     deeper portions  of the lake in part
     through the action of plants.

   g When filling is well advanced,
     mats of sphagnum moss may extend
     outward from the shore. These
     mats are followed by sedges and
     grasses which finally convert the
     lake into a marsh.

3  Extinction of lakes.  After lakes reach
   maturity,  their progress toward
   filling  up is accelerated.  They become
   extinct through:

   a The downcutting of the outlet.

   b Filling with detritus eroded from
     the  shores  or brought in by
     tributary streams.

   c Filling by the accumulation of the
     remains of vegetable materials
     growing in the lake itself.
     (Often two or three processes may
     act  concurrently)

-------
                                                                 The Aquatic Environment
III  PRODUCTIVITY IN FRESH WATERS

 A Fresh waters in general and under
    natural conditions by definition have a
    lesser supply of dissolved substances
    than marine waters, and thus a lesser
    basic potential for the growth of aquatic
    organisms.  By the same token, they
    may be said to be more sensitive to the
    addition of extraneous materials
    (pollutants, nutrients, etc.) The
    following notes are directed toward
    natural geological and other environ-
    mental factors as they affect the
    productivity of fresh waters.

 B Factors Affecting Stream Productivity
    (See Table 1)

                 TABLE 1

     EFFECT OF SUBSTRATE ON STREAM
                PRODUCTIVITY*

     (The productivity of sand bottoms is
     taken as 1)
         Bottom Material
  Sand
  Marl
  Fine Gravel
  Gravel and silt
  Coarse gravel
  Moss on fine gravel
  Fissidens (moss) on  coarse
    ; .  gravel
  Ranunculus (water buttercup)
  Watercress
  Anacharis (waterweed)
Relative
Productivity
     1
     6
     9
    14
    32
    89
   111

   194
   301
   452
  *Selected from Tarzwell 1937

     To be productive of aquatic life,  a
     stream must provide adequate nutrients,
     light, a  suitable temperature, and time
     for growth to take place.

     1  Youthful streams, especially on rock
       or sand substrates are low in essential
       nutrients. Temperatures in moun-
       tainous regions  are usually low, and
       due to the steep gradient, time for
       growth is short.  Although ample
       light is available,  growth of true
       plankton is thus greatly limited.
       2  As the stream flows toward a more
         "mature" condition, nutrients tend to
         accumulate, and gradient diminishes
         and so time of flow increases, tem-
         perature tends to increase, and
         plankton flourish.

         Should a heavy load of inert silt
         develop on the other hand, the
         turbidity would reduce the light
         penetration and consequently the
         general plankton production would
         diminish.

       3  As the stream approaches base level
         (old age) and the time available for
         plankton growth increases, the
         balance between turbidity, nutrient
         levels, and temperature and other
         seasonal conditions, determines the
         overall productivity.

  C Factors Affecting the Productivity of
    lakes (See Table  2)

       1  The size,  shape, and depth of the
         lake basin.  Shallow water is more
         productive  than deeper water since
          more light  will reach the bottom to
          stimulate rooted plant growth.  As
          a corollary, lakes with more shore-
          line, having more shallow water,
          are in general more productive.
          Broad shallow lakes and reservoirs
          have the greatest production potential
          (and hence  should be avoided for
          water supplies).

                TABLE 2

        EFFECT OF SUBSTRATE
       ON LAKE PRODUCTIVITY *

(The productivity of sand bottoms is taken as 1)
Bottom Material
Sand
Pebbles
Clay
Flat rubble
Block rubble
Shelving rock
Relative Productivity
1
4
8
9
11
77
                   * Selected from Tarzwell 1937
                                                                                       1-19

-------
The'Aquatic Environment
   2  Hard waters are generally more
      productive than soft waters as there
      are more plant nutrient minerals
      available.  This is often greatly in-
      fluenced by the character of the soil
      and rocks in the watershed and the
      quality and quantity of ground water
      entering the lake.  In general, pH
      ranges of 6. 8 to 8.2 appear to be
      most productive.

   3  Turbidity reduces productivity as
      light penetration is reduced.

   4  The presence or absence of thermal
      stratification with its semi-annual
      turnovers affects productivity by
      distributing nutrients throughout the
      water mass.

   5  Climate,  temperature,  prevalence of
      ice and snow, are also of course
      important.

   Factors Affecting the Productivity of
   Reservoirs

   1  The productivity of reservoirs is
      governed by much the same principles
      as that of lakes,  with the difference
      that the water level is much  more
      under the control of man.  Fluctuations
      in water level can be used to de-
      liberately increase or decrease
      productivity.  This can be demonstrated
      by a comparison of the  TVA  reservoirs
      which practice a summer drawdown
      with some of those in the west where
      a winter drawdown is the rule.

   2  The level at which water is removed
      from a reservoir is important to the
      productivity of the stream below.
      The hypolimnion may be anaerobic
      while the epilimnion is  aerobic, for
      example, or the  epilimnion is poor in
      nutrients while the hypolimnion is
      relatively rich.

   3  Reservoir discharges also profoundly
      affect  the DO, temperature,  and
      turbidity in the stream below a dam.
      Too much fluctuation in flow  may
      permit sections of the stream to dry,
      or provide inadequate dilution for
      toxic waste.
IV  CULTURAL EUTROPHICATION

 A  The general processes of natural
    eutrophication, or natural enrichment
    and productivity have been briefly out-
    lined above.

 B  When the activities of man speed up
    these enrichment processes by intro-
    ducing unnatural quantities of nutrients
    (sewage, etc.) the result is often called
 ,   cultural eutrophication.  This term is
    often extended beyond its original usage
    to include the enrichment (pollution) of
    streams, estuaries, and even oceans, as
    well as lakes.
V CLASSIFICATION OF LAKES AND
   RESERVOIRS

A The productivity of lakes and impound-
   ments is such a conspicuous feature that
   it is often used as a convenient means of
   classification.

   1  Oligotrophic lakes are the younger,
      less productive lakes, which are deep,
      have clear water, and usually support
      Salmonoid fishes in their deeper waters.

   2  Eutrophic lakes  are more mature,
      more turbid,  and richer.  They are
      usually shallower.  They are richer
      in  dissolved solids; N,  P, and Ca are
      abundant. Plankton is abundant and
      there is often a rich bottom fauna.

   3  Dystrophic lakes, such as bog lakes,
      are low in Ph, water yellow to brown,
      dissolved solids, N,  P,  and Ca scanty
      but humic materials abundant, bottom
      fauna and plankton poor,  and fish
      species are limited.

B Reservoirs may also be classified as
   storage, and run of the river.

   1  Storage reservoirs have a large
      volume in relation to their inflow.

   2  Run of the river  reservoirs have a
      large flow-through in relation to their
      storage value.
1-20

-------
                                                                The Aquatic Environment
    According to location,  lakes and
    reservoirs may be classified as polar,
    temperate, or tropical.  Differences in
    climatic and geographic conditions
    result in differences in their biology.
VI  SUMMARY

 A A body of water such as a lake, stream,
    or estuary represents an intricately
    balanced system in a state of dynamic
    equilibrium.  Modification imposed at
    one point in the system automatically
    results in compensatory adjustments at
    associated points.

 B The more thorough our knowledge of the
    entire system,  the better we can judge
    where to impose control measures to
    achieve a desired result.
6  Tarzwell,  Clarence M.  Experimental
      Evidence on the Value of Trout 1937
      Stream Improvement in Michigan.
      American Fisheries'Society Trans.
      66:177-187.  1936.

7  U.S.  Dept.  of Health,  Education, and
      Welfare.  Public Health Service.
      Algae and Metropolitan Wastes.
      Transactions of a seminar held
      April 27-29,  1960 at the Robert A.
      Taft Sanitary Engineering Center.
      Cincinnati, OH.  No. SECTRW61-3.

8  Ward and Whipple.  Fresh Water
      Biology.  (Introduction).  John
      Wiley Company.  1918.
 REFERENCES

 1  Chamberlin,  Thomas C.  and Salisburg,
       Rollin P.  Geological Processes and
       Their Results.  Geology 1: pp i-xix,
       and 1-654. Henry Holt and Company.
       New York. 1904.

 2  Frey,  David  G.  Limnology in North
       America.   Univ.  Wise. Press.  1963.

 3  Hutcheson, George E. A Treatise on
       Limnology Vol. I  Geography, Physics
      . and Chemistry.  1957. Vol. II.
       Introduction to Lake Biology and the
       Limnoplankton.  1115  pp.  1967.
       John Wiley Co.

 4  Hynes, H. B.N.  The Ecology of Running
       Waters.  Univ. Toronto Press.
       555 pp.  1970.

 5  Ruttner,  Franz.  Fundamentals of
       Limnology.  University of Toronto
       Press,  pp.  1-242.  1953.
                                                                                     1-21

-------
       Part 4.  The Marine Environment and its Role in the Total Aquatic Environment
I  INTRODUCTION

A  The marine environment is arbitrarily
   defined as the water mass extending
   beyond the continental land masses,
   including the plants and animals harbored
   therein.   This water mass is large and
   deep, covering about 70 percent of the
   eairth's surface  and being as deep as
   7 miles.  The salt  content averages
   about 35 parts per  thousand.  Life extends
   to all depths.

B  The general nature of the water cycle on
   earth is well known.  Because the  largest
   portion of the surface area of the earth
   is covered with  water,  roughly 70  percent
   of the earth's rainfall is on the seas.
   (Figure 1)
                  1.  THE WATER CYCLE
   Since roughly one third of the
   rain which falls on the land is again
   recycled through the  atmosphere
   (see Figure 1 again), the total amount
   of water washing over the earth's surface
   is significantly greater than one third of
   the  total world rainfall.   It  is thus not
   surprising to note that the rivers which
   finally empty into the sea carry a
   disproportionate burden of dissolved and
   suspended solids picked up  from the  land.
   The chemical composition of this burden
   depends on the composition  of the rocks
   and soils through which the  river flows,
   the proximity of an ocean, the  direction
   of prevailing winds,  and other  factors.
   This is the substance of geological erosion.
   (Table 1)
                  TABLE 1

   PERCENTAGE COMPOSITION OF THE MAJOR IONS
        OF TWO STREAMS AND SEA WATER

 (Data from Clark, F.W..  1924, "The Composition of River
 and Lake Waters of the United States", U.S. Geol. Surv.,
 Prof. Paper No. 135; Harvey, H.W.,  1957, "The Chemistry
 and Fertility of Sea Waters", Cambridge University  Press,
 Cambridge)
Ion
Na
K
Ca
Mg
Cl
S04
C03
Delaware River
at
Lambertville, N.J.
6.70
1.46
17.49
4.81
4.23
17.49
32.95
Rio Grande
at
Laredo, Texas
14.78
.85
13.73
3.03
21.65
30. 10
11.55
Sea Water
30.4
1. 1
1. 16
3.7
55.2
7.7
"HCOq 0.35
 C  For this presentation, the marine
    environment will be (1) described using
    an ecological approach, (2) characterized
    ecologically by comparing it with fresh-
    water and estuarine environments, and
    (3) considered as a functional ecological
    system (ecosystem).
H   FRESHWATER,  ESTUARINE, AND
    MARINE ENVIRONMENTS

 Distinct differences are found in physical,
 chemical, and biotic factors in going from
 a freshwater to an oceanic environment.
 In general, environmental factors are more
 constant in freshwater (rivers) and oceanic
 environments than in the highly variable
 and harsh environments of estuarine and
 coastal waters.  (Figure 2)

 A  Physical and Chemical Factors

    Rivers, estuaries,  and oceans are
    compared in Figure 2 with reference to
    the relative instability (or variation) of
    several important parameters.  In the
    oceans, it will be noted, very little change
    occurs in any parameter.  In rivers, while
    "salinity" (usually referred to as "dissolved
    solids") and temperature (accepting normal
    seasonal variations) change little, the other
    four parameters vary considerably.  In
    estuaries, they all  change.
                                     1-23

-------
  The Aquatic Environment
Type of environment
and general direction
 of water movement
                                     Degree of instability
Salinity
Temperature
 Water
elevation
Vertical
 strati-
 fication
 Avail-
 ability
   of
nutrients
(degree)
Turbidity
 Riverine
    Oceanic
       Figure2 .  RELATIVE VALUES OF VARIOUS PHYSICAL AND CHEMICAL FACTORS
                  FOR RIVER, ESTUARINE, AND OCEANIC ENVIRONMENTS
 B  Biotic Factors

    1  A complex of physical and chemical
       factors determine the biotic composi-
       tion of an environment.  In general,
       the number of species in a rigorous,
       highly variable  environment tends to be
       less than the number in a more stable
       environment (Hedgpeth,  1966).

    2  The dominant animal species (in
       terms of total biomass) which occur
       in estuaries are often transient,
       spending only a part of their lives in
       the estuaries.  This results in better
       utilization of a rich environment.
                           C  Zones of the Sea

                              The nearshore environment is often
                              classified in relation to tide level and
                              water depth.  The nearshore and offshore
                              oceanic regions together,  are  often
                              classified with reference to light penetra-
                              tion and water depth.  (Figure 3)

                              1  Neritic - Relatively shallow-water
                                zone which extends from the high-
                                tide mark to the edge of the
                                continental shelf.
   1-24

-------
                                                            The Aquatic Environment
                                  MARINE ECOLOGY
                                        P £  L A  G I C-
     '>N£*»
     Supro-
     Bttorol
           BENTHIC (Bottom)
            Stipro-llltorol
            Littoral (lAUrtldgl)
            Sutlillorol
              Inntr
              0»l«r
            Bolltyol
            Abyliol
            Ho*jl
                        FIGURE 3—Classification of marine environments
a.  Stability of physical factors is
   intermediate between estuarine
   and oceanic environments.

b  Phytoplankters are the dominant
   producers but in some locations
   attached algae are also important
   as producers.

c  The animal consumers are
   zooplankton, nekton, and benthic
   forms.

Oceanic  - The region of the ocean
beyond the continental shelf.  Divided
into three parts, all relatively
poorly populated compared to the
neritic zone.

a  Euphotic zone - Waters  into which
   sunlight penetrates (often to the
   bottom in the neritic zone).  The
   zone of primary productivity often
   extends to 600 feet below the surface.
   1) Physical factors fluctuate
      less than in the neritic zone.

   2) Producers are the phyto-
      plankton and consumers are
      the zooplankton and nekton.

b  Bathyal zone - From the bottom
   of the euphotic zone to about
   2000 meters.

   1) Physical factors relatively
      constant but light is absent.

   2) Producers are absent and
      consumers are scarce.

c  Abyssal zone   All the sea below
   the bathyal zone.

   1) Physical factors more con-
      stant than in bathyal zone.

   2) Producers absent and consumers
     even less abundant than in the
     bathyal  zone.
                                  1-25

-------
The Aquatic Environment
   SEA WATER AND THE BODY FLUIDS

A  Sea water is a remarkably suitable
   environment for living cells, as it
   contains all of the chemical elements
   essential to the growth and maintenance
   of plants  and animals.  The ratio and
   often the  concentration of the major
   salts of sea water are strikingly similar
   in the cytoplasm  and body fluids of
   marine organisms.   This similarity is
   also evident,  although modified somewhat
   in the body fluids of fresh  water  and
   terrestrial animals.  For example,
   sterile sea water may be used in
   emergencies as a substitute for blood
   plasma in man.

B  Since  marine organisms have an internal
   salt content similar to that of their
   surrounding medium (isotonic condition)
   osmoregulation poses no problem.  On the
   other  hand, fresh water organisms are
   hypertonic (osmotic pressure of body
   fluids is higher than  that of the surround-
   ing water).  Hence, fresh water animals
   must constantly expend more energy to
   keep water out (i. e., high osmotic
   pressure fluids contain more salts, the
   action being then to dilute this concen-
   tration with more water).

   1 Generally, marine invertebrates are
     narrowly poikilosmotic, i.e.,  the salt
     concentration of the body fluids changes
     withthat of the external  medium.  This
     has special significance in estuarine
     situations where salt concentrations
     of the  water often vary considerably
     in short periods of time.

   2 Marine bony fish (teleosts) have lower
     salt content internally than the external
     environment (hypotonic). In order to
     prevent dehydration,  water is ingested
     and salts are excreted through special
     cells in the gills.
IV FACTORS AFFECTING THE DISTRI-
   BUTION OF MARINE AND ESTUARINE
   ORGANISMS

 A Salinity.  Salinity is the single most
   constant and controlling factor in the
   marine environment, probably followed
   by temperature.  It ranges around
   35, 000 mg. per liter,  or "35 parts per
   thousand" (symbol: 35%0 ) in the language
   of the oceanographer.   While variations
   in the open ocean are relatively small,
   salinity decreases rapidly as one
   approaches shore and proceeds through
   the estuary and up into fresh water with
   a salinity of "0 %„ (see Figure  2)

 B Salinity and temperature as limiting
   factors in ecological distribution.

   1  Organisms  differ in the salinities
      and temperatures in which they
      prefer to live, and in the variabilities
      of these  parameters which they can
      t-olerate . These preferences and
      tolerances often change with successive
      life history  stages,  and in turn often
      dictate where  the organisms live:
      their "distribution. "

   2  These requirements or preferences
      often lead to extensive migrations
      of various species for breeding,
      feeding,  and growing stages.  One
      very important result of this is that
      an estuarine environment is an
      absolute necessity for over half of
      all coastal commercial and sport
      related species of fishes and invertebrates,
      for either all or certain portions of their
      life histories. (Part V, figure 8)
      The Greek word roots "eury"
      (meaning wide) and "steno" (meaning
      narrow) are customarily combined
      with such words as "haline" for salt,
      and "thermal" for temperature, to
      give us "euryhaline" as an adjective
      to characterize an organism  able to
      tolerate a wide range of salinity, for
      example; or "stenothermal" meaning
      one which cannot stand much change
      in temperature. "Meso-" is a prefix
      indicating an intermediate capacity.
  1-26

-------
                                                               The Aquatic Environment
C  Marine, estuarine,  and fresh water
   organisms.  (See Figure 4)
Fresh Water
Stenohaline
Marine
Stenohaline
                  Salinity
        ca.:35
 Figure 4.  Salinity Tol»r«»ce of Organisms

   1  Offshore marine organisms are, in
      general, both Stenohaline and
      stenothermal unless, as noted above,
      they have certain life history require-
      ments for estuarine conditions.

   2  Fresh water organisms are also
      Stenohaline, and (except for seasonal
      adaptation)  meso- or stenothermal.
      (Figure 2)

   3  Indigenous or native estuarine species
      that normally spend their entire lives
      in the estuary are relatively few in
      number.  (See Figure 5).  They are
      generally meso- or euryhaline and
      mesor or euryt.hermal..
              10
                   Salinity
                           25   30   35
     Figure 5.  DISTRIBUTION OF
                ORGANISMS IN AN ESTUARY
        a  Euryhaline, freshwater
        b  Indigenous,  estuarine, (mesohaline)
        c  Euryhaline, marine
   4   Some well known and interesting
       examples of migratory species which
       change their environmental preferences
       with the life history  stage include the
       shrimp (mentioned above), striped bass,
       many herrings and relatives, the salmons,
       and many others.  None are more
       dramatic than the salmon hordes which
       lay their eggs in freshwater streams,
       migrate far out to sea to feed and grow,
       then return to the stream where they
       hatched to lay their own eggs before
       dying.

    5  Among euryhaline animals landlocked
      (trapped), populations living in lowered
      salinities often have a smaller maximum
      size than individuals of the same species
      living in more saline  waters.  For
      example, the lamprey (Petromyzon
      marinus)  attains a length of 30  - 36"
      in the sea, while in the Great  Lakes
      the length is 18 - 24".

      Usually the larvae of  aquatic organisms
      are more sensitive to changes in
      salinity than are the adults.  This
      characteristic both limits and dictates
      the distribution and size of populations.

D  The effects of tides on organisms.

   1  Tidal fluctuations probably subject
      the benthic or intertidal populations
      to the most extreme and rapid variations
      of environmental stress encountered
      in any aquatic habitat.  Highly specialized
      communities have developed in this
      zone,  some adapted to the rocky surf
      zones of the open coast, others to the
      muddy inlets of protected estuaries.
      Tidal reaches of fresh water rivers,
      sandy beaches,  coral  reefs and
      mangrove swamps in the tropics; all
      have their own floras  and faunas. All
      must emerge and flourish when whatever
      wate'r there is rises  and covers or
      tears at them,  all must collapse or
      retract to endure drying,  blazing
      tropical sun, or freezing arctic ice
      during the low tide interval. Such a
      community is depicted in Figure  6.
                                                                                      1-27

-------
The Aquatic Environment
     SNAILS

 o   Littorina neritoides
 0   L. rudis
 0   L. obtusata
 (•j)   L. littorea

     BARNACLES

 ®   Chthamalus stellatus
 ®   Balanus balanoides
 fy   B. perforatus
g$W
fc/r
>  c>p *"F"?/JS:: V'V1 •'•;-;'r-^-'-'v^'c
?Cif^fe?S' '$f K'|SiV-1 "
                                       Figure g
            Zonation of plants, snails, and barnacles on a rocky shore. While
            this diagram is based on the situation on the southwest coast of
            England, the general idea of zonation may be applied to any temper-
            ate rocky ocean shore,  though the species will differ.  The gray
            zone consists largely of lichens.  At the left is the zonation of rocks
            with exposure too extreme to support algae; at the right, on a less
            exposed situation, the animals are mostly obscured by the algae.
            Figures at the right hand margin  refer to the percent of time that
            the zone is exposed to the air, i. e.,  the time that the tide  is out.
            Three major zones can be  recognized: the Littorina zone (above the
            gray zone); the Balanoid zone (between the gray zone and the
            laminarias);  and the Laminaria zone.  a. Pelvetia  canaliculata;
            b. Fucus spiralis; c. Ascophyllum nodosum; d. Fucus serratus;
            e. Laminaria digitata. (Based on Stephenson)
    28

-------
                                                               The Aquatic Environment
V  FACTORS AFFECTING THE                   REFERENCES
   PRODUCTIVITY OF THE MARINE
   ENVIRONMENT                              1  Harvey,  H.  W.  The Chemistry and
                                                      Fertility of Sea Water (2nd Ed.).
A  The sea is in continuous circulation.  With-           Cambridge Univ. Press, New  York.
   out circulation, nutrients of the ocean would          234 pp.   1957.
   eventually become a part of the bottom and
   biological production would cease. Generally,  2  Hedgpeth, J. W.  (Ed.).  Treatise on
   in all oceans there exists a warm surface             Marine Ecology and Paleoecology.
   layer which overlies the colder water and             Vol. I.  Ecology Mem.  67 Geol.
   forms a two-layer system of persistent               Soc. Amer.,  New York.  1296pp.
   Stability.  Nutrient concentration is usually           1957.
   greatest in the lower zone. Wherever a
   mixing or disturbance of these two layers       3  Hill, M. N. (Ed.).  The Sea. Vol. II.
   occurs biological production is greatest.              The Composition of Sea Water
                                                      Comparative and Descriptive
B  The estuaries are also a mixing  zone of               Oceanography.  Interscience Publs.
   enormous importance.  Here the fertility             John Wiley & Sons,  New York.
   washed off the land is mingled with the                554 pp.   1963.
   nutrient capacity of seawater,  and many
   of the would's most productive waters          4  Moore, H.  B. Marine Ecology..  John
   result.                                             Wiley & Sons,  Inc., New York.
                                                      493 pp.   1958.
C  When man adds his cultural contributions
   of sewage, fertilizer, silt or toxic waste,       5  Reid, G. K.  Ecology of Inland Waters
   it is no wonder that the dynamic  equilibrium          and Estuaries.  Reinhold Publ.
   of the ages is rudely upset, and the                   Corp. New York.  375pp.  1961.
   environmentalist cries,  "See what man
   hath wrought"!                                6  Sverdrup, Johnson, and Fleming.
                                                      The Oceans.  Prentice-Hall, Inc.,
                                                      New York.  1087 pp.   1942.
ACKNOWLEDGEMENT:

This outline contains celected material
from other outlines prepared by C.  M.
Tarzwell, Charles L. Brown, Jr.,
C. G. Gunnerson,  W. Lee Trent, W. B.
Cooke, B. H. Ketchum,  J. K. McNulty,
J.  L.-Taylor, R. M. Sinclair, and others.
                                                                                   1-29

-------
                                       Part 5:   Wetlands
 I  INTRODUCTION

 A Broadly defined, wetlands are areas
    which are "to wet to plough but  too
    thick to flow."  The soil tends to be
    saturated with water,  salt or fresh,
    and numerous  channels or ponds of
    shallow or open water  are common.
    Due to ecological features too numerous
    and variable to list here,  they comprise
    in general a rigorous (highly stressed)
    habitat,  occupied by a  small relatively
    specialized indigenous  (native) flora
    and fauna.

 B They are prodigiously productive
    however, and many constitute an
    absolutely essential habitat for some
    portion of the life history  of animal
    forms generally recognized as residents
    of other habitats (Figure 8).  This is
    particularly true of tidal marshes as
    mentioned below.

 C Wetlands in toto comprise a remarkably
    large proportion of the earth1 s surface,
    and the total organic carbon bound in
    their  mass constitutes  an  enormous
    sink of energy.

 D Since our main concern here is with
    the "aquatic"  environment, primary
    emphasis will be directed  toward a
    description of wetlands as the transitional
    zone between the waters and the  land, and
    how their desecration by human  culture
    spreads degradation in  both directions..
II   TIDAL MARSHES AND THE ESTUARY

 A  "There is no other case in nature, save
    in the coral reefs, where the adjustment
    of organic relations to physical condition
    is seen in such a beautiful way as the
    balance between the growing marshes
    and the tidal streams by which they are
    at once nourished and worn away. "
    (Shaler, 1886)
      B  Estuarine pollution studies are usually
         devoted to the dynamics of the circulating
         water, its chemical,  physical,  and
         biological parameters, bottom deposits, etc.

      C  It is easy to overlook the intimate  relation-
         ships which exist between the bordering
         marshland, the moving waters, the tidal
         flats,  subtidal deposition, and seston
         whether of local, oceanic, or riverine
         origin.

      D  The tidal marsh (some inland  areas also
         have salt marshes) is  generally considered
         to be the marginal areas of estuaries and
         coasts in the  intertidal zone, which are
         dominated by emergent vegetation.  They
         generally extend inland to the farthest
         point reached by the spring tides, where
         they merge into freshwater swamps and
         marshes (Figure 1).  They may range in
         width from nonexistent on rocky coasts to
         many kilometers.
Figure!. Zonatlon In a positive New England eatuary. 1, Spring tide level. 3. Mean high tide.
J. Mean low tide, 4. Bog hole. 5. Ice cleavagt pool, 6. Chunk ot Spartlna lurt deposited by Ice,
7. Organic oote »lth Msoclated community, 8. eelgtaaa (Zoalcra). 9. Ribbed rmusele (modlotus)-
clam Imya) • mud inall (Nasnal community. 10. Sea lettuce (UlviO
                                                                                        1-31

-------
  The Aquatic Environment
III  MARSH ORIGINS AND STRUCTURES

 A In general, marsh substrates are high in
    organic content,  relatively low in minerals
    and trace elements.  The upper layers
    bound together with living roots called
    turf,  underlaid by more compacted peat
    type material.

    1  Rising or eroding  coastlines may
       expose peat from ancient marsh
       growth to wave action which cuts
       .into the  soft peat rapidly (Figure 2).
        Terrestrial turf
        Salt ma»h peat
        Substrate

Such banks are likely to be cliff-like,
and are often undercut.  Chunks of
peat are often found lying about on
harder substrate below high tide line.
If face of cliff is well above high water,
overlying vegetation is likely to be
typically terrestrial of the area.
Marsh type vegetation is probably
absent.

Low lying deltaic,  or sinking coast-
lines,  or those with low energy wave
action are likely to have active marsh
formation in progress. Sand dunes
are also common in such areas
(Figure 3).  General coastal
configuration is a factor.
       Figure 2. Diagrammatic section of eroding peat cliff
                                                                      MMW -m IJ0018C
                                               Figure 3
                        Development of a Massachusetts Marsh since 1300 BC, Involving an
                        18 foot rise In water level. Shaded area Indicates sand dunes.  Note
                        meandering marsh tidal drainage.  A: 1300 BC, B: 1950 AD.
   1-32

-------
                                                              The Aquatic Environment
Rugged or precipitous coasts or
slowly rising coasts, typically
exhibit narrow shelves, sea  cliffs,
fjords, massive beaches, and
relatively less marsh area (Figure 4).
An Alaskan fjord subject to recent
catastrophic subsidence and  rapid
deposition of glacial flour shows
evidence of the recent encroachment
of saline waters in the presence of
recently buried trees and other
terrestrial vegetation, exposure
of layers of salt marsh peat  along
the edges of channels,  and a poorly
compacted young marsh turf developing
at the new high water level (Figure 5).
                                             Figure 4 * River Mouth on a Slowly Rising Coast. Note absence
                                                    of deltaic development and relatively little marshland.
                                                    although mud flats stippled are extensive.
Figure fi  Some general relationships in a northern fjord with a rising water level.  1.  mean low
         water, 2.  maximum high tide, 3.  Bedrock, 4.  Glacial flour to depths in excess of
         400 meters, 5. Shifting flats and channels, 6.  Channel against bedrock, 7. Buried
         terrestrial vegetation, 8. Outcropplngs of salt marsh peat.
Low lying coastal plains tend to be
fringed by barrier islands, broad
estuaries and deltas, and broad
associated marshlands (Figure 3).
Deep tidal channels fan out through
innumerable branching and often
interconnecting rivulets.  The
intervening grassy plains are
essentially at mean high tide level.
                                                                                    1-33

-------
  The Aquatic Environment
          Tropical and subtropical regions
          such as Florida, the Gulf Coast,
          and  Central America, are frequented
          by mangrove swamps.  This unique
          type of growth is able to  establish
          itself in shallow water and move out
          into progressively deeper areas
          (Figure 6).  The strong deeply
          embedded roots enable the mangrove
          to resist considerable wave action
          at times,  and the tangle of roots
          quickly accumulates a deep layer of
          organic sediment.  Mangroves
          in the  south may be  considered  to
          be roughly the equivalent of the
          Spartina marsh grass in the north
          as a land builder.  When fully
          developed, a mangrove swamp is an
          impenetrable thicket of roots over
          the tidal flat affording shelter to an
          assortment of  semi-aquatic organisms
          such as various molluscs and
          crustaceans, and providing access
          from the nearby land to predaceous
          birds, reptiles,  and mammals.
          Mangroves are not restricted to
          estuaries,  but may develop out  into
          shallow oceanic lagoons,  or upstream
          into relatively fresh waters.
                                            vssa
                                              SSIS*,
  Figure 6  Diagrammatic transect of a mangrove swamp
           showing transition from marine to terrestrial
           habitat.
      tidal marsh is the marsh grass,  but very
      little of it is used by man as  grass.
      (Table 1)

      The nutritional analysis of several
      marsh grasses as compared  to dry land
      hay is  shown in Table 2.
'TABLE 1. General Orders of Magnitude of Gross Primary Productivity in Terms
             at Dry Weight of Organic Matter Fixed Annually
      Ecosystem
                        '  gms/M /year
                      (grams/square meters/year)
    Ibs/aere/yc
 Land deserts, deep oceans       Tens
 Grasslands, forests, cutrophle    Hundreds
   lakes, ordinary agriculture
 Estuaries, deltas, coral reefs.    Thousands
   Intensive agriculture (sugar
   cane, rice)
   •Hundreds
    Thousands
    Ten*thousands
      TABLE 2.  Analyses of Some Tidal Marsh Grasses
                                                         T/A
                                                       Dry Wl.
                 Percentage Composition
           Protein   Fat     Fiber    Water
                                         Ash
                                               N-free Extract
 DisrfcMis ip/cara (pure stand, dry)
   2.B       5.3     1.7      32.4      8.2      6.7
 Short Spartina ahcrniflora and Sa/icornJa europaea (in standing water)
   1.2       7.7     2.5      31.1      8.8
 Sparfina tttcrnillon (tall, pure stand in standing water)
   3.5       7.«     2.0      29.0      8.3
 Spartina paflm 'purr; stand, rjry)
   3.2       fiO     2.2      30.0      8.1
 Spurtina alterniflttra and Sparttna patcm (mixed stand, wet)
   3.4       6.8     1.9      29.8      8.1
 Sjurtina altcrnithrj (short, wet)
   2.2        aa     2.4      30.4      8.7
Comparable Analyses for Hay
 1st >ut       (i.O     2.0      3fi.2      6.7
 2iKl
-------
                                                                  The Aquatic Environment
B  The actual utilization of marsh grass is
   accomplished primarily by its decom-
   position and ingestion by micro organisms.
   (Figure 7) A  small quantity of seeds and
   solids is consumed directly by birds.
              IN j*s <|y m &
      Figure .7  The nutritive composition of
      successive stages of decomposition of
      Spartina marsh grass, showing increase
      in protein and decrease in carbohydrate
      with increasing age and decreasing size
      of detritus particles.

      The quantity of micro invertebrates
      which thrive on  this wealth of decaying
      marsh has not been estimated, nor has
      the actual production of small indigenous
      fishes and invertebrates such as the
      top minnows (Fundulus),  or the  mud
      snails (Nassa),  and others.

      Many forms of oceanic life migrate
     .into the estuaries,  especially the
      marsh areas,  for important portions
      of their life histories as is mentioned
      elsewhere (Figure 8),   It has been
      estimated that in excess of 60% of the
      marine commercial and sport fisheries
      are  estuarine or marsh dependent in
      some way.
                                                          Figure  8  Diagram of the life cycle
                                                          of white shrimp (after Anderson and
                                                          Lunz 1965).
An effort to make an indirect
estimate of productivity in a Rhode
Island marsh was made on a single
August day by recording the numbers
and kinds of birds that fed on a
relatively  small area (Figure 9).
Between 700 and 1000 wild birds of
12 species, ranging from 100 least
sandpipers to uncountable numbers
of seagulls were counted.   One food
requirement estimate for  three-
pound poultry in the confined inactivity
of a poultry yard is approximately one
ounce per pound of bird per day.
                                                         Greater yellow legs (left)
                                                           and black duck
                                                                                     4
                                                                       Great blue heron  ?
                                                      Figure Q  Some Common Marsh Birds
                                                                                        1-35

-------
The Aquatic Environment
      One-hundred black bellied plovers
      at approximately ten ounces each
      would weigh on the order of sixty
      pounds.  At the  same rate of food
      consumption,  this would indicate
      nearly four pounds of food required
      for this species alone.  The much
      greater activity of the wild birds
      would obviously greatly increase their
      food requirements,  as would their
      relatively smaller size.

      Considering the range of foods con-
      sumed, the sizes of the birds, and the
      fact that at  certain seasons, thousands
      of migrating ducks and others pause
      to feed here,  the enormous productivity
      of such a marsh can be better under-
      stood.
V  INLAND BOGS AND MARSHES

A  Much of what has been said of tidal
   marshes also applies to inland wetlands.
   As was mentioned earlier, not all inland
   swamps are salt-free, any more than all
   marshes affected by tidal rythms are
   saline.

B  The specificity of specialized floras to
   particular types  of wetlands  is perhaps
   more spectacular in freshwater wetlands
   than in the marine, where Juncus,
   Spartina, and Mangroves tend to dominate.

   1  Sphagnum,  or peat moss, is
      probably one of the most widespead
      and abundant wetland plants on earth.
      Deevey (1958) quotes an estimate that
      there is probably upwards of 223
      billions (dry weight) of tons of peat
      in the world today, derived during
      recent geologic time from Sphagnum
      bogs.  Particularly in the northern
      regions, peat moss tends to overgrow
      ponds and shallow depressions, eventually
      forming the vast tundra plains and
      moores of the north.

   2  Long lists of other bog and marsh plants
      might be cited, each with its own
      special requirements, topographical,
      and geographic distribution,  etc.
      Included would be the familiar cattails,
      spike rushes, cotton grasses,  sedges,
      trefoils, alders,  and many, many
      others.

C  Types of inland wetlands.

   1  As noted above (Cf:  Figure 1)
      tidal marshes often  merge into
      freshwater marshes and bayous.
      Deltaic tidal swamps and marshes
      are often saline in the seaward
      portion, and fresh in the landward
      areas.

   2  River bottom wetlands differ from
      those formed from lakes, since wide
      flood plains subject to periodic
      inundation are the final stages of
      the erosion of river valleys,  whereas
      lakes in general tend to be eliminated
      by the geologic processes of natural
      eutrophication  often involving
      Sphagnum and peat formation.
      Riverbottom marshes in the southern
      United States, with favorable climates,
      have luxurient growths such as the
      canebrake of the lower Mississippi,
      or a characteristic timber growth
      such as cypress.

   3  Although bird life  is the most
      conspicuous animal element in the
      fauna (Cf:  Figure 9), many mammals,
      such as muskrats, beavers, otters,
      and others are  also marsh-oriented.
      (Figure 12)
      Figure 12
1-36

-------
                                                                  The Aquatic Environment
VI  POLLUTION

 A No single statement can summarize the
    effects of pollution on marshlands as
    distinct from effects noted elsewhere on
    other habitats.

 B Reduction of Primary Productivity

    The primary producers in most wetlands
    are the grasses and peat mosses.
    Production may be reduced or eliminated
    by:

    1  Changes in the water level brought
       about by flooding or  drainage.

       a  Marshland areas  are sometimes
          diked and flooded to produce fresh-
          water ponds.  This may be for
          aesthetic reasons, to suppress the
          growth of noxious marsh inhabitating
          insects such as mosquitoes or biting
          midges, to construct an industrial
          waste holding pond,  a thermal or a
          sewage stabilization pond,  a
          "convenient" result of highway
          causeway construction,  or other
          reason.  The result is the elim-
          ination of an area of marsh.  A
          small compensating border of
          marsh may or may not develop.

       b  High tidal marshes were often
          ditched and drained in former days
          to stabilize the sod for salt hay or
          "thatch" harvesting which was highly
          sought after in colonial  days.  This
          inevitably changed the character
          of the marsh, but it remained as
          essentially marshland.  Conversion
          to outright agricultural  land has
          been less widespread because of the
          necessity of diking to exclude the
          periodic floods or tidal  incursions,
          and carefully timed drainage to
          eliminate excess  precipitation.
          Mechanical pumping of tidal marshes
          has not been economical in this
          country,  although the success of
          the Dutch and others in  this regard
          is well known.
2  Marsh grasses may also be eliminated
   by smothering as, for example, by
   deposition of dredge  spoils, or the
   spill or discharge of sewage sludge.

3  Considerable marsh  area has been
   eliminated by industrial construction
   activity such as wharf and dock con-
   struction, oil well construction and
   operation, and the discharge of toxic
   brines and other chemicals.

Consumer production (animal life) has
been drastically reduced by the deliberate
distribution of pesticides.  In some cases,
this has been aimed at nearby agricultural
lands for  economic crop pest control,  in
other cases the marshes have been sprayed
or dusted directly to control noxious
insects.

1  The results have been universally
   disastrous for the marshes, and the
   benefits to the human community often
   questionable.

2  Pesticides designed to kill nuisance
   insects,  are also toxic to other
   arthropods so that in addition to the
   target  species, such forage staples as
   the various scuds (amphipods), fiddler
   crabs, and other macroinvertebrates
   have either been drastically reduced
   or entirely eliminated in many places.
   For example,  one familiar with fiddler
   crabs can traverse miles of marsh
   margins, still riddled with their burrows,
   without seeing a single live crab.

3  DDT and related compounds have been
   "eaten up the food chain" (biological
   magnification effect) until fish eating
   and other predatory birds such as herons
   and egrets (Figure 9),  have been virtually
   eliminated from vast areas, and the
   accumulation of DDT in man himself
   is only too well known.
                                                                                       1-37

-------
The Aquatic Environment
   Most serious of the marsh enemies is
   man himself.  In his quest for "lebensraum"
   near the water, he has all but killed the
   water he strives to approach.  Thus up to
   twenty percent of the marsh--estuarine
   area in various parts of the country has
   already been utterly destroyed by cut and
   fill real estate developments (Figures
   10,  11).
E  Swimming birds such as ducks, loons,
   cormorants, pelicans,  and many others
   are severely jeopardized by floating
   pollutants such as oil.
                     Figure 10.  Diagrammatic representation of cut-and-fill for
                                 real estate development,  mlw = mean low water
                     Figure 11.  Tracing of portion of map of a southern
                                 city showing extent of cut-and-fill real
                                 estate development.
 1-38

-------
                                                                The Aquatic Environment
VII SUMMARY

 A Wetlands comprise the marshes,  swamps,
    bogs, and tundra areas of the world.
    They are essential to the well-being of
    our surface waters and ground waters.
    They are essential to aquatic life of
    all types living in the open waters.  They
    are essential as habitat for all forms  of
    wildlife.

 B The tidal marsh is the area of emergent
    vegetation bordering the ocean or an
    estuary.

 C Marshes are highly productive areas,
    essential to the maintenance of a well
    rounded community of aquatic life.

 D Wetlands may be destroyed by:

    1  Degradation of the life  forms of
       which it is composed in the name of
       nuisance control.

    2  Physical destruction by cut-and-fill
       to create more  land area.
5  Morgan, J.P.  Ephemeral Estuaries of
      the Deltaic Environment in: Estuaries,
      pp. 115-120. Publ. No. "83, Am.
      Assoc. Adv. Sci.  Washington, DC.  1967.

6  Odum, E.P.  and Dela Crug,  A. A.
      Particulate Organic Detritus in a
      Georgia Salt Marsh - Estuarine
      Ecosystem, in: Estuaries, pp. 383-
      388,  Publ. No.  83, Am. Assoc. Adv.
      Sci.  Washington, DC.  1967.

7  Redfield,  A.C. The Ontogeny of a Salt
      Marsh Estuary, in: Estuaries, pp.
      108-114.   Publ. No.  83, Am.  Assoc.
      Adv. Sci.  Washington,  DC.  1967.

8  Stuckey, O. H.  Measuring the Productivity
      of Salt Marshes.  Maritimes (Grad
      School of Ocean.,  U.R.I.) Vol. 14(1):
      9-11.  February 1970.

9  Williams, R. B. Compartmental
      Analysis of Production and Decay
      of Juncus  reomerianus.  Prog.
      Report, Radiobiol. Lab.,  Beaufort, NC,
      Fiscal Year 1968,  USDI, BCF, pp. 10-
      12.
  REFERENCES

  1  Anderson,  W.W. The Shrimp and the
        Shrimp Fishery of the Southern
        United States. USDI,  FWS,  BCF.
      .  Fishery Leaflet 589.  1966.

  2  Deevey,  E.S.,  Jr.  Bogs. Sci. Am. Vol.
        199(4):115-122.  October 1958.

  3  Emery, K. O. and Stevenson.  Estuaries
        and Lagoons.  Part n,  Biological
        Aspects by J.W. Hedgepeth, pp. 693-
        728. in: Treatise on Marine Ecology
        and Paleoecology.  Geol. Soc. Am.
        Mem. 67.  Washington, DC.  1957.

  4  Hesse, R., W. C. Allee,  and K. P.
        Schmidt.  Ecological Animal
        Geography.  John Wiley & Sons. 1937.
This outline  was prepared by H. W.  Jackson,
former Chief Biologist, National  Training
Center, and revised by R. M. Sinclair, Aquatic
Biologist, National Training Center,   MOTD,
OWPO, EPA,  Cincinnati, OH 45268.
Descriptors: Aquatic Environment, Biological
Estuarine Environment, Lentic Environment,
Lotic Environment, Currents, Marshes,
Limnology,  Magnification,  Water Properties
                                                                                    1-39

-------
      CLASSIFICATION OF COMMUNITIES,  ECOSYSTEMS, AND TROPHIC LEVELS
   A COMMUNITY is an assemblage of popu-
   lations of plants, animals, bacteria,  and
   fungi that live in an environment and inter-
   act with one another,  forming together a
   distinctive living system with its own com-
   position,  structure,  environmental rela-
   tions, development,  and function.
II An ECOSYSTEM is a community and its
   environment treated together as a function-
   al system of complementary relationships,
   and transfer and circulation of energy and
   matter, (a delightful little essay on the
   odyssey of atoms X and Y through an
   ecosystem is in Leopold's, A Sand County
   Almanac).
Ill TROPHIC levels are a convenient means
   of classifying organisms according to
   nutrition, or food and feeding.

A PRODUCER, the photosynthetic plant or
   first organism on the food chain sequence.
   Fossil fuels were produced photosynthe-
   ticallyl

B Herbivore or primary CONSUMER,  the
   first animal which feeds on plant food.

C First carnivore or secondary CONSUMER,
   an animal feeding on a plant-eating animal.

D Second carnivore or tertiary CONSUME R
   feeding on the preceding.v

E Tertiary carnivore.

F Quaternary carnivore.

G DECOMPOSERS,  OR REDUCERS, bact-
   eria which break down the above organisms.
   Often called the middlemen or stokers of
   the furnace of photosynthesis.

H Saprovores or DETRITIVORES which feed
   on bacteria and/or fungi.
IV Taxonomic Groupings

A  TAXOCENES, a specific group of organ-
   isms.  Ex. midges.  For obvious reasons
   most systematists (taxonomists) can
   specialize in only one group of organisms.
   This fact is difficult for the non-biologist to
   graspl

B  Size, which is often dictated by the
   investigator's sampling equipment
   and specific interests.
V  Arbitrary due to organism habitat
   preferences, available sampling devices,
   whims of the investigator,  and mesh sizes of
   nets and sieves.

A  PLANKTON, organisms suspended in a
   body of water and at the mercy of currents.
   This group has been subject to numerous
   divisional schemes.  Plants are PHYTO-
   PLANKTON, and animals, ZOOPLANKTON.
   Those  retained by nets are obviously, NET
   PLANKTON.  Those passing thru even the
   finest meshed nets are NANNOPLANKTON.

B  PERIPHYTON, the  community of micro-
   organisms which grow on  submerged
   substrates.  Literal meaning "to grow
   around plants", however standard glass
   microslides are placed in the aquatic
   habitat to  standardize results.

C  BENTHOS, is often used to mean
   MACROINVERTEBRATES, although there
   are benthic organisms in other plant,  animal,
   and protist groups.   Benthic  refers strictly
   to the bottom substrates of lakes, streams,
   and other  water bodies.

D  MACROINVERTEBRATES, are animals
   retained on a No. 30 mesh screen (approx-
   imately 0. 5  mm) and thus  visible to the
   naked eye.
BI. ECO. 25.6.76
                                 2-1

-------
Classification of Communities, Ecosystems and Trophic Levels
E  MACROPHYTES,  the larger aquatic plants
   which are divided into emersed,  floating,
   and submersed communities.  Usually
   vascular plants but may include the larger
   algae and "primitive" plants.  These have
   posed tremendous economic problems in the
   large man-made lakes,  especially in
   tropical areas.

F  NEKTON, in freshwater, essentially fish,
   salamanders,  and the larger Crustacea.
   In contrast to PLANKTON, these
   organisms are not at the mercy of the
   current.

G  NEUSTON, or PLEUSTON,  are inhabit-
   ants of the surface film (meniscus organ-
   isms), either supported by it,  hanging
   from, or breaking through it.  Other
   organisms are trapped by this neat little
   barrier of nature.  The micro members
   of this are easily  sampled by placing a
   clean cover slip on top of the surface
   film then either leaving it a specified
   time or examining it immediately under
   the  microscope.

H  DRIFT, macroinvertebrates which drift
   with the streams current either period-
   ically (diel or 24 hour), behaviorally,
   catastrophically or incidentally.

I  BIOLOGICAL FLOGS,  are suspended
   microorganisms that are formed by
   various means. In wastewater treat-
   ment plants they are encouraged in con-
   crete aeration basins using diffused air
   or oxygen (the heart of the activated
   sludge process).
J  MANIPULATED SUBSTRATE COM-
   MUNITIES.  Like the preceding
   community,  these are manipulated
   by man.  Placing artificial or natural
   substrates in a body of water will cause
   these communities to appear thereon.

K  We will again emphasize ARBITRARY,
   because organisms confound our neat
   little schemes to classify them.  Many
   move from one community to another for
   various reasons.  However, all these
   basic schemes do have intrinsic  value,
   provided they are used with reasonl
This outline was prepared by R. M. Sinclair,
Aquatic Biologist, National Training Center,
MOTD, OWPO, USEPA,  Cincinnati. Ohio 45268.

Descriptors: Biological  Communities
 2-2

-------
                        LIMNOLOGY AND ECOLOGY OF PLANKTON
      INTRODUCTION
        or outside of a lake.
      A   Most Interference Organisms are
          Small.

      B   Small Organisms generally have
          Short Life Histories.

      C   Populations of Organisms with
          Short Life Histories may Fluctuate
          Rapidly in Response to Key Environ-
          mental Changes.

      D   Small Organisms are Relatively
          at the Mercy of the Elements

      E   The Following Discussion will
          Analyze the Nature of These Ele-
          ments with Reference to the Res-
          ponse of Important Organisms.
II     PHYSICAL FACTORS OF THE ENVIRON-
      MENT

      A   Light is a Fundamental Source of
          Energy for Life and Heat.

          1   Insolation is affected by geo-
              graphical location and mete-
              orological factors.

          2   Light penetration in water is
              affected by angle of incidence
              (geographical),  turbidity,  and
              color.  The proportion of light
              reflected depends on the angle
              of incidence, the temperature,
              color, and other qualities  of
              the water.  In general, as the
              depth increases arithmetically,
              the light tends to decrease geo-
              metrically.  Blues, greens, and
              yellows tend to penetrate most
              deeply while ultra violet,  vio-
              lets,  and orange-reds are most
              quickly absorbed.  On the  oarder
              of 90% of the total illumination
              which penetrates the surface
              film is absorbed in the first
              10 meters of even the  clearest
              water.

          3   Turbidity may originate within
         a    That which comes in from
             outside (allochthonous) is
             predominately inert solids
             (tripton).

        'b    That of internal origin (auto-
             chthonous) tends to be bio-
             logical in nature.

B   Heat and Temperature Phenomena
    are Important in Aquatic Ecology.

    1    The total quantity of heat avail-
         able to a body of water per year
         can be calculated and is known
         as the heat budget.

    2    Heat is derived directly from in-
         solation; also by transfer  from
         air, internal friction, and other
         sources.

C   Density Phenomena

    1    Density and viscosity affect the
         floatation and locomotion of
         microorganisms.
             Pure fresh water achieves
             its maximum density at 4 C
             and its maximum viscosity
             at 0°C.
        b    The rate of change of density
             increases with the temperature.

        Density stratification affects
        aquatic life and water uses.

        a    In summer,  a mass of warm
             surface water, the epilimnion,
             is usually present and separated
             from a cool deeper mass, the
             hypolimnion,  by a relatively
             thin layer known as the
             thermocline.

        b    Ice cover and annual spring
             and fall overturns are due to
             successive seasonal changes
             in the relative densities of
             the epilimnion and the hypo-
    fet. MIC. eco. 4d. 6.
                                                                                       3-1

-------
Limnology and Ecology of Plankton
               limnion, profoundly influ-
               enced by prevailing meteoro-
               logical conditions.

           c   The sudden exchange of
               water masses having differ-
               ent chemical characteris-
               tics may have catastrophic
               effects on certain biota,  may
               cause others to bloom.

           d   Silt laden waters may seek
               certain levels, depending
               on their own specific gravity
               in relation to existing layers
               already present.

           e   Saline waters will also
               stratify according to the
               relative densities of the
               various layers.

   3 The viscosity of water is greater
     at lower temperatures.

           a   This is  important not only
               in situations involving the
               control of flowing water  as  in
               a sand filter, but also since
               overcoming resistance to
               flow generates heat, it is
               significant in the heating
               of water by internal friction
               from wave and current ac-
               tion and many  delay the
               establishment of anchor
               ice under critical conditions.

           b   It is easier for plankton
               to remain suspended in cold
               viscous (and also dense)
               water than in less viscous
               warm water.   This is re-
               flected in differences  in the
               appearance of winter vs
               summer forms of life (also
               arctic vs tropical).

   Shore development, depth, inflow -
   outflow pattern,  and topographic
   features affect the behavior of the water.

   Water movements that may affect organ-
   isms include such phenomena as waves,
   currents,  tides, seiches, floods, and
   others.
Waves or rhythmic movement

a  The best known are traveling
   waves.  These are effective
   only against objects near
   the surface.  They have little
   effect on the movement of
   large masses of water.

b  Standing waves or seiches
   occur in all lakes but are
   seldom large enough to be
   observed.  An "internal seich"
   is an oscillation in a density
   mass within a lake with no
   surface manifestation may
   cause considerable water
   movement.

Langmuire spirals (or Langmuire
circulation)are a relatively  mass-
ive cylindrical motion imparted
to surface waters under the
influence of wind. The axes of
the cylinders are parallel to the
direction of the wind, and their
depth and velocity depend on the
depth of the water,  the velocity
and duration of the wind, and other
factors. The net result is that
adjacent cylinders tend to rotate
in opposite directions like meshing
cog wheels.  Thus the water between
two given spirals may be meeting
and sinking, while that between
spirals  on either side will be meet-
ing and  rising.  Water over the
sinking  areas tends to accumulate
flotsam and jetsam on the surface
in long conspicuous lines.  Masses
of microcrustacea attemping to
stay near the surface may impart
a reddish color to this water,  and
it  is thus often referred to as the
"red dance. "  The rising water on
the other hand, having recently
come from some depth, may (at
least in the oceans or large lakes)
have a bluish appearance, and is
known as the "blue dance. "

a  This phenomenon is of consider-
   able  importance to those sampling
   for plankton (or even chemicals)
   near the surface when the wind
   is blowing.  Grab samples from
   3-2

-------
                                            Limnology and Ecology of Plankton
    either dance might obviously
    differ considerably,  and if
    a plankton tow is contemplat-
    ed, it should be made across
    the wind in order that the
    net may pass through a
    succession of both dances.

    Langmuire spirals are not
    usually  established until the
    wind has either been blowing
    for an extended period,  or
    else is blowing rather hard.
    Their presence can be detect-
    ed by the lines of foam and
    other floating  material which
    coincide with the direction
    of the wind.
Currents
    Currents are arhythmic
    water movements which have
    had major study only in ocean-
    ography. They primarily
    are concerned with the trans-
    location of water masses.
    They may be generated inter-
    nally by virtue  of density
    changes, or externally by
    wind or runoff.

    Turbulence phenomena or
    eddy currents are largely re-
    sponsible for lateral mixing
    in a current.  These are of
    far more importance in the
    economy of a body of water
    than mere laminar flow.

    Tides,  or rather tidal
    currents, are reversible
    (or oscillatory) on a relative-
    ly long and predictable period.
    They are closely allied to
    seiches. For all practical
    purposes, they are restricted
    to oceanic (especially coastal)
    waters.

    If there is no freshwater
    inflow involved, tidal currents
    are basically "in and out;"
    if a significant amount of
    freshwater is added to the
             system at a constant rate, the
             outflowing current will in general
             exceed the inflow by the amount
             of freshwater input.

             There are typically two tidal
             cycles per lunar day (approx-
             imately 25 hours), but there is
             continuous gradation from this
             to only one cycle per (lunar) day
             in some places.

             Estuarine plankton populations
             are extremely influenced by local
             tidal patterns.

          d  Flood waters  range from torren-
             tial velocities which tear away
             and transport vast masses of
             substrate to quiet backwaters
             which may inundate normally dry
             land areas for extended periods
             of time.   In the former case,
             planktonic life is flushed away
             completely; in the latter, a local
             plankton bloom may develop which
             may be of immediate significance,
             or  which may serve as an inoculum
             for receding waters.

 F Surface Tension and the Surface Film

    1     The surface film is the habitat of
          the "neuston", a group of particular
          importance in water supplies.

    2     Surface tension lowered by surfactants
          may eliminate the neuston.  This can
          be a significant biological observation.

IH  DISSOLVED SUBSTANCES

 A Carbon dioxide is released by plants and
    animals in respiration, but taken in by
    plants in photosynthesis.

 B Oxygen is the biological complement of
    carbon dioxide, and necessary for all
    animal life.

 C Nitrogen and phosphorus are fundamental
    nutrients for plant life.

    1     Occur in great dilution, concentrated
          by plants.
                                                                          3-3

-------
 Limnology and Ecology of Plankton
            The distribution of nitrogen
            compounds is generally correlat-
            ed with the oxygen curve, espe-
            cially in oceans.
 D  Iron, manganese, sulphur, and silicon
    are other minerals important to aquatic
    life which exhibit biological stratification.

 E  Many other minerals are present but their
    biological distribution in waters is less
    well known, fluorine,  tin, and vanadium
    have recently been added to the "essential"
    list, and more may well follow.

 F  Dissolved organic matter is present in
    even the purest of lakes.

IV  BIOLOGICAL FACTORS

 A  Nutritional Classification of Organisms

    1        Holophyt ic or independent or-
            ganisms, like green plants, pro-
            duce their own basic food elements
            from the physical environment.

    2        Holozoic or dependent organisms,
            like animals, ingest and  digest
            solid food particles of organic
            origin.

    3        Saprophytic or carrion eating
            organisms, like many fungi and
            bacteria, digest and assimilate
            the dead bodies of other organ-
            isms or their products.

 B  The Prey-Predator Relationship is
    Simply one Organism Eating Another.

 C  Toxic and Hormonic Relationships

    1        Some organisms such as certain
            blue green algae and some ar-
            mored flagellages produce sub-
            stances poisonous to others.

    2        Antibiotic  action in nature is
            not well understood but has been
            shown to play a very influential
            role in the economy of nature.
V  BIOTIC COMMUNITIES (OR ECOSYSTEMS)

A  A biotic community will be defined here
   as an assemblage of organisms living in
   a given ecological niche (as defined
   below). Producer (plant-like), consumer
   (animal-like) and reducer (bacteria and
   fungi) organisms are usually included.
   A source of energy (nutrient,  food) must
   also be present.  The essential concept
   in that each so-called community is a
   relatively independent entity.  Actually
   this position is only tenable at any  given
   instant, as individuals are constantly
   shifting from one community to another in
   response to stages in their life cycles,
   physical conditions, etc.  The only one
   to be considered in detail here is the
   plankton.

B  Plankton are the macroscopic and
   microscopic animals, plants, bacteria,
   etc. floating free in the open water.
   Many clog filters, cause tastes, odors,
   and other troubles in water supplies.

   1     Those that pass through a plankton
         net (No. 25 silk bolting cloth or
         equivalent) or sand filter are often
         known as nannoplankton (they
         usually greatly exceed the "net"
         plankton in actual quantity).

   2     Those less than four microns in
         length are sometimes called
         ultraplankton.

   3     There are many ways in which
         plankton may be classified:  taxo -
         nomic, ecological,  industrial.

   4     The concentration of plankton varies
         markedly in space and time.

         a   Depth, light, currents,  and
             water quality profoundly affect
             plankton distribution.

         b   The relative  abundance  of
             plankton in the various sea-
             sons is generally:
                                                               1 spring,
                                                               4 winter
                       2 fall, 3 summer,
   3-4

-------
                                             Limnology and Ecology of Plankton
   5        Marine plankton include many
            larger animal forms than are
            found in fresh waters.

 C The benthic community is generally
   considered to be the macroscopic life
   living in or on the bottom.

 D The periphyton community might be
   defined as the microscopic benthos,
   except that they are by no means confined
   to the bottom.  Any surface, floating, or
   not, is usually covered by film of living
   organisms.  There is frequent exchange
   between the periphyton and plankton
   communities.

 E The nekton is the community of larger,
   free-swimming animals  (fishes,  shrimps,
   etc.), and so is dependent on the other
   communities for basic plant foods.

 F Neuston or Pleuston

   This community inhabits the air/water
   interface, and may be suspended above
   or below it or break it.  Naturally this
   interface is a very critical one,  it being
   micro molecular and allowing interchange
   between atmospheric contaminants and
   the water medium.  Rich in bacteria,
   metals, protozoa,  pesticides etc.

VI   THE EVOLUTION OF WATERS

  A  The history of a body of water determines
     its present condition. Natural waters have
     evolved in the course of geologic time
     to what we know today.

  B  In the  course of their evolution, streams
     in general pass  through four general
     stages of development which may be called:
     birth,  youth, maturity, and old age.

     1       Establishment of birth.  In an
             extant stream, this might be
             a "dry run" or headwater
             streambed,  before it had eroded
             down to the level of ground water.

     2       Youthful streams; when the
             stream bed  is eroded below the
             ground water level, spring water
             enters and the stream becomes
             permanent.

     3       Mature streams; have wide
             valleys,  a developed flood plain.
         deeper, more turbid,  and usually
         warmer water,  sand,  mud, silt,
         or clay bottom materials which
         shift with increase in flow.

   4     In old age, streams have approa-
         ched base level.  During flood
         stage they scour their bed and de-
         posit materials on the flood plain
         which may be very broad and  flat.
         During normal flow the channel is
         refilled and many shifting bars are
         developed.

         (Under the influence of man this
         pattern may be broken  up, or tem-
         porarily interrupted.  Thus as essen-
         tially "youthful" stream might take
         on some of the characteristics of a
         "mature" stream following soil
         erosion, organic enrichment, and
         increased surface runoff.  Correction
         of these conditions might likewise be
         followed by at least a partial rever-
         sion to the "original" condition.)

C  Lakes have a developmental history
   which somewhat parallels that of streams.

   1     The method of formation greatly
         influences the character and sub-
         sequent history of lakes.

   2     Maturing or natural eutrophication
         of lakes

         a  If not already present, shoal
           areas are developed through
           erosion of the shore by wave
           action and undertow.

         b  Currents produce bars across
           bays and thus cut off irregulars
           areas.

         c  Silt brought in by tributary
           streams settles  out in the quiet
           lake water.

         d  Rooted aquatics  grow on shoals
           and bars,  and in doing so cut
           off bays and contribute to the
           filling of the lake.

         e  Dissolved carbonates and other
           materials are precipitated in the
           deeper portions  of the lake in
           part through the action of plants.
                                                                                 3-5

-------
  Limnology and Ecology of Plankton
             f    When filling is well advanced
                 sphagnum mats extend out-
                 ward from the shore.  These
                 mats are followed by sedges
                 and grasses which finally
                 convert the lake into a
                 marsh.

    3        Extinction of lakes.  After lakes
             reach maturity their progress
             toward filling  up is accelerated.
             They become extinct through:

             a    The  downcutting of the out-
                 let.

             b    Filling with detritus eroded
                 from the shores or brought
                 in by tributary streams.

             c    Billing by the accumulation of
                 the remains of vegetable
                 materials growing in the
                 lake  itself.

                 (Often two or three  pro-
                 cesses may act concurrently)

                 When man hastens the above
                 process, it is often called
                 "cultural eutrophication."

VII PRODUCTIVITY

  A  The biological resultant of all physical
     and chemical factors is the quantity of
     life that may actually be present. The
     ability to produce this "biomass" is
     often referred to  as the "productivity"
     of a body of water.  This is neither good
     nor bad per se.  A water of low producti-
     vity  is a "poor" water biologically,  and
     also a relatively "pure" or "clean" water;
     hence desirable as a water supply.  A
     productive water  on the other hand may
     be  a nuisance to man or highly desirable.
     Some of the factors which influence the
     productivity of waters are as follows:

  B  Factors affecting stream productivity.
     To be productive  of plankton,  a stream
     must provide adequate  nutrients,  light,
     a suitable temperature, and time for
     growth to take place.
1     Youthful streams,  especially on
      rock or sand substrates are low
      in essential nutrients.  Tempera-
      tures in mountainous regions are
      usually low,  and due to the steep
      gradient,  time for growth is short.
      Although ample light is available,
      growth of true plankton is thus
      greatly limited.

2     As the stream flows toward a
      more "mature" condition nutrients
      tend to accumulate, and gradient
      diminishes and so time of flow
      increases, temperature tends to
      increase, and plankton flourish.

      Should a heavy load of inert silt
      develop on the other hand, the
      turbidity would reduce the light
      penetration and consequently the
      general plankton production would
      diminish.

3     As the stream approaches base
      level (old age) and the time avail-
      able for plankton growth increases,
      the balance between turbidity,
      nutrient levels, and temperature
      and other seasonal conditions,
      determines the overall produc-
      tivity.

Factors Affecting the Productivity
of Lakes

1     The size, shape, and depth
      of the lake basin.  Shallow water
      is more productive than deeper
      water since more light will reach
      the bottom to stimulate rooted
      plant growth.  As a corollary,
      lakes with more shoreline, having
      more shallow water, are in general
      more productive.  Broad shallow
      lakes and reservoirs have the
      greatest production potential (and
      hence should be avoided for water
      supplies).

2     Hard waters are generally more
      productive than soft waters as
      there are more plant nutrient
      minerals available. This is often
  3-6

-------
   Human
   Influence
   Sewage
 Agriculture
   Mining
                        FACTORS AFFECTING  PRODUCTIVITY
                                   Geographic Location
                                                                  Latitude
                                                                         Longitude
                                                                                Altitude
                      Topography
                    Competition
                    of Substrate
                        Shape of Basin
                                      Depth      Area     Bottom   \   Precipitation //\ Insolation
                                                       Conformation \      ^,     / /  \
Primary
Nutritive
Materials
Drainage
 Area
Nature o*
 Bottom
 Deposit!
            Inflow of
          A llochthonous
            Materials
     Trans-
    parency
  Light      Heat Penetration
Penetration   and Stratification
   and
Utilization
                               Trophic Nature of a Lake
           Seasonal Cycle
Littoral  Circulat.  Stagnation
Region    Growing Season
                                                                                                                      3
                                                                                                                      O
                                                                                               (B
                                                                                               D
                                                                                               a
                                                                                                                      8
                                                                                                                     o
                                                                                                                     OTQ
                                                                                                                      O
                                                                                                                      i-h
                                                                                                                      —
                                                                                                                      s
                                                                                                                      yr

-------
Limnology and Ecology of Plankton
           greatly influenced by the
           character of the soil and rocks
           in the watershed, and the quality
           and quantity of ground water
           entering the lake.  In general,
           pH ranges of 6. 8 to 8.2 appear
           to be most productive.

   3       Turbidity reduces productivity
           as light penetration is reduced.

   4       The presence or absence of
           thermal stratification with its
           semi-annual turnovers affect
           productivity by distributing
           nutrients throughout the water
           mass.

   5       Climate,  temperature, pre-
           valance of ice and snow,  are
           also important.

   Factors Affecting the Productivity of
   Reservoirs

   1       The productivity of  reservoirs
           is governed by much the same
           principles as that of lakes,  with
           the difference that the water
           level is much more under the
           control of man.  Fluctuations
           in water level can be used to
           deliberately increase of decrease
           productivity.  This  can be dem-
           onstrated by a comparison of
           the TVA reservoirs which practice
           a summer drawdown with some of
           those in the west where a winter
           drawdown is the rule.

   2       The level at which water is re-
           moved from the reservoir is also
           important.  The upper epilimnion
           may have a high plankton turbi-
           dity while lower down the plankton
           count may be less,  but a taste
           and odor causer (such as Mallo-
           monas) may be present.  There
           may be two thermoclines, with
           a mass of muddy water flowing
           between a clear upper epilimnion
           and a clear hypolimnion. Other
           combinations ad infinitum may
           occur.
      3     Reservoir discharges also pro-
           foundly affect the DO, temperature,
           and turbidity in the stream below
           a dam.  Too much fluctuation in
           flow may permit sections of the
           stream to dry periodically.

VIH CLASSIFICATION OF LAKES AND
    RESERVOIRS

   A  The productivity of lakes and impound-
      ments is such a conspicuous feature
      that it is often used as a means of
      classification.

      1     Oligotrophic lakes are the
           geologically younger, less produc-
           tive lakes,  which are deep, have
           clear water,  and usually support
           Salmonoid fishes.

    2      Mesotropic lakes are generally
           intermediate between oligotrophic
           and eutrophic lakes.  They are
           moderately productive, yet
           pleasant to be around.

      3     Eutrophic lakes are more mature,
           more turbid, and richer.  They
           are usually shallower. They are
           richer in dissolved solids; N, P,
           and Ca are abundant.  Plankton is
           abundant and there  is often a
           rich bottom fauna.  Nuisance
           conditions often appear.

      4     Dystrophic lakes - bog lakes -
           low in pH, water yellow to brown,
           dissolved solids; N, P, and Ca
           scanty but humic materials abun-
           dant; bottom  fauna and plankton
           poor, and fish species are limited.

   B  Reservoirs may be classified as storage,
      or run of the river.

      1     Storage reservoirs have a large
           volume in relation to their inflow.

      2     Run of the river reservoirs have
           a large flow through in relation
           to their storage value.
3-8

-------
                                                        Limnology and Ecology of Plankton
IX
According to location,  lakes and
reservoirs may be classified as polar,
temperate, or tropical.  Differences
in climatic and geographic conditions
result in differences in their biology.

THE MANAGEMENT OR CONTROL OF
ENVIRONMENTAL FACTORS
 A  Liebig's Law of the Minimum states
    that productivity is limited by the
    nutrient present in the least amoung
    at any given time relative to the
    assimilative capacity of the organism.

 B  Shelford's Law of Toleration:
Minimum Limit
of toleration
Abaent
Decreasing
Abundance
Range of Optimum
of factor
Greatest abundance
Maximum limit of
toleration
Decreasing
Abundance
Absent
 D
The artificial introduction of nutrients
(sewage pollution or fertilizer) thus
tends to eliminate existing limiting
minimums for some species and create
intolerable maximums for other species.

1       Known limiting minimums may
        sometimes be deliberately
        maintained.

2       As the total available energy
        supply is increased, productivity
        tends to increase.

3       As productivity increases, the
        whole character of the water
        may be changed from a meagerly
        productive clear water lake
        (oligotrophic) to a highly pro-
        ductive and usually turbid lake
        (eutrophic).

4       Eutrophication leads to treatment
        troubles.

Control of eutrophication may be  accom-
plished by various means

1       Watershed management, ade-
        quate preparation of reservoir
        sites, and pollution control tend
        to maintain minimum limiting nu-
        tritional factors.

   2    Shading out the energy of insola-
        tion by roofing or inert turbidity;
        suppresses photosynthesis.

   3    Introduction of substances  toxic
        to some  fundamental part of the
        food chain (such as copper sul-
        phate) tends to temporarily inhibit
        productivity.

X  SUMMARY

A  A body of water such as a lake rep-
   resents an intricately balanced system
   in a state of dynamic equilibrium.
   Modification imposed at one point in
   the system automatically results in
   compensatory  adjustments at associated
   points.

B  The more thorough our knowledge of
   the entire system, the better we can
   judge where to impose control measures
   to achieve a desired result.

REFERENCES

1  Chamberlin, Thomas C.,  and Salisburg,
        RollinP.,  Geology  Vol. 1. "Geolo-
        gical Processes and Their Results",
        pp i-xix, and 1-654, Henry Holt and
        Company, New York,  1904.

2  Dorsey,  N.  Ernest.  Properties of
        Ordinary Water - Substance.
        Reinhold Publ. Corp.,  New York.
      .  pp. 1-673.  1940.

3  Hutcheson,  George E.  A  Treatise on
        Limnology.  John Wiley Company.
        1957.

4  Ruttner, Franz.  Fundamentals  of
        Limnology.  University of Toronto
        Press,  pp. 1-242.  1953.

5  Tarzwell, Clarence M. Experimental
        Evidence on the Value of Trout 1937
        Stream Improvement in Michigan.
        American Fisheries Society Trans.
        66:177-187. 1936.
                                                                                     3-9

-------
Limnology and Ecology of Plankton
6  US DHEW, PHS.  Algae and Metropolitan
         Wastes, transactions of a seminar
         held April 27-29.  1960 at the
         Robert A. Taft Sanitary Engineer-
         ing Center, Cincinnati, Ohio.
         No.  SEC TR W61-3.

7  Ward and  Whipple.  Freshwater Biology
         (Introduction).  John Wiley
         Company.  1918.

8  Whittaker, R. H.  Communities and
         Ecosystems.  Macmillan,
         New York.  162 pp.  1970.

9  Zhadin, V.I. and Gerd,  Sr.   Fauna
         and  Flora of the lakes and
         Reservoirs of the  USSR. Avail-
         able from the Office of Technical
         Services, U. S.  Dept.  Commerce,
         Washington, DC.

10  Josephs, Melvin and Sanders, Howard J.
         Chemistry and the Environment
         ACS Publications, Washington,  DC.
         1967.
This outline was prepared by H. W. Jackson,
former Chief Biologist, National Training
Center, and revised by R. M. Sinclair,
Aquatic Biologist, National Training Center,
MOTD, OWPO, USEPA,  Cincinnati, Ohio
45268.

Descriptors: Plankton, Ecology, Limnology
 3-10

-------
                       BIOLOGY OF ZOOPLANKTON COMMUNITIES
I  CLASSIFICATION

A  The planktonic community is composed of
   organisms that are relatively independent
   of the bottom to complete their life history.
   They inhabit the open water of lakes
   (pelagic zone).  Some species have inactive
   or resting stages that lie on the bottom
   and carry the species through periods of
   stress; e. g. , winter.  A few burrow in
   the mud and enter the pelagic zone at night,
   but most live in the open water all the
   time that the  species is present in an active
   form.

B  Compared to  the bottom fauna and flora,
   the plankton consists of relatively few
   kinds  of organisms that are consistently
   and abundantly present.  Two major cat-
   egories are often called phytoplankton
   (plants) and zooplankton (animals), but
   this is based  on an outmoded classification
   of living things.   The modern tendency is
   to identify groupings according to their
   function in the ecosystem:  Primary pro-
   ducers (photosynthetic organisms), consumers
   (zooplankton), and decomposers (hetero-
   trophic bacteria and fungi).

C  The primary difference then is nutritional;
   phytoplankton use inorganic nutrient
   elements and solar radiation.  Zooplankton
   feed on particles, much of which can be
   phytoplankton cells,  but can be bacteria or
   particles of dead organisms (detritus)
   originating in the plankton, the shore
   region,  or the land surrounding the lake.

D  The swimming powers of planktonic
   organisms is so limited that their hori-
   zontal distribution is determined mostly
   by movements of water.  Some of the
   animals are able to swim fast enough that
   they can migrate vertically tens of meters
   each day, but they are capable of little
   horizontal navigation.  At most,  some
   species of crustaceans show a general
   avoidance of the shore areas during calm
   weather when the water is moving more
   slowly than the animals can swim.  By
   definition, animals that are able to control
   their horizontal location are nekton, not
   plankton.
    In this presentation, a minimum of clas-
    sification and taxonomy is used, but it
    should be realized that each group is
    typified by adaptations of structure on
    physiology that are related to the plank-
    tonic mode of existence.  These adapta-
    tions are reflected in the classification.
II   FRESHWATER ZOOPLANKTON

 A  The freshwater zooplankton is dominated
    by representatives of three groups of
    animals,  two of them crustaceans:
    Copepoda, Cladocera, Rotifera.  All have
    feeding mechanisms  that permit a high
    degree of selectivity of food,  and two can
    produce resting eggs that can withstand
    severe environmental conditions. In
    general the food of usual zooplankton pop-
    ulations ranges from bacteria and small
    algae to small animals.
 B  The Copepoda reproduce by a normal
    biparental process, and the females lay
    fertilized eggs in groups which are carried
    around in sacs until they hatch.  The
    immature  animals go through an elaborate
    development with many stages.   The later
    stages have mouthparts that permit them
    to collect particles.  In many cases, these
    are in the  form of combs which remove
    small particles by a  sort of filtration
    process.   In others,  they are modified to
    form grasping organs by which small
    animals or large  algae are captured
    individually.

 C  The Cladocera (represented by Daphnia)
    reproduce much of the  time by partheno-
    genesis, so that only females are present.
    Eggs are held by  the mother in a brood
    chamber until the young are developed far
    enough to fend for themselves.  The newborn
    animals look  like  miniature adults, and do
    not go through an  elaborate series of
    developmental stages in the water  as do
    the copepods.  Daphnia has comb-formed
    filtering structures on  some of  its legs
    that act as filters.
  BI.AQ. 29. 6. 76
                                        4-1

-------
 Biologv of Zooplankton Communities
 D Under some environmental conditions the
    development of eggs is affected and males
    are produced.  Fertilized eggs are produced
    that can resist freezing and drying, and
    these carry the population through
    unsatisfactory conditions.

 E The Rotifera are small animals with a
    ciliated area on the head  which creates
    currents used both for locomotion and for
    bringing food particles to the mouth.  They
    too reproduce by parthenogenesis during
    much of the year, but production of males
    results in fertilized,  resistant resting eggs.
    Most rotifers lay eggs one at a time and
    carry them until they hatch.
Ill  ZOOPLANKTON POPULATION DYNAMICS

 A In general,  zooplankton populations are at
    a minimum in the  cold seasons,  although
    some species flourish in cold water. Species
    with  similar food requirements seem to
    reproduce at different times of the year or
    are segregated in  different layers of lakes.

 B There is no single, simple measurement
    of activity for the  zooplankton  as a whole
    that can be used as an index of production
    as can the uptake of radioactive carbon for
    the phytoplankton. However, it is possible
    to find the rate of  reproduction of the species
    that carry their eggs. The basis of the
    method is that the number of eggs in a
    sample taken at a  given time represents
    the number of animals that will be  added
    to the population during an interval that
    is equal to the length of time it takes the
    eggs to develop.  Thus the potential growth
    rate of the populations can be determined.
    The actual growth rate, determined by
    successive samplings and counting, is  less
    than the potential, and the difference is a
    measure of the death rate.

 C Such measurements of birth and death rates
    permits a more penetrating analysis to be
    made of the causes of population change
    than if data were available for population
    size alone.

 D Following is an  indication of the major
    environmental factors in the control of
    zooplankton.

    1  Temperature has an obvious effect in
       its general control of rates. In addition,
       the production and hatching of resting
       eggs may be  affected.
2  Inorganic materials

   Freshwater lakes vary in the content
   of dissolved solids  according to the
   geological situation.  The total salinity
   and proportion of different dissolved
   materials in water  can affect the pop-
   ulation.  Some species are limited to
   soft water, others to saline waters,  as
   the brine shrimp.   The maximum pop-
   ulation size developed maybe related
   to salinity, but this is probably an
   indirect effect working through the
   abundance of nutrients and production
   of food.

3  Food supply

   Very strong correlations have been
   found between reproduction and food
   supply as measured by abundance of
   phytoplankton.  The rate of food supply
   can affect almost all aspects of pop-
   ulation biology including rate of indi-
   vidual growth, time of maturity,  rate
   of reproduction and length of life.

4  Apparently in freshwater, dissolved
   organic materials are of little nutri-
   tional significance,  although some
   species can be kept if the concentration
   of dissolved material is high enough.
   Some species require definite vitamins
   in the food.

5  Effect of predation  on populations

   The kind, quantity and relative pro-
   portions of species  strongly affected
   by grazing by vertebrate and: inverte-
   brate predators.  The death rate of
   Daphnia is correlated with the abun-
   dance of a predator.  Planktivorous
   fish (alewives) selectively feed on
   larger  species, so  a lake with alewives
   is dominated by the smaller species of
   crustaceans and large ones are scarce
   or absent.

6  Other aspects of zooplankton

   Many species migrate vertically con-
   siderable distances each day.  Typically,
   migrating species spend the daylight
   hours deep in the lake and rise toward
   the surface in late afternoon and  early
   evening.

   Some species go through a seasonal
   change of form (cyclomorphosis) which
   is not fully understood. It may have an
   effect in reducing predation.
    4-2

-------
                                                       Biology of Zooplankton Communities
REFERENCES
1  Baker, A. L.  An Inexpensive Micro-
      sampler.   Limnol. and Oceanogr.
      15(5): 158-160.  1970.

2  Brooks, J.  L. and Dodson, S. I.
      Predation, Body,  Size, and Com-
      position of Plankton.  Science 150:
      28-35.  1965.

3  Dodson, Stanley I.  Complementary
      Feeding Niches  Sustained by Size-
      Selective  Predation, Limnology
      and Oceanography 15(1):  131-137.

4  Hutchinson,  G.  E.   1967.  A Treatise
      on Limnology.   Vol. II.  Introduction
      to Lake Biology and the LimnoplanKton.
      xi + 1115. John Wiley & Sons, Inc.,
      New York.

5  Jossi, JackW.  Annotated Bibliography
      of Zooplankton Sampling Devices.
      USFWS.   Spec.  Sci. :  Rep. -Fisheries.
      609.  90 pp.  1970.

6  Likens,  Gene E. and Gilbert, John J.
      Notes on  Quantitative Sampling of
      Natural Populations of Planktonic
      Rotifers.   Limnol. and Oceanogr.
      15(5): 816-820.
7  Lund, J.  W. G.  1965.  The Ecology of
      the Freshwater Plankton.  Biological
      Reviews, 40:231-293.

8  UNESCO.  Zoolplankton Sampling.
      UNESCO Monogr. Oceanogr. Methodol.
      2.  174 pp.  1968.  (UNESCO.  Place
      de Fortenoy,  75, Paris 7e France).
This outline was prepared oy W. T7  Edmondson,
Professor of Zoology,  University of
Washington,  Seattle, Washington.

Descriptor:   Zooplankton
                                                                                     4-3

-------
Biology of Zooplankton Communities
       FIGURE  1   SEASONAL CHANGES OF ZOOPLANKTON IN LAKE ERKEN, SWEDEN
                  Diaptomus  gracij.oides
                  Ceriodaphnia  quadrangula
               Each panel shows  the abundance of a species of animal.   Each
               mark on the vertical axis represents 10 individuals/liter.
               Nauwerck,  A.  1963.  Die Beziehungen zwischen Zooplankton und
               Phytoplankton im  See Erken.  Symbolae Botanicae Upsaliensis, 17:1-163.
   4

-------
     FIGURE  2   REPRODUCTIVE RATE OF ZOOPLANKTON AS A FUNCTION OF ABUNDANCE OF FOOD
•o
01
0)
U-l

I
ID
I
w
o
3
•a
o
H
s-
    0.20 -
0.15 -
    0.10 -
    0.05 -
                     Temperatu
                     less  than
                                   Temperature
                                   more than 10
                                                   Young per  j
                                                      Brood  —

                                                          20 -
                                                          10
                                                                   Cells/ml
                                                                   of food
                                                                                100,000
Total young
  223
  177
  132


   76
                                                                                Days
                                                                                                40
     0           200          400           600

     Abundance of food organisms ygm/1,  dry weight

     Mean rate of laying eggs  by the  planktonic
     rotifer Keratella cochlearis in  natural
     populations as  a function of abundance of
     food organisms  and temperature.   W.  T.
     Edmonson.  1965.   Reproductive rate  of
     planktonic rotifers as  related to food
     and  temperature in nature.   Ecol. Mmogr.
     35:   61-111.
                                                      Number of young produced in each brood by Daphnia living in
                                                      four different concentrations of food organisms, renewed
                                                      daily.  The total number produced during the life of a
                                                      mother is shown by the numbers at the right.  The Daphnia
                                                      at the two lowest concentrations produced their first batch
                                                      of eggs on the same day as the others, but the eggs degen-
                                                      erated, and the first viable eggs were released two days
                                                      later.  Richman, S.  1958.  The transformation of energy by
                                                      Daphnia pulex.  Ecol. Monogr.  28:  273-291.
                                                                                                                                   Kt

                                                                                                                                   O
                                                                                                                                    D
                                                                                                                                    3
                                                                                                                                   o>
                                                                                                                                   en

-------
Biology of Zooplankton Communities
                                         PROTOZOA
                                         Difflugia
                                         Amoebae
                                         Codonella
                Stentor
Epistylis
                                          Ciliates

-------
                                      Biology of Zooplankton Communities
                         ROTIFERA
   Synchaeta
Polygarthra
Brachionus
Cladocera
                        ARTHROPODA
                         Crustacea
                                                Copepoda
                   Nauplius larva of copepod

                     Ins e eta - Chaoborus

-------
Biology of Zooplankton Communities
                          PLANKTON1C BIVALVE LARVAE
                         380p.
377^
                  spineti (fin attached)
   simple  (gill attached)
                     Glochidia (Unionidae)  Fish Parasites
                                   (1-3)
            veliger
  pediveliger
               Veliger  Larvae (Corbiculidae) Free Living Planktonic
                                   (4-5)
                      Pediveliger attaches byssus lines)
                      Y

-------
                              OPTICS AND THE MICROSCOPE
I  OPTICS

An understanding of elementary optics is
essential to the proper use of the microscope.
The  microscopist will find that unusual pro-
blems in illumination and  photomicrography
can be handled much more effectively once
the underlying ideas  in physical optics are
understood.

A  Reflection

   A good place to begin is with reflection at
   a surface or interface.   Specular (or
   regular) reflection results  when a beam
   of light leaves a surface at  the same angle
   at which it reached it.  This type of
   reflection occurs  with highly polished
   smooth surfaces.  It is stated more pre-
   cisely as Snell's  Law,  i. e. , the angle of
   incidence,  i,  is equal to the angle of
   reflection, r (Figure l). Diffuse (or
   scattered)  reflection results when a beam
   •of light strikes a rough or irregular sur-
   face and different portions of the  incident
   light are reflected from the surface at
   different angles.   The light reflected from
   a piece of white paper or a  ground glass is
 .  an example of diffuse reflection.
                 Figure 1
SPECULAR REFLECTION - SNELL'S
LAW
BI. MIC. 18. 6. 76
   Strictly speaking,  of course, all reflected
   light, even diffuse, obeys Snell's Law.
   Diffuse reflected light is made up of many
   specularly reflected rays,  each from a
   a tiny element of surface, and appears
   diffuse when the reflecting elements are
   very numerous and very small.   The terms
   diffuse and .specular,  referring  to reflection,
   describe not so much a difference in the
   nature of the  reflection but rather a differ-
   ence in the type  of surface.   A polished sur-
   face gives specular reflection; a rough
   surface gives diffuse  reflection.

   It is also important to note and remember
   that specularly reflected light tends to be
   strongly polarized in  the plane of the reflect-
   ing surface.  This is  due to the  fact that
   those rays  whose vibration directions  lie
   closest to the plane of the reflection surface
   are most strongly reflected.  This effect is
   strongest when the angle of incidence is
   such that the  tangent of the angle is equal
   to the refractive index of the reflecting sur-
   face.  This particular angle of incidence is
   called the Brewster angle.

B  Image Formation on Reflection

   Considering reflection by mirrors, we find
   (Figure  2) that a plane mirror forms a
   virtual image behind the mirror, reversed
   right to left but of the same size as the
   object.  The word" virtual means that the
   image appears to be in a given plane but
   that a ground glass screen or a  photographic
   film placed in that plane would show no
   image.  The converse of a virtual image is
   a real image.

   Spherical mirrors are either convex or con-
   cave with the surface of the mirror repre-
   senting a portion of the surface  of a sphere.
   The center of curvature is the center of the
   sphere, part of whose surface forms the
   mirror.  The focus lies halfway between the
   center of curvature and the  mirror surface.
                                    5-1

-------
Optics and the Microscope
   Object
Virtual
Image
                  Mirror
                 Figure 2

 IMAGE FORMATION BY PLANE MIRROR


   Construction of an image by a concave
   mirror follows from the two premises
   given below (Figure 3):
                 Figure 3
IMAGE FORMATION BY CONCAVE MIRROR

   1  A ray of light parallel to the axis of
     the mirror must pass through the
     focus after reflection.

   2  A ray of light which passes through the
     center of curvature  must return along
     the same path.

A corollary of the  first premise is:
                                                  3  A ray of light which passes through the
                                                     focus is reflected parallel to the axis
                                                     of the mirror.

                                                  The image from an object can be located
                                                  using the familiar lens formula:
                   where p = distance from the object to
                             the mirror
                         q = distance from the image to
                            the mirror
                         f  = focal length

             C  Spherical Aberration

                No spherical surface can be perfect in its
                image-forming ability.  The most serious
                of the imperfections, spherical aberration,
                occurs in spherical mirrors of large
                aperture (Figure  4).  The rays of light
                making up an image point from the outer
                zone of a spherical mirror do not pass
                through the same point as the  more central
                rays. This type of aberration is  reduced by
                blocking the outer zone rays from the image
                area or by using aspheric surfaces.
                               Figure 4

                    SPHERICAL ABERRATION BY
                         SPHERICAL  MIRROR
 5-2

-------
                                                                    Optics and the Microscope
D  Refraction of Light

   Turning now to lenses rather than  mirrors
   we find that the most important cluiructcr-
   istic is refraction.  Refraction refers to
   the change of direction and/or velocity of
   light as it passes from one nu-dium to
   another.   The ratio of the velocity in  air
   (or more correctly in a vacuum) to the
   velocity in the medium is called tin-
   refractive  index. Some typical values of
   refractive  index measured with mono-
   chromatic  light (sodium D line) are listed
   in Table  1.

   Refraction causes an object  immersed in
   a medium of higher refractive index than
   air to appear closer to the surface than it
   actually is (Figure 5).  This effect may
   into focus and the new micrometer reading
   is taken.  Finally, the microscope is re-
   focused until the surface of the liquid appears
   in sharp focus.  The micrometer reading
   is taken again and, with this information,
   the refractive index may be calculated from
   the simplified equation:
           ,.   ..   .   .     actual depth
         relractive index = 	f	—
                           apparent depth
Table 1.  RKI-'RACTIVK  INDICES OF COMMON
MATERIALS MKASURED  WITH SODIUM LIGHT
Vacuum
Air
C02
Water
1. 0000000
1. 0002918
1. 0004498
1. 3330
Crown glass
Rock salt
Diamond
Lead sulfide
1.48 to
1.5443
2.417
3. 912
1.61



                                     Air
Actual
depth
I Apparent 1
^ depth 1
1 M
Medium
Imnrje
i
	 J Ohio i~ »
   When the situation is reversed, and a ray
   of light from a medium of high refractive
   index passes through the interface of a
   medium of lower index,  the ray is refracted
   until a critical angle  is. reached beyond which
   all of the light is reflected from the interface
   (Figure  6).  This critical angle,  C, has the
   following relationship to the refractive, indices
   of the two media:                       {
                                                         sin C = — 2  , where
                                                                                
-------
  Optics and the Microscope
 E  Dispersion

    Dispersion is another important property
    of transparent materials.  This is the
    variation of refractive index with color
    (or wavelength) of light.  When white light
    passes through a glass prism,  the light
    rays are refracted by different amounts
    and separated into the colors of the
    spectrum.  This spreading of light into
    its component colors is due to dispersion
    which, in turn, is due to the fact that the
    refractive index of transparent substances,
    liquids and solids, is lower for long wave-
    lengths than for short wavelengths.

    Because of dispersion, determination of
    the refractive index  of a  substance re-
    quires designation of the particular wave-
    length used.  Light from a sodium lamp
    has a strong, closely spaced doublet with
    an average wavelength of 5893A,  called
    the D line,  which is  commonly used as a
    reference wavelength.  Table 2 illustrates
    the change of refractive index with wave-
    length for a few common substances.
 F Lenses

   There are two classes of lenses, con-
   verging and diverging, called also convex
   and concave,  respectively.   The focal   "
   point of a converging lens is defined as
   the point at which a bundle of light rays
   parallel to the axis of the lens appears to
   converge  after passing through the lens.
   The focal length of the lens is the distance
   from the lens to the focal point (Figure 7).
 Table 2.  DISPERSION OF REFRACTIVE
INDICES OF SEVERAL COMMON MATERIALS

                       Refractive index
                     F line   D line   C line
                     blue    (yellow)   (red)
                     4861A   5893A   6563A
Carbon disulfide
Crown glass
Flint glass
Water
1.
1.
1.
1.
6523
5240
6391
3372
1.
1.
1.
1.
6276
5172
6270
3330
1.
1.
1.
1.
6182
5145
6221
3312
   The dispersion of a material can be defined
   quantitatively as:
   v = dispersion =
                    n (yellow) -  1
                    n (blue) - n (red)
        n (593mti) - 1
        n (486mji) - n(656mn)

    where n is the refractive index of the
    material at the particular wavelength
    noted in the parentheses.
                   Figure 7

CONVERGENCE OF LIGHT AT FOCAL POINT
G  Image Formation by Refraction

   Image formation by lenses (Figure  8)
   follows rules analogous to those already
   given above for mirrors:

   1  Light traveling parallel to the axis of
      the lens will be refracted so as to pass
      through the focus of the lens.

   2  Light traveling through the geometrical
      center  of the lens will  be unrefracted.

   The position of the image  can be determined
   by remembering that a light ray passing
   through the focus, F, will be parallel to
   the axis of the lens on the opposite  side of
   the lens and that a ray passing through the
   geometrical center of the  lens will  be
   unrefracted.
5-4

-------
                                                                   Optics and the Microscope
                 Figure 8

IMAGE FORMATION BY A CONVEX LENS

   The magnification,  M, of an image of an
   object produced by a lens is given by the
   relationship:
         _  image size _  image distance _ q
           object size    object distance " p

   where q = distance from image to lens
     and p = distance from object to lens.

H  Aberrations of Lenses

   Lenses have aberrations of several types
   which, unless corrected, cause loss of
   detail in the image.  Spherical aberration
   appears in lenses with spherical surfaces.
   Reduction of spherical aberration can be
   accomplished by diaphragming the outer
   zones of the lens or by designing special
   aspherical surfaces in the lens system.

   Chromatic aberration is a phenomenon
   caused by the variation of refractive index
   with wavelength (dispersion).  Thus a lens
   receiving  white light from an object will
   form a violet image closer to the lens and
   a red  one  farther away.  Achromatic
   lenses are employed to minimize this
   effect.  The lenses are combinations  of
   two or more lens elements made up of
   materials having different dispersive
   powers.  The use of monochromatic light
   is another obvious way of eliminating
   chromatic aberration.

   Astigmatism is a third aberration of
   spherical  lens systems.  It occurs when
object points are not located on the optical
axis of the lens and results in the formation
of an indistinct image.  The simplest
remedy for astigmatism is  to place the
object close to the axis of the lens system.

Interference  Phenomena

Interference  and diffraction are two phe-
nomena which are due to the wave character-
istics of light.  The superposition of two
light rays arriving simultaneously at a given
point will give rise to  interference effects,
whereby the intensity at that point will vary
from dark to bright depending on the  phase
differences between the two light rays.

The  first requirement for interference is
that  the light must come from a single
source.  The light may be  split into any
number of paths but must originate from
the same point (or coherent source).   Two
light waves from a coherent source arriv-
ing at a point in phase agreement will
reinforce each other (Figure 9a).   Two
light waves from a coherent source arriv-
ing at a point in opposite phase will cancel
each other (Figure 9b).
Figure 9a.
Two light rays,  1 and 2, of
the same frequency but dif-
ferent amplitudes, are  in phase
in the upper diagram.   In the
lower diagram,  rays 1  and 2
interfere constructively to give
a single wave of the  same fre-
quency and with an amplitude
equal to the summation of the
two former waves.
                                                                                    5-5

-------
Optics and the Microscope
                                  o*b
  Figure 9b.  Rays 1 and 2 are no>v 180°
             out of phase and interfere
             destructively.   The resultant,
             in the bottom diagram, is of
             the same frequency but is of
             reduced amplitude (a is
             negative and is  subtracted
             from b).
The reflection of a monochromatic light
beam by a thin film results in two beams,
one reflected from the top surface and one
from  the bottom surface.  The distance
traveled by the latter beam in excess of
the first is twice the thickness of the film
and its equivalent air path is:

              2 nt

   where n is the refractive index and
   t is the thickness of the film.

The second beam,  however, upon reflection
at the bottom surface, undergoes a half
wavelength shift and now the total retard-
ation  of the second beam with respect to
the first is given as:

      retardation = 2 nt + -=-
     where \ is the wavelength of the light
     beam.

  When retardation is exactly an odd number
  of half wavelengths, destructive interfer-
  ence takes place resulting in darkness.
  When it is  zero or an even number of half
  wavelengths, constructive interference
  results in brightness (Figure 10).
5-6
               Figure 10
    INTERFERENCE IN A THIN FILM

A simple interferometer can be made by
partially silvering a microscope slide and
cover slip.  A preparation between the  two
partially silvered surfaces will show inter-
ference fringes when viewed with mono-
chromatic light,  either transmitted or by
vertical  illuminator.  The fringes will be
close together with a wedge-shaped prep-
aration and  will reflect refractive index
differences  due to temperature variations,
concentration differences,  different solid
phases,  etc. The method has been used to
measure quantitatively the concentration of
solute around a growing crystal ^'(Figure 11).

                                                               50% Mirror
                                                                           \
                                                     L\L
          J-	Cover slip- — d
           ,     Specimen
\Agy«
               Figure 11
MICROSCOPICAL METHOD OF VIEWING
          INTERFERENCE IMAGES
 a Examination is by transmitted light.
      Light ray  undergoes multiple
      reflections  and produces dark and
      light fringes in the field.  A speci-
      men introduces a phase shift and
      changes  the fringe pattern.
 b Illumination is from the top.  The
      principle is the same but fringes
      show greater contrast.

-------
                                                                    Optics and the Microscope
   Each dark band represents an equivalent
   air -thickness of an odd number of half
   wavelengths.  Conversely,  each bright
   band is  the result of an even number of
   half wavelengths.

   With interference illumination, the effect
   of a transparent  object of different re-
   fractive index than the medium in the
   microscope  field is:

   1 a  change of light intensity of the object
     if the background  is uniformly illumi-
     nated (parallel cover slip) ,  or

   2 a  shift of the interference bands within
     the object if the background consists
     of bands (tilted cover slip).

   The relationship of refractive indices  of
   the surrounding medium and the object is
   as  follows:
                                             d =
          i= "m*1
                      ex
              2.44 f\
                D
                                           where f is the focal length of the lens,
                                           X. the wavelength, and D the diameter
                                           of the lens.

                                        It is  seen  that in order to maintain a
                                        small diffraction disc  at a given wave-
                                        length,  the diameter of the lens should
                                        be as large as possible with respect to
                                        the focal length.  It should be noted,
                                        also,  that a shorter wavelength produces
                                        a smaller disc.

                                        If two pin points  of  light are to be distin-
                                        guished in an image, their diffraction discs
                                        must not overlap more than one half their
                                        diameters.  The ability to  distinguish such
                                        image points is called resolving power and
                                        is expressed as one half of the preceding
                                        expression:
                                                          resolving power =
                     360t
                                                                1. 22 f X
                                                                  D
      where ns = refractive index of the
                 specimen
                 refractive index of the
                 surrounding medium
                 phase shift of the two
                 beams, degrees
                 wavelength of the light
                 thickness of the specimen.
m

6  =

X
t
J Diffraction
  In geometrical optics,  it is assumed  that
  light travels in straight lines.  This is not
  always true.   We note  that a beam passing
  through a  slit toward a screen creates a
  bright band wider than the slit with alter-
  nate  bright and dark bands appearing on
  either side of the central bright band,
  decreasing in intensity as a function of
  the distance from the center.  Diffraction
  describes this phenomenon and, as one of
  its practical consequences,  limits the
  lens  in it? ability to reproduce an image.
  For example, the image of a pin point of
  light produced by a lens is not a pin point
  but is revealed to be a  somewhat larger
  patch of light surrounded by  dark  and
  bright rings.  The diameter,  d, of this
  diffraction disc (to the  first dark  ring)
  is given as:
II   THE COMPOUND MICROSCOPE

 The compound microscope is an extension in
 principle of the simple magnifying glass;
 hence it is essential to understand fully the
 properties of this simple lens system.

 A  Image Formation by the Simple Magnifier

    The apparent size of an object is  determined
    by the angle that is formed at the eye by the
    extreme rays of the object.  By bringing the
    object closer to the  eye, that angle (called
    the visual angle) is  increased.  This also
    increases the apparent size.  However a
    limit of accommodation of the eye is reached,
    at which distance the eye can no longer focus.
    This limiting distance  is about  10 inches or  25
    centimeters.  It is at this distance that the
    magnification of an object observed by the
    unaided eye is  said  to be unity.   The  eye can,
    of course, be focused at shorter distances but
    not usually  in a relaxed condition.

    A  positive,  or  converging,  lens can be used
    to permit placing an object closer than 10
    inches to the eye (Figure 12).  By this means
    the visual angle of the object  is increased
    (as is its  apparent size) while the image of
                                                                                      5-7

-------
Optics and the Microscope
     Image
                Figure 12

    VIRTUAL IMAGE FORMATION BY
             CONVEX LENS

   the object appears to be 10 inches from
   the eye,  where it is best accommodated.

B  Magnification by a Single Lens System

   The magnification, M,  of a simple magni-
   fying glass is given by:

         M. f +1

      where f =  focal length of the lens in
                centimeters.

   Theoretically the magnification can be
   increased with shorter focal length lenses.
   However such lenses require placing the
   eye very close to the lens surface and
   have much image distortion and other
   optical aberrations. The practical limit
   for a simple  magnifying glass  is about
   2 OX.

   In order  to go to magnifications higher
   than 20X, the compound microscope is
   required. Two  lens systems are used
   to form an enlarged image of an object
   ^Figure 13).  This is accomplished in
   two steps, the first by a lens called the
   objective and the second by a lens known
   as the eyepiece  (or ocular).

C  The Objective

   The objective is the lens (or lens system)
   closest to the object.   Its function is to
   reproduce an enlarged image of the object
   in the body tube of the  microscope.
   Objectives are available in various focal
         Objective
                                                                             Eyepiece
         Vrluol Image
                Figure 13

         IMAGE FORMATION IN
        COMPOUND MICROSCOPE

lengths to give different magnifications
(Table 3).  The magnification is calculated
from the focal length by dividing the latter
into  the tube length, usually 160 mm.

The  numerical aperture (N. A.) is a measure
of the ability of an objective to resolve detail.
This is more fully discussed in the next
section.  The working distance is in the free
space between the objective and the cover
slip  and varies slightly for objectives of the
same focal length depending upon the degree
of correction and the manufacturer.

There  are three basic classifications of
objectives:  achromats,  fluorites and
apochromats, listed in the order of their
complexity.  The achromats are good for
routine work while the fluorites and apo-
chromats offer additional optical corrections
to compensate  for spherical, chromatic and
other aberrations.
 5-8

-------
                                                                Optics and the Microscope
Table 3. NOMINAL CHARACTERISTICS OF USUAL
Nominal
focal length
mm
56
32
16
8
4
4
1.8
Nominal
magnif.
2. 5X
5
10
20
43
45
90
N.A.
0.08
0. 10
0.25
0.50
0. 66
0. 85
1. 30
Working
distance
mm
40
25
7
1. 3
0. 7
0.5
0.2
Depth
focus
H
50
16
8
2
1
1
0.4
Diam. of
field
mm.
8.5
5
2
1
0. 5
0.4
0.2
MICROSCOPE OBJECTIVES
Resolving
power, white
light, IJL
4.4
3.9
1.4
0.7
0.4
0.35
0.21
Maximum
useful
magnif.
SOX
90X
250X
500X
660X
850X
1250X
Eyepiece
for max.
useful magnif.
SOX
2 OX
25X
25X
15X
20X
12X
Another system of objectives employs  •
reflecting surfaces in the shape of concave
and convex mirrors.  Reflection optics,
because they have no refracting elements,
do not suffer from chromatic aberrations
as ordinary refraction objectives do.  Based
entirely on reflection, reflecting objectives
are extremely useful in the infrared and
ultraviolet regions of the  spectrum.  They
also have a much longer working distance
than the refracting objectives.

The body tube of the microscope supports
the objective at  the bottom (over the object)
and the eyepiece at the top.  The tube
length is maintained at 160 mm except for
Leitz instruments, which have a 170-mm
tube length.

The objective support may be of two kinds,
an objective clutch changer or a rotating
nosepiece:

1  The objective clutch changer  ("quick-
   change"  holder) permits the mounting  ,
   of only one objective at a time on the
   microscope.  It has a centering arrange-
   ment, so that each objective need be
   centered only once with respect to the
   stage  rotation.  The changing of objec-
   tives with this system is  somewhat
   awkward compared with the rotating
   nosepiece.

2  The revolving nosepiece allows mounting
   three  or four objectives on the microscope
      at one time (there are some nosepieces
      that accept five and even six objectives).
      In this system, the  objectives are
      usually noncenterable and the  stage is
      centerable.  Several manufacturers pro-
      vide centerable objective mounts so that
      each objective on the nosepiece need be
      centered only:pnce to the fixed rotating
      stage.  The insides of objectives are
      better protected from dust by  the rotating
      nosepiece.  This, as well as the incon-
      venience of the so-called "quick-change"
      objective holder, makes it worthwhile
      to have one's microscope  fitted with
      rotating nosepiece.

D  The Ocular

   The eyepiece, or ocular,  is necessary in
   the second step of the magnification process.
   The eyepiece functions as a simple magni-
   fier viewing the  image formed by the
   objective.

   There are three classes of eyepieces in
   common use:  huyghenian,  compensating
   and flat-field.  The huyghenian (or  huyghens)
   eyepiece is designed to be used with
   achromats while the compensating type is
   used with fluorite and apochromatic
   objectives.  Flat-field eyepieces, as the
   name implies, are  employed in photo-
   micrography or projection and can  be used
   with  most objectives.   It is best to  follow
   the recommendations  of the manufacturer
   as to the proper combination of objective
   and eyepiece.
                                                                                 5-9

-------
Optics and the Microscope
   The usual magnifications available in
   oculars run from about 6X up to 25 or
   SOX.  The 6X is generally too low to be of
   any real value while the 25 and SOX oculars
   have slightly poorer imagery than medium
   powers and have a very low eyepoint.  The
   most useful eyepieces lie in the 10 to 20X
   magnification range.

E  Magnification of the Microscope

   The total magnification of the objective-
   eyepiece combination is simply the product
   of the two individual magnifications.  A
   convenient working rule to assist in the
   proper choice  of eyepieces states that the
   maximum useful magnification (MUM) for
   the  microscope is 1, 000 times the numeri-
   cal  aperture (N.A.) of the objective.
   The MUM is related to resolving power
   in that magnification in excess  of MUM
   gives little or no additional resolving
   power and results in what is termed empty
   magnification.  Table  4 shows the results
   of such combinations and a comparison
   with the 1000XN. A. rule.  The under-
   lined figure shows the magnification near-
   est to the MUM and the eyepiece required
   with each objective to achieve the MUM.
   From this table it is apparent that only
   higher power eyepieces can give full use
   of the resolving power of the objectives.
   It is obvious that a 10X, or even a 15X,
   eyepiece gives insufficient magnification
   for the eye to see detail actually resolved
   by the objective..

F  Focusing the  Microscope

   The coarse adjustment is used to roughly
   position the body tube (in some newer
   microscopes,  the stage) to bring the image
   into focus.  The fine adjustment is used
   after the coarse adjustment to bring the
   image into perfect focus and to maintain
   the focus as the slide is moved across the
   stage.  Most  microscope objectives are
   parfocal so that once they are  focused any
   other objective can be swung into position
   without the necessity of refocusing except
   with the fine adjustment.

   The student of the  microscope should first
   learn to focus in the  following fashion, to
   prevent damage to a  specimen or objective:

   1   Raise the body tube and place the speci-
      men on the stage.

   2   Never focus the body tube down (or the
      stage up) while  observing the field
      through the eyepiece.

   3   Lower the body tube (or raise the stage)
      with the coarse adjustment while care-
      fully observing  the space between the
                   Table 4.  MICROSCOPE MAGNIFICATION CALCULATED
                   FOR VARIOUS OBJECTIVE-EYEPIECE COMBINATIONS
Objective
Focal Magni-
length
56mm
32
16
8
4
1.8
fication
3X
5
10
20
40
90
5X
15X
25X
SOX
100X
200X
450X
10X
SOX
50X
100X
200X
400X
900X
Eyepiece
15X
45X
75X
150X
300X
600X
1350X

2 OX
6 OX
100X
200X
40 OX
800X
1800X

25X
75X
125X
2jOX
500JX
1000X
2250X
MUMa
(1000 NA)
SOX
100X
250X
500X
660X
1250X
            aMUM = maximum useful magnification
       5-10

-------
                                                                    Optics and the Microscope
      objective and slide and permitting the
      two to come close together without
      touching.

   4  Looking through the microscope and
      turning the fine adjustment in such a
      way as to move the objective away from
     .the specimen, bring the image into
      sharp focus.

   The fine adjustment is usually calibrated
   in one-  or two-micron steps to indicate
   the vertical movement of the body tube.
   This feature is useful in making depth
   measurements but should not be relied
   upon for accuracy.

G  The Substage Condenser

   The substage holds the condenser and
   polarizer.   It can usually be focused in a
   vertical direction so that the condenser can
   be brought into the  correct position  with
   respect to the specimen  for proper
   illumination.  In some models, the conden-
   ser is centerable so that it may be set
   exactly in the axis of rotation of the  stage;
   otherwise it will have been precentered at
   the factory and should be permanent.

H  The Microscope Stage

   The stage of the microscope supports the
   specimen between the condenser and
   objective, and may offer a mechanical stage
   as an attachment to provide a means of
   moving the slide methodically during obser-
   vation.  The polarizing microscope  is
   fitted with a circular rotating stage  to
   which a mechanical stage may be added.
   The rotating stage, which is used for object
   orientation to observe optical effects, will
   have centering screws if the objectives are
   not centerable,  or vice versa.  It is un-
   desirable to have both objectives and stage
   centerable as this does not provide a fixed
   reference axis.

I  The Polarizing Elements

   A polarizer is fitted to the condenser of all
   polarizing microscopes.  In routine instru-
   ments,  the polarizer is fixed with its
   vibration direction oriented north-south
   (east-west for most European instruments)
   while in research microscopes, the
   polarizer can be  rotated.   Modern instru-
   ments have polarizing filters (such as
   Polaroid) replacing the older calcite
   prisms.  Polarizing filters are preferred
   because they:

   1  are low-cost;

   2  require no maintenance;

   3  permit use of  the full condenser
      aperture.

   An analyzer, of the same  construction as
   the polarizer, is  fitted in the body tube of
   the microscope on a slider so that it may
   be easily removed from the optical path.
   It is  oriented with its plane of vibration
   perpendicular to  the corresponding direction
   of the polarizer.

J  The Bertrand Len&

   The Bertrand lens is usually found only on
   the polarizing microscope although some
   manufacturers are beginning to include it
   on phase microscopes. It is located in the
   body tube above the analyzer on a slider
   (or pivot) to permit quick removal from
   the optical path.  The Bertrand lens is used
   to observe the back focal  plane of the objective.
   It is  convenient for checking quickly the type
   and quality of illumination, for observing
   interference figures of crystals,  for adjust-
   ing the phase annuli in phase microscopy
   and for adjusting  the annular and central
   stops in dispersion staining.

K  The Compensator Slot

   The compensator slot receives compensators
   (quarter-wave,  first-order red and quartz-
   wedge) for observation of the optical prop-
   erties of crystalline materials.  It is usually
   placed at the lower end of the body tube just
   above the objective mount, and is  oriented
   45° from the vibration directions  of the
   polarizer and analyzer.

L  The Stereoscopic Microscope

   The stereoscopic microscope,  also called
   the binocular, wide-fie Id,  dissecting or
                                                                                        5-11

-------
  Optics and the Microscope
    Greenough binocular microscope, is in
    reality a combination of two separate
    compound microscopes.  The two micro-
    scopes, usually mounted in one body, have
    their optical axes inclined from the vertical
    by about 7° and from each other by  twice
    this angle.  When an object is placed on the
    stage of a stereoscopic microscope, the
    optical systems view it from slightly
    different angles, presenting a stereoscopic
    pair of images to the eyes, which fuse the
    two into a single three-dimensional image.
                           .1.
    The objectives are supplied  in pairs,  either
    as separate units to be mounted on the
    microscope or, as in the new instruments,
    built into a rotating drum.  Bausch  and
    Lomb  was the first manufacturer  to have a
    zoom lens system which gives a continuous
    change in magnification over the full range.
    Objectives for the stereomicroscope run
    from about 0. 4X to 12X,  well below the
    magnification range of objectives  available
    for single-objective microscopes.

    The eyepieces supplied with stereoscopic
    microscopes run from  10 to 25X and have
    wider  fields than their counterparts in the
    single-objective microscopes.

    Because of mechanical limitations,  the
    stereomicroscope is limited to  about 200X
    magnification and usually does not permit
    more than about  120X.  It is most useful
    at relatively low powers in observing
    shape  and surface texture, relegating the
    study of greater detail to the monocular
    microscope.  The stereomicroscope is
    also helpful in manipulating  small samples,
    separating ingredients of mixtures,  pre-
    paring specimens for detailed study at
    higher magnifications and performing
    various mechanical operations under micro-
    scopical observation, e. g. micromanipulation.
Ill  ILLUMINATION AND RESOLVING POWER

 Good resolving power and optimum specimen
 contrast are prerequisites for good microscopy.
 Assuming the availability  of suitable optics
 (ocular, objectives and substage condenser)
 it is still of paramount importance to use
 proper illumination.  The requirement for a
good illumination system for the microscope
is to have uniform intensity of illumination
over the 'entire field of view with independent
control of intensity and of the angular aperture
of the illuminating cone.

A  Basic Types of Illumination

   There are three types of illumination
   (Table 5) used generally:

   1  Critical.  This is used when high levels
      of illumination intensity are necessary
      for oil immersion,  darkfield,  fluores-
      cence, low birefringence or photo-
      micrographic studies.  Since the lamp
      filament is  imaged in the plane of the
      specimen, a ribbon filament or arc
      lamp is required.  The lamp must be
      focusable and have an iris diaphragm;
      the position of the filament must also
      be adjustable in all directions.

   2  Kohler.  Also useful for intense illumi-
      nation, Ko'hler illumination may be
      obtained with any lamp not fitted with a
      ground glass.  The  illuminator must,
      however, be focusable,  it must have an
      adjustable field diaphragm (iris) and the
      lamp filament position must be adjust-
      able in all directions.

   3  "Poor man's".  So-called because a low-
      priced illuminator may be used, this
      method gives illumination of high quality
      although of  lower intensity because of the
      presence of a ground glass in the system.
      No adjustments are necessary on the
      illuminator or lamp filament although
      an adjustable diaphragm on the illuminator
      is helpful.

   All three types of illumination require that
   the microscope substage condenser focus
   the image of the  illuminator aperture in the
   plane of the specimen.  In each case, then,
   the lamp iris acts as a field diaphragm and
   should be closed to just illuminate the  field
   of view.  The differences in these three
   types of illumination lie in the adjustment
   of the lamp condensing lens.  With poor
   man's illumination there is no lamp conden-
   ser,  hence no adjustment.  The lamp should
   be  placed close to the microscope so that
  5-12

-------
                                                                 Optics and  the Microscope
                         Table 5.   COMPARISON OF CRITICAL,
                      KOHLER AND J^OOR MAN'S ILLUMINATION
                                   Critical
   Kohler
Poor man's
Lamp filament
Lamp condensing lens
Lamp iris
Ground glass at lamp
Image of light source

Image of field iris
Image of substage iris
ribbon filament
required
required
none
in object plane

near object
plane
back focal plane
of objective
any type
required
required
none
at substage
iris
in object •
plane
back focal plane
of objective
any type
none
useful
present
none

near object
plane
back focal plane
of objective
the entire field of view is always
illuminated.  If the surface structure of the
ground glass becomes apparent in the field
of view the substage condenser is very
slightly defocused.

Critical Illumination

With critical illumination the lamp conden-
ser is focused to give parallel rays;  focus-
ing the lamp filament on a far wall is
sufficient.  Aimed, then, at the substage
mirror,  the substage condenser will focus
the lamp filament in the object plane. The
substage condenser iris will now be found
imaged in the back focal plane of the ob-
jective; it serves as a control over con-
vergence of the illumination.   Although the
substage iris also affects the light intensity
over the  field of view it should most decid-
edly not be used for this purpose.  The
intensity of illumination may  be varied by  .
the use of neutral density filters and, unless
color photomicrography is anticipated, by
the use of variable voltage on the  lamp
filament.
  it
Kohler illumination (Figure 14) differs
from critical illumination in the use  of the
lamp condenser.   With critical illumination
the lamp condenser focuse^ the lamp
filament  at infinity; with Kohler illumination
the lamp filament is focused in the plane of
the substage condenser iris (also coincident
with the anterior focal plane of the substage
condenser).  The functions of the lamp
condenser iris and the substage condenser
iris in controlling, respectively,  the area
of the illuminated field of view and the
angular aperture of the illuminating cone
are precisely alike for all three types of
illumination.

Critical illumination  is seldom used because
it requires a special  lamp filament and be-
cause, when used,  it shows no advantage
over well-adjusted Kohler illumination.
  n
Kohler Illumination

To arrange the microscope and illuminator
for Kohler illumination it is well to proceed
through the following steps:

   a  Remove the diffusers and filters
      from the lamp.

   b  Turn the lamp on and aim at a con-
      venient wall or vertical screen about
      19 inches away. Open the lamp
      diaphragm.

   c  By moving the lamp  condenser,  focus
      a sharp image of the filament.   It
      should be of such a size as to fill,
      not necessarily evenly,  the microscope
                                                                                       5-13

-------
Optics and the Microscope
                Critical
Kohler
Poor man's
    Eye

  Eyepoint


    Ocular



  Focal plane
  Focal  plane
  Objective


  Preparation


  Substage
    condenser
  Substage  —
     iris
  Lamp  iris  —
  Lamp
    condenser

  Light source
5-14

-------
                                                              Optics and the Microscope
   substage condenser opening.  If it
   does not,  move the lamp away from
   the wall to enlarge the filament, image;
   refocus.

d  Turn the lamp ami aim it at the micro-
   scope mirror so as to maintain the
   same 18  inches (or adjusted lamp
   distance).

e  Place a specimen  on the microscope
   stage and focus sharply with a l(>-mm
   (10X) objective.  Open fully the
   aperture diaphragm in the substage
   condenser.  If the  light is  too bright,
   temporarily place  a neutral density
   filter or  a diffuser in the lamp.

f  Close the lamp diaphragm, or field
   diaphragm,  to about a 1-cm opening.
   Rack the microscope  substage con-
   denser up and down to focus the
   field diaphragm sharply  in the same
   plane as  the specimen.

g  Adjust the mirror  to center the field
   diaphragm in the field of view.

h  Remove the 16-mm objective and
   replace with a 4-mm  objective.  Move
   the specimen so that a clear area is
   under observation. Place  the
   Bertrand  lens in the optical path,  or
   remove the  eyepiece and insert an
   auxiliary  telescope (sold with phase
   contrast  accessories)  in its place,
   or remove the eyepiece and observe
   the back  aperture  of the objective
   directly.  Remove any ground glass
   diffusers  from the lamp.   Now
   observe the lamp filament  through
   the microscope.

i  If the filament does not appear to be
   centered, swing the lamp housing in
   a horizontal arc whose center is at
   the field  diaphragm.  The  purpose
   is to maintain the  field diaphragm on
   the lamp in  its centered position.  If
   a vertical movement of the filament
   is required, loosen the buib base and
   slide it up or down.  If the base is
   fixed, tilt the lamp housing in a
   vertical arc with the field  diaphragm
      as the center of movement (again
      endeavoring to keep the lamp dia-
      phragm in the centered position).
      If you have mastered this step, you
      have accomplished the most difficult
      portion.   (Hetter microscope lamps
      have adjustments to move the bulb
      independently of the lamp housing to
      simplify this step. )

   j  Put the  specimen in place,  replace
      the eyepiece  and the desired objec-
      tive and  refocus.

   k  Open or  close the field diaphragm
      until it just disappears from the field.

   1  Observe the back aperture of the
      objective, preferably with the  Bertrand
      lens or the ..auxiliary telescope, and
      close  the aperture  diaphragm on the
      substage condenser until it  is about
      four-fifths the diameter of the back
      aperture. This is  the best position
      for the aperture diaphragm, a posi-
      tion which minimizes glare  and maxi-
      mizes the resolving power.   It is
      instructive to vary  the aperture dia-
      phragm and observe the image criti-
      cally during the manipulation.

   m If the  illumination is too great,   »
      insert an appropriate neutral density
      filter between the  illuminator and
      the condenser.  Do not use the con-
      denser aperture diaphragm or the
      lamp field diaphragm to control the
      intensity of illumination.

Poor Man's Illumination
Both critical and Kohler illumination re-
quire expensive illuminators with adjust-
able focus,  lamp iris and adjustable lamp
mounts.  Poor man's illumination requires
a cheap illuminator although an expensive
illuminator  may be used if its expensive
features are negated by inserting a  ground
glass diffuser or by using a frosted bulb.
Admittedly an iris diaphragm on the lamp
would be a help though  it  is not necessary.

   a  The illuminator must have a frosted
      bulb or a ground  glass diffuser.
                                                                                 5-15

-------
Optics and the Microscope
         It should bo possible to direct it in
         the general direction of the substage
         mirror, very close thereto or in
         place thereof.

      b  Focus on any preparation after
         tilting the  mirror to illuminate the
         field.

      c  Remove the top lens of the condenser
         and, by racking the condenser up or,
         more often,  down, bring into focus
         (in the  same plane as  the specimen)
         a finger, pencil or other object placed
         in the same general region as the
         ground  glass diffuser  on the lamp.
         The glass  surface itself can then be
         focused in the plane of the specimen.

      d  Ideally  the ground glass surface will
         just fill the field of view when centered
         by the substage mirror; adjustment
         may be made by moving the  lamp
         closer  to or farther from the micro-
         scope (the position might be marked
         for each objective used) or by cutting
         paper diaphragms of fixed aperture
         (one for each objective used).  In this
         instance a lamp iris would be useful.

      e  Lower  the condenser just sufficiently
         to defocus the ground  glass surface
         and render the field of illumination
         even.

      f  Observe the back aperture of the
         objective and open the substage con-
         denser  iris about 75 percent of the
         way.  The final adjustment of the
         substage iris is made while  observing
         the preparation; the iris should be
         open as far as possible,  still giving
         good contrast.

      g  The intensity of illumination should
         be adjusted only with neutral density
         filters  or by changing the lamp voltage.

   Proper illumination is one of the most im-
   portant operations in microscopy.  It is
   easy to judge a microscopist's ability by
   a glance at his field of view and the objec-
   tive back lens.
   5-16
H  llesolving Power

   The resolving power of the microscope is
   its ability to distinguish separate details
   of closely spaced microscopic structures.
   The theoretical limit of resolving two
   discrete points,  a distance- X  apart, is:

         X   1^2JL
         * "  2 N. A.

      where X.  - wavelength of  light used to
                 illuminate the  specimen
          N. A. = numerical aperture of the
                 objective

   Substituting a  wavelength of 4, 500
   Angstroms and a numerical aperture of
   1. 3,  about the best that can be done with
   visible light,  we find that two points about
   2, OOOA (or 0. 2 micron) apart can be seen
   as two separate points. Further increase
   in resolving power can be achieved for the
   light microscope by using light or shorter
   wavelength.   Ultraviolet light near 2, 000
   Angstroms lowers the  limit to about 0. 1
   micron, the lower limit for the light
   microscope.

   The numerical aperture of an objective is
   usually engraved  on the objective and is
   related to the angular aperture, AA
   (Figure 15),  by the formula:
        N. A. = n sin
AA
 2
      where n = the lowest index in the space
                between the object and the
                objective.
                           Angular aperture
      Object
                 Figure 15

         ANGULAR APERTURE OF
         MICROSCOPE OBJECTIVE

-------
                                                                Optics and the Microscope
1  Maximum useful magnification

   A helpful rule of thumb is that the use-
   ful magnification will not exceed 1,000
   times the numerical aperture of the
   objective (see Tables 3 and 4).  Although
   somewhat higher magnification may be
   used in specific cases,  no additional
   detail will be resolved.

   It is curious, considering the figures
   in the table, that most, if not all, manu-
   facturers of microscopes furnish a 10X
   eyepiece as the highest power.  A 10X
   eyepiece is useful but anyone interested
   in critical work should use a 15-25X eye-
   piece; the  5-10X eyepieces are best for
   scanning purposes.

2  Abbe's theory of resolution

   One of the most cogent theories of
   resolution is due to Ernst Abbe, who
   suggested  that microscopic objects act
   like diffraction gratings (Figure 16) and
   that the angle of diffraction,  therefore,
   increases  with the fineness of the detail.
   He proposed that a given microscope
   objective would resolve a particular
   detail if at least two or three transmitted
   rays (one direct and two diffracted  rays)
   entered the objective.  In Figure 16 the
   detail shown would be resolved in A and
   C but not in B.   This theory, which can
   be borne out by simple experiment,  is
   useful in showing how to improve resolu-
   tion.  Since shorter wavelengths will
   give a smaller diffraction angle,  there
   is more chance of resolving fine detail
   with short wavelengths.  Also, since
   only two of the transmitted rays are
   needed, oblique light and a high N.A.
   condenser will aid in resolving fine detail.

3  Improving resolving power

   The following list summarizes the
   practical approaches to higher resolu-
   tion with the light microscope:

   a The specimen should be illuminated
     by either critical or Kohler
     illumination.
                               /
             Figure 16

 ABBE THEORY OF RESOLUTION
b  The condenser should be well-
   corrected and have a numerical
   aperture as high as the objective to
   be used.

c  An apochromatic oil-immersion
   objective should be used with a com-
   pensating eyepiece of at least 15X
   magnification.  The  immersion oil
   should have an index  close to 1. 515
   and have proper dispersion for the
   objective being used.

d  Immersion oil should be placed
   between the condenser and slide and
   between cover slip and objective.
   The  preparation itself should be
   surrounded by a liquid having a
   refractive index of 1. 515 or more.

e  The  illumination  should be reasonably
   monochromatic and as short in wave-
   length as possible. An interference
   filter transmitting a wavelength of
   about 480-500 millimicrons is a
   suitable answer to this problem.
   Ideally, of cpurse, ultraviolet light
   should be used to decrease the wave-
   length still further.

The practical effect of many of these
factors is critically discussed by
Loveland^2) in a paper on the optics of
object space.
                                                                                    5-17

-------
  Optics and the Microscope
IV  PHOTOMICROGRAPHY

 A Introduction

    Photomicrography, as distinct from micro-
    photography,  is the art of taking pictures
    through the microscope.  A microphoto-
    graph is a small photograph; a photomicro-
    graph is a photograph of a small object.
    Photomicrography  is a valuable tool in
    recording the results of microscopical
    study.  It enables the microscopist to:

    1  describe a microscopic field objectively
       without resorting to written descriptions.

    2  record a particular field for future
       reference,

    3  make particle size counts and counting
       analyses easily  and without tying up a
       microscope,

    4  enhance or exaggerate the visual micro-
       scopic field to bring out or emphasize
       certain details not readily apparent
       visually,

    5  record images in ultraviolet and infra-
       red microscopy  which are otherwise
       invisible to the unaided eye.

    There are two general approaches to photo-
    micrography; one requires only a plate or
    film holder supported above the eyepiece
    of the microscope with a light-tight bellows;
    the other utilizes any ordinary camera with
    its own lens system,  supported with a light-
    tight adaptor above the eyepiece.  It is
    best, in the latter case,  to use a reflex
    camera so that the  image can be carefully
    focused on the ground glass.  Photomi-
    crography of this type can be regarded
    simply as replacing the eye with the camera
    lens system.  The  camera should be focused
    at infinity, just as  the eye is for visual
    observation, and it should be positioned
    close to and over the eyepiece.

    The  requirements for photomicrography,
    however, are more rigorous than those
    for visual work.  The eye can normally
    compensate for varying light intensities.
   curvature of field and depth of field.  The
   photographic plate, however,  lies in one
   plane; hence the greatest care must be
   used to focus sharply on the subject plane
   of interest and  to select optics to give
   minimum amounts of field curvature and
   chromatic aberrations.

   With black and  white film,  color filters
   may be used to enhance the contrast of
   some portions of the specimen while mini-
   mizing chromatic aberrations of the lenses.
   In color work,  however, filters cannot
   usually be used for this purpose and better
   optics may be required.

   Photomicrographic cameras which fit
   directly onto the microscope are available
   in 35-mm or up to 3-1/4 X 4-1/4 inch sizes.
   Others are made which  accommodate larger
   film sizes and which have their  own support
   independent of the  microscope.  The former,
   however,  are preferred for ease of handling
   and lower cost.  The latter system is pre-
   ferred for greater flexibility and versatility
   and lack of vibration. The Polaroid camera
   has many  applications in microscopy and
   can be used on  the microscope directly but,
   because of its weight, only when the micro-
   scope has a vertically moving stage for
   focusing rather than a focusing body tube.

B  Determination of Correct Exposure

   Correct exposure determination can be
   accomplished by trial and error, by relating
   new conditions to previously used successful
   conditions and by photometry.

   With the trial and error method a series of
   trial exposures is  made, noting the type of
   subject, illumination, filters, objective,
   eyepiece,  magnification, film and  shutter
   speed.  The best exposure is selected.  The
   following parameters can be changed and
   the exposure time adjusted accordingly:

   1  Magnification.   Exposure time varies
      as the square of the magnification.

      Example:   Good exposure  was  obtained
                 with a 1/10-second  exposure
                and a magnification of 100X.
                If'.lthe magnification is now
      5-18

-------
                                                             Optics and the Microscope
           200X,  the correct exposure
           is calculated as follows:
new

   .new magnification.2    .    /200.2 .
   Vold magnification '     '    H00;
4/10 or, say, 1/2 second.
                                                        Kodachrome II Type A
                                                        Professional is 40.
exposure time = old exposure time            new exposure time = old exposure time
                                             X A.S.A. of old film  = 1/100(400/40) =
                                               A. S. A. of new film

                                             10/100 or 1/10 second.
It should be noted, however, that the
above calculation can be made only when
there has been no change in the  illumi-
nation system including the condenser
or the objective.  Only changes  in magni-
fication due to changing eyepieces or
bellows extension distance can be hand-
led in the above manner.

Numerical aperture.  Exposure  time
varies inversely as the  square of the
smallest working numerical aperture
of the condenser and objective.

Example:   Good exposure was obtained
            at 1/10 second with  the 10X
            objective, N. A. 0.25, at
            full aperture.  With a 20X
            objective, N.A. 0.25, at
            full aperture and the same
            final magnification,  what is
            the correct exposure time?

new exposure time  = old exposure time

X(2WN^r)2Bi/io fg4J)2.  1/40 or.
   new N. A.          0. 50

say,  1/50 second.

It is seen that more light reaches the
photographic film with higher numeri-
cal apertures at the same magnification.

Film.  Exposure time varies inversely
with the. American Standards Association
speed index of the film.

Example:   A good picture was obtained
            with Eastman Tri-X film at
            1/100 second. What is the
            correct exposure for
            Eastman Kodachrome II
            Type A. The A. S. A. speed
            for Tri-X is 400 and for
                                          4  Other parameters may be varied but the
                                             prediction of exposure time cannot be
                                             made readily.  Experience and photo-
                                             electric devices are the best guides to
                                             the proper  exposure.

                                          Photoelectric  devices are excellent for
                                          determining correct exposure.  Since
                                          ordinary photographic exposure meters
                                          are not sensitive enough for photomi-
                                          crography, more sensitive instruments,
                                          having a galvanometer or electronic
                                          amplifying circuit, are required.   Some
                                          photosensitive cells are inserted in the
                                          body tube in place of the eyepiece for
                                          light intensity readings. This has the
                                          advantage of detecting the light level at a
                                          point  of high intensity but does not take
                                          into account the eyepiece, the distance to
                                          the film or the film speed.

                                          The cell may be placed just above the eye-
                                          piece so that it registers the total amount
                                          of light leaving the eyepiece.  Again,  the
                                          effects of film speed  and the projection
                                          distance are not accounted for.  The prin-
                                          cipal  drawback with the total light
                                          measuring photometer is the difficulty of
                                          taking into account the area of field covered.
                                          Take,  for example, a bright field in which
                                          only a few crystals appear; perhaps 1 per-
                                          cent of the light entering the field of view is
                                          scattered by the crystals and  the photometer
                                          shows close to a maximum reading.  Now
                                          assume that everything remains constant
                                          except the number  of crystals and, conse-
                                          quently,  the amount of light scattered.
                                          The photometer reading could easily drop
                                          by 50 percent,  yet  the proper  exposure is
                                          unchanged.  The situation is similar for
                                          photomicrography with crossed polars since
                                          the photometer reading depends on the
                                          intensity of illumination, on the bire-
                                          fringence and  thickness of the crystals and
                                                                                5-19

-------
Optics and the Microscope
   on the number and size of the crystals in
   the field or,  alternatively, on the area of
   the field covered by birefringent crystals.
   One of the best solutions to this problem
   is to measure the photometer reading with
   no preparation on the stage.  A first-order
   red compensator or a quartz wedge is  in-
   serted when crossed polars are being used
   to illuminate the  entire field.

   An alternative is to place the cell on the
   ground glass where the film will be
   located.  However, although all variables
   except film speed are now taken into
   account, measurements in the image plane
   have the disadvantage of requiring a more
   sensitive electronic photoelectric apparatus.

   No matter what method is used for placing
   the photocell, the exposure time can be
   determined by the general formula:
      exposure time =
                       meter reading
   The constant k will depend on the physical
   arrangement and film used.  To determine
   k for any particular system, first set up
   the microscope to take a picture.  Record
   the meter reading and take a series of
   trial exposures.  Pick out the best exposure
   and calculate k.  Then the k which was
   determined holds as long as no change is
   made in the light path beyond the photocell,
   e. g. changing to a faster film or changing
   the projection distance.  Thus the objective,
   condenser  position or illuminator may be
   changed without affecting k  if the cell is
   used as described above.

   Example:   With one particular arrange-
               ment of photocell and film,
               the meter reading is  found to
               be  40.  A series of photographs
               are taken at 1/2,  1/5,  1/10,
               1/25 and 1/50 seconds.  The
               photomicrograph taken at 1/5
               second is judged to be the best;
               hence k is calculated as follows:

               k = meter reading X exposure
               time =  40 X  1/5  =  8.

               Assume now that a new picture
               is to be taken at another
               magnification (but with the
               same film and projection
               distance) and that the new
               meter reading is 16; therefore:

               exposure time = k/meter
               reading = 8/16 = 1/2 second.
V   MICROMETRY

 A  Particle Size Determination

    Linear distances and areas can be
    measured with the microscope.  This
    permits determination of particle size
    and quantitative analysis  of physical
    mixtures.  The usual unit of length for
    microscopical measurements is the  micron
    (1 X 10-3mm or about 4 X 10-5inch).
    Measuring particles  in electron microscopy
    requires an even smaller unit, the milli-
    micron (1 X  10~3 micron or 10 Angstrom
    units).   Table 6 shows the approximate
    average' size of a few common airborne
    materials.
 Table 6.  APPROXIMATE PARTICLE SIZE OF
      SEVERAL COMMON PARTICULATES
 Ragweed pollen
 Fog droplets
 Power plant flyash
 (after precipitators)
 Tobacco smoke


 Foundry fumes
  25 microns
  20 microns

 2-5 microns


   0. 2 micron
  (200 millimicrons)
   0. 1 - 1 micron
(100-1000 millimicrons)
    The practical lower limit of accurate
    particle size measurement with the light
    microscope is about 0. 5  micron.  The
    measurement of a particle  smaller than
    this with the light microscope leads to
    errors which,  under the  best circum-
    stances,  increase to about  + 100 percent
    (usually +).

    One of the principal uses of high resolving
    power is in the precise measurement of
  5-20

-------
                                                                Optics and the Microscope
particle size.  There are, however,  a
variety of approximate and useful proce-
dures as well.

1  Methods of particle size measurement

   a  Knowing the magnification of the
      microscope (product of the magni-
      fication of objective and eyepiece),
      the size of particles can be esti-
      mated.  For example,  with a 10X
      eyepiece  and a 16-mm (or 10X)
      objective, the total  magnification
      is 100X.  A particle that appears to
      be  10-mm at 10  inches from the eye
      has an actual size of 10 mm divided
      by  100 or 0. 10 mm  or  100 microns.
      This  is in no sense  an accurate
      method, but it does permit quick
      estimation of particle size; the error
      in this estimation is usually 10-25
      percent.

   b  Another approximate method is also
      based on  the use of  known data. If
      we know approximately the diameter
      of the microscope field, we can
      estimate  the percentage of the
      diameter occupied by the object to
      be measured and calculate from
      these figures the approximate size
      of the object.  The size of the micro-
      scope field depends on both the objec-
      tive and the ocular although the latter
      is a minor influence.  The size of
      the field should be determined with
      a millimeter scale for each objective
      and ocular.  If this  is done,  esti-
      mation of sizes by comparison  with
      the entire field diameter can be quite
      accurate  (5-10%).

   c  The movement of a  graduated mechan-
      ical stage can also be used for  rough
      measurement of diameters of large
      particles.  Stages are usually gradu-
      ated  (with vernier) to read to 0. 1
      millimeter,  or 100  microns. In
      practice, the leading edge of the
      particle is brought to one  of the lines
      of the cross hair in the  eyepiece and
      a reading is taken of the stage position.
      Then the particle is moved across the
      field  by moving the  mechanical stage
   in an appropriate direction until the
   second trailing edge just touches the
   cross-hair line.  A second reading is
   taken and the difference in the two
   readings is the distance moved or the
   size of the particle.   This method is
   especially useful when the particle
   is larger than the field, or when the
   optics give a distorted image  near the
   edge of the field.

d  The above method can be  extended to
   projection or photography.  The image
   of the particles can be projected on a
   screen with a suitable light source or
   they may be photographed.  The final
   magnification,  M, on the  projection
   surface  (or film plane) is given  approxi-
   mately by

        M = D X O. M.  XE. M. /25

      where O. M. = objective magnification
            E. M. = eyepiece magnification
               D  = projection distance
                    from the eyepiece  in
                    centimeters.

   The image detail can then be measured
   in centimeters and the actual  size com-
   puted by  dividing by M. This  method
   is usually accurate to within 2-5 percent
   depending on the size range of the detail
   measured.

e  The stated magnifications and/or focal
   lengths of the  microscope optics are
   nominal and vary a bit from objective
   to objective  or eyepiece to eyepiece.
   To obtain accurate measurements, a
   stage micrometer is used to calibrate
   each combination of eyepiece  and
   objective.  The stage micrometer is
   a glass microscope slide that  has,
   accurately engraved  in the center, a
   scale, usually 2 millimeters long,
   divided into  200 parts, each part repre-
   senting 0. 01 millimeter.  Thus when
   this scale is observed,  projected or
   photographed, the exact image magni-
   fication can be determined. For
   example, if 5 spaces  of the stage micro-
   meter measure 6 millimeters when
   projected, the actual  magnification is
                                                                                     5-21

-------
Optics and the Microscope
              5 (0.01)
                       = 120 times.
        This magnification figure can be
        used to improve the accuracy of
        method 4 above.

      f  The simplest procedure and the most
        accurate is based on the use of a
        micrometer eyepiece.  Since  the
        eyepiece magnifies a real image
        from the objective,  it is possible
        to place a transparent scale in the
        same plane as the image from the
        objective and thus have a scale
        superimposed over the  image.  This
        is done by first placing an eyepiece
        micrometer scale disc  in the  eyepiece.
        The eyepiece micrometer has an
        arbitrary scale and must be cali-
        brated with each objective used.  The
        simplest way to do this is to place
        the stage micrometer on the stage
        and note a convenient whole number
        of eyepiece micrometer divisions.
        The value in microns for each eye-
        piece micrometer division is then
        easily  computed.   When the stage
        micrometer is removed and replaced
        by the  specimen,  the superimposed
        eyepiece scale can be used for accu-
        rate measurement of any feature in
        the specimen by direct observation,
        photography or projection.

   2   Calibration of eyepiece micrometer

      Each micrometer stage scale  has
      divisions  lOOji (0. 1 mm) apart; one
      or two of  these are usually subdivided
      into  10^ (0. 01-mtri) divisions.  These
      form the standard against which the
      arbitrary divisions in the micrometer
      eyepiece are to be calibrated.  Each
      objective  must be calibrated separately
      by noting  the correspondence between
      the stage  scale and the eyepiece scale.
      Starting witii the lowest power  objective
      focus on the stage scale, arrange the
      two scales parallel and in good focus.
      It should be possible  to determine the
      number of eyepiece divisions exactly
      equal to some whole number of
      divisions  of the stage scale, a  distance
      readily expressed in  microns.
       The calibration consists,  then, of
       calculating the number of microns per
       eyepiece scale division.  To make the
       comparison as accurate as possible,  a
       large part of each scale must be used
       (see Figure 17).  Let's assume that
       with the low power 16-mm objective
       6 large divisions of the stage  scale
       (s. m. d.) are equal to 38 divisions of
       the eyepiece scale.  This  means that
       38  eyepiece micrometer divisions (e.m. d.)
       are equivalent to 600 microns.  Hence:

            1 e. m.d.  = 600/38
                      = 15. 8n.
                   Figure 17

   COMPARISON OF STAGE MICROMETER
SCALE WITH EYEPIECE MICROMETER SCALE

       Thus when that micrometer eyepiece
       is used with that 16-mm objective each
       division of the eyepiece scale is equivalent
       to 15. 8n,  and it can be used to make an
       accurate measurement of any object on
       the microscope stage. A particle,  for
       example,  observed with the 16-mm objec-
       tive and measuring 8. 5 divisions on the
       eyepiece scale  is 8. 5 (15. 8) or 135p in
       diameter.

       Each objective  on your microscope must
       be calibrated in this manner.

       A convenient way to record the necessary
       data and to calculate n/emd is by means
       of a table.
    5-22

-------
                                                               Optics and the Microscope
               Table  7
Objective
No. smd =    n =       ji =
 no. emd   no.  emd   1 emd
 32-mm     18 = 44   1800 = 44  40. 9(o.

 16-mm      6 = 38    600 = 38  15. 8ji
 4-mm      1 = 30    100 = 30   3. 33^
   Determination of particle size
   distribution

   The measurement of particle size can
   vary in complexity depending on parti-
   cle shape.  The  size of a sphere may be
   denoted by its diameter.   The size of a
   cube may be expressed by the length of
   an edge or diagonal.   Beyond these two
   configurations, the particle "size" must
   include information about the shape of
   the particle in question, and the
   expression of this shape takes a more
   complicated form.

   Martin's diameter is  the simplest means
   of measuring and expressing the dia-
   meters of irregular particles and  is
   sufficiently accurate when averaged for
   a large number of particles. In this
   method, the horizontal or east-west
   dimension of each particle which divides
   the projected area into halves is taken as
   Martin's diameter (Figure 18).
                       I-PH
             \	)
             !/H  i
             0
              Figure  18

         MARTIN'S DIAMETER
   The more particles counted, the more
   accurate will be the average particle
   size.  Platelike and needlelike particles
   should have a correction factor applied
   to account for the third dimension since
   all such particles are restricted in their
   orientation on the microscope slide.
   When particle size is reported, the
   general shape of the particles as well as
   the method used to determine the
   "diameter"  should be noted.

   Particle  size distribution is determined
   routinely by moving a preparation of
   particles past an eyepiece micrometer
   scale in  such a way that their Martin's
   diameter can be tallied.  All particles
   whose centers fall within  two fixed
   divisions on the scale are tallied. Move-
   ment  of the preparation is usually
   accomplished by means of a mechanical
   stage but may be carried  out by rotation
   of an  off-center rotating stage.  A sample
   tabulation appears in Table 8.  The eye-
   piece and objective are chosen so that
   at least six, but not more than twelve,
   size  classes are required and sufficient
   particles are counted to give a smooth
   curve.  The actual number tallied (200  -
   2, 000) depends on particle shape
   regularity and the range of sizes. The
   size  tallied for each particle is that
   number of eyepiece micrometer divisions
   most closely approximating Martin's
   diameter for that particle.

4  Calculation of size averages

   The size data may be treated in a variety
   of ways;  one simple, straightforward
   treatment is shown in Table 9.  For a
   more complete discussion of the treat-
   ment of particle size data see Chamot
   and Mason's Handbook of Chemical
   Microscopy^', page 26.

   The averages_ with respect to number,
   
-------
Optics and the  Microscope
                 Table 8.  PARTICLE SIZE TALLY FOR A SAMPLE OF STARCH GRAINS
           Size claM
            (emd»)
        Number of particles
Total
rt-w
rt-*a  n-w  rw-4  rt-u   r-*-*j
r**a  rt-»j  r-t-*j  r*-*j   1 1 1
r-*-*-i  rt-*j  r-r-*-i  r*-»j   t-*-u
rt-*j
                                                                            no
                              «-*-4
                              rr-w
                       1 1
              r-t-*-i
              r-r-*-j  r-r-t-i
              n-t-j  r-*-*j  t-*-u

              i-*-u  rt-*-*  t-t-*j
              ri-u
                                                                            107
                                                                            71
                       i i
                                                                            45
              •emd * excniece micrometer. diKiaions
            dj = Snd/En = 1758/470

               = 3. 74 emd X 2. 82* = 10. 5p

            d3 = 2nd3/ 2nd2 = 37440/7662

               = 4. 89 emdX 2.82 =  13. 8^

            d4 = Znd4/Snd3 =  199194/37440

               = 5.32 emdX 2.82 = 15. OHL

            *2. 82 microns per emd
            (determined by calibration of the
            eyepiece-objective combination
            used for the determination).

      Cumulative percents by  number,
      surface and weight (or volume) may be
      plotted from the data in  Table 9.  The
      calculated percentages,  e. g.
                              d = 1
                                               d = 15
                                                nd* X 100
                                               d = 1
                           for the cumulative weight or volume
                           curve, are plotted against d.   Finally,
                           the specific surface,  Sm,  in square
                           meters per  gram, m, may be calculated
                           if the density, D, is known; the surface
                           average d3, is used.

                           If D =!.•!,  Sm = 6/d3D =  6/13. 8(1. 1)
                                          = 0. 395m2/g.

-------
                                                                    Optics and the Microscope
                 Table 9.  CALCULATIONS FOR PARTICLE SIZE AVERAGE
d
(Aver. diam. n
in emd)
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
16
98
110
107
71
45
21
2
nd
16
196
330
428
355
270
147
16
nd2
16
392
990
1712
1775
1620
1029
128
nd.3
16
784
2970
6848
8875
9720
7203
1024
nd4
16
1568
8910
27392
44375
58320
50421
8192
                                     470   1758  7662   37440    199194
B  Counting Analysis

   Mixtures of particulates can often be
   quantitatively analyzed by counting the
   total number of particulates from each
   component in a representative sample.
   The calculations are, however, compli-
   cated by three factors:  average particle
   size, particle  shape and the density
   of the components.  If all of the compon-
   ents were equivalent in  particle size,
   shape and density then the weight per-
   centage would be identical to the number
   percentage. Usually, however,  it is
   necessary to determine  correction factors
   to account for  the differences.

   When properly applied,  this method  can
   be accurate to within ^ 1 percent  and,
   in special cases,  even better.  It is  often
   applied to the analysis of fiber mixtures
   and is then usually called a dot-count
   because the tally of fibers is kept as the
   preparation is moved past a point or dot
   in the eyepiece.

   A variety of methods can be used to
   simplify recognition of the different
   components.  These include chemical
   stains or dyes and enhancement of optical
   differences such as refractive indices,
   dispersion or color.  Often, however, one
   relies on the differences in morphology,
e. g.  counting the percent of rayon fibers
in a sample of "silk".

Example 1: A dot-count of a mixture of
           fiberglass and nylon shows:
                  nylon
              fiberglass
             262
             168
Therefore:
              % nylon = 262/ (262 + 168) X 100
                      = 60. 9% by number.
However, although both fibers are smooth
cylinders,  they do have different densities
and usually different diameters.  To
correct for diameter one must measure
the average diameter of each type of fiber
and calculate the  volume of a unit length
of each.
             aver. diam.    volume  of
                  (i        1-H slice, n3
   nylon

 fiberglass
18.5
13.2
268
117
The percent by volume is,  then:

                     262 X 268
      % nylon
               (262 X 268)+(168X 117)

               78. 1% by volume.
                     X 100
Still.we must take into account the density of
each in order to calculate the weight percent.
                                                                                       5-25

-------
 Optics and the Microscope
   If the densities are 1. 6 for nylon and 2. 2
   for glass then the percent by weight is:
        nylon =
                         262 X 268 X 1. (i
                            ^ 6)+(lf)8 x 117 x 2. 2)
              = 72% by weight.

      Example 2:  A count of quartz and
                  gypsum shows:
                    quartz
                   gypsum
283
467
   To calculate the percent by weight we must
   take into account the average particle size,
   the shape and  the density of each.      :

   The average particle size with respect to
   weight, d4, must be measured for each
   and the shape  factor must be  determined.
   Since gypsum  is more platelike than quartz
   each particle of gypsum is thinner.   The
   shape factor can be approximated or can be
   roughly calculated by measuring the actual
   thickness of a number of particles.   We
   might find, for example, that  gypsum parti-
   cles average 80% of the volume of the aver-
   age quartz particle; this is our shape factor.
   The final equation for the  weight percent is:
      % quartz
                          283 X ird4/6 X Dq
                                                   • on
                 238 X ird4/6X Dq + 467 X IT dJ/6 X 0. 80 X Dg
                           X 100
   where Dq and Dg are the densities of quartz
   and gypsurn_ respe£tively; 0. 80 is the shape
   factor and d4 and d4 are the average parti-
   cle sizes with respect to weight for quartz
   and gypsum respectively.
ACKNOWLEDGMENT:  This outline was
prepared by the U. S. Public Health Service,
Department of Health, Education and Welfare,
for use in its Training Program.

REFERENCES

1  Bunn, C.W.   Crystal Growth from Solution.
     Discussions of the Faraday Society No. 5.
     132.  Gunery and Jackson.  London. (1949).
                 2  Loveland, R.P., J. Roy. Micros. Soc.
                      79,  59. (1960).

                 3  Chamot. Emile Monnin,  and Mason,
                      Clyde Walter.  Handbook of Chemical
                      Microscopy,  Vol.  1, third  ed.  John
                      Wiley and Sons, New York  (1959).
  26

-------
                           STRUCTURE AND FUNCTION OF CELLS
 I  INTRODUCTION

 What are cells?  Cells may be defined as the
 basic structural units of life.  The cell has
 many different parts which carry on the
 various functions of cell life.  These are
 called organelles ("little organs").

 A The branch of biology which deals with the
   form and structure of plants and animals
   is called "Morphology. "  The study of the
   arrangement of their several parts  is.
   called "anatomy", and  the study of cells
   is called "cytology".

 B There is no "typical" cell, for cells differ
   from each other in detail, and these
   differences are in part responsible  for the
   variety of life that exists on the earth.
H   FUNDAMENTALS OF CELL STRUCTURE

 A How do we recognize a structure as a cell?
    We must look for certain characteristics
    and/or structures which have been found
    to occur in cells.  The cell is composed
    of a variety of substances and structures,
    some of which result from cellular
    activities.  These include both living and
    non-living materials.

    1 Non-living components include:

      a  A "cell wall" composed of cellulose
         may be found as the outermost
         covering of many plant cells.

      b  "Vacuoles" are chambers in the
         protoplasm which contain fluids of
         different densities (i.e., different
         from the surrounding protoplasm).

    2 The "living" parts of the  cell are called
      "protoplasm. "  The following structures
      are  included:

      a  A thin "cell membrane" is located
         just inside the  cell wall.  This
membrane may be thought of as the
outermost layer of protoplasm.

In plant cells the most conspicuous
protoplasmic structures are the
"chloroplasts",  which contain
highly organized membrane systems
bearing the photosynthetic pigments
(chlorophylls, carotenoids, and
xanthophylls) and enzymes.

The "nucleus" is a spherical body
which regulates cell function by
controlling enzyme synthesis.

"Granules" are structures of small
size and may be  "living" or
non-living" material.

"Flagella" are whip-like structures
found in both plant and animal cells.
The flagella are used for locomotion,
or to  circulate the surrounding
medium.

"Cilia" resemble short flagella, found
almost exclusively on animal cells.
In the lower animals, cilia are used
for. locomotion and food gathering.

The "pseudopod", or false foot, is
an extension of the protoplasm of
certain  protozoa, in which the
colloidal state of the protoplasm
alternates from a "sol" to a "jel"
condition from time to time to
facilitate cell movement.

"Ribosomes" are protoplasmic bodies
which are the site of protein
synthesis. They are too small
(150 A in diameter)to be seen with
a light microscope.

"Mitochondria" are small mem-
branous structures containing
enzymes that oxidize food t,o produce
energy transfer compounds (ATP).
 BI.CEL. la.6.76
                          6-1

-------
Structure and Function of Cells
B  How basic structure is expressed in some
   major types of organisms.

   We  can better visualize the variety of cell
   structure by considering several specific
   cells.

   1 Bacteria have few organelles, and are
     so minute that under the light
     microscope only general morphological
     types (i.e., the three basic shapes;
     rods, spheres,  and spirals) can be
     recognized.  The following structures
     have been defined:

     a The  "capsule" is a thick protective
        covering of the cell exterior, con-
        sisting of polysaccharide or
        polypeptide.

     b The  cell wall and plasma membrane
        are present.

     c Although no well defined nucleus is
        visible in bacterial cells, the
        electron microscope has revealed
        areas of deoxyribose nucleic acid
        (DNA) concentration.  This sub-
        stance is present within the nucleus of
        of higher cells,  and is the genetic
        or hereditary material.

     d Some types of bacteria contain a
        special type of chlorophyll
        (bacteriochlorophyll) and carry on
        photosynthesis.

   2 The blue-green algae  are similar to the
     bacteria in structure, but contain the
     phot'osynthetic pigment chlorophyll a.

     a Like the bacteria,  these forms also
        lack an organized nucleus  (the
        nuclear region is not bounded by a
        membrane).

     b The chlorophyll-bearing membranes
        are not localized in distinct bodies
        (chloroplasts), but are dispersed
        throughout the cell.

      c Gas-filled structures called
        "pseudovacuoles" are found in some
        types of blue-greens.
The green algae as a group include a
great variety of structural types,
ranging from single-celled non-motile
forms to large motile colonies. Some
types are large enough to resemble
higher aquatic plants.

a  The chloroplasts are modified into
   a variety of shapes and are located
   in different positions.  Examples
   of chloroplast shape and position are:
   1) Parietal - located on the
      periphery of the cell; usually
      cup-shaped and may extend
      completely around the inner
      surface of the plasma membrane.

   2) Discoid - also located on the
      periphery of the cell,  but are
      plate-shaped; usually many per
      cell.

   3) Axial - lying in the  central axis
      of the cell; may be ribbon-like
      or star-shaped.

   4) Radial - have arms or processes
      that extend outward from the
      center of the cell (radiate),
      reaching the plasma membrane.

   5) Reticulate - a mesh-like network
      that extends throughout volume
      of the cell.

b  Located in the chloroplasts may be
   dense, proteinaceous,  starch-
   forming bodies called "pyrenoids".

The flagellated algae possess one-to-
eight flagella per cell.  The chloro-
plasts may contain brown and/or red
pigments in addition to chlorophyll.

a  Reserve food may be stored as
   starch (Chlamydomonas) paramylon
   (Euglena), or as oil.

The protozoa are single-celled
animals which exhibit a variety of
cell structure.
    6-2

-------
                                                          Structure and Function of Cells
         The amoebae move by means of
         pseudopodia, as described
         previously.

         The flagellated protozoa
         (Mastigophora) possess one or more
         flagella.

         The ciliates are the most highly
         modified protozoans.  The cilia may
         be more or less evenly distributed
         over the entire surface of the cell,
         or may be  localized.
E   FUNCTIONS OF CELLS

 What are the functions of cells and their
 structural components?  Cellular function
 is called "life", and life is difficult to define.
 Life is characterized by processes  commonly
 referred to as reproduction,  growth, photo-
 synthesis, etc.

 A  Microorganisms living in surface waters
    are subjected to constant fluctuations in
    the physical and chemical characteristic
    of the environment, and must constantly
    modify their activities.

    1   The cell requires a source of chemical
       energy to carry on life processes and
       successfully compete with other
       organisms.  Plant cells may obtain
      this energy from light,  which is
      absorbed by chlorophyll and converted
       into ATP or food reserves,  or from
      the oxidation of food stuffs.  Animal
       cells obtain energy only from the
      oxidation of food.

    2   Cells must obtain raw materials from
      the environment in order to grow and
       carry  out other life functions.  Inorganic
      and organic materials may be taken up
      by passive diffusion or  by "active
      transport".  In the  later process,
       energy is used to build  up and maintain
       a higher concentration of a substance
       (such as phosphate) inside the cell than
       is found outside.  Algae are able to
       synthesis organic matter from inorganic
       raw materials (carbon dioxide and
       water),  with the aid of energy derived
       from light, whereas animal cells must
       obtain their organic matter  "ready-
       made" by consuming other organisms,
       organic debris, or dissolved organics.
IV  SUMMARY

 The cell is made up of many highly special-
 ized substructures.  The types of sub-
 structures present, and their appearance
 (shape, color,  etc,) are very important in
 understanding the role of the organism in
 the aquatic community, and in classification.
 REFERENCES

 1  Bold, H. C.  Cytology of algae.  In:  G.M.
       Smith, (ed.), Manual of Phycology.
       Ronald Press.   1951.
  2  Bourne,  Geoffry H.,
       Cell Physiology.
       Press.   1964.
ed.  Cytology and
3rd ed.  Academic
 3  Brachet, Jean.   The Living Cell.
       Scientific American.  205(3).  1961.

 4  Corliss, John O.   Ciliated Protozoa.
       Pegamon.   1961.

 5  Fritsch, F. E.   The structure and
       reproduction of the algae.   Cambridge
       Univ. Press.   1965,

 6  Frobisher,  M.  Fundamentals of
       microbiology.   7th edition.   W. B.
       Saunders Co., Philadelphia.  1962.

 7  Round,  F.E.   The biology of the algae.
       St. Martin's Press.   New York.  1965.
                                                  This outline originally prepared by Michael
                                                  E. Bender, Biologist, formerly with
                                                  Training Activities, FWPCA,  SEC. and
                                                  revised by Cornelius I. Weber, March 1970.

                                                  Descriptor:  Cytological Studies
                                                                                      6-3

-------
                                      TYPES  OF ALGAE
III
     INTRODUCTION

     Algae  in general  may be  defined as
     small  pigmented plant-like organisms
     of relatively simple structure.   Actually
     the size range  is extreme:  from only a
     few microns to over three hundred feet
     in length.   Commonly observed examples
     include the greenish pond scum or frog
     spittle of freshwater ponds,  much of the
     golden brown slime covering  rocks in a
     trout stream,  and the great marine  kelps
     and  seaweeds.  Large freshwater forms
     as Nitella  and Chara  or  stonewort are
     also included.

     Algae  approach ubiquity in distribution.
     In addition to the commonly observed
     bodies of water,  certain algae also  live
     in such unlikely places  as thermal springs,
     the surface of melting snow,  on the hair
     of the three toed sloth in Central America,
     and  in conjunction with certain fungi to
     form lichens.
ALGAE WILL BE  GROUPED  FOR THE
SAKE OF CONVENIENCE INTO FOUR
GENERAL TYPES:

Blue-greens (See plate: Blue-Green
Algae,  Cyanophyceae).   This  is a valid
technical  group.   The size  range  is not
very great,  some  being  so  small as to
approach  the size  range  of  the bacteria.

1  These are the only algae in which
   the pigments  are not  localized in
   definite bodies  but  dissolved through-
   out the cell.   Blue, red,  or other
   pigments are present in addition to
   chlorophyll thus giving the cells a
   bluish green, yellow, or red color,
   at least  enmasse.

2  The  nucleus lacks a nuclear membrane.

3  Tend to  achieve nuisance concentrations
   more frequently in the warm summer
   months and in the richer waters.
4  Vegetative reproduction, in addition
   to cell  division,  includes the forma-
   tion of  "hormogones, " or short specif-
   ically delimited sections of trichomes
   (filaments).

5  Spores  of three types are  encountered:

   a   Akinetes  are  usually larger, thick
       walled resting spores.

   b   Heterocysts appear like  empty
       cell walls,  but are actually filled
       with protoplasm,  have occasionally
       been observed to germinate.

   c  Endospores,  also called  "gonidia"
       or conidia,  are formed by repeated
       division  of the protoplast within a
       given cell wall.   Present  in only  a
       few  genera.

6  Some common examples  of blue-
   green algae are:

       Anacystis (Microcystis or
       Polycystis),  Anabaena,  Aphani-
       zomenon, and Oscillatoria
                                                       The Pigmented flagellates (in  contrast
                                                       to the non-pigmented or animal-like
                                                       flagellates) are a heterogeneous
                                                       collection  of  motile  forms from several
                                                       different algal groups  (See plate:
                                                       Flagellated algae).

                                                       1  There  may be one,  two,  four,  or
                                                          more flagella per cell.

                                                       2  There  is a well organized nucleus.

                                                       3  A  light-sensitive  red  eyespot usually
                                                          present.

                                                       4  The chlorophyll is  contained in one
                                                          or  more distinctive bodies  called
                                                          plastids.
   BI.MlC.cla. 19a. 6.76
                                                                                        7-1

-------
Types  of Algae
    5  Two or more cells may be associated
       in a colony.

    6  Non-motile life history stages may
       be encountered.

    7  Masses of stored starch called
       pyrenoid bodies are often  conspicuous.

    8  Some examples of pigmented  flag-
       ellates  are:  Euglena. Phacus.
       Chlamydomonas.  Gonium,  Volvox,
       Peridinium,  Ceratium Mallomonas,
       Synura  and Dinobryon.
   The Non-motile  green algae constitute
   another  heterogeneous assembly of un-
   related forms (See plate: Non-Motile
   Green Algae)

   1   Like the  flagellates they have  well
       organized nuclei and  chloroplasts.
       The shape of the chloroplast is  often
       distinctive.

   2   They lack flagella or any  other  loco-
       motor device.

   3   There is  extreme  structural variation
       among the group.

   4   Some types tend to occur  as a general
       planktonic mass or bloom,  " often in
       combinations of two  or more species.

       Some examples are:  Sphaerocystis,
       Pediastrum,  Scenedesmus, and the
       desmid Cosmarium.

   5   Threadlike (filamentous) green algae
       may form masses  or blankets,  cutting
       off  light,  and reducing  water circula-
       tion.   They also add  considerably to
       the  total  mass of organic  matter.
       Some examples of  this  type are:
       Spirogyra, Hydrodictyon,  Cladophora,
       Oedogonium,  and Char a.
D  The Diatoms constitute another valid
    technical group (See plate:  Diatoms-
    Bacillariophyceae).
       In appearance,  they are geometrically
       regular  in shape.   The presence of a
       brownish pigment in addition to the
       chlorophyll gives them a golden to
       greenish color.

       Motile forms have  a  distinctive
       hesitating progression.

       The most distinctive  structural
       feature is the two-part shell
       (frustule) composed of silicon
       dioxide (glass).

       a   One part fits inside the other as
           the two halves of a pill box,  or a
           petri dish.

       b   The surface of these shells are
           sculptured with  minute pits  and
           lines  arranged with geometrical
           perfection.

       c   The view  from the side is called
           the  "girdle view, " that from above
           or below,  the "valve view. "

       There are two  general shapes of
       diatoms,  circular  (centric) and
       elongate  (pennate).   The elongate
       forms may be motile, the circular
       ones are not.

       Diatoms  may associate in colonies
       in various ways.

       Examples of  diatoms frequently en-
       countered are:   Stephanodiscus
       Cyclotella,  Asterionella.  Fragilaria,
       Tabellaria,  Synedra,  and Nitzschia.
This outline was prepared by H. W.  JACKSON,
former Chief Biologist, National Training
Center, and revised by R. M.  SINCLAIR,
Aquatic Biologist, National Training Center,
MOTD, OWPO,  USEPA. Cincinnati, Ohio
45268.

Descriptor: Algae
 7-2

-------
                                                                          Types of Algae
           KEY FOR IDENTIFICATION OF GROUPS OF FRESHWATER ALGAE
              Beginning with "la" and "ib",  choose one of the two contrasting
              statements and follow this procedure with the  "a" and "b" state-
              ments of the number given at the end of the  chosen  statement.
              Continue until the name of the  algal group is given instead of
              another key number.
              la.   Plastid (separate color body) absent; complete protoplast
                    pigmented; generally blue-green; iodine starch test*
                    negative	Blue-green algae

              Ib.   Plastid or plastids present; parts of protoplast free of some
                    or all pigments; generally green, brown, red, etc.,  but not
                    blue-green; iodine starch test* positive or negative	 2
              2a.   Cell wall permanently rigid (never showing evidence of
                    collapse), and with regular pattern of fine markings
                    (striations, etc.); plastids brown to green; iodine starch test*
                    negative; flagella absent; wall of two essentially similar halves,
                    one placed over the other as a cover	Diatoms

              2b.   Cell wall, if present, capable of sagging, wrinkling, bulging
                    or rigidity, depending on existing turgor pressure of cell
                    protoplast; regular pattern of fine markings on wall generally
                    absent; plastids green, red, brown, etc.; iodine  starch test*
                    positive or negative; flagella present or absent; cell wall
                    continuous and generally not of two parts	3
              3a.   Cell or colony motile; flagella present (often not readily visible);
                    anterior and posterior ends of cell different from one another in
                    contents and often in shape	Flagellate algae

              3b.   Non-motile; true flagella absent; ends of cells often not
                    differentiated	Green algae and associated forms
*Add one drop Lugol's (iodine) solution, diluted 1-1 with distilled water.  In about  1 minute,
 if positive,  starch is stained blue and,  later black.   Other structures (such as nucleus,
 plastids, cell wall) may also stain, but turn brown to yellow.


                                                                                   7-3

-------
Types of Algae
CMP
               COMPARISON OF FOUR MAJOR GROUPS OF ALGAE

Color
Location
of pigment
Starch
Slimy
coating
Nucleus
Flagellum
Cell Wall
"Eye "spot
Blue-Green
Blue -Green
(Brown)
Throughout
cell
Absent
Present
Absent
Absent
Inseparable
from slimy
coating
Absent
Pigmented
flagellates
Green
Brown
In plastids
Present or
Absent
Absent
in most
Present
Present
Thin or
Absent
Present
Greens
Green
In plastids
Present
Absent
in most
Present
Absent
Semi-rigid
smooth or
with spines
Absent
Diatoms
Brown
(Light-Green)
In plastids
Absent
Absent
in most
Present
Absent
Very rigid,
with regular
markings
Absent

-------
                                   BLUE-GREEN ALGAE
I   WHAT ARE THE BLUE-GREEN ALGAE?

The blue-green algae (Myxophyceae) comprise
that large group of microscopic organisms
living in aquatic or moist habitats, carrying
on photosynthesis  and having differentiation
of cells which is a little more complex than
bacteria,  and simpler than all of the other
plants called algae.
II   WHY ARE THEY CALLED BLUE-GREEN:

In addition to the green photosynthetic pigment
(chlorophyll-a) they always have a blue pig-
ment  (phyocyanin-c) which tends to give the
cushions or mats they may form a blue-green
tinge.
Ill  WHERE ARE THE BLUE-GREENS FOUND?

Some are free floating (pelagic and planktonic),
others grow from submerged or moist soil,
rocks, wood and other objects in both fresh-
water and marine habitats.
IV  WHAT ARE SOME OF THEIR GENERAL
    CHARAC TERISTICS ?

Some are gelatinous masses of various shapes
floating in water.  Others, microscopic in
size,  grow in great numbers so as to color
the water in which they live.  Structurally
their  cells are similar to bacteria.  Their
protoplasts may be sheathed or imbedded in
gelatin, making them slimy.  Cells of blue-
green algae are without organized nuclei,
central vacuoles, or cilia and flagella.
No sexual reproduction is known.  Asexual
reproduction may be effected by fragmentation,
in which case special separation devices are
formed (dead cells,  and heterocysts).  Some
species are preserved over unfavorable
periods by special spores (akinetes and endo-
spores).
V   OF WHAT IMPORTANCE ARE BLUE-
     GREEN ALGAE?

They have both positive and negative economic
significance.  Because they can convert
radient energy into chemical energy, they
are producers forming a first link at the base
of the food chain.  Because many very in-
tricate nutritional relationships exist among
the  myraids of organisms it is difficult to
know the value of the blue-greens.  However,
people who know what the blue-greens can dp
to drinking and recreational water classify
them as of negative economic importance,
because they are often nuisances when they
impart color, bad odors, and fishy tastes,
or toxins.  Some of them can foul pipes
and clog filters.


VI  WHEN ARE THEY MOST COMMON?

They are widely distributed in time and space,
but  tend to reach nuisance  concentrations more
frequently in the late summer and in eutrophic
waters.
VII WHAT DO BLUE-GREEN ALGAE DO
    FOR A LIVING?

The pioneer-forms are of great ecological
importance because they live in habitats fre-
quented by few other forms of live, synthesiz-
ing organic substances and building substrata
that can support other kinds of life.

    A  Some blue-greens live in association
        with other organisms  as symbionts.
        Still others are found  in polluted
        waters,  because they  are  able to
        exist in habitats poor  in oxygen.  The
        growth of these kinds  of algae under
        such conditions tends  to make a pol-
        luted condition worse.

    B  On the other hand some species
        should be promoted because they
        provide oxygen and food through photo-
        synthesis.  The first evident product
        of photosynthesis is glycogen, and
        is the  cause  of the brown coloration
        with the  iodine test.  Some of the
        glycogen is used to produce  glycopro-
        teins.  The gelatinous sheath is com-
        posed of pectic substances,  cellulose
        and related compounds.
BI. MIC.cla. 16a. 6.76
                                   '8-1

-------
Blue-Green Algae
        When blue-greens mat at the surface
        of the water the increased lighting
        may be too  strong, resulting in a
        kill.  At this time they may turn
        from a blue-green to a yellow-green
        color.   Here they decompose in
        mass.   The resulting intermediate
        products of decomposition may be
        highly undesirable, because of bad
        looks,  four odors, bad tastes and
        toxins. Under these conditions the
        BOD may produce conditions not
        unlike raw  sewage.
VIII  WHAT DO BLUE-GREEN ALGAE LOOK
     LIKE UNDER THE MICROSCOPE?

    A   A cross section of a typical cell
        would show an outside nonliving
        gelatinous layer surrounding a woody
        cell wall, which is bulging from
        turgor pressure from the cell (plasma)
        membrane,  pushing the wall outward-
        ly.  The protoplasm, contained with-
        in the plasma membrane, is divided
        into two regions.  The peripheral
        pigmented portion called chroma-
        toplasm, and an inner centroplasm,
        the centroplasm contains chromatins,
        which is also known as in incipient
        nucleus or central body, containing
        chromosomes and genes.   Structures
        (chromatophores or plastids) con-
        taining  pigments have not been found
        in the blue-greens.  The photosyn-
        thetic pigments are dissolved in the
        peripheral cytoplasm, which is known
        as the chromatoplasm.

    B   A simple way to understand the cross
        section would be to compare it with
        a doughnut,  with the hole represent-
        ing the  colorless central body or
        incipient nucleus,  which houses the
        chromatoplasm, having the charac-
        teristic blue-green color from its
        dissolved photosynthetic pigments.
IX  WHAT CAUSES THESE FOUL-TO-SMELL
    UNSIGHTLY BLOOMS?

When the protoplasts become sick or old they
may develop a great number of "pseudovac-
uoles" filled with gas.  These gas bubbles make
the algae buoyant in such a way that they may
"flower" or bloom by rising to the surface
(planktonic, healthy blue-greens normally
possess pseudovacuoles, which are here
excepted).   Soon they begin to stink because
of the odors produced from putrefaction.
The lack of dissolved oxygen during this
period may Affect other organisms*
X   ARE ALL BLOOMS PUTREFACTIVE?

No.  Healthy blooms are produced by myraids
of cells living near the surface of the water
at times when environmental conditions are
especially favorable for  them.  Putrefactive
blooms are usually from masses of algae
undergoing degradation.
XI  WHAT ARE SOME OF THE MAJOR
    KINDS OF BLUE-GREENS?

Most species of blue-greens may be placed
into two major groups:  the nonfilamentous
(coccoid) forms, and the filamentous forms.
See the set of drawings following this treat-
ment to get a graphic concept of the two
groups.
XII WHAT ARE SOME OF THE MORE
    DISTINCTIVE FEATURES OF BLUE-
    GREENS?

    A  In comparing the blue-greens with
        other algae it is easier to tell what
        they do not possess than what they
        do.  They  do not have chromatophores
        or plastids, cilia,  flagella, organized
        nuclei, gametes, central vacuoles,
        chlorophyll-b,  or true starch.

    B  Many  of the filamentous forms,  es-
        pecially the Oscillatoriaceae, exhibit
        an unexplained movement.   When the
        filamentous forms  are surrounded
        by a gelatinous sheath the row of cells
        inside is called a trichome, and the
        trichome with its enclosing sheath is
        called a filament.   There may be more
        than one trichome within a sheath.
 8-2

-------
                                                                          Blue-Green Algae
        True branching occurs when a cell
        of the series divides lengthwise and
        the outer-formed cell  adds cells to
        form a true branch. However, two
        or more trichomes within a single
        sheath may be  so arranged that though
        they appear to  be branches, their cells
        actually have all divided in the same
        plane,  and the  trichomes have pushed
        out from growth to form false branch-
        ing, as in Tolypothrix.

    C   An occasional reticulated or bubbly
        appearance is referred to as  pseudov-
        acuolation,  and en mass imparts a
        pale, yellowish color to the algae.
        Under low powers these vacuoles
        appear dark, under higher magnifi-
        cations they are reddish.

    D   Vegetative reproduction in addition
        to cell division for the unicellular
        forms,  is by special kinds of frag-
        mentation.  This includes the for-
        mation of hormogones, which are
        specifically delimited sections of
        trichomes,  and are characteristic
        of some taxonomic entities.

    E   Spores  of three types  are encountered.

        1  Akinetes are usually larger, non-
           motile, thick-walled resting spores.
        2  Heterocysts appear like empty cell
           walls, but are filled with colorless
           protoplasm  and have been occasion-
            ally observed to germinate.
        3  Endospores, also called gonidia,
            are formed by  a repeated  division
            of the protoplast within a cell wall
            container.
    extremely transparent, easily
    broken up on preservation.

4   They frequently contain pseudov-
    acuoles.

Anabaena is an example of a fila-
mentous form.

1   Filaments may occur singly or
    in irregular colonies,  and free
    floating or in a delicate nucous
    matrix.

2   Trichomes have practically
    the same diameter throughout;
    may be straight, spiral,  or
    irregularly contorted.

3   Cells are usually spherical,
    or barrel shaped,  rarely cy-
    lindrical and never discoid.

4   Heterocysts are usually the same
    shape but are slightly larger
    than the  vegetative cells.

5   Akinetes are always larger than
    the vegetative cells, roughly
    cylindrical, and with rounded
    ends.

6   It may be readily distinguished
    from Nostoc by the lack of a
    firm gelatinous envelope.

7   It may produce an undesirable
    grassy,  moldy or other odor.

Aphanizomenon is a strictly plank-
tonic  filamentous form.
XIII  WHAT ARE SOME EXAMPLES OF BLUE-
      GREEN ALGAE?

    A   Anacystis  (Microcystis) is common
         in hard waters.

         1    Colonies are always free floating.

         2    Their shapes may be roughly
             spherical or irregular,  micro-
             scopic or macroscopic.

         3    The gelatinous matrix may be
     Trichomes are relatively straight,
     and laterally joined into loose
     macroscopic free-floating flake-
     like colonies.

     Cells are cylindrical or barrel
     shaped,  longer than broad.

     Heterocysts occur within the
     filament (i.e., not terminal).

     Akinetes are cylindrical and
     relatively long.
                                                                                        8-3

-------
Blue-Green Algae
                     SOME   BLUE-GREEN  ALGAE

                                    ..-.Green Algae:     '$&© C?)© ©©>'
          Anacystis (Chroococcus) X600.
                                    Agmenellum

                                   (Meris-mopediun)J-_X600,
             Coccochloris  (Gloeocapsa) X600.
                                                                  (X825)
         II. Filamentous blue -green algae;
                  Trichomes  of  Spirulina. (X600).
               Trichomes of Arthrospira
tf^vegetative cell

  )\heterocyst
                      akinete
                     I (spore)

                      Anabaena

                       (X825).
                                                      Phormidiuin (with sheath)
                                                                   (X825).
                                                      mmmmm^^
                                                    Oscillatoria  (without sheath)
                                                                  (X825)
                                      False branching
                                     Tolypothrix  (X375)
                 Hapalpsiphon  Prepared by Louis  G.Williams
                  (X375)      Aquatic ;Biologist, Basic Data, SEC.
  8-4

-------
                                                                     Blue-Green Algae
    5   Often imparts grassy or nastur-
        tium-like odors to water.

D   Oscillatoria is a large and ubiquitous
    genus.

    1   Filaments may occur singly or
        interwoven to form mats of
        indefinite extent.

    2   Trichomes are unbranched, cy-
        lindrical,  and practically with-
        out sheaths.

    3   Species with narrow trichomes
        have long cylindrical cells
        while those with broader tri-
        chomes have short broad cells.

    4   No heterocysts or akinetes are
        known in Oscillatoria.  It re -
        produces  by fragmentation from
        hormongonia only.

    5   Live species exhibit "oscillatoria"
        movements,  which are oscillating.

    6   Species of Oscillatoria may be
        readily distinguished from
        Lyngbya by the absence of a
        sheath.

E   Nodularia is an occasional producer
    of blooms.
             Trichomes are practically the
             same diameter throughout.

             Sheaths are usually distinct,
             fairly firm, and with a single
             trichome.
REFERENCES

1  Bartsch, A. F.  (ed.)  Environmental
      Requirements of Blue-Green Algae.
      FWPCA. Pacific Northwest Water
      Laboratory, Corvallis, Oregon.
      Ill pp.  1967.

2  Desikachary, T. V.  Cyanophyta,  Indian
      Council Agric. Res.  New Delhi.  1959.

3  Drouet,  Francis.  Mxyophyceae.   Chapter
      5 in Edmondson.  Freshwater Biology.
      p.  95-114.  Wiley.  1959.

4  Drouet,  Francis.  Revision of the  Classifi-
      cation of the Oscillariaceae.  Monograph
      15.  Acad.  Nat.  Sci.  Phil. 370pp.  1968.

5  Jackson, Daniel F.  (ed.) Algae, Man, and
      the Environment. Univ. Syracuse Press.
      554 pp.  1968.
This outline was prepared by L. G. Williams,
Formerly Aquatic Biologist, Aquatic Biology
Activities, Research and Development,
Cincinnati Water Research Laboratory,  FWPCA.
    1   Vegetative cells, heterocysts,
        and even the akinetes are broader
        than long.
 Descriptor: Cyanophyta
                                                                                   8-5

-------
                       GREEN AND OTHER PIGMENTED FLAGELLATES
 I  INTRODUCTION

 A  A flagellate is a free swimming cell
    (or colony) with one or more flagella.

 B  Motile flagellated cells occur in most
    (not all) great groups of plants and animals.

 C  Out main concern will be  with "mature"
    flagellated algae.
 H  THE STRUCTURE OF A PIGMENTED OR
    PLANT-LIKE FLAGELLATE

 A There is a well organized nucleus.

 B The flagellum is a long whip-like process
    which acts as a propeller.

    1  It has a distinctive structure.

    2  There may be one or several per cell.

 C The chlorophyll is contained in one or
    more chloroplasts.

 D Two or more cells may be associated in
    a colony.

 E Non-Motile Life history stages may be
    encountered.

 F -Size is of little use in identification.

 G Pyrenoid bodies are often conspicuous.
in  The Euglenophyta or Euglena-like algae
 (Figures 1-4) are almost exclusively single
 celled free swimming flagellates.  Nutrition
 may be holophytic, holozoic,  or saprophytic,
 even within the same species.  Referred to
 by zoologists as mastigophora; many animal
 like forms are parasitic or commensalistic.
 Food reserves of plant-like forms are as
 paramylin (an insoluble carbohydrate) and
 fats (do not respond to starch test).  Thick
 walled resting stages (cysts)  are common.
"Metabolic movement" characteristics of
some genera (Euglena).

Eyespot usually present in anterior end,
rarely more than one flagellum.

A  Euglena is a  large genus with pronounced
   metabolic movement (Figure 1).

   1  Cells  spindle shaped

   2  Single flagellum

   3  Eyespot usually present

   4  Chloroplasts numerous,  discoid
      to band shaped

   5  E_.  sanguinea has red pigment.

   6  E.  viridis generally favors water
      rich in organic matter.

   7  E_.  gracilis is less tolerant of pollution.

B  Fhacus cells maintain a rigid shape
   (Figure 2).

   1  Often  flattened and twisted, with
      pointed tip or tail end.

   2  Cell wall (periplast) often marked
      with fine ridges.

   3  P.  pyrum favored by polluted water.

   4  P.  pleuronectes relatively intolerant
      of pollution.

C  Trachelomonas cells surrounded by a
   distinct shell (lorica) with flagellum
   sticking through hole or collar (Figure  4).

   1  Surface may be smooth or  rough

   2  Usually brown in color

   3  Some  species such as T. cerebea
      known to clog filters
  BI.MIC.cla. 6c. 6.76
                                                                                     9-1

-------
   Green and Other Pigmented Flagellates
 D Lepocinclls has rigid naked cells with
    longitudinal or spiral ridges (Figure 3).

    1  Cells uncompressed, elipsoidal to oval
       (in contrast to phacus)

    2  Only two species with pointed tails

    3  L. texta often associated with waters
       of high organic content
B  Carteria resembles Chlamydomonas very
   closely except that it has four flagella
   instead of two.   Generally favored by
   polluted water (Figure 7).

C  Phacotus usually has free swimming
   biflagellate cells surrounded by biconcave
   envelopes resembling two clam shells.
   These are usually sculptured,  dark
   colored,  and impregnated with calcium
   carbonate.
IV  The Chlorophyta or grass green algae
 (Figures 5-9) are the largest and most varied
 group.  Non-flagellated forms predominate but
 many conspicuous flagellates are included.
 Food reserves are usually stored as starch
 which is readily identified with iodine.
 Usually two flagella of equal length are
 present.  More planktonic forms are included
 than in any other group,  predominating in the
 late spring and early autumn.

 The cell is typically surrounded by a definite
 wall and usually has a definite shape. Cell
 pigments closely resemble those of higher
 plants,  but some have accessory pigments
 and a few forms have little or none.  The
 chloroplasts always have a shape charac-
 teristic of the genus.

 The flagellated chlorophyta are contained in
 the Order Volvocales, the Volcocine algae.
 All are actively motile during vegetative
 phases. Maybe  unicellular or colonial.  All
 have an eyespot near the base of the flagella.
 Colonies may range from a simple plate
 (Gonium sociale) to a complete hollow sphere
 (Volvox spp  ).

 A  Chlamydomonas is a solitary free swimming
    genus (Figure 5).

    1  Species range from cylindrical to
       pearshaped.

    2  Some species have a gelatinous sheath.

    3  There  are two flagella inserted close
       together.

    4  Generally favored by polluted waters.
   1  The eyespot ranges from anterior
      to posterior.

   2  Several daughter cells may be retained
      within the old envelopes of the parent
      cell.

   3  A clean water indicator.

D Chlorogonium is a distinctive genus in
   which the  cell is fusiform, the tail end
   pointed, and the anterior end slightly
   blunt (Figure 6).

   1  The two flagella only about half as
      long as the cell.

   2  The cell wall is  rather delicate.

   3  An eyespot usually present near the
      anterior end.

   4  Favored by pollution.

E Gonium colonies typically have 4 to 32
   cells arranged in a plate (Figure 8).

   1  The cells are imbedded in a gelatinous
      matrix.

   2  Sixteen celled colonies move through
      the water with a somersault-like
      motion.

   3  Four and eight celled colonies swim
      flagella end first.

   4  Gonium pectorale is typically a
      plankton form.

F Pandorina colonies range up to 32 cells,
   usually roughly spherical (Figure 9).
  9-2

-------
                                                   Green and Other Pigmented Flagellates
   1   Cells arranged in a hollow sphere
      within a gelatinous matrix.

   2   Often encountered especially in hard-
      water  lakes, but seldom abundant.

   3   P. morum may cause a faintly fishy
      odor.

G  Eudorina has up to 64 cells in roughly
   spherical colonies.

   1   The cells may be deeply imbedded in
      a gelatinous matrix.

   2   Common in the plankton of soft water
      lakes.

   3   E. elegans is widely distributed.

   4   May cause faintly fishy odor.

H  Pleodorina has up to 128 cells located
   near the  surface of the gelatinous matrix.
   It is widespread in the United States.

I  Volvox rarely has less than 500 cells
   per colony.

   1   Central portion of the mature colony
      may contain only water.

   2   Daughter colonies form inside the
      parent colony.

   3   V. aureus imparts a fishy odor to  the
      water when present in abundance.

J  Chlamydobotrys has "mulberry shaped"
   colonies,  with biflagellate cells alternately
   arranged in tiers of four each.
   (Spondylomorum has quadriflagellate  cells).

   1   There is no enveloping sheath.

   2   C. stellata is favored by pollution.
V   The Pyrrhophyta includes principally the
 armored or dinoflageHates (Dinophyceae)
 (Figures 14-16).  This group is almost
 exclusively flagellated and is characterized
 by chromatophores which are yellow-brown
 in color.  Food reserves are stored as
 starch or oil.  Naked, holozoic, and
 saprozoic representatives are found.
 Both "unarmored", and "armored" forms
 with chromatophores are found to ingest
 solid food readily, and holozoic nutrition
 may be as important as holophytic.

 The great majority have walls of cellulose
 consisting of a definite number of articulated
 plates which may be very elaborate in
 structure.  There is always a groove
 girdling the cell in which one flagellum
 operates, the other extends backward from
 the point of origin.

 Most of the dino-flagellates are marine and
 some are parasitic.  There are six fresh
 water genera of importance in this  country.

 A  Gymnodinum species are generally naked
    except for a few freshwater species.

    G.  brevls (marine) is a toxic form
    considered to be responsible for the
    "red tide" episodes in Florida and
    elsewhere.

 B  Species of Gonyaulax (catanella and
    tamarensis) are responsible for the
    paralytic shellfish poisoning.

 C  Ceratium is distinctive in that the
    anterior and posterior ends are  con-
    tinued as long horns (Figure 16).

    1  Seasonal temperature changes have  a
      pronounced effect on the shape of the
       cells of this species.

    2  C. hirudinella in high concentration is
       reported to produce a "vile stench".
                                                                                9-3

-------
  Green and Other Pigmented Flagellates
 D Peridinium is a circular, oval,  or
    angular form, depending on the view
    (Figure 15).

    1  Cell wall is thick and heavy.

    2  Plates are usually much ornamented.

    3  P. cinctum has been charged with a
       fishy odor.
VI  The Division Chrysophyta contains two
 classes which include flagellates, the
 Xanthophyceae or Heterokontae (yellow-
 green algae) and the Chrysophyceae (golden-
 green algae) (Figures 10-13).  The third
 class, the diatoms (Bacillarieae or
 Bacillariophyceae), is not flagellated.

 A  None of the Xanthophyceae are included
    in the present discussion.

 B  The Chrysophyceae possess chroma-
    tophores of a golden brown color, usually
    without pyrenoids.  Food reserves are
    stored as fats and leucosin.  One or two
    flagella; if two, they may be of equal or
    unequal length.  Internal silicious cysts
    may be formed.  Tend to occur in
    relatively pure water.  Both holozoic and
    holophytic types of nutrition are found.
    Certain minute forms considered to be
    highly  sensitive to pollution.

    1  Mallomonas is a solitary, free
       swimming genus with one flagellum
       (Figure 13).

       a  Covered with silicious plates,  many
         of which bear long silicious spines.

       b Tends to inhabit clear water lakes
         at moderate depths.

       c M. caudata imparts a fishy odor
         to the water.

    2  Chrysococcus cells are minute, with
       two yellowish brown chromatophores
       and one flagellum.

       a Droplets of stored oil present

       b  Lorica distinct
   c  C_. rufesceus a clean water form

3  Chromulina has a single flagellum,
   may accumulate single large granule
   of leucosin at posterior end of cell
   (Figure 10).

   C_. rosanoffii is a clean water indicator.

4  Synura is a biflagellate form growing
   in radially arranged, naked colonies
   (Figure 11).

   a  Flagella equal in length

   b  Cells pyriform or egg shaped

   c  S. uvella produces a cucumber or
      muskmelon odor

5  Uroglenopsis forms free swimming
   colonies of approximately spherical
   biflagellate cells embedded near the
   periphery of a roughly spherical
   gelatinous matrix.

   a  Flagella are unequal in length.

   b  IJ. americana may range up to
      . 5 mm in diameter, and contain
      1000 or more cells.

   c  U. am. also causes strong fishy
      odor.

6  Dinobryon may be solitary or colonial,
   free floating or attached.  Colonies
   are arborescent (Figure 12).

   a  Cells attached to bottom of open
      roughly cylindrical lorica or sheath.

   b  Two flagella of unequal length.

   c  Conspicuous eyespot usually present.

   d  Taxonomy of the group  is involved.

   e  D. sertularia may clog filters.

   f  D. divergens may cause a fishy odor.
   9-4

-------
                                              Green and Other Pigmented Flagellates
(fig 1-13 from Lackey and Callaway)
    Euglena
                  Phacus
                                  Lepocinclis
                        Trachelomonas
                                                             GREEN   EUGLENOIDS
     Chlamydomonas

                                                                    Pandorina
                      Chlorogonium
                                                            GREEN   PHYTOMONADS
10
 Chromulina
                  11
Synura
                                       Dinobryon
                                                         YELLOW   CHRYSOMONADS
 14
     Massartia
                              15
                                   Peridinium
                              16
                                                                Ceratium
                                                  YELLOW-BROWN   DINOFLAGELLATES

-------
  Green and Other Pigmented Flagellates
                                          FLAGELLATES
                                         (MASTIGOPHORA)
                           PLANT FLAGELLATES
                           (PHYTOMASTIGINA!
ANIMAL FLAGELLATES
  (z OOMASTIGINA)
CHRY
SOMONADI
CRYPT
gA
JMONADIN

1
PHYTOM'ONADINA
Rmzot
IASTIGIN*
PROTOM

3NADINA

                                          EUGLENOIDINA
         POLYMASTIGINA
                      Figure 17 Phylogenetic Family Tree of the Flagellates
                                   (from Calaway and Lackey)
VII  There are two distinctive groups whose
  systematic position is uncertain, the chloro-
  monads and the cryptomonads.  Only one
  genus of the latter group is included here.

  A  Rhodomonas may range from bright red
     through pale brown to olive green.

     1  Cells compressed, narrow at the
        posterior end

     2  Two flagella of unequal length

     3  R. lacustris a small form intolerant
        of pollution
 REFERENCES

 1  Calaway, Wilson T. and Lackey,  James
       B.   Waste .Treatment Protozoa
       Flagellata.  Series No. 3. Univ. Fla.
       140 pp.   1962.

 2  Gojdics, M.  The Genus Euglena.
       Univ. of Wisconsin Press,  Madison.
       1953.
 This outline was prepared by H. W.  Jackson,
 former Chief Biologist, National Training
 Center,  MOTD, OWPO, tJSEPA, Cincinnati,
 Ohio 45268.
                                                    Descriptor:  Algae, Flagellates
   9-6

-------
                               FILAMENTOUS GREEN ALGAE
 I  MANY OF THESE FORMS ARE VISIBLE
   TO THE UNAIDED EYE

 A They may be several inches or even a foot
   or more in length.  In many cases they are
   not found as isolated filaments but develop
   in large aggregations to form floating or
   attached mats or tufts. The attached
   forms are generally capable of remaining
   alive after being broken away from the
   substrate.

 B Included in the group are  some of the most
   common and most conspicuous algae in
   freshwater habitats.  A few of them have
   been given common names such as pond
   silk, green felt, frog-spawn algae, and
   stoneworts.
 C Specialized structures are present in
    some filaments.

    1  Some filaments break up into "H"
       sections.

    2  Apical caps are present in others.

    3  Replicate end walls are present in
       some.

    4  Some filaments are overgrown with a
       cortex.

    5  Attached filaments have the basal cell
       developed into a "hold fast cell"
       (hapteron).
H   CHARACTERISTICS OF FILAMENTOUS
    ALGAE

 A  These algae are in the form of cylindrical
    cells held together as a thread ("filament"),
    which may be in large clusters or growing
    separately.  Some are attached to rocks
    or other materials while others are free.
    They may be unbranched ("simple") or
    branched; the tips are gradually narrowed
    ("attenuated") to a point.  Some are
    surrounded by a mucilaginous envelope.

 B  Each cell is a short or long cylinder with
    a  distinct wall.  The protoplast contains
    a  nucleus which is generally inconspicuous.

    1  The plastid or  chloroplast is the
      prominent structure. It contains
      chlorophyll and starch centers
      ("pyrenoids"),  and varies in size,
      shape, and number per cell.  It may
      be pressed against the wall ("parietal")
      or extend through the central axis of
      the cell ("axial").

    2  Clear areas of cell sap ("vacuoles") are
      generally present in the cell.

 1  Including a few yellow-brown and red algae.
IE  REPRODUCTION MAY TAKE PLACE
    BY SEVERAL METHODS

 A Cell division may  occur in all cells or
    in certain selected ones.

 B Spores called akinetes may be formed.

 C Zoospores (motile) and aplanospores
    (non-motile) are common.

 D Fragmentation of filaments may occur.

 E Many kinds reproduce sexually,  often
    with specialized gamete forming cells.
IV  EXAMPLES OF FILAMENTOUS GREEN
    ALGAE ARE:

 A Unbranched forms

    *Spirogyra
    *Mougeotia
     Zygnema
     Ulothrix
     Microspora
     Tribonema
     Desmidium
     Oedogonium
  #Planktonic or occasionally planktonic
 BI. MIC.cla.l4b.6.V6
                                                                                     10-1

-------
  Filamentous Green Algae
  B Branched forms

    Cladophora
    Pithopora
    Stigeoclonium
    Chaetophora
    Draparnaldia
    Rhizoclonium
    Audouinella
    Bulbochaete
    Nitella

  C Specialized and related forms

    Schizomeris
    Comsopogon
    Batrachospermum
    Chara
    Lemanea
    Vaucheria
 V  Habitats include the planktonic growths as
 well as surface mats or blankets and benthic
 attached forms on rocks  in riffles of streams,
 at the shoreline of lakes  and reservoirs,
 concrete walls, etc.

 A Attached forms may break loose to
    become mixed with plankton or to form
    floating mats.

 B Cladophora mats are a nuisance  on many
    beaches on the Great Lakes.
VI  IMPORTANCE OF FILAMENTOUS
    GREEN ALGAE

 A They may cause  clogging of sand filters,
    intake screens, and canals.

 B They may produce tastes and odors in
    water or putrid odor (also producing
    ELS which damage painted surfaces) when
    washed  ashore around lakes and reservoirs.

 C They may cause  unsightly growths or
    interfere with fishing and swimming in
    recreation areas.

 D Some are useful  as indicators of water
    quality in relation to pollution.
  E  Together with other algae, they release
     oxygen required by fish, and for self-
     purification of streams.

  F  They may produce a slime which inter-
     feres with some industrial uses of water
     such as in paper manufacture and in
     cooling towers.
VH  CLASSIFICATION

  A  Ulotrichaceae

     Ulothrix. Microspora,  Hormidium

  B  Cladophoraceae

     Cladophora. Pithophora.  Rhizoclonium

  C  Chaetophoraceae

     Chaetophora. Stigeoclonium. Draparnaldia

  D  Oedogeniaceae

     Oedogonium.  Bulbochaete

  E  Schizomeridaceae

     1  Schizomeris

  F  Ulvaceae

     Enteromorpha.  Monostroma

  G  Zygnemataceae

     Zygnema.  Spirogyra. Mougeotia

  H  Desmidiaceae

     Desmidium. Hyalotheca

  I  Tribonemataceae

     Tribonema. Bumilleria

  J  Characeae

     Chara. Nitella. Tolypella
  10-2

-------
                                               j iiamentous Green Algae
13. GREENS, FILAMENTOUS

-------
   Filamentous Green Algae
VIE  IDENTIFICATION

   A Branching and attenuation are of primary
     importance.

   B Plastids: shape, location and number per
     cell are essential.

   C Other characteristics include grouping
     of filaments, gelatinous envelope and
     special features such as "H" shaped
     fragments.
   REFERENCES

   1  Collins,  F.S.  1909.  The green algae
        of North America.  Tufts College
        Studies, Scientific Series 2:79-480.
        Reprinted Hafner Publ.  Co.,   1928
        (Reprinted,  1968) Lew's Books,
        San Francisco.

   2  Faridi, M.   A monograph of the fresh-
        water species of Cladophora and
        Rhizoclonium.  Ph.D.   Thesis.
        University Microfilms,  Ann Arbor.

   3  Hirn, K. E.  Monograph of the
        Oedogoniaceae.   Hafner Publ.,
        New York.  1960.
4  Pal,  B.P., Kundu, B.C., Sundaralingam,
      V. S., and Venkataraman, G. S.
      Charophyta.   Indian Coun. Agric.
      Res., New Delhi.   1962.

5  Soderstrom,  J.  Studies in Cladophora.
      Almquist,  Uppsala.   1963.

6  Tilden,  J.  The Myxophyceae of North
      America.  Minn. Geol. Surv.
      (Reprinted 1967,  J. Cramer,  Lehre,
      Germany)  1910.

7  Transeau, E.N.  The Zygnemataceae.
      Ohio State  Univ. Press.   1951.
8  Van der Hoek, C.  Revision of the
      European species of Cladophora.
      Brill Publ,  Leiden, Netherlands.
1963.
9  Wood, R.D. and Imahari,  K.   A revision
      of the Characeae.  Volume I.
      Monograph (by Wood).  Vol. II,
      Iconograph (by Wood & Imahari). 1964.
This outline was prepared by C. M. Palmer,
Former Aquatic Biologist, In Charge,
Interference Organisms Studies,  Micro-
biology Activities, Research and
Development, Cincinnati Water Research
Laboratory, FWPCA.

Descriptor;  Green Algae
    10-4

-------
                                  COCCOID GREEN ALGAE
 I  INTRODUCTION

 For the sake of convenience, the non-motile
 green algae are to be discussed in two
 sections: those that tend to live as relatively
 discrete or free floating planktonic units,
 and those that tend to grow in masses or
 mats of material,  often filamentous in nature,
 attached or free floating.

n  The green or "grass green" algae is one
 of the most varied and conspicuous groups
 with which we have to deal.   The forms
 mentioned below have been artificially grouped
 for convenience according to cell shape.
 Botanists would list these genera in several
 different categories in the family "Chloro-
 phyceae."

 These algae typically have a relatively high
 chlorophyll content,  and the food reserves
 accumulated are typically starch.   Thus
 these forms will usually give a typical black
 or deep purple color when treated with iodine.

 A Individual cells of the following genera are
   perfectly round, or nearly so.  The first
   does not form organized colonies.  In the
   next two the  colonies themselves tend to
   be round, and in the last,  the colonies are
   triangular or irregular, and the cells bear
   long  slender spines.

    1 Chlorella cells are small and spherical
    • to broadly elliptical.   They have a
      single parietal chloroplast.  This is a
      very large genus with an  unknown
      number of similar appearing species,
      living in a great variety of habitats.
      Although often accumulating in great
      numbers, organized colonies are not
      formed.
   a  Chlorella ellipsoides is reported to
      be a common plankton form.

   b  Chlorella pyrenoidosa and Chlorella
      vulgaris are often found in
      organically enriched waters.
      Indeed a dominance of Chlorella
      species is considered in some
      places to be an indication that a
      sewage stabilization pond is func-
      tioning to maximum capacity.

   c  Chlorella pyrenoidosa is reported
      as a filter clogger in water treat-
      ment plants.

2  Sphaerocystis colonies are free floating
   and almost always with a perfectly
   spherical, homogeneous gelatinous
   envelope. Up to 32 spherical cells
   may be included. Sphaerocystis
   scheoeteri, the only species, is of
   wide occurrence in the plankton of
   lakes and reservoirs.

3  Coelastrum forms coenobial* colonies
   of up to 128 cells.  Generally spherical
   or polygonal in shape—both cells and
   colony.   Cells connected by protoplasmic
   processes of varying length.
   Coelastrum microporum is often
   reported in the plankton of water
   supplies.  Not surrounded by gelatinous
   envelope as in Sphae rocystis.

4  Micractinium.  The cells  of this alga
   are spherical to broadly ellipsoidal and
   are usually united in irregular 4-celled
   coenobes. These in turn are almost
   always united with other coenobes to
   form multiple associations of up to
   100 or more cells.  The free face of
 1  Including miscellaneous yellow-brown algae.

 *A coenobe is a colony in which the number of cells does not increase during the life of the
  colony.  It was established by the union of several independent swimming cells which simply
  stick together and increase in size.
 Bl.MlC.cla.9c. 6.76
                                11-1

-------
Coccoid Green Algae
      each cell in a coenobe bears from one
      to seven very long slender setae or
      hairs.

      Micractinium pus ilium.   This is a
      strictly planktonic genus.
   Individual cells of the following genera
   are elongate.  In the first two they are
   relatively straight or irregular and pointed.
   The next two are also long and pointed,
   but bent into a tight "C" shape (one  in a
   gelatinous envelope,  one naked).  The last
   one (Actinastrum) is long and straight,
   but with blunt ends, and with the cells of
   a coenobe attached at a point.

   1  Ankistrodesmus cells are usually long
      and slender, tapering to sharp point at
      both ends.  They may be  straight,
      curved, or twisted into loose aggregations.
      Ankistrodesmus falcatus  is often found
      in the plankton in water supplies and is
      considered to be one  of the forms
      indicative of clean water.

   2  Schroederia is a solitary, free floating
      alga.  Cells are long and pointed at
      both ends.  May be bent in various ways.
      Terminal points are continued as long
      slender spines which may be forked and
      bent back, or end as  a plate.  Of the
      three species reported in this country,
      Schroederia setigera has  been reported
      in water supplies.

   3  Selenastrum cells are pointed at both
      ends, and bent so that their tips  approach
      each other.  They tend to occur in groups
      of 4,  8, or  16,  which may be associated
      with other groups  to form masses of a
      hundred or more cells.  There is no
      gelatinous envelope.  Selenastrum
      gracile occurs in the plankton of water
      supplie s.

   4  Kirchneriella.  The cells of this genus
      are generally relatively broad, tapering
      to a sharp or rounded point at each end,
      and the whole cell bent into a C-shape.
   They usually occur in groups of four
   to eight in a broad, homogeneous,
   gelatinous matrix.  Kirchneriella
   lunaris is known principally from the
   plankton.

5  Actinastrum  colonies or "coenobes"
   are composed of 4, 8,  or 16 elongate
   cells that radiate in all directions from
   a common center.

   Actinastrum  is a  widely distributed
   plankton organism.  There are two
   species:

   Actinastrum  gracillimum and
   Actinastrum  Hantzschii differ only
   in the sharpness of the taper toward
   the tips of the cells. The former has
   relatively little taper,  and the latter,
   more.

Cells of the following genera are
associated in simple naked colonies.
The first has elongate cells arranged
with their long axes  parallel (although
some cells may be curved).  The last
two are flat plate-like coenobes.
Crucigenia has four-celled coenobes
while Pediastrum coenobes may be
larger,  appear plate-like,  and are much
more ornate.

1  Scenedesmus is a flat plate of elliptical
   to double ended pointed cells arranged
   with  their long axes parallel.  Coenobes
   consist of up to 32, but  usually 4 to 8
   cells.  The number of cells in a
   coenobe may vary from mother to
   daughter colony.  The appearance of
   cells may vary considerably with the
   species.

   a  Scenedesmus bijuga. S. dimorphus,
     and S. quadricauda are common
     planktonic forms.

   b  Scenedesmus quadricauda is also
     common in organically enriched
     water, and may become dominant.
   c  Scenedemus abundans is reported
     to impart a grassy odor to drinking
     water.
 11-2

-------
                                                                   Coccoid Green Algae
D
2  Crucigenia forms free floating four-
   celled coenobes that are solitary or
   joined to one another to form plate-
   like multiple coenobes of 16 or more
   cells.  The cells maybe elliptical,
   triangular, trapezoidal, or semi-
   circular in surface view.  Crucigenia
   quadrata is a species  often reported
   from water supplies.

3  Pediastrum.  Colonies are free floating
   with up to 128 polygonal cells arranged
   in a single plane.  There may or may
   not be open spaces between the cells.
   The exact arrangement of the cells
   seems to depend largely on the chance
   distribution of the original motile
   swarming zoaspores at the time  the
   coenobe was formed.  Peripheral cells
   may differ in shape from interior cells.

   a Pediastrum boryanum and P.  duplex
     are frequently found in the plankton,
     but seldom dominate.

   b Pediastrum tetras  has been reported
     to impart a grassy odor to water
     supplies.

Cells of the following Genera are slightly
elongated.

1  Oocystis. The cells of Oocystis may
   be solitary,  or up to 16 cells may be
   surrounded by a partially gellatinized
   and greatly expanded mother cell wall.
   Cells may be ellipsoidal or almost
   cylindrical,  cell wall  thin,  no spines
   or other ornamentation.  Oocystis
   borgei.  for example,  is of frequent
   occurrence in the plankton.

2  Dimorphococcus cells are arranged in
   groups of four, and these tetrads are
   united to one another in irregularly
   shaped free floating colonies by the
   branching remains of  old mother-cell
   walls.  Two shapes of cell are normally
   found in each tetrad (hence the name),  two
   longer ovate cells end to end,  and a
   pair of slightly shorter, C-shaped cells
   on either side.  Dimorphococcus
   lunatus is a widely distributed plankton
   organism, sometimes reported in
   considerable numbers.
A distinctive group of green algae
characterized by a median constriction
dividing the cell into two geometrically
similar halves is known generally as the
"desmids. "  (Closterium and Penium do
not have this construction).  Each half
of the cell is known as a "semicell. "
The nucleus lies in the  "isthmus. "
Extremes of ornamentation and structural
variety exist.  Most are unicellular,  but
a few are filamentous or have the cells
associated in shapeless colonies.  They
are found sparingly in the plankton almost
everywhere, but predominate in acid
waters.

1  Closterium is one of the exceptional
   genera without a median constriction.
   The cells are elongate,  attenuated
   toward the tips but not sharply pointed,
   usually somewhat bent.

   a  Closterium aciculare is a planktonic
      species.

   b  Closterium moniliforme is reported
      as a filter clogging organism.

2  Cosmarium is a large,  poorly defined
   genus of over 280  species, many of
   which apparently intergrade with other
   genera such as Staurastrum.  In
   general,  it can be said that Cosmarium
   species are relatively small, with a
   length only slightly greater than the
   width,  and with a deep median con-
   striction.  Shapes of the semicells
   may vary greatly. Although shallow
   surface ornamentation may occur,
   long spines do not occur.

   a  Cosmarium botrytis  is reported in
      plankton from water  supply
      reservoirs.

   b  Cosmarium portianum  is said to
      impart a grassy odor to water.

   c  Other species have been reported
      to bft sufficiently  resistant to
      chlorine to penetrate rapid sand
      filters and occur in distribution
      systems  in considerable numbers.
                                                                                     11-3

-------
 Coccoid Green Algae
    3  Micrasterias is relatively common,
       ornate.

    4  Euastrum cells tend to be at least twice
       as long as broad, with a deeply con-
       stricted isthmus, and a dip  or incision
       at the tip of each semicell.  The cell
       wall may be smooth, granulate, or
       spined.

       Euastrum oblongum is reported as a
       planktonic species from water reser-
       voirs. It has also been noted as
       intolerant of pollution, and hence an
       indicator of clean water.

    5  Staurastrum is the  commonest of the
       desmids in the plankton of fresh waters;
       the genus contains upwards  of 245 species
       in the United States alone.  Inter-
       gradation with other genera such as
       Cosmarium make it a difficult group
       to define. Most of the species are
       radially symmetrical,  and almost all
       have a deeply constricted isthmus.
       The cell wall may be smooth, orna-
       mented, or  spined in a variety of ways.
       Relatively long truncated processes
       extending from the  cell body in
       symmetrical patterns are common.

       a  Staurastrum polymorphum is a
          typical planktonic form.

       b  Staurastrum punctulatum is reported
          as an indicator of clean water.

       c  Staurastrum paradoxicum causes a
          'grassy odor in water.
   1  The plant body is a free floating colony
      of indefinite shape, with a cartilag-
      inous and hyaline or orange-colored
      envelope; surface greatly wrinkled
      and folded.

   2  Individual cells lie close together, in
      several aggregates connected in
      reticular fashion by strands of the
      colonial envelope.

   3  The envelope structure tends to
      obscure cell structure.  Considerable
      deep orange colored oil may collect
      within the envelope, outside of the
      cells,  obscuring cell structure.

   Ophiocytium capitatum like Botryococcus.
   is widely distributed,  but seldom abundant.

   1  Both ends of cylindrical cell are
      rounded,  with a sharp spine extending
      therefrom.

   2  Many nuclei and several chloroplasts
      are present.
REFERENCES

1  Palmer,  C.M.   Algae in Water Supplies.
      Government Printing Office.   PHS
      Publication No. 657.  1959.

2  Smith,  G.S.  Phytoplankton of the
      Inland Lakes of Wisconsin.  Part I.
      Bulletin No. 57, Scientific Series
      No.  12.  1920.
in  A type of "green" alga known as "golden
 green" (Xanthophyceae) is represented in the
 plankton by two genera.  In these algae there
 is a predominance of yellow over green pig-
 ments, hence frequently imparting a yellowish
 or golden tint to the cell.  Reserve food
 material is stored as oil and leucosin,  rather
 than as starch,  hence giving a negative test
 with iodine in most cases.

 A Botryococcus braunii is a widely dis-
    tributed plankton alga,  though it is
    rarely abundant.
This outline was prepared by H. W. Jackson,
former Chief Biologist,  National Training
Center, and revised by R. M. Sinclair,
Aquatic Biologist, National  Training Center,
MOTD, OWPO, USEPA.  Cincinnati, Ohio
45268.	

Descriptor: CMorophyta
   11-4

-------
                                          DIATOMS
 I   GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS

 A  Diatoms have cells of very rigid form due
    to the presence of silica in the wall. They
    contain a brown pigment in addition to the
    chlorophyll.  Their walls are ornamented
    with markings which have a specific pattern
    for each kind.

    1  The cells often are isolated but others
      are in filaments or other shapes of
      colonies.

    2  The protoplast contains normal cell
      parts, the most conspicuous being the
      plastids.  No starch is present.
 B  Cell shapes include the elongate ("pennate")
    and the short cylindric ("centric") one view
    of which is circular.

    1  Pennate diatoms may be symmetrical,
       transversely unsymetrical, or longitudi-
       nally unsymmetrical.
    4  Internal shelves ("septae") extending
       longitudinally or transversely.
 II  REPRODUCTION

 A The common method is by cell division.
    Two new half cells are formed between the
    halves of the parent cell.

 B Auxospores and gametes may also be
    formed.
HI  EXAMPLES OF COMMON DIATOMS:

 A Pennate, symmetrical:

          Navicula
          Pinnularia
          Synedra
          Nitzschia
          Diatoma
          Fragilaria
          Tabellaria
          Cocconeis
 C  Wall is formed like a box with a flanged
    cover fitting over it.

    1  "Valve" view is that of the top of the
       cover or the bottom of the box.

    2  "Girdle" view is that of the side where
       flange of cover fits over the box.

    3  End view is also possible for pennate
       types.
 D  Cell markings include:

    1  Raphe or false raphe extending
       longitudinally.

    2  Striations which are lines of pores
       extending from the area of the raphe to
       the margin.  Coarse ones are "costae".

    3  Nodules which may be terminal and
       central.
 B Pennate,  unsymmetrical:

          Gomphonema
          Surirella
          Cymbella
          Achnanthes
          Asterionella
          Meridion
                                                  C  Centric:
          Cyclotella
          Stephanodiscus
          Melosira
IV  Habitats include fresh and salt wateyr. Both
 planktonic and attached forms occur, the latter
 often are broken loose.  They may be attached
 by stalks or by their slimy surface.
BI. MIC. cla.lOa. 6.76
                                                                                    12-1

-------
 Diatoms
 A Many diatoms are more abundant in late
    autumn,  winter, and early spring than in
    the warmer season.
              Fragilaria
              Synedra
              Asterionella
 B The walls of dead diatoms generally remain
    undecomposed and may be common in water.
    Many deposits of fossil diatoms exist.


 V Importance of diatoms is in part due to
 their great abundance and their rigid walls.

 A They are the most important group of
    organisms causing clogging of sand filters.

 B Several produce tastes and odors in water,
    including the obnoxious fishy flavor.
  C Mats of growth may cause floors or steps
    of swimming pools to be slippery.

  D They may be significant in determining
    water quality in relation to pollution.

  E They release oxygen into the water.
     2  Achnanthineae.  Group with cells
        having one false and one true raphe.

        a  Representative genera:

              Cocconeis
              Achnanthes
        Naviculineae.  True raphe group with
        raphe in center of valve.

        a  Representative genera:

           Navicula
           Pinnularia
           Stauroneis
           Pleurosigma
           Amphiprora
           Gomphonema
           Cymbella
           Epithemia
VI  Classification.  There are several thou-
 sand species of diatoms.  Only the most com-
 mon of the freshwater forms are considered
 here.

 A Centrales Group

    1  Representative genera:

          Cyclotella
          Stephanodiscus
          Melosira
          Rhizosolenia
          Biddulphia


  B Pennals Group

    1  Fragilarineae.  The false raphe group.

       Representative genera:

          Tabellaria
          Me rid ion
          Diatoma
     4  Surirellineae. True raphe group with
        raphe near  one  side of valve.

        a  Representative genera:

           Nitzschia
           Cymatopleura
           Surirella
           Campylodiscus
VII  IDENTIFICATION OF DIATOMS

  A  Some genera are  easily recognized by their
     distinctive shape.

  B  Many genera and  most species can be
     determined only after diatoms are freed
     of their contents and observed under the
     high magnification of an oil immersion
     lens of the compound microscope.

  C  Contents of the cell are generally not
     used in identification.  Only the char-
     aracteristics of the wall are used.
   12-2

-------
                                                                                   Diatoms
D For identification of genera, most im-
   portant features include:

   1  Cell shape,  and form of colony

   2  Raphe and false raphe

   3  Striations

   4  Septa
E For identification of species, measure-
   ments involving the number of striae per
   10 microns, the direction of the striae
   and many other characteristics may be
   needed.
REFERENCES

1 . Boyer, C. S.  The Diatomaceae of
      Philadelphia and Vicinity.  J. B. Lippin-
      cott Co.   Philadelphia. 1916.  p 143.

2  Boyer, C. S.  Synopsis of North America
      Diatomaceae.  Parts 1(1927)  and II
      (1928). Proceedings of the Academy
      of Natural Sciences.  Philadelphia.

3  Elmore,  C. J. The Diatoms of Nebraska.
      University of Nebraska Studies. 21:
      22-215.   1921.

4  Hohn, M. H.   A Study of the Distribution
      of Diatoms in Western New York
      State. Cornell University Agricultural
      Experimental Station. Memoir 308.
      pp 1-39.  1951.

5  Pascher, A.  Bacillariophyta (Diatomeae).
      Heft 10 in Die Susswasser-Flora
      Mitteleuropas, Jena.  1930. p 466.

6  Patrick,  R.  A Taxonomic and Ecological
      Study of Some Diatoms from the
      Pocono Plateau and Adjacent Regions.
      Farlowia. 2:143-221.  1945.
 7  Patrick,  Ruth and Reimer, Charles W.
       The Diatoms of the United States.
       Vol.  1 Fragilariaceae, Eunotiaceae,
       Achnanthaceae, Naviculaceae.
       Monog. 13.  Acad. Nat. Sci.
       Philadelphia.  688 pp.  1966.

 8  Smith, G.M.   Class Bacillariophyceae.
       Freshwater Algae of the United
       States, pp 440-510, 2nd Edition.
       McGraw Hill Book Co. New York.
       1950.

 9  Tiffany,  L. H. and Britton, M. E.  Class
       Bacillariophyceae.  The Algae of
       Illinois,  pp 214-296.   University
       of Chicago Press.  1952.

10  Ward, H. B.  and Whipple, G. C.  Class
       I, Bacillariaceae (Diatoms).  Fresh-
       water Biology, pp 171-189.  John
       Wiley & Sons.  New York.  1948.

11  Weber, C. I.  A Guide to the  Common
       Diatoms at Water Pollution
       Surveillance System Stations.
       FWPCA.   Cincinnati.  101 pp.  1966.

12  Whipple, G.C.,  Fair, G. M., and
       Whipple,  M.C.   Diatomaceae.
       Microscopy of Drinking Water.
       Chapter 21. 4th Edition.   John Wiley
       & Sons. New York.  1948.
 This outline was prepared by C.M.  Palmer,
 Former Aquatic Biologist, In Charge,
 Interference Organisms Studies, Microbiology
 Activities,  Research and Development,
 Cincinnati Water Research Laboratory,
 FWPCA.

 Descriptor: Diatoms
                                                                                     12-3

-------
                                    FILAMENTOUS BACTERIA
 I   INTRODUCTION

 There are a number of types of filamentous
 bacteria that occur in the aquatic environment.
 They include the sheathed sulfur and iron
 bacteria such as Beggiatoa, Crenothrix and
 Sphaerotilus, the actinomycetes which are
 unicellular microorganisms that form chains
 of cells with special branchings, and
 Gallionella, a unicellular organism that
 secretes a long twisted ribbon-like  stalk.
 These filamentous forms have at times
 created serious problems in rivers,
 reservoirs, wells,  and water distribution
 systems.
n  BEGGIATOA

 Beggiatoa is a sheathed bacterium that grows
 as a long filamentous form.  The flexible
 filaments may be as large as 25 microns wide
 and 100 microns long. (Figure 1)
Figure 1
                           Beggiatoa alba
                           2'-
15>*  *

   up to 1,OOO|M
                     Transverse separations within the sheath
                     indicate that a row of cells is included in
                     one sheath.  The sheath may be clearly
                     visible or so slight that only special staining
                     will indicate that it is present.

                     The organism grows as a white slimy or
                     felted cover on the surface of various objects
                     undergoing decomposition or on the surface
                     of stagnant areas of a stream receiving
                     sewage.  It has also been observed on the
                     base of a trickling filter and in contact
                     aerators.

                     .It is most commonly found in sulfur springs
                     or polluted waters where HyS is present.
                     Beggiatoa is distinguished by its ability  to
                     deposit sulfur within its cells; the sulfur
                     deposits appear as large refractile globules.
                     (Figure 2)
                                                                      Figure 2

                                                                 Filaments of Beggiatoa
                                                                 containing granules |of
                                                                 sulphur.
When H S is no longer present in the environ-
ment, the sulfur deposits disappear.
Dr. Pringsheim of Germany has recently
proved that the organism can grow as a true
autotroph obtaining all its energy from the
oxidation of H^S and using this energy to fix
CO- into all material.  It can also use
certain organic materials if they are present
along with the H2S.

Faust and Wolfe,  and Scotten and Stokes
have grown the organism in pure culture in
this country.  Beggiatoa exhibits a motility
that is quite different from the typical
flagellated motility of most  bacteria; the
filaments have a flexible gliding motion.
   BA. 8a. 6. 76
                                                                                        13-1

-------
 Filamentous Bacteria
 The only major nuisance effect of Beggiatoa
 known has been overgrowth on trickling filters
 receiving waste waters rich in H^S.  The
 normal microflora of the filter was suppressed
 and the filter failed to give  good treatment.
 Removal of the H?S from the water by blowing
 air through the water before it reached the
 filters caused the slow decline of the
 Beggiatoa and a recovery of the normal
 microflora.  Beggiatoa usually indicates
 polluted conditions with the presence of H.S
 rather than being a direct nuisance.
UI  ACTINOMYCETES AND EARTHY ODORS
    IN WATER

 Actinomycetes are unicellular microorganisms,
 1 micron in diameter, filamentous, non-
 sheathed, branching monopodially, and
 reproduced by fission or by means of special
                             Figure 4

                            Egg albumin isolation plate.
                           'A'  an actlnojmycete colony,
                           and 'B1 a bacterial colony
  Appearance:
                  Appearance:
 conidia. (Figure 3)
        Figure3   Filaments of Actinomycetes
  Their filamentous habit and method of
  sporulation is reminiscent of fungi.  However,
  their size,  chemical composition,  and other
  characteristics are more similar to bacteria.
  (Figure 4)
dull and powdery   smooth and mucoid

     These organisms may be considered as a
     group intermediate between the fungi and
     the bacteria.  They require organic matter
     for growth but can use a wide variety of
     substances and are widely distributed.

     Actinomycetes have been implicated as the
     cause of earthy odors in some drinking
     waters (Romano and Safferman,  Silvey and
     Roach) and in earthy smelling substance has
     been isolated from several members of the
     group by Gerber and Lechevalier. Safferman
     and Morris have reported on a method for the
     "isolation and Enumeration of Actinomycetes
     Related to Water Supplies. " But the actino-
     mycetes are primarily soil microorganisms
     and often grow in fields or on the banks of a
     river or lake used for the water supply.
     Although residual chlorination will kill the
     organisms in the treatment plant or distribution
   13-2

-------
                                                                      Filamentous Bacteria
 system, the odors often are present before
 the water enters the plant.  Use of perman-
 ganate oxidation and activated carbon filters
 have been most successful of the methods
 tried to remove the odors from the water.
 Control procedures to prevent the odorous
 material from being washed into the water
 supply by rains or to prevent possible develop-
 ment of the actinomycetes in water rich in
 decaying organic matter is  still needed.
IV  FILAMENTOUS IRON BACTERIA

 The filamentous iron bacteria of the
 Sphaerotilus- Leptothrix  group, Crenothrix,
 and Gallionella have the ability  to either
 oxidize manganous or ferrous ions to manganic
 or ferric salts or are able to accumulate
 precipitates of these compounds within the
 sheaths of the organisms.   Extensive growths
 or accumulations of the empty,  metallic
 encrusted sheaths devoid of cells,  have
 created much trouble in wells or water dis-
 tribution systems. Pumps and  back surge
 valves have been clogged with masses of
 material,  taste and odor problems have
 occurred, and rust colored masses of
 material have spoiled products  in contact
 with water.

 Crenothrix polyspora has only been examined
 under the microscope as we have never been
 able to grow it in the laboratory.  The orga-
 nism is easily recognized by its special
 morphology.  Dr.  Wolfe of the University of
 Illinois has published photomicrographs of
 the organism. (Figure  5)

 Organisms of the Sphaerotilus- Leptothrix
 group have been extensively studied by many
 investigators (Dondero et. al.,  Dondero,
 Stokes, Waitz and Lackey,  Mulder and van
 Veen, and Amberg and Cormack.)  Under
 different environmental conditions the mor-
 phological appearance of the organism varies.
 The usual form found in polluted streams or
 bulked activated sludge is Sphaerotilus natans.
 (Figure 6)
       Figure 5
Crenothrix polyspora

  cells are very variable in
  size  from small cocci or
 •polyspores to cells 3x12/4
       Figure 6

   Sphaerotilus natans


    3-8 X 1.2 - 1.8/M
        cells
                                                                                         13-3

-------
Filamentous Bacteria
This is a sheathed bacterium consisting of
long,  unbranched filaments, whereby individual
rod-shaped bacterial cells are enclosed in a
linear order within the sheath.  The individual
cells are 3-8 microns long and 1. 2-1. 8
microns wide.  Sphaerotilus grows in great
masses; at times in streams or rivers that
receive wastes from pulp mills, sugar
refineries, distilleries,  slaughterhouses,
or milk processing plants.  In these conditions,
it appears as large masses or tufts attached
to rocks, twigs, or other projections and the
masses may vary in color from light grey to
reddish brown.  In some rivers large masses
of Sphaerotilus break loose and clog water
intake pipes or foul fishing nets. When the
cells  die,  taste and odor problems may also
occur in the water.

Amberg, Cormack,  and Rivers and McKeown
have reported on methods to try to limit the
development of Sphaerotilus in rivers by
intermittant discharge of wastes.  Adequate
control will probably only be achieved once
the wastes are treated before discharge to
such an extent that the growth of Sphaerotilus
is no  longer favored in the river. Sphaerotilus
grows well at  cool temperatures and slightly
low DO levels in streams receiving these
wastes and domestic sewage.  Growth is slow
where the only nitrogen present is inorganic
nitrogen; peptones and proteins are utilized
preferentially.

Gallionella is  an iron bacterium which appears
as a kidney-shaped cell with a twisted ribbon-
like stalk emanating from the concavity of the
cell.   Gallionella obtains its energy by
oxidizing ferrous iron to ferric iron and uses
only CO_ and inorganic salts to form all of
the cell material; it is an autotroph.  Large
masses of Gallionella may cause problems
in wells or accumulate in low-flow low-
pressure water mains.  Super chlorination
(up to 100 ppm of sodium hypochlorite for
48 hours) followed by flushing will often
remove the masses  of growth and periodic
treatment will prevent the nuisance effects
of the extensive masses of Gallionella.
(Figure 7)
                          Figure 7
                     Sallonella furruglnea


                      O.5|XlO.7 - 1.1 ju
                         Cells
REFERENCES

Beggiatoa

1  Faust, L. and Wolfe, R.S.  Enrichment
      and Cultivation of Beggiatoa Alba.
      Jour.  Bact.,  81:99-106.   1961.

2  Scotten, H. L. and Stokes, J. L.
      Isolation and Properties of Beggiatoa.
      Arch Fur. Microbiol.  42:353-368.
      1962.

3  Kowallik,  U.  and Pringsheim,  E.G.
      The Oxidation of Hydrogen Sulfide by
      Beggiatoa. Amer. Jour, of Botany.
      53:801-805.   1966.

Actinomycetes and Earthy Odors
   Silvey, J.K. G. .etaj^ Actinomycetes and
      Common Tastes and Odors.  JAWWA,
      42:1018-1026.  1950.

   Safferman, R.S. and Morris, M. E.
      A Method for the Isolation and
      Enumeration of Actinomycetes Related
      to Water Supplies.  Robert A. Taft
      Sanitary Engineering Center Tech.
      Report W-62- 10.   1962.
 13-4

-------
                                                                     Filamentous Bacteria
 6  Gerber, N.N.  and Lechevalier, H.A.
       Geosmin, an Earthy-Smelling Substance
       Isolated from Actinomycetes.  Appl.
       Microbiol.  13:935-938.  1965.

 Filamentous Iron Bacteria
 7  Wolfe,  R.S.  Cultivation, Morphology, and
       Classification of the Iron Bacteria.
       JAWWA.  50:1241-1249.  1958.

 8  Kucera, S. and Wolfe,  R. S.  A Selective
       Enrichment Method for Gallionella
       ferruginea.  Jour. Bacteriol.  74:344-
       349.   1957.

 9  Wolfe,  R.S.  Observations and Studies
       of Crenothrix polyspora.   JAWWA,
       52:915-918.   1960.

10  Wolfe,  R.S.  Microbiol.   Concentration
       of Iron and Manganese in Water with
       Low Concentrations  of these Elements.
       JAWWA. 52:1335-1337.   1960.

11  Stokes, J. L.   Studies on the  Filamentous
       Sheathed Iron Bacterium Sphaerotilus
       natans.  Jour.  Bacteriol.  67:278-291.
       1954.

12  Waitz,  S.  and Lackey,  J. B.  Morphological
       and Biochemical Studies on the
       Organism Sphaerotilus natans.  Quart.
       Jour. Fla. Acad. Sci.  21(4):335-340.
       1958.

13  Dondero,  N.C., Philips, R.A. and
       Henkelkian, H.  Isolation  and
       Preservation of Cultures of Sphaerotilus.
       Appl. Microbiol. 9:219-227.   1961.
14  Dondero, N. C.   Sphaerotilus, Its Nature
      and Economic Significance. Advances
      Appl. Microbiol. 3:77-107.  1961.

15  Mulder, E.G. and van Veen,  W. L.
      Investigations on the Sphaerotilus-
      Leptothrix Group. Antonie van
      Leewenhoek.   29:121-153.  1963.

16  Amberg,  H.R. and Cor mack, J. F.
      Factors Affecting Slime Growth in
      the Lower Columbia River and
      Evaluation of Some Possible Control
      Measures.  Pulp and Paper Mag.  of
      Canada.  61:T70-T80.   1960.

17  Amberg,  H.R., Cormack, J. F. and
      Rivers, M.R.  Slime Growth Control
      by Intermittant Discharge of Spent
      Sulfite Liquor.  Tappi.   45:770-779.
      1962.

18  McKeown, J. J.   The Control of
      Sphaerotilus natans.  Ind. Water
      and Wastes.   8:(3) 19-22  and
      8:(4)30-33.   1963.

19  Curtis, E. J. C.,  Sewage Fungus; Its
      Nature and Effects.  Wat. Res.
      3:289-311. 1969.

20  Lechevalier, Hubert A., Actinomycetes
      of Sewage Treatment Plants. Envir.
      Prot. Tech.  Series USEPA,
      600/1-75-031.  1975.

  This outline was prepared by R. F. Lewis
  Bacteriologist, Advanced Waste Treatment
  Research Laboratory, NERC, USEPA,
  Cincinnati, Ohio 45268.

  Descriptors: Aquatic Bacteria,  Sphaerotilus
  Actinomycetes, Nocardia
                                                                                     13-5

-------
                     FUNGI AND THE "SEWAGE FUNGUS" COMMUNITY
I    INTRODUCTION

A    Description

     Fungi are heterotrophic achylorophyllous
     plant-like organisms which possess true
     nuclei with nuclear membranes  and nu-
     cleoli.  Dependent upon the species and
     in  some  instances the environmental
     conditions, the body of the fungus,  the
     thallus,  varies from a microscopic
     single cell to an extensive plasmodium
     or mycelium;  Numerous forms produce
     macroscopic fruiting bodies.

B   Life Cycle

     The life cycles of fungi vary from simple
     to  complex and may include sexual and
     asexual stages  with  varying spore  types
     as the reproductive units.

C   Classification

     Traditionally,  true fungi are classified
     within the Division Eumycotina of the   1
     Phylum Mycota of the plant kingdom.
     Some authorities consider the  fungi an
     essentially monophyletic group distinct
     from the  classical plant and animal
     kingdoms.
                                            Ill  ECOLOGY


                                             A  Distribution


                                                Fungi are ubiquitous in nature and mem-
                                                bers of all classes may occur in large
                                                numbers in aquatic habitats. Sparrow
                                                (1968) has briefly reviewed the ecology
                                                of fungi in freshwaters with particular
                                                emphasis on the zoosporic phycomycetes.
                                                The occurrence and ecology of fungi in
                                                marine and estuarine waters has been
                                                examined recently by a number of in-
                                                vestigators (Johnson and Sparrow, 1961;
                                                Johnson,  1968;  Myers, 1968; van Uden
                                                and Fell, 1968).


                                            B  Relation to  Pollution


                                                Win.  Bridge Cooke, in a series  of  in-
                                                vestigations (Cooke, 1965), has  estab-
                                                lished that fungi other than phycomycetes
                                                occur in high numbers in  sewage and
                                                 polluted waters.   His reports on organic
                                                pollution of streams (Cooke, 1961; 1967)
                                                show that the variety of the Deuteromy-
                                                cete flora is decreased at the immediate
                                                sites of pollution, but dramatically in-
                                                creased downstream from these  regions.
II
ACTIVITY
 In general, fungi possess broad enzymatic
 capacities.  Various species are able to
 actively  degrade  such  compounds as
 complex polysaccharides (e. g., cellulose,
 chitin,  and glycogen), proteins (casein,
 albumin,  keratin), hydrocarbons (kerosene)
 and pesticides. .Most species possess an
 oxidative or microaerophilic metabolism,
 but anaerobic catabolism is not uncommon.
 A few species  show anaerobic metabolism
 and growth.
                                                Yeasts,  in particular, have  been found
                                                in large numbers in organically enriched
                                                waters (Cooke, et al., 1960; Cooke and
                                                Matsuura, 1963; Cooke, 1965b; Ahearn,
                                                 et al.,  1968).   Certain yeasts are  of
                                                special interest  due to their potential
                                                use as  "indicator" organisms and their
                                                ability  to  degrade  or utilize proteins,
                                                various hydrocarbons,  straight and
                                                branch chained alkyl-benzene sulfonates,
                                                fats,  metaphosphates, and wood sugars.
  BI. FU. 6a. 6. 76
                                                                                    14-1

-------
 Fungi
C   "Sewage Fungus" Community  (Plate I)

    A few microorganisms have long been
    termed "sewage fungi. "  The  most
    common microorganisms included in
    this  group are the iron bacterium
    Sphaerotilus natans and the phy corny -
    cete Leptomitus lacteus.

    1  Sphaerotilus natans  is not a fungus;
       rather it is a sheath bacterium of
       the  order  chlamydobacteriales.
       This polymorphic bacterium occurs
       commonly in organically  enriched
       streams where it  may produce
       extensive slimes.

       a Morphology

         Characteristically, S. natans
         forms chains of rod  shaped
         cells (1. 1-2. On x 2.5- l?n)
         within a clear sheath or tri-
         chome composed ofaprotein-
         polysaccharidae-lipid complex.
         The rod cells are frequently
         motile upon release from the
         sheath; the flagella are lopho-
         trichous.  Occasionally  two
         rows of cells may be present
         in a single sheath. Single tri-
         chomes may be several  mm
         in length and bent at various
         angles.  Empty sheaths,  ap-
         pearing like thin cellophane
         straws,  may be present.


       b Attached growths

         The trichomes are cemented
         at one end to solid substrata
         such as stone or metal,  and
         their cross  attachment  and
         bending  gives a superficial
         similarity to true fungal hyphae.
         The ability to attach firmly to
         solid substrates gives S. natans
         a selective advantage in the
         population of flowing streams.
         For more thorough reviews of
         S. natans  see Prigsheim( 1949)
         and Stokes (1954).
Leptomitus lacteus also produces
extensive slimes and fouling floes
in fresh waters.  This species forms
thalli typified by regular constrictions.

a  Morphology

   Cellulin plugs may be present
   near the constrictions and there
   may be numerous granules in
   the  cytoplasm. The basal cell
   of the thallus may possess
   rhizoids.

b  Reproduction

   The segments delimited by the
   partial constrictions are con-
   verted basipetally to sporangia.
   The zoospores are diplanetic
   (i. e., dimorphic)  and each
   possesses one whiplash and one
   tinsel flagellum.  No sexual
   stage has been demonstrated
   for  this species.

c  Distribution

   For further information on the
   distribution and  systematics
   of L. lacteus see Sparrow (1960),
   Yerkes (1966) and Emerson and
   Weston (1967). Both S.  natans
   and L. lacteus appear to thrive
   in organically enriched cold
   waters (5°-22°C) and both seem
   incapable of extensive growth at
   temperatures of about 30°C.

d  Gross morphology

   Their metabolism is oxidative
   and growth of both species may
   appear as reddish brown floes
   or stringy slimes of 30 cm or
   more in length.

e  Nutritive requirements

   Sphaerotilus natans  is able to
   utilize a wide variety of organic
   compounds, whereas L. lacteus
   does not assimilate simple
  14-2

-------
                                                                         Fungi
                                 PLATE I

            "SEWAGE FUNGUS" COMMUNITY OR "SLIME GROWTHS"
                 (Attached "filamentous" and slime growths)
  Zoogloea
Sphaerotilus natans
                              Beggiatoa alba
               BACTERIA
Fusartum aqueductum
                                                   Leptomitus lacteus
                             Geotrichum .candidum
                                                         FUNGI
          Epistylis   8
                                                      /£><>
                        10
                 Opercularia

                   PROTOZOA
                                                                            14-3

-------
Fungi
                                                            PLATE   II

                                                 REPRESENTATIVE FUNGI
      Figure        •*•
      Fiaarium aquacductuum
      (Radlmacher and
      Rabenhorat) Saccardo
        Microconidia (A) produced
      from phialidea  as in Cephalo-
      iporium,  remaining  in  slime
      balls. Macroconidia (B), with
      one  to  several  cross  walls,
      produced from collared phial-
      ides. Drawn from culture.


            Figure   3
            Geouichum candidum
            Link ex Persoon
               Mycelium with short  cells
            and arthrospores. Young hy-
            pha (A); and mature arthro-
            spores (B). Drawn from cul-
            ture.
  Figure  5^

  Achlya  amcricana Humphrey

    Ooogonium with three  oo-
  spores  (A);  young xoospor-
  angium  with delimited  zoo-
  spores (B); and xoosporangia
  (C) with released loospores
  that remain encysted in clus-
  ters at the mouth of the dis-
  charge tube.  Drawn from cul-
  ture.
Figure     2.
Leplomitus lacteus (Roth)
Agardh
  Cells of the hyphae show-
ing constrictions with cellulin
plugs. In  one cell large  zoo-
spores have  been delimited.
Redrawn  from Coker, 1923.
            Mycelium with hyphal pegs
           (A)  on  which rotifers  will
           become impaled; gemmae (B)
           produced as conidia on short
           hyphal branches;  and rotifer
           impaled on hyphal peg  (C)
           from  which   hyphae  have
           grown into the rotifer whose
           shell  will  be discarded after
           the contents  are consumed.
           Drawn from culture.
                                                                                 FIGURE  /   •Jjaplosporidium costale.  A—mature spore;
                                                                                   B—early  plnsmodiu in.
  Figures  1 through 5  from  Cooke;  Figures  6 and 7 from Galtsoff.

       4

-------
                                                                                     Fungi
      sugars and grows most luxuriantly in
      the presence of organic nitrogenous
      wastes.

   3  Ecological roles

      Although the "sewage fungi" on
      occasion attain visually noticeable
      concentrations, the less obvious
      populations of  deuteromycetes may
      be more important in the ecology of
      the aquatic habitat. Investigations of
      the past decade indicate that numerous
      fungi are of primary importance in the
      mineralization of organic wastes; the
      overall significance and exact roles of
      fungi in this process are yet to be
      established.

D  Predacious Fungi

   1  Zoophagus insidians

      (Plate II,  Figure 4) has been observed
      to impair  functioning of laboratory
      activated sludge units (see Cooke and
      Ludzack).

   2  Arthrobotrys is usually found along
      with Zoophagus in laboratory activated
      sludge units.   This fungus is predacious
      upon nematodes.  Loops rather than
      "pegs" are used in snaring nematodes.
IV  CLASSIFICATION

 In recent classification schemes, classes
 of fungi are distinguished primarily on the
 basis of the morphology of the sexual and
 zoosporic stages.  In practical schematics,
 however, numerous fungi do not  demonstrate
 these stages.  Classification must therefore
 be based  on the sum total of the morphological
 and/or physiological characteristics.  The
 extensive review by Cooke (1963) on  methods
 of isolation and classification of  fungi from
 sewage and polluted waters precludes the
 need herein of extensive' keys and species
 illustrations.  A brief synopsis key of the
 fungi adapted in part from Alexopholous
 (1962) is  presented on the following pages.
  This outline was prepared by Dr. Donald G.
  Ahearn, Professor of Biology, Georgia State
  College, Atlanta,  Georgia  30303.

  Descriptor:  Aquatic Fungi
           PLATE II (Figure 4)
                                                                                      14-5

-------
Fungi
      KEY  TO THE MAJOR TAXA OF FUNGI

      1        Definite cell walls lacking, somatic phase a free living Plasmodium	
              	Sub-phylum Myxomycotina . . (true slime molds). .Class Myxomyeetea
      1'       Cell walls usually well defined,  somatic phase no* a free-living Plasmodium	
              	(true fungi)	Sub-phylum Eumycotina	2

      2        Hyphal filaments usually coenoctytic,  rarely septate, sex cells when present forming
              oospores or  zygospores, aquatic species propagating asexually by zoospores, terrestrial
              species by zoospores,  sporangiospores conidia or conidia-like sporangia .'.'Phycomycetes". .. 3

                  The phycomycetes are generally considered to include the most primitive of the true
              fungi.   As a  whole, they encompass a wide diversity of forms with some showing relation-
              ships to the flagellates, while others closely resemble colorless algae, and still others
              are true molds.  The vegetative body  (thallus) may be non-specialized and entirely con-
              verted into a reproductive organ (holocarpic), or it may bear tapering rhizoids, or be
              mycelial and very extensive.  The outstanding characteristics of the thallus is a tendency
              to be nonseptate and, in most groups, multinucliate; cross walls are laid down in vigorously
              growing material  only to delimit the reporductive organs.  The spore unit of nonsexual re-
              production is borne in a sporangium,  and, in aquatic and semiaquatic orders, is  provided
              with a  single posterior or anterior flagellum or two laterally attached ones.  Sexual activity
              in the phycomycetes characteristically results  in the formation of resting spores.

      2' (I1)   Hyphal filaments when present septate,  without  zoospores, with or without sporangia,
              usually with  conida; sexual reproduction absent  or culminating in the formation of asci
              or basidia	8

      3 (2)     Flagellated cells characteristically produced	4
      3'       Flagellated cells lacking or rarely produced	7

      4 (3)     Motile cells uniflagellate	5
      4'       Motile cells biflagellate	6

      5 (4)     Zoospores posteriorly uniflagellate, formed inside the sporangium. . . class. . .Chytridiomycetes

                  The Chytridiomycetes produce asexual zoospores with a single  posterior whiplash
              flagellum.  The thallus is highly variable; the most primitive forms are unicellular and
              holocarpic and in their  early stages of development are plasmodial (lack cell walls),  more
              advanced forms develop rhizoids and with further evolutionary progress develop mycelium.
              The principle chemical component of the cell wall is chltin, but cellulose  is also present.
              Chytrids are typically aquatic organisms but may be found in other habitats.  Some species
              are chitinolytic and/or  keratinolytic.  Chytrids  may be isolated from nature by baiting (e.g.
              hemp seeds or pine pollen) Chytrids occur both  in marine and fresh water habitats and are
              of some economic importance due to their parasitism of algae  and animals.  The genus
              Dermoevstidium may be provisionally grouped with the chytrids.  Species of this genus
              cause serious epidemics of oysters and  marine  and fresh water fish.

      5'       Zoospores anteriorly uniflagellate,  formed inside  or outside the sporangium	class
              	Hyphochytridiomycetes

                  These fungi are aquatic (fresh water or marine) chytrid-like fungi whose motile cells
              possess a single anterior flagellum of the tinsel type (feather-like).  They are parasitic on
              algae and fungi or may  be saprobic.  Cell walls contain chitin with some species also demon-
              strating cellulose  content.  Little information is available on the biology of this class and
              at present it  is limited  to less than 20 species.

      6 (4')    Flagella nearly equal, one whiplash the  other tinsel	class	Oomycetes

                  A number of representatives of the  Oomycetes have  been shown to have cellulosic cell
              walls.   The mycelium is coenocytic, branched and well developed in most cases.  The sexual
              process results in the formation of a resting spore of the oogamous type,  i. e. , a type of
              fertilization in which two heterogametangia come in  contact and fuse their contents through
              a pore or tube.  The thalli in this class  range from unicellular to profusely branched
              filamentous types.  Most forms are eucarpic; zoospores are produced throughout the class
              except in the more highly advanced species.  Certain species are of economic importance due
              to their destruction of food crops (potatoes and grapes) while others cause serious diseases of
              fish (e.g. Saprolegina parasitica).  Members of the  family Saprolegniaceae are the common

-------
                                                                                                        Fungi
         "water molds" and are among the most ubiquitous fungi in nature.   The order Lagenidiales
         includes only a few species which are parasitic on algae, small animals,  and other aquatic
         life.  The  somatic structures of this taxon are holocarpic and endobiotic.   The sewage fungi
         are classified in the order Leptomitales.  Fungi of this order are characterized by the
         formation  of refractile constrictions; ''cellulin plugs" occur throughout the thalli or,  at least,
         at the bases of hyphae or to cut off  reproductive  structures.  Leptomitus lacteus may
         produce rather extensive fouling floes or slimes in organically enriched waters.

6'        Flagella of unequal size, both whiplash	class. . . JPlasmodiophoromycetes

             Members of this class are obligate endoparasites of  vascular plants,  algae,  and  fungi.
         The thallus consists of a plasmodium which develops within the host cells.  Nuclear division
         at some stages of the life cycle is of a type found in no other  fungi but  known to occur in
         protozoa.  Zoosporangia which arise directly from the plasmodium bear zoospores with two
         unequal anterior falgella. The cell walls of these fungi apparently lack cellulose.

7(3')    Mainly 'saprobic,  sex cell when present a zy go spore	class. ...  Zveomycetes

             This class has well developed mycelium with septa developed in portions of the
         older hyphae; actively growing hyphae are normally non-septate.  The asexual spores are
         non-motile sporangiospores (aplanospores).  Such spores lack flagella and are usually
         aerialy disseminated.  Sexual reproduction is initiated by the fusion of two gametangia
         with resultant formation of a thick-walled,  resting  spore, the zygospore.   In the more
         advanced species,  the sporangia or the  sporangiospores are conidia-like.   Many of the
         Zygomycetes are of economic importance due to their ability to synthesize commercially
         valuable organic acids and alcohols, to  transform steroids  such as  cortisone, and to
         parasitize and destroy food crops.  A few species are capable of causing disease in man
         and animals (zygomycosis).

7'        Obligate commensals of arthropods, zygospores usually lacking	class. . . . Trichomycetes

             The Trichomycetes are an ill-studied group of fungi  which appear to be obligate
         commensals of arthropods.   The trichomycetes are associated with a wide variety of insecta,
         diplopods, and Crustacea of terrestrial  and aquatic (fresh and marine) habitats.   None of
         the members of this class have been cultured in  vitro for continued periods of times  with any
         success.   Asexual reproduction is by means of sporangiospores.  Zygospores have been
         observed in species of several orders.

8 (2')    Sexual spores borne in  asci	class	Ascomycetes

             In the Ascomycetes the products of meiosis, the ascospores,  are borne in sac
         like structures termed  asci.  The ascus usually contains eight ascospores,  but the number
         produced  may vary with the species or  strain.  Most species produce  extensive septate
         mycelium.  This large  class is divided into two  subclasses on the presence or absence
         of an ascocarp.  The Hemiascomycetidae lack an ascocarp and do not  produce ascogenous
         hyphae; this subclass includes the true  yeasts.   The Euascomycetidae usually are divided
         into three series (Plectomycetes,  Pyrenomycetes,  and Discomycetes) on the basis of
         ascocarp  structure.

8'       Sexual spores borne on  basidia	class	Basidiomycetes

             The Basidiomycetes generally are  considered  the  most highly evolved of the fungi.
         Karyogamy and meiosis occur in the basidium which bears sexual exogenous spores,
         basidiospores.  The mushrooms, toadstools, rusts, and smuts are included in this class.

8"       Sexual stage  lacking	'.	.Form class.(Fungi Imperfecti)..Deuteromycetes

             The Deuteromycetes is a form class for  those fungi  (with morphological affinities
         to the Ascomycetes or Basidiomycetes) which have  not demonstrated a sexual stage.
         The generally employed classification scheme for these fungi is based on  the morphology
         and color  of the asexual reproductive stages.  This scheme is briefly  outlined below.
         Newer  concepts of the classification based  on conidium development after the classical
         work of S. J. Hughes (1953) may eventually replace the gross morphology system (see
         Barron 1968).

-------
Fungi
       KEY TO THE FORM-ORDERS OF THE FUNGI IMPERFECTi

       1        Reproduction by means of conidia, oidia, or by budding	2
       1'       No reproductive structures present	Mycelia Sterilia

       2 (1)    Reproduction by means of conidia borne in pycnidia	Sphaeropsidales
       21       Conidia, when formed, not in cycnidia	3

       3 (21)   Conidia borne in acervuli	Melanconiales
       3'       Conidia borne otherwise, or reproduction by oidia or by budding	Moniliales

       KEY TO THE FORM-FAMILIES OF THE MONILIALES

       1        Reproduction mainly by unicellular budding, yeast-like; mycelial phase, if present,
               secondary,  arthrospores occasionally produced, manifest melanin pigmentation lacking	2
       1'       Thallus mainly filamentous; dark melanin pigments sometimes produced	3

       2 (1)    Ballistospores produced	Sporobolomycetaceae
       2'       No ballistospores	Cryptococcaceae

       3       Conidiophores, if present,  not united into sporodochia or synnemata	4
       3'       Sporodochia present	Tuberculariaceae
       3"      Synnemata present                                                             Stilbellaceae

       4 (3)    Conidia and Conidiophores or oidia hyaline  or brightly colored	Moniliaceae
       4'       Conidia and/or Conidiophores, containing dark melanin pigment	Dematiaceae

-------
                                                                                   Fungi
SELECTED'REFERENCES

Ahearn, D. G., Roth, F.J.  Jr., Meyers, S. P.
    Ecology and Charact erization of Yeasts
    from Aquatic Regions of South Florida.
    Marine Biology 1:291-308.   1968

Alexopoulos,  J. C.  Introductory Mycology.
    2nd ed.  John Wiley and Sons, New York,
    613 pp.  1962

Barren,  G. L. The Genera of Hyphomycetes
    from Soil.  Williams and Wilkins Co.,
    Baltimore.  364 pp.  1968

Cooke, W. B.  Population Effects on the
    Fungus Population of a Stream.
    Ecology 42:1-18.  1961

           .  A Laboratory Guide to Fungi in
    Polluted Waters, Sewage, and Sewage
    Treatment Systems.  U. S.  Dept. of
    Health, Education and Welfare, Cincinnati,
    132 pp.  1963

    	.  Fungi in Sludge Digesters.
    Purdue Univ. Proc. 20th Industrial
    Waste Conference, pp 6-17.  1965a

    	.  The Enumeration of Yeast
    Populations in a Sewage Treatment Plant.
    Mycologia 57:696-703.  1965b

    	.  Fungal Populations in Relation
    to Pollution of the Bear River,  Idaho-Utah.
    UtahAcad. Proc. 44(1):298-315.  1967

           and Matsuura, George S.  A Study
    of Yeast Populations in a Waste Stabilization
    Pond System.  Protoplasma 57:163-187.
    1963

	,  Phaff, H.J., Miller,  M.W.,
    Shifrine, M., and Khapp,  E.  Yeasts
    in Polluted Water and Sewage.
    Mycologia 52:210-230.  1960

Emerson, Ralph and Weston, W.H.
    Aqualinderella fermentans Gen. et Sp.
    Nov., A Phycomycete Adapted to
i      Stagnant waters.  I.  Morphology and
      Occurrence in Nature.  Amer. J.
      Botany 54:702-719.  1967

Hughes,  S.J.  Conidiophores, Conidia and
      Classification.  Can. J. Bot. 31:577-
      659.   1953

Johnson, T.W., Jr.  Saprobic Marine Fungi.
      pp. 95-104.  InAinsworth,  G. C. and
      Sussman, A.S.  The Fungi, III.
      Academic Press,  New York.  1968

	and Sparrow,  F.K., Jr.  Fungi
      in Oceans and Estuaries. Weinheim,
      Germany.  668 pp.  1961

Meyers, S. P,  Observations  on the Physio-
      logical Ecology of Marine Fungi. Bull..
      Misaki Mr. Biol.  Inst.  12:207-225.  1968

Prigsheim, E.G.  Iron Bacteria.  Biol. Revs.
      Cambridge  Phil. Soc.  24:200-245.  1949

Sparrow, F. K., Jr.  Aquatic Phycomycetes.
      2nd ed.  Univ. Mich. Press, AnnArbor.
      1187  pp.  1960.

	.  Ecology of Freshwater Fungi.
      pp. 41-93.  InAinsworth,  G.C. and
      Sussman, A.S.  The Fungi, III. Acad.
      Press, New York.   1968

Stokes, J. L.  Studies on the Filamentous
      Sheathed Iron Bacterium Sphaerotilus
      natans.  J.  Bacteriol. 67:278-291.   1954

van Uden,  N. and Fell,  J.W.  Marine Yeasts.
      pp. 167-201.  In Droop, M.R. and Wood,
      E. J.F.  Advances in Microbiology of
      the Sea, I.  Academic Press, New York.
      1968

Yerkes,  W. D.  Observations on an Occurrence
      of Leptomitus lacteus in Wisconsin.
      Mycologia 58:976-978.  1966

Cooke, William B.  and Ludzack,  F.J.
      Predacious Fungus Behavior in
      Activated Sludge Systems.  Jour. Water
      Poll. Cont. Fed. 30(12):1490-1495.  1958.
                                                                                     14-9

-------
                       PROTOZOA,  NEMATODES, AND ROTIFERS
I  GENERAL CONSIDERATIONS

A  Microbial quality constitutes only one
   aspect of water sanitation; microchemicals
   and radionuclides are attracting increasing
   amount of attention lately.

B  Microbes  considered here include bacteria,
   protozoa,  and microscopic metazoa; algae
   and fungi  excluded.

C  Of the  free-living forms,  some are
   members  of the flora and fauna of surface
   waters; others washed into the water from
   air and soil; still others of wastewater
   origin; nematodes most commonly from
   sewage effluent.

D  Hard to separate  "native" from ".foreign"
   free-living microbes, due to close
   association of water with soil and other
   environments; generally speaking, bacteria
   adapted to water are those that can grow
   on very low concentrations of nutrient
   and zoomicrobes adapted to water are
   those that feed on algae, and nematodes,
   especially bacteria eaters, are uncommon
   .in water but in large numbers in sewage
   effluent.

E  More species and lower densities of
   microbes  in clean water and fewer species
   and higher densities in polluted water.

F  Pollution-tolerance or nontolerance of
   microbes  closely related to the DO  level
   required in respiration.

G  From pollution viewpoint, the following
   groups of  microbes are of importance:
   Bacteria,  Protozoa, Nematoda,  and
   Rotifera.

II  BACTERIA

A  No ideal method for studying distribution
   and ecology of bacteria  in freshwater.

                       (9)
B  According to Collins,   Pseudomonas.
   Achrombacter, Alcaligenes,  Chromobac-
   terium, Flavobacterium, and Micro coccus
   are the most widely distributed and may be
    considered as indigenous to natural
    waters.  Sulfur and iron bacteria are
    more common  in the bottom mud.

 C Actinomycetes, Bacillus sp. Aerogenes
    sp., and nitrogen-fixation bacteria are
    primarily soil  dwellers and may be washed
    into the water by runoffs.

 E Nematodes are usually of aerobic sewage
    treatment origin.

 D E.  coli,  streptococci, and Cl. perfringens
    are true indicators of fecal pollution.

IE  PROTOZOA

 A Classification

    1  Single- cell animals in the most
       primitive phylum (Protozoa) in the
       animal kingdom.

    2  A separate kingdom,  Protista, to in-
       clude protozoa, algae, fungi,  and
       bacteria proposed in the 2nd edition
       of Ward-Whipple's Fr esh-Water
       Biology .(10)

    3  Four subphyla or classes:

       a  Mastigophora (flagellates)-Subclass
          phytomastigina dealt with under
          algae; only subclass Zoomastigina
          included here; 4 orders:

          1)  Rhizomastigina - with flagellum
             or flagella and pseudopodia

          2)  Protomonadina - with 1 to 2
                    ^mostly free-living many
            paras:
          3) Polymastigina - with 3 to 8
            flagella;1 mostly parasitic in
            elementary tract of animals
            and man

          4) Hypermastigina -  all inhabitants
            of alimentary tract of insects.
W. BA. 45c. 6. 76
                                 15-1

-------
Protozoa, Nematodes, and Rotifers
         Ciliophora or Infusoria (ciliates) -
         no pigmented members; 2 classes:

         1) Ciliata - cilia present during the
           whole trophic life; containing
           majority of the ciliates

         2) Suctoria - cilia present while
           young and tentacles during trophic
           life.
         Sarcodina (amoebae) - Pseudopodia
         (false feet)  for locomotion and food-
         capturing; 2 subclasses:

         1)  Rhizopoda - Pseudopodia without
            axial filaments; 5 orders:

            a)  Proteomyxa - with radiating
               pseudopodia; without test or
               shell

            b)  Mycetozoa - forming plasmodium;
               resembling fungi in sporangium
               formation

            c)  Amoebina - true amoeba -
               forming lobopodia

            d)  Testacea - amoeba with single
               test or shell of chitinous
               material

            e)  Foraminifera -  amoeba with 1
               or.more shells of calcareous
               nature; practically all marine
               forms
         Sporozoa - no organ of locomotion;
         amoeboid in asexual phase; all
         parasitic
B General Morphology

   1  Zoomastigina:

      Relatively small size (5 to 40 n); with
      the exception of Rhizomastigina,  the  '•
      body has a definite shape (oval,  leaf-
      like, pear-like, etc.); common members
      with 1 or 2 flagella and some with 3, 4,
      or more; few forming colonies;-cytostome
      present in many for feeding.
   2  Ciliophora:

      Most highly developed protozoa; with
      few exceptions,  a macro and a micro-
      nucleus; adoral zone of membranellae,
      mouth, and groove usually present in
      swimming and crawling forms, some
      with conspicuous ciliation of a disc-like
      anterior region and little or no body
      cilia (stalked and shelled forms);
      Suctoria nonmotile (attached) and with-
      out cytostome cysts formed in most.
   3  Sarcodina:

      Cytoplasmic membrane but no cell wall;
      endoplasm and ectoplasm distinct or in-
      distinct; nucleus with small or large
      nucleolus; some with test or shell;
      moving by protruding pseudopodia; few
      capable of flagella transformation; fresh-
      water actinopods usually sperical with
      many radiating axopodia; some Testacea
      containing symbiotic algae and mistaken
      for pigmented amoebae; cysts with single
      or double wall and 1 or 2 nuclei.
   4  Sporozoa: to be mentioned later..


C  General Physiology

   1  Zoomastigina:

      Free-living forms normally holozic;
      food supply mostly bacteria in growth
      film on surfaces or clumps relatively
      aerobic, therefore the first protozoa to
      disappear in anaerobic conditions and
      re-appearing at recovery; reproduction
      by simple fission or occasionally by
      budding.


   2  Ciliophora:

      Holozoic; true ciliates concentrating
      food particles by ciliary movement
      around the mouth part; suctoria sucking
      through tenacles; bacteria and small
  15-2

-------
                                                          Protozoa, Nematodes, and Rotifers
       algae and protozoa constitute main
       food under natural conditions; some
       shown in laboratory to thrive on dead
       organic matter and serum protein; not as
       aerobic as flagellates - some surviving
       under highly anaerobic conditions,  such
       as Metopus; reproduction by simple
       fission, conjugation or  encystment.
    3  Sarcodina:

       Holozoic; feeding through engulfing by
       pseudopodia; food essentially same as
       for ciliates;  DO requirement somewhat
       similar to ciliates - the small amoebae
       and Testacea frequently present in large
       numbers in sewage effluent and polluted
       water; reproduction by simple fission
       and encystation.
IV  NEMATODES

 A Classification

    1  All in the phylum Nemata (nonsegment-
       ed round worms); subdivided by some
       authors into two classes:
       Secernentea -
        (phasmids)
3 orders:
          Tylenchida,  Rhabditida, Strongylida,
          and Teratocephalida; with papillae on
          male tail, caudal glands absent.
       Adenophora - 6 orders:
        ( aphasmids)
          Araeolaim.ida, Dorylaimida,
          Chromdorida,  Monhysterida, Enoplida,
          and Trichosyringida no papillae-on
          malevcaudal glands absent.
       Orders encounteredin water and sewage
       treatment - Free-living forms inhabitat-
       ing sewage treatment plants are usually
       bacteria-feeders and those feeding on
       other nematodes; those inhabitating clean
       waters feeding on plant matters; they
       fall into the following orders:
Tylenchida - Stylet in mouth; mostly
plant parasites; some feed on
nematodes, such as Aphelenchoides.

Rhabditida - No stylet in mouth or caudal
glands in tail; mostly bacteria-feeders;
common genera:  Rhabiditis, Diplogaster.
Diplogasteroides. Monochoides,  Pelodera,
Panagrelhis,' and Turbatrix.

Dorylaimida - Relatively large nematodes;
stylet in mouth; feeding on other nematodes,
algae and probably zoomicrobes; Dorylaimus
common genus.

Chromadorida - Many marine forms;
some freshwater dwellers feeding on
algae;  characterized by strong orna-
mentation of knobs, bristles or
punctations in cuticle.

Monhysterida - Freshwater dwellers;
esophago-intestinal valve spherical to
elongated;  ovaries single or paired,
usually straight; common genus in
water - Monhystera.

Enoplida - Head usually with a number
of setae; Cobb reported one genus,
Mohonchulus, in sand filters in
Washington,  D.C.
                              B General Morphology

                                Round,  slender,  nonsegmented(transverse
                                markings in cuticle of some) worms;
                                some small (about | mm long, as Tri-
                                cephalobus), many 1 to 2 mm long
                                (Rhabditis. Diplogaster.  and Diplogasteriodes
                                for instance), and some  large (2 to 7 mm,
                                such as Dorylaimus); sex separated but few
                                parthenogenetic;  complete alimentary canal;
                                with elaborate mouth parts with or without
                                stylet; complete reproductive system in
                                each sex; no circulatory or respiratory
                                system;  complex nervous system with
                                conspicuous nerve ring across oesophagus.
                              C General Physiology

                                1  Feeding  - Most sewage treatment plant
                                   dwellers feeding on bacteria; others
                                   preying on protozoa, nematodes, rotifers,
                                                                                    15-3

-------
protozoa, Nematodes, and Rotifers
      etc.,  clean-water species apparently
      vegetarians; those with stylet in mouth
      use the latter to pierce the body of animal
      or plant and suck contents; metabolic
      waste mostly liquid containing ammonium
      carbonate or bicarbonate; enteric
      pathogens swallowed randomly with
      suspending fluid, hence remote possi-
      bility of sewage effluent-borne nematodes
      being pathogen-carriers.
      Oxygen requirement - DO apparently
      diffused through cuticle into body; DO
      requirement somewhat similar to
      protozoa;  Rhabditis tolerating reduced
      DO better than other Rhabditida members;
      all disappear under sepsis in liquid; some
      thrive in drying sludge.
      Reproduction - Normal life cycle requires
      mating, egg with embryo formation,
      hatching of eggs inside or outside femals,
      4 larval stages,  and adult; few repro-
      duce in the absence of males.
V ROTIFERS

A Classification:

   1  Classified either as a class of the phylum
      Aschelminthes (various forms of worms)
      or as a separate phylum (Rotifera); com-
      monly called wheel animalcules,  on
      account of apparent circular movement of
      cilia around head (corona); corona con-!
      tracted when crawling or swimming and
      expanded when attached to  catch food.

   2  Of the 3 classes, 2 (Seisonidea and
      Bdelloidea) grouped by some authors
      under Digononta (2 ovaries) and the
      other being Monogononta (1 ovatry);
      Seisonidea containing mostly marine
      forms.

   3  Class Digononta containing 1 order
      (Bdelloida) with  4 families, Philodinedae
      being the most important.
   4  Class Monogononta comprising 3  orders:
      Notommatida (mouth not near center of
      corona) with 14 families, Floscularida
      Melicertida( corona with two wreaths of
      cilia and furrow between them) with 3
      families; most import genera included
      in the order Notommatida:  Brachionus,
      Keratella,  Monostyla, Trichocerca.
      Asplanchna, Polyarthra. Synchaeta,
      Microcodon; common genera under the
      order Flosculariaceae: Floscularia,
      and Atrochus.  Common genera under
      order Melicertida:  Lammas and
      Conochilus.
   5  Unfortunately orders and families of
      rotifers partly based on character of
      corona and trophi(chewing organ),
      which are difficult to study, esp. the
      latter; the foot and cuticle much easier
      to study.

B  General Morphology and Physiology

   1  Body weakly differentiated into head,
      neck, trunk, and foot, separated by
      folds; in some, these regions are
      merely gradual changes in diameter
      of body and without a separate neck;
      segmentation external only.

   2  Head with corona, dosal antenna,  and
      ventral mouth; mastax,  a chewing organ,
      located in head and neck, connected to
      mouth anteriorly by a ciliated gullet  and
      posteriorly to a large stomach occupying
      much of the trunk.

   3  Common rotifers reproducing partheno-
      genetically by diploid eggs; eggs laid in
      water,  cemented to plants,  or carried
      on female until hatching.

   4  Foot, a prolongation of body, usually
      with 2 toes; some with one toe;  some
      with one toe and an extra toe-like
      structure (dorsal spur).

   5  Some, like Philodina, concentrating
     bacteria and other microbes and minute
     particulate organic matter by ciliary
     movement on corona  larger microbes
     chewed by mastax; some such as
     Monostyla feeding on clumped matter,
     such as bacterial growth, fungal masses,
     etc. at bottom; virus generally not
     ingested - apparently undetected by
     cilia.
   6  DO requirement somewhat similar to
      protozoa; some disappearing under
      reduced DO, others,  like Philodina,
      surviving at as little as  2 ppm DO.
   15-4

-------
                                                        Protozoa, Nematodes, and Rotifers
  VI SANITARY SIGNIFICANCE

  A  Pollution tolerant and pollution non-
     tolerant species - hard to differentiate -
     requiring specialist training in protozoa,
     nematodes, and rotifers.

  B  Significant quantitative difference in clean
     and polluted waters -  clean waters con-
     taining large variety of genera and species
     but quite low in densities.

  C  Aerobic sewage treatmen^ processes
     (trickling filters and activated sludge
     processes, even primary settling) ideal
     breeding grounds for those that feed on
     bacteria, fungi, and minute protozoa and
     present in very large numbers; effluents
     from such processes carrying large  num-
     bers of these zoomicrobes; natural waters
     receiving such effluents showing significant
     increase in all 3 categories.

  D  Possible Pathogen and Pathogen Carriers

     1  Naegleria causing swimming associated
        meningoencephalitis and Acanthameoba |
        causing nonswimming associated  cases.

     2  Amoebae and nematodes grown on
        pathogenic enteric bacteria in lab; none
        alive in amoebic cysts; very few alive
        in nematodes after 2 days after ingestion;
        virus demonstrated in nematodes  only
        when very high virus concentrations
        present; some freeliving amoebae
        parasitizing humans.

     3  Swimming ciliates and some rotifers
        (concentrating food by corona) ingesting
        large numbers of pathogenic enertic
        bacteria, but digestion rapid; no
        evidence of concentrating virus; crawling
        ciliates and flagellates feeding on clumped
        organisms.

     4  Nematodes concentrated from sewage
        effluent in Cincinnati area showing
        live_E_.  coli  and streptococci, but no
        human enertic pathogens.

VII  EXAMINATION OF WATER FOR MICROBES

  A  Bacteria - not dealt here.
   Protozoa and rotifers - should be included
   in examination for planktonic microbes.
C  Nematodes
                        (3)
D  Laboratory Apparatus

   1  Sample Bottles - One-gallon glass or
      plastic bottles with metal or plastic
      screw caps, thoroughly washed and
      rinsed three times with distilled water.

   2  Capillary Pipettes and Rubber Bulbs -
      Long (9 in.) Pasteur capillary pipettes
      and rubber bulbs of 2 ml capacity.

   3  Filtration Unit - Any filter holder
      assembly use/1 on bacteriological
      examination.  The  funnel should be
      at least 650 ml and the filter flask at
      least 2 liter capacity.

   4  Filter Membranes -  Millepore SS (SS  .
      047 MM) type membranes or equivalent.

   5  Microscope - Binocular microscope
      with 10X eyepiece, 4X, 10X,  and 43X
      objectives, and mechanical stage.

E  Collection of Water Samples

   Samples are collected in the same manner^
   as those for bacteriological examination,
   except that a dechlorinating agent is not
   needed.  One-half to one gallon samples are
   collected from raw water and one-gallon
   samples from tap water.  Refrigeration is
   not essential and samples may be transported
   without it unless examination is to be delayed
   for more than five days.

F  Concentration of Samples

   1  One gallon of tap water can usually be
      filtered through a single  8-u membrane
      within 15  minutes unless  the water has
      high turbidity.  At least one gallon of
      sample should be used  in a single examina-
      tion.  Immediately after the last of the
      water is disappearing from the membrane,
      the  suction line is disconnected and the
      membrane placed on the wall of a clean
      50 to 100  ml beaker and flushed repeatedly
      with about 2- 5 ml of  sterile distilled  water
                                                                                     15-5

-------
Protozoa. Nematodes, and Rotifers
       with the aid of a capillary pipette and a
       rubber bulb.  The concentrate is then
       pipetted into a clean Sedgewick-Rafter
       Counting Cell and is ready for examina-
       tion.

    2  In concentration of raw water samples
       having visible turbidity, two to four
       8-micron membranes may be required
       per sample,  with filtration through each
       membrane being limited to not more
       than 30 minutes.  Samples ranging from
       500 ml to 2 liters may be filtered with
       one membrane, depending on degree of
       turbidity.  After filtration the membranes
       are placed on the walls of separated
       beakers and washed as above. To
       prevent the particulates from obscuring
       the nematodes, the washing from each
       filter  is examined in a separate  counting
       chamber.

G Direct Microscopic Examination

   Each counting chamber containing the
   filter concentrate  is first examined  under
   a 4X objective.  Unless the concentrate
   contains more than 100 worms,  the  whole
   cell area  is surveyed for nematodes, with
   respect to number, developmental stage,
   and motility.  When an object having an
   outline resembling that of a nematode  is
   observed,  it is re-examined under a 10X
   objective  for anatomical structures, unless
   the object exhibits typical nematode  move-
   ment,  which is sufficient for identifying the
   object as  a nematode.  When the concentrate
   contains more than 100 worms,  the  worm
   density can be estimated by counting the
   number of worms  in representative  micro-
   scopic fields and multiplying the average
   number of worms  per field by the number
   of fields in the cell area. The nematode
   density may be expressed as number of
   worms per gallon with or without differenti-
   ation as to adult or larval stages or as to
   viability.                                    VIII
 H  General Identification of Nematodes

    1 While actively motile nematodes can be
      readily recognized by any person who
      has some1 general concept  of micro-
      scopic animals, the nonmotile or
   sluggishly motile nematodes may be
   confused with root fibers, plant fila-
   ments of various types, elongated
   ciliates such as  Homalozoon vermi-
   culare.  or segments of appendages of
   small Crustacea. To facilitate a
   general identification of nematodes, the
   gross morphology of three of the  free-
   living nematodes that are frequently
   found in water supplies is shown in the
   attached drawing.  The drawing provides
   not only the  general anatomy for recogni-
   tion  of nematodes but also most of the
   essential structures  for guidance  to those
   who want to  use  the "Key to Genera" in
   chapter No.  15 on Nemata by B. G.
   Chitwood and M. W. Allen in the book,
   Fresh Water Biology. 110>

2  Under normal conditions, practically
   all nematodes seen in samples of
   finished water are in various larval
   stages and will range from 100 to 500
   microns in length and 10 to 40 microns
   in width. Except in the fourth (last)
   stage,  the larvae have  no sexual organs
   but show other structural characteristics.

3  If identification of genera is desired,
   the filter washings are centrifuged at
   500  rpm for a few minutes.  The
   supernate is discarded, except a  few
   drops,  and the sediment is resuspended
   in the remaining water.  A drop of the
   final suspension is examined under both
   10X and 43X objectives for anatomical
   characteristics without staining,  and for
   supplementary study of structures the
   rest is fixed in 5% formalin or other
   fixation fluid and stained according to
   instructions  given in Chitwood and
   Allen's Chapter  on Nemata,^'
   Goodey's Soil and Freshwater Nema-
   tode s^11) or other books on nematology.
USE OF ZOOMIC ROBES AS
POLLUTION INDEX

Idea not new, protozoa suggested long ago;
many considered impractical because of
the need of identifying pollution-intolerant
and pollution-tolerant species - proto-
zoologist required. Method also time
consuming.
    15-6

-------
                                                         Protozoa,  Nematodes, and Rotifers
B Can use them on a quantitative basis -
   nematodes.  and nonpigmented
   protozoa present in small numbers in
   clean water.  Numbers greatly increased
   when polluted with effluent from aerobic
   treatment plant or recovering from sewage .
   pollution; no significant error introduced
   when clean-water members included in the
   enumeration if a suitable method of com-
   puting the pollution index developed.

 C Most practical method involves the
    equation:  A + B + 1000 C  = Z.P.I..
                    A
    where
    A = number of pigmented protozoa,
    B = non pigmented protozoa, and
    C = nematodes in a unit volume of sample,
    and Z.P.I. « zoological pollution index.
    For relatively clean water,  the value of
    Z.P.I, close to 1; the larger the value
    above 1, the greater the pollution by aerobic
    effluent (see attached  report on zoomicrobial
    indicator of water pollution).

DC  CONTROL

 A Chlorination of .effluent

 B Prolongation of detention time of effluent

 C Elimination of slow sand filters in
    nematode control.

  LIST OF COMMON ZOOLOGICAL ORGANISMS
  FOUND IN SEWAGE TREATMENT PROCESS -
  TRICKLING FILTERS
  PROTOZOA
     Sarcodina - Amoebae
        Amoeba proteus; A radiosa

        Hartmannella
        Arcella Vulgaris
        Noegleria gruberi

        Actinophrys	
FLAGELLATA

   Bodo caudatus

   Pleuromonas jaculans

   Oikomonas termo

   Cercomonas longicauda

   Peranema trichophorum


   Swimming type

      Ciliophora:
         Colpidium colpoda

         Colpoda cuculus

         Glaucoma pyriformis
         Paramecium candatum; P bursaria

   Stalked type

      Opercularia sp. (short stalk dichotomous)

      Vorticella sp.  (stalk single and contractile)

      Epistylis plicatilis (like opercularia,  more
                colonial,  stalk not contractile)

      Carchesium sp.  (like vorticella but colonial,
                individual zooids contractile)

      Zoothamnium sp. (entire colony contracts)

   Crawling type

      Euplotes patella

      Stylonychia  mylitus

      Urostyla sp.

      Oxytricha sp.

 NEMATODA

      Diplogaster sp.       Dorylamus sp.

      Monochoides sp.      Chlindrocorpus ap.

      piplogasteroides sp.  Cephalobus sp.

      Rhabditis sp.          Rhabditolaimus sp.

      Pelodera sp.          Monhystera  sp.

      Aphelenchpides sp.    Trilobus sp.
                                                                                     15-7

-------
Protozoa. Nematodes. and Rotifers
ROTATORIA

   Diglena

   Monostyla

   Polyarthra

   Philodina

   Keratella

   Brachionus

OLIGOCHAETA (bristle worms)

   Aelosoma hemprichl

   Aulophorus limosa

   Tubifex tubifex

   Lumbricillus lineatus

INSECT LARVAE

   Chironomus

   Psychoda sp.  (trickling filter fly)

ARTHROPODA

   Lessertia sp.

   Porrhomma sp.

   Achoratus subuiaticus (collembola)

   Folaomla sp.  (collembqla)

   Tomocerus sp. (collembola)

REFERENCES

1  American Public Health Association,
      American Water Works Association and
      Water Pollution Control Federation.
      Standard Methods for the Examination
      of Water and Wastewater. 13th ed.
      New York.  1971.

2  Chang, S. L.,  et al. Survey of Free-
      Living Nematodes and Amoebas In
      Municipal Supplies. J.A.W.W.A. 52:
      613-618.
3  Chang, S.  L. Interactions between Animal
     Viruses and Higher Forms of Microbes.
     Proc. Am. Soc. Civ. Eng. Jl. San. Eng.
     96:151.  1970

 4  Chang, S. L.  Zoomicrobial Indicators
      of Water Pollution presented at the
      Annual Meeting of Am. Soc. Microbial,
      Philadelphia, April 23-28,  1972.

 5  Chang, S. L.  Pathogenic Free-Living
      Amoebae and Recreational Waters.
      Presented at 6th International Confer-
      ence of Water Pollution Research
      Association,  Jerusalem,  Israel,
       June 19-24,  1972.

 6  Chang, S. L.  Proposed Method for
      Examination of Water for Free-Living
      Nematodes.   J.A.W.W.A.  52:695-698.
      1960.

 7  Chang, S. L., et al.  Survival and Protection
      Against Chlorination of Human Enteric
      Pathogens in Free- Living Nematodes
      Isolated from Water Supplies.  Am. Jour.
      Trop.  Med.  and Hyg.  9:136-142.  1980.

 8  Chang, S. L. Growth of Small Free- Living
      Amoebae in Bacterial and Bacteria-Free
      Cultures. Can. J. Microbial.
      6:397-405.   1960.

 9  Chang, S. L. and Kabler, P. W.  Free-Living
      Nematodes in Aerobic Treatment Plant
      Effluents. J.W.P.C.F.  34:1256-2161.
      1963.

10  Chitwood, B. G. and Chitwood, M. B.  An
      Introduction to Nematology.  Section I:
      Anatomy. 1st ed. Monumental Printing
      Co. Baltimore.  1950. pp 8-9.

11  Cobb, N.A. Contributions to the Science 01
      Nematology VII.  Williams and Wilkins Co.
      Baltimore.  1918.

12  Collins, V.G.  The Distribution and Ecology
      of Bacteria in Freshwater,  Pts. I & II,
      Proc.  Soc. for Water Treatment and Exam.
      12:40-73. 1963.  (England)

13  Edmondson, W. T., et al. Ward-Whipple's
      Fresh  Water Biology.  2nd ed.  John
      Wiley & Sons, New York.  1959. pp 368-401.
  15-8

-------
                                                 Protozoa, Nematodes, and Rotifers
14 Goodey,  T.  Soil and Freshwater              This outline was prepared by S. L. Chang,
      Nematodes.  (A Monograph) 1st ed.          Chief, Etiology, Criteria Development
      Methuen and Co.  Ltd.  London.  1951.       Branch,  Water Supply Research Laboratory,
                                                NERC, USEPA, Cincinnati, Ohio 45268.

                                                Descriptors:  Protozoa,  Nematodes, Rotifers
                                                                            15-9

-------
Protozoa, Nematodes, and Rotifers
                              Insects
                          Oligochaetes &'
                          insect larvae
                           Nematodes
                           & rotifers

                         t  t     '   f
                        Nonpigmented
                         protozoa
                          I   I  i  fff
                      Hete rotrophic
                        bacteria
                           Fuiigi
                           Algae
                      Autotrophic bacteria.
                    Pathogenic organisms"
Suspended organic matter

         (by hydrolysis)
^Dissolved organic matter
   (respiration,
   deamination,
   decarboxylation,  etc.)
    Inorganic C,  P, N,
              S comp.

(NH3. NO". C0=. P)

  (Nitrification, sulfur
   & iron bacteria)
                                                                            •' Raw Sewage
                   Food Chain in Aerobic Sewage Treatment Processes
 15-10

-------
                                 ACTIVATED  SLUDGE

                                        PROTOZOA
Larger animals (worms,  snails, fly larvae,
etc.) dominate trickling filters.  Why are
these always absent from the activated
sludge process?
Why are there numerous micro-species
common to both trickling filters and
activated sludge?
What organisms besides protozoans and
animals are present in activated sludge?
What is the advantage(s) of microscopic
examination of activated sludge?
One sampling site would be the one of choice
in sampling an activated sludge plant for
microscopic analysis.  Why? Where?
What organisms predominate in activated
sludge?
Why are photosynthetic green plants (in
contrast to animals) basically absent from
the activated sludge process in general and
mixed liquor specifically?
Why are the same identical species of protozoa  8
found in activated sludge plants all over the
world?
What is the significance of a microscopic
examination of mixed liquor?
Define and characterize:                       10
    Activated Sludge
    Mixed Liquor
    Floes
What is the relation between bacterial/         11
protozoan populations in activated sludge
and the process itself?
At what total magnification were you able to    12
believe the smallest cells observed were in
fact bacteria?
 Activated sludge is a dynamic (although        13
 man-manipulated) ecosystem.  How does
 it differ from a natural ecosystem?
 BLIND. 14a. 6.76                                                                         16_j

-------
Activated Sludge Protozoa
What is the greatest problem(s) with a wet     14
mount slide preparation?
How do you overcome these disadvantages?     15
How do you slow down fast moving protozoans  16
on a wet mount?
Why are quantitative counts of protozoa (like   17
number/ml) generally meaningless?
What is the significance of proportional        18
counts?
Scanning a slide (in making a count) should     19
generally be done at	X.  (Total
magnification)
The iris diaphragm on the microscope is
used to adjust light intensity (true -false).
Why sample the surface film of the
settleometer?
Why is the thinnest film most ideal for a
wet mount?
What did you learn from the microscopic
examination of the activated sludge?
What is the physical nature of the floes
observed?
What filamentous organisms were
observed?
Why are "rare" species of no practical
significance in microscopic analyses of
activated sludge?
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
Why are there no protozoan indicator species   27
of process efficiency in activated sludge?
Activated sludge biological communities        28
are temporal in contrast to biological
communities in trickling filters which
are spatial (TRUE/FALSE).
"Seeding" a newly started activated sludge      29
plant with cultures or material from other
plants is only a wasted  effort (TRUE/FALSE).
Justify your answer.
16-2

-------
                                                               Activated Sludge Protozoa
If a wet mount slide of mixed liquor is
prepared and placed in a petri dish with a
wet blotter underneath and allowed to sit
for several hours,  what will be the distri-
bution of the protozoa under the cover slip?
30
In a mixed liquor sample nearly all of the
stalked ciliates have "broken off" the stalks
and are free swimming as "telotrochs. "
What does this indicate?
31
What are Monads?  And are they good, bad,    32
or indifferent in activated sludge?
What are hypotrichs or crawling ciliates,
and are they good, bad or indifferent in
activated sludge?
33
What are swimming ciliates,  and are they      34
good, bad or indifferent in activated sludge?
What are flagellates, and are they good,  bad   35
or indifferent in activated sludge?
What are amoebae, and are they good, bad,    36
or indifferent in activated sludge?
What are the ideal characteristics of a wet
mount slide preparation?
37
Why does total community give a better        38
indication of process efficiency in activated
sludge?
In observing and identifying protozoa one looks 39
for what characteristics of an individual
organism?
What is the role of bacteria in activated
sludge?
40
What is the role of protozoa in activated
sludge?
                                             41
Microscopic analysis of the mixed liquor
sample can be very quick, simple, and
meaningful (TRUE/FALSE).
42

-------
Activated Sludge Protozoa
Protozoan communities present in activated    43
sludge reveal:

   a.  Plant efficiency
   b.  Settleability
   c.  BOD removal
   d.  Solids removal
   e.  Plant loading

(Circle applicable descriptions)
Protozoan communities in activated sludge    44
reveal complete and instantaneous conditions;
average of physical and chemical conditions;
extremes of chemical and physical conditions.
(Draw a line through phrases not true.)
Rank in increasing plant efficiency the         45
following protozoan group which would pre-
dominate.
   	Rotifers
        Stalked ciliates
        Amoebae
        Swimming ciliates
       "Crawling ciliates
       "Flagellates
(For example,  use number  1-6.  One would be
startup conditions or least efficient, and six
would be the most efficient.)
Identification is usually done at	X and   46
sometimes requires	X.
Immersion oil should be used sparingly at     47
what two points on a slide?
Which comes first in microscopic examina-   48
tion; scanning at low power to pick out
unknowns or higher  power to identify?
In making proportional count, which total      49
number to count would be better; total of ten
organisms or a total of 100 organisms?  Why?
Why not kill the organisms so you can         50
identify and count them on the slide?
What simple chemical solutions are useful     51
to immobilize protozoa if methyl cellulose
or poly vinyl alcohol is not available?
1.6-4

-------
                                                              Activated Sludge Protozoa
Initially the wet mount slide should be
racked up close to the low power objectives
by your eye on the eyepiece through the
scope; or by glancing at the actual distance
with the naked eye while you rotate the
coarse adjustment knob. (Underline which)
                                            52
What are par-focal objectives on the
microscope?
                                            53
Why should water on the microscope and all  54
its parts be carefully avoided?
If activated sludge is a man manipulated
system,  are there comparable natural
ecosystems?  Example?
                                            55
What is the " community" concept in exami-  56
nation  of activated sludge?
What are the applications of direct micro-    57
scopist examination of activated sludge?
What are rotifers,  and are they good, bad    58
or indifferent in activated sludge?
List the five kingdoms of organisms and give 59
a specific example for each.
What techniques are most  useful in          60
identifying an unknown organism,  and why
is correct identification important?
                                      X
Scanning and counting is done at	
magnification.  Identification of most
PROTOZOA usually requires	X
magnification and occassionally	
magnification.
61
                                      X
OBJ.
        TOTAL MAG.    USE
                                            62
100 X
(10 X eyepieces)
                                                                                      16-5

-------
                                                    Activated Sludge Protozoa
            hand is constantly operating the   63
            hand is constantly operating the
The microscope is manually operated and
requires skill and understanding on the part
of the operator.  A microscope no matter
how costly is only as good as the micro-
scopist operating it.
List the basic skills required in utilizing the  64
optimum capability of your microscope.
 This outline was prepared by R. M. Sinclair,
 National Training Center, MOTD, OWPO,
 USEPA, Cincinnati, Ohio 45268.
 Descriptors:  Microorganisms, Protozoa,
 Rotifers, Activated Sludge, Biota
                                                                              16-6

-------
                     FREE-LIVING AMOEBAE AND NEMATODES
I  FREE-LIVING AMOEBAE

   A  Importance of Recognizing Small. .
      Free- Living Amoebae in Water
      Supplies

      1  Commonly found in soil, aerobic
        sewage effluent and natural, fresh
        waters - hence, frequently en-
        countered in examination of raw
        water.

      2  Cysts not infrequently found in
        municipal supplies -  not pathogen
        carriers.

      3  Flagellate-amoebae Naegleria
        involved in 50 some cases of
        meningoencephalitis,  about half
        in the U. S.;  associated with
        swimming in small warm, lakes.
        Acanthamoeba rhv_so_des parasitizing
        hyman throats and causing (3 cases)
        nonswimming-associated meningo-
        encephalitis .

      4  Cysts not to  be  confused with those
        of Endamoeba histolytica in water-
        borne epidemics.

   B  Classification of Small,  Free- Living
      Amoebae

      1  Recognized classification based
        on characteristics in mitosis.

      2  Common species fall into the
        following families and genera:

        Family Schizopyrenidae: Genera
        Naegleria, Didascalus, and
        Schizopyrenus - first two being
        flagellate amoebae.

        Family Hartmannellidae:  Genera
        Hartmanella (Acanthamoeba)

      3  How to prepare materials  for
        studying mitosis - Feulgen stain
    C Morphological Characteristics of
      Small,  Free-Living Amoebae

      1  Morphology of Trophozoites -
         Ectoplasm and endoplasm usually
         distinct; nucleus with large nucleolus.

      2  Morphology of cysts -  Single or
         double wall with or without pores

    D Cultural Characteristics of Small,
      Free-Living Amoebae

      1  How to cultivate these  amoebae -
         plates with bacteria; cell cultures,
         axenic culture.

      2  Growth characteristics on plate,
         cell, and axenic culture

      3  Complex growth requirements
         for most of these amoebae

    E Resistance of Amoabic Cysts to
      Physical and Chemical Agents
II   FREE-LIVING NEMATODES

    A  Classification of Those Commonly
       Found in Water Supplies

       1  Phasmidia (Secerneutes):
         Genera Rhabditis, Diplogaster,
         Diplogasteroides, Cheilobus,
         Panagrolaimus

       2  Aphasmidia (Adenophoro): Genera
         Monhystera, Aphelenchus, Turbatrix
         (vinegar eel), Dorylaimus, and
         Rhab dolaimus

    B  Morphological Features

       1  Phasmids: papilla on tail of males,
         mouth adapted to feed on bacteria,
         few exceptions.

       2  Aphasmids:  no papilla on male tail;
         glandular cells in male.
 BI.AQ. 14b. 6.76
                                                                                  17-1

-------
Amoebae and Nematodes in Water Supplies
   C Life Cycle

     1  Methods of mating

     2  Stages of development

     3  Parthenogenesis

   D Cultivation

     1  Bacteria-fed cultures

     2  Axenic cultures

   E Occurrence in Water Supplies

     1  Relationship between their
        appearance in finished water
        and that in raw water.

     2  Frequency of occurrence in
        different types of raw water
        and sources.

     3  Survival of human enteric path-
        ogenic bacteria and viruses in
        nematodes.

     4  Protection of human enteric
        pathogenic bacteria and viruses
        in nematode-carriers.

   F Control

     1  Chlorination of sewage effluent

     2  Flocculation and sedimentation
        of water

     3  Chlorination of water

     4  Other methods of destruction
REFERENCES

Amoebae

1  Singh, B. N., "Nuclear Division in Nine
      Species of Small, Free-Living Amoe-
      bae and its Bearing on the Classifica-
      tion of the Order Amoebida", Philos.
      Trans. Royal Soc. London,  Series B,
      236:405-461,  1952.
2  Chang, S. L., et al.  "Survey of Free-
      Living Nematodes and Amoebas in
      Municipal Supplies".   J. A. W . W. A.
      52^:613-618, 1960.

3  Chang, S. L., "Growth of Small Free-
      Living Amoebae in Various Bacterial
      and in Bacteria-Free Cultures". Can.
      Jour.  Microbiol.  j>:397-405,  1960.

Nematodes

1  Goodey, T., "Freshwater Nematodes",
      1st. Edition, Methuen&Co.,  London,
      1951.

2  Edmondson, W.T.,  Ed., Ward & Whipple's
      "Fresh-Water Biology" 10th Edition,
      page 397, 1955.

3  Chang, S. L., et al.,  "Occurrence of a
      Nematode Worm in a  City Water Supply".
      J.A.W.W.A., _51:671-676, 1959.

4  Chang, S. L., et al.,  "Survival, and
      Protection Against Chlorination, of
      Human Enteric Pathogens in Free-
      Living Nematodes Isolated From Water
      Supplies". Am. Jour. Trop. Medicine
      & Hygiene, Q: 136-142, 1960.

5  Chang, S.L., et al.,  "Survey of Free-
   Living Nematodes and Amoebas in
   Municipal Supplies".   J.A.W.W.A.,
   52^:613-618,  1960.

6  Chang, S. L., "Proposed Method for
      Examination of Water for Free- Living
      Nematodes".  J.A.W.W.A., 52:695-698,
      1960.

7  Chang, S. L., "Viruses, Amoebas,
      and Nematodes and Public Water
      Supplies". J.A.W.W.A.,  53:288-296,
      1961.

8  Chang, S. L., and Kabler, P.W.,  "Free-
      Living Nematodes in Sewage Effluent
      from  Aerobic Treatment Plants".  To
      be published.
This outline was prepared by Shih L. Chang,
M. D., Chief, Etiology,  Criteria Development
Branch, Water Supply Research Laboratory,
NERC, EPA, Cincinnati. OH 45268.

Descriptors: Amoebae, Nematodes
 17-2

-------
                  SUGGESTED CLASSIFICATION OF SMALL AMOEBAE


Subphylum:     Sarcodina Hertwig and Lesser

   Class:       Rhizopoda von Siebold

      Subclass:    Amoebaea Butschli

        Order:    Amoebida Calkins and Ehrenberg

           Superfamily:   Amoebaceae - free-living
                          (Endamoebaceae - parasitic in animals)

               Family:  Schizopyrenldae •  - active limax form common; transcient
                            flagellates present or absent; nucleonus-origin of
                            polar masses;  polar caps and interzonal bodies present
                            or absent

                  Genus:    Schizopyrenus - no transcient flagellates; single-walled
                             cysts; no polar caps or interzonal bodies in mitosis

                     Species:    S_.  erythaenusa -  reddish orange pigment formed in agar
                                cultures with gram-negative bacillary bacteria

                                _S.  russelli - no pigment produced in agar cultures

                  Genus:    Didascalus - morphology and cytology similar to Schizopyrenus
                               but small numbers of transcient flagellates formed at times

                     Species:    D. thorntoni - only species described by Singh (1952)

                  Genus:    Naegleria Alexeieff -  double-walled cysts; transcient
                             flagellates formed readily; polar caps  and interzonal
                             bodies present in mitosis

                     Species:    N. gruberi (Schardinger) - only species established;
                                ~  Singh (1952) disclaimed the N. jol^he described in 1951

               Family:  Hartmannellidae - no transcient flagellate formed; motility
                            sluggish; no limax form; nucleolus disappearing, probably
                            forming spindle in mitosis; no polar caps or masses, aster
                            and cehtrosome not known

                  Genus:    Hartmannella - ectoplasm clear or less granular than
                               endoplasm;  single-walled cysts; single vacuole

                     Species:    H. glebae  - clear ectoplasm
                                **• g-gricoja - ectoplasm less granular than endoplasm

                  Genus:    Acanthamoeba  - filamentous processes from ecto- or
                               endoplasm;  growing axenically in fluid bacteriological
                               media
                                                                               17-3

-------
Suggested Classification of Small Amoebae
                     Species:    A. rhyspctes,

                  Genus:    Sinehella - double-walled cysts; ecto- and endoplasm
                             indistinguishable; many vacuoles

                     Species:    Singhella leptocnemus
 17-4

-------
                                   ANIMAL PLANKTON
I  INTRODUCTION

A Planktonic animals or zooplankton are
   found in nearly every major group of
   animals.

   1  Truly planktonic species (euplankton)
      spend all or most of their active life
      cycle suspended in  the water.  Three
      groups are predominantly involved in
      fresh water;  the protozoa, rotifers,
      and microcrustacea.

   2  Transient planktonic phases  such as
      floating eggs and cysts,  and  larval
      stages occur in many other groups.

B Many forms are strictly seasonal in
   occurrence.

C Certain rare forms occur in great numbers
   at unpredictable intervals.

D Techniques of collection, preservation,
   and identification  strongly influence the
   species reported.

E In oceanographic work, the zooplankton is
   considered  to include many relatively large
   animals such as siphonophores, ctenophores,
   hepteropods, pteropods, arrowworms, and
   euphausid shrimp.

F The plant-like or  phytoplankton on the
   other hand are essentially similar in all
   waters, and are the nutritional  foundation
   for the animal community.
II   PHYLUM PROTOZOA

 A  The three typically free living classes,
    Mastigophora, Rhizopoda, and Ciliophora,
    all have planktonic representatives.  As
    a group however, the majority of the phylum
    is benthic or bottom-loving.  Nearly any
    of the benthic forms  may occasionally be
    washed up into the overlying waters and
    thus be collected along with the euplankton.

 B  Class mastigophora, the nonpigmented
    zooflagellates.

    These have frequently been confused with
    the phytomastigina or plant-like flagellates.
    The distinction is made here  on the basis
    of the presence or absence of chlorophyll
    as  suggested by Palmer and Ingram 1955.
 BI.AQ.20c. 6. 76
   (Note Figure:  Nonpigmented,  Non-Oxygen
   Producing Protozoan Flagellates in the
   outline Oxygen Relationships.)

   1  Commonly encountered genera

      Bodo

      Peranema

   2  Frequently associated with eutrophic
      conditions

C  Class Rhizopoda - amoeboid protozoans

   1  Forms commonly encountered as
      plankton:

                    (Amoeba)
                    Centropyxis

                    Heliozoa
Difflugia

Euglypha
   2  Cysts of some types may be encountered
      in water plants or distribution systems;
      rarely in plankton of open lakes or
      reservoirs.

D  Class Ciliophora

   1  Certain "attached" forms  often found
      floating freely with  plankton:

      Vorticella

      Carchesium
   2  Naked, unattached ciliates.  Halteria
      one of commonest in this group.  Various
      heavily ciliated forms (holotrichs) may
      occur from time to  time such as
      Colpidium, Enchelys, etc.

   3  Ciliates protected by a shell or test
      (testaceous) are most often  recorded
      from preserved samples.  Particularly
      common in the experience of the National
      Water Quality Sampling Network are:

      Codonella fluviatile

      Codonella cratera.

      Tintinnidium (usually with organic matter)

      Tintinnopsis

                                    18-1

-------
     Animal Plankton
IH  PHYLUM ROTIFERA

 A Some forms such as Anuraea  cochlearis
    and A splanchna pridonta tend to be present
    at all times of the year.
 B
    Notholca striata. N.
                        Others such as
                    longispina and Poly-
artnra platyptera are reported to be essen-
tially winter rorms.

Species in approximate order of descending
frequency currently recorded by National
Water Quality Sampling Network are:

Keratella cochlearis

Polyarthra vulgaris

Synchaeta pectinata

Brachionus quadridentata

Trichocerca longiseta

Rotaria sp.

Filinia longiseta

Kellicottia longispina

Pompholyx sp.
 C Benthic species almost without number may
    be collected with the plankton from time to
    time.
IV  PHYLUM ARTHROPODA

 A  Class Crustacea

    1  The Class Crustacea includes the larger
       common freshwater euplankton.  They
       are also the greatest planktonic consum-
       ers of basic nutrients in the form of
       phytoplankton, and are themselves the
       greatest planktonic contribution to the
       food of fishes.  Most of them are herb-
       ivorous. Two groups, the cladocera
       and the copepods are most conspicuous.

    2  Cladocera (Subclass Branchiopoda,
       Order Cladocera) or Water Fleas

       a  Life History

          1)  During most of the year, eggs
             which will develop without fertil-
             ization (parthenogenetic) are
             deposited by the female in a dorsal
             brood chamber.  Here they hatch
             into minature adults which escape
             and swim away.
   2) As unfavorable conditions develop,
      males appear, and thick-walled
      sexual eggs are enclosed in egg
      cases called ephippia which can
      often endure freezing and  drying.

   3) Sexual reproduction may occur
      at different seasons in different
      species.

   4) Individuals of a great range of
      sizes, and even ephippia,  are
      thus encountered in the plankton,
      but there is no "larval" form.

b  Seasonal variation - Considerable
   variation may occur between winter
   and summer forms of the same
   species in some cases.   Similar
   variation also occurs between arctic
   and tropical situations.

c  Forms commonly encountered as
   open water plankton include:

   Bosmina longirostris and others

   Daphnia galeata and others

   Other less common genera are:

   Diaphanosoma, Chydorus, Sida.
   Acroperus, Cerlodaphnia, Bytho-
   trephes,  and the carnivorous
   Leptodora and Polyphemus.

d  Heavy blooms, of Cladocerans may
   build up in eutrophic waters.

The  copepods (order Copepoda) are the
perennial microcrustacea of open waters,
both fresh and marine.  They are the
most ubiquitous  of animal plankton.

a  Cyclops is the genus most often
   found by the National Water Quality
   Sampling Network activities.   Eucy-
   clops, Paracyclops, Diaptomus,
   CanthQcamptus, E"pischura^~and
   Liimnocalanus are other forms
   reported to be planktonic.

b  Copepods hatch into a minute char-
   acteristic larvae called a nauplius
   which differs considerably from the
   adults.  After five or six moults, the
   copepodid stage is reached, and after
   six more moults,  the adult.   These
   larval stages are  often encountered
   and are difficult to identify.
    18-2

-------
                                                                        Animal Plankton
B  Class Insecta

   1  Only a few kinds of insect that can be
      ranked as a truly planktonic.  Mainly
      the phantom midge fly Chaborus.

   2  The larva of this insect has hydrostatic
      organs that enable it to  remain suspended
      in  the water,  or make vertical ascents in
      the water column.

   3  It is usually benthic during the daytime,
      but ascends to the surface at night.


V  OCCASIONAL PLANKTERS

A  While the protozoa, rotifers,  and micro-
   crustacea make up the bulk of the plankton,
   there are many other groups as mentioned
   above that may also occur.  Locally or
   periodically these may be of major import-
   ance. Examples  are given below.

B  Phylum Coelenterata

   1  Polyps of the genus Hydra may become
      detached and float about hanging from
      the surface film or floating detritus.

   2  The freshwater medusa Craspedacusta
      occasionally appears  in lakes or reser-
      voirs in great numbers.

C  Phylum Platyhelminthes

   1  Minute Turbellaria (relatives of the
      well known Planaria)  are sometimes
      taken with the plankton in eutrophic
      conditions.   They are often confused
      with ciliate protozoa.

   2  Cercaria larvae of Trematodes  (flukes)
    •  parasitic on certain wild animals,
      frequently appear in great numbers.
      When trapped in the droplets of water
      on a swimmer's skin, they attempt to
      bore in.  Man not being their natural
      host,  they fail. The  resultant irritation
      is  called "swimmer's itch".  Some can
      be identified, but many  unidentifiable
      species may be found.

   3  In many areas of the  world, cercaria
      larvae of human parasites such  as the
      blood fluke Schistosoma japonic um may
      live as plankton, and penetrate the"human
      skin directly on contact.
D  Phylum Nemathelminthes

   1  Nematodes (or nemas) or roundworms
      approach the bacteria and the blue-green
      algae in ubiquity.  They are found in
      the soil and in the water,  and in the air
      as dust.  In both marine  and  fresh waters
      and from the Arctic to the tropics.

   2  Although the majority are free  living,
      some occur as parasites of plants,
      animals, and man, and some of these
      parasites are among our most  serious.

   3  With this distribution, it is obvious that
      they will occasionally be encountered as
      plankton.  A more complete  discussion
      of nematodes and their public health
      implications in water supplies  will be
      found elsewhere (Chang,  S.  L.).

E  Additional crustacean groups sporadically
   met with in the plankton include the following:

   1  Order Anostraca or fairy shrimps
      (formerly included with the two
      following orders in the Euphyllopoda)
      primarily planktonic in nature.

      a Extremely local and sporadic, but
        when present, may be dominating.

      b Artemia, the brine shrimp,  can
        tolerate very high  salinities.

      c Very widely distributed,  poorly
        understood.

   2  Order  Notostraca, the tadpole  shrimps.
      Essentially southern and western in
      distribution.

   3  Order  Conchostraca,  the clam  shrimps.
      Widely distributed, sporadic in occur-
      rence.  Many local species.

   4  Subclass Ostracoda,  the seed shrimps.
      Up to 3 in.  in length.   Essentially
      benthic but certain species of Cypris,
      and Notodromas may  occur in consid-
      erable numbers as plankton at  certain
      times of the year.

   5  Certain members of the large subclass
      Malacostraca are limnetic,  and thus,
      planktonic to some extent.

      a The scuds, (order Amphipoda) are
         essentially benthic but are sometimes
         collected in plankton samples around
                                                                                      18-3

-------
 Animal Plankton
         weed beds or near shore.  Nekto-
         planktonic forms include Pontoporeia
         and some species of Gammarus.

      b  The mysid, or opossum shrimps are
         represented among the plankton by
         Mysis relicta,  which occurs in the
         deeper waters,  large lakes as far
         north as the Arctic Ocean.

F The Class Archnoidea, Order Hydracarina
   (or Acari) the  mites.  Frequent in plankton
   tows near shore although Unionicola crass-
   ipes has been reported to be virtually
   planktonic.

G The phylum Mollusca is but scantily
   represented in the freshwater plankton,
   in contrast to the marine situation.
   Glochidia (ciliated) larvae are occasion-
   ally collected, and snails now and then
   glide  out on a quiet surface film and are
   taken in a plankton net.  An exotic
   bivalve Corbicula has a planktonic
   veliger stage.

H Eggs and other reproductive structures
   of many forms including fish, insects, and
   rotifers may be found in plankton samples.
   Special reproductive structures such as
   the statoblasts of bryozoa and sponges,
   and the ephippia of cladocerans may also
   be included.

I   Adventitious and Accidental Plankters

   Many shallow water benthic organisms
   may become accidentally and temporarily
   incorporated into the plankton.  Many of
   those  in the preceding section might be
   listed here,  in addition to such forms as
   certain free living nematodes, small
   oligochaetes, and tardigrades, Collembola
   and other surface film livers are also
   taken  at times  but should not be mistaken
   for plankton. Fragments and molt skins
   from a variety of arthropods are usually
   observed.

   Pollen from terrestrial or aquatic plants
   is often unrecognized, or confused with
   one of the above.  Leaf hairs from
   terrestrial plants are also confusing to
   the uninitiated,  they are sometimes  .
   mistaken for fungi or other organisms
   (and vice versa).

   In flowing waters,  normally benthic
   (bottom living) organisms are often found
   drifting freely in the stream.  This
   phenomenon may be constant or periodic.
   When included in plankton collections,
   they must be reported, but recognized
   for what they are.
    Surface films are especially rich in
    micro "biological garbage" and these
    enrich the plankton.

REFERENCES

1  Edmondson, W.F., ed.  Ward and
      Whipples's Freshwater Biology,  2nd
      Edition, Wiley & Sons, Inc.,  New York.
      1959.

2  Hutchinson, G. Evelyn.   A Treatise on
      Limnology.   Vol.  2.   Introduction to
      Lake Biology and the Limnoplankton.
      Wiley.   1115 pp.  1967.

3  Lackey, J. B.   Quality and Quantity of
      Plankton in the South End of Lake
      Michigan in 1952.   JAWWA.
      36:669-74.   1944.

4  McGauhey, P.H., Eich,  H.F.,  Jackson,
      H.W.,  and Henderson, C.  A Study
      of the Stream Pollution Problem in the
:      Roanoke, Virginia, Metropolitan
      District.  Virginia Polytech.  Inst.,
      Engr. Expt. Sta.

5  Needham, J. G. and Lloyd, J.T.   The
      Life of Inland Waters.   Ithaca, New
      York, Comstock Publishing Co., Inc.
      1937.

6  Newell,  G.E.  and NeweU, R. C.
      Marine Plankton.  Hutchinson Educ.
      Ltd.   London.   221 pp.   1963.

7  Palmer,  C.M. and Ingram,  W.M.
      Suggested Classification of Algae and
      Protozoa in Sanitary Science.
      Sew. & Ind. Wastes.  27:1183-88.
      1955.
  18-4

-------
                                                                      Animal Plankton
8  Pennak, R.W.   Freshwater Invertebrates      10  Welch, P.S.   Limnology, McGraw-Hill
     of the United States.  The Ronald Press,           Book Co., Inc.,  New York.   1935.
     New York.   1953.

9  Sverdrup,  H.W., Johnson, M.W., and
     Fleming,  R.H.  The Oceans,  Their
     Physics,  Chemistry and General             This outline was prepared by H. W. Jackson,
     Biology.  Prentice-Hall, Inc., New York.    former Chief Biologist, National Training
     1942.                                      Center,  and revised by R. M. Sinclair,
                                                Aquatic  Biologist, National Training Center
                                                MOTD,  OWPO, USEPA, Cincinnati, Ohio
                                                45268.

                                                Descriptor:  Zooplankton
                                                                                18-5

-------
       3/4
       Phylum PROTOZOA

Free Living Representatives
     I. Flagellated Protozoa, Class Mastigophera
    Anthophysis
Pollution tollerant
    Pollution tollerant
           19/1
                                                    Colony of Poteriodendron
                                                    Pollution tollerant,
     II. Ameboid Protozoa, Class  Saroodina
   Pimastigamoeba
 Pollution tollerant
       10-50/1
     Nuelearia.reported
    to be intollerant of
    pollution, 45/».
     III. Ciliated Protozoa, Class Ciliophora
      Colpoda
Pollution tollerant
     20-120/1
      Holophrya.reported
     to be intollerant of
     pollution, 35/i
        Difflueia
    Pollution tollerant
                    60-500/1
 Epistvlis. pollution
tollerant. Colonies often
maorosoopio.
                                                        H.W.Jackson

-------
                                                     Animal Plankton
                       PJLANKTONIC PROTOZOA
                       Peranema trichophorum
                Top
                Side
 Chaos
Arcella
vulgaris
Actinosphaerium
Vorticella
  Codonella

  cratera
   Tintinnidium
   fluviatile

-------
     Animal Plankton
                                    PLANKTONIC  ROTIFERS
                            Various Forms of Keratella cochlearis
                     Synchaeta
                     pectinata
Polyarthra
vulgaris
                                         Rotaria sp
Brachionus
quadridentata
18-8

-------
                                                                Animal Plankton
                       SOME PLANKTONIC CRUSTACEANS
                                CRUSTACEANS
Copepod; Cyclops. Order Copepoda

             2-3 mm
            Water Flea;
             Daphnia
                                                A Nauplius larva of a Copepod

                                                          1-5 mm
       Order dadocera
                                     mm
                                 OSTRACODE
             Left: Shell closed
Right:  Appendages extended
                                   1-2 mm

-------
   Animal Plankton
                           PLANKTONIC ARTHROPODA
    A mysid shrimp - crustacean
A water mite - arachnid
                              Chaoborus midge larva - Insect
               Aspects in the life cycle of the human tapeworm
               Diphyllobothrium latum, class Cestoda.  A.  adult as in human
               intestine;  B.  procercoid larva in copepod; C.  plerocercoid
               larva in flesh of pickerel (X-ray view).
                                                           H.W. Jackson
10

-------
                      TECHNIQUES OF PLANKTON SAMPLING PROGRAMS
 I   INTRODUCTION

 A  A plan is necessary.  "If you fail to plan,
    you are planning to fail. "  Overall objec-
    tives, integration with other survey units,
    statistical design.

 B  A planned program of plankton analysis
    should involve periodic sampling at weekly
    intervals or more  often.

    1  Most interference organisms are small,
       and hence have  relatively short-life
       histories.

    2  Populations of such organisms may
       fluctuate rapidly in response to chang-
       ing water, weather, or seasons.

    3  Seasonal growth patterns of plankton
       tend to repeat themselves from year to
       year,  thus they are relatively predictable.

 C  A well-planned study or analysis of the
    growth pattern of plankton in one year will
    provide a basis for predicting conditions
    the following year.

    1  Since the seasons and the years differ,
       the more records are accumulated, the
       more useful can they become.

    2  As the time for an anticipated bloom of
       some trouble maker approaches,  the
       frequency of analysis may be increased.

 D  Detection of a bloom in its early stages
    will facilitate more economical control.

II   FIELD ASPECTS OF THE ANALYSIS
    PROGRAM

 A  Two general aspects of sampling are com-
    monly recognized:  quantitative and
    qualitative.

    1  Qualitative examination tells what is
       present.

    2  Quantitative tells how much.

    3  Either approach is useful,  a combination
       is best.
Equipment of collecting samples in the
field is varied.

1  A half-liter bottle will suffice for sur-
   face samples of phytoplankton if carefully
   taken.  If zooplankton also are  of interest,
   2 or more liters should be collected.
  (See below).

2  Plankton nets concentrate the sample
   in the act of collecting,  and capture
   certain larger forms which escape  from
   the bottles.  Only the more elaborate
   types are quantitative however.

3  A kemmerer-type sampler is suggested
   for depth samples.

4  Other methods  such as the Clark-Bumpus
   sampler or the Juday plankton trap may
   be employed for special purposes.

The  location of sampling points is
important

1  Both shallow and deep samples are
   suggested.

   a  "Shallow" samples should be taken
      at a depth of 6 inches to one foot.

   b  "Deep" samples should be taken at
      such intervals as the depth of the
      reservoir permits. There should be
      at least one  open water sampling
      point.

   c  Each major  bay or shoal area should
      have at least one sampling point.

   d  Additional sampling stations should
      be established on the basis of ex-
      perience  and resources.

   e  Samples may be composited if nec-
      essary to give an overall summary  of
      conditions.   Such summaries are not
      advised and  should be interpreted
      with care.
                                                                                      19-1
    BI. MIC.enu. 9h. 6. 76

-------
  Techniques of Plankton Sampling Programs
          A standardized vertical haul however,
          can be useful for routine comparisons.
Ill  FACTORS WHICH INCLUENCE SAMPLING
    AND DATA COLLECTION

 A Physical Features

    1  Temperature

       a  Lakes are warmed in spring princi-
          pally by the action of wind forcing
          the warmer water down into the
          cooler water against the forces of
          gravity.

       b  Thermal stratification

    2  Turbidity

    3  Color

    4  Water movement

    5  Light penetration

       a  A factor of turbidity, color, biolog-
          ical activity, and time of day

          (1) Effective length of daylight
             diminishes with the depth of
             the lake.

    6  Wind velocity and direction

    7  Bottom materials

    8  Size, shape, and slope  of lake basin

  B Chemical Factors

    1  Alkalinity,  pH, and dissolved minerals
       excluding nitrogen and phosphorus

    2  Dissolved oxygen

       a  From photosynthesis in sunlight

       b  From contact of lake surface with
          the air

       c  Fluctuates seasonally because of
          temperature and biological activity,
          and diurnally because of biological
          activity.
        Nutrients for biological growth -
        especially nitrogen and phosphorus

        a  A given body of water will produce
           a given quanity of aquatic life.
           Biological production is determined
           primarily by the nutrients in solu-
           tion in the water, and an increase
           in basic fertility will increase
           biological activity.

        b  Basic suppliers of nutrients
           include tributary streams,  precip-
           itation from the atmosphere, and
           interchange with lake bottom sedi-
           ments.
IV  FIELD PRESERVATION OF SAMPLES

 Provision should be made for the field
 stabilization of the sample until the laboratory
 examination can be made. Techniques and
 materials are listed below.  No "ideal" pre-
 servative or technique has yet been developed,
 each has its virtues.

 A Refrigeration or icing. The container
    containing the sample  can be cooled, but
    under no circumstances should ice be
    dropped into the sample.

 B Preservation by 3-5%  formalin is time-
    tested and widely used.  Formalin  shrinks
    animal tissue,  fades colors, and makes all
    forms brittle.

 C Ultra-violet sterilization is useful in the
    laboratory to retard decomposition of
    plankton.

 D Lugol's solution is often used.


   E A  special merthiolate preservative
     developed by the FWPCA Water Pollution
     Surveillance System which has proved very

     satisfactory and is described in reference
     No.  9.
      19-2

-------
                                                  Techniques of Plankton Sampling Programs
V  SUMMARY AND CONCLUSIONS

 A The field sampling program should be
   carefully planned to evaluate all signifi-
   cant locations in the reservoir or stream,
   giving due  consideration to the capacity
   of the laboratory.

 B Adequate records and notes should be
   made of  field conditions and associated
   with the laboratory analyses in a permanent
   file.

C  Once a procedure for processing plankton
   is adopted,  it should be used exclusively
   by all workers at the plant.
D
Such a procedure should enable the water
plant operator to prevent plankton troubles
or at least to anticipate them and have
corrective materials or equipment
stockpiled.
 ACKNOWLEDGMENT:

 Portions of this outline were prepared by
 K. M. Mackenthun, Biologist, formerly with
 Technical Advisory and Investigation Activities,
 FWPCA, SEC, Cincinnati, Ohio.

 REFERENCES

 1  APHA. Standard Methods for the
       Examination of Water and Wastewater
       14th Kd, NY,  1976.
2  Hutcheson, George E.  A Treatise.on
      Limnology.  John Wiley and Co.  New
      York. 1957.

 3  Jackson,  H.  W. Biological Examination
      (of plankton) Part III in Simplified
      Procedures for Water Examination.
      AWWA Manual M12.  Am.  Water
      Works Assoc., N.Y.  1964.

4   Lackey,  J. B.  The Manipulation and
      Counting of  River Plankton and Changes
      in Some Organisms Due to  Formalin
      Preservation.   Public Health Reports
      53: 2080-93. 1938.

5  Mackenthun,  K. M., Ingram,  W. M.,
      and Ralph  Forges.  Limnological
       Aspects of Recreation Lakes, DHEW,
       PHS  Publication No. 1167, 1964.

 6  Olson, Theodore A. and Burgess,  Fred-
       erick J.  Pollution and Marine Ecology.
       Interscience Publishers.   364 pp.- 1967.

 7  Palmer, C. M. Algae in Water Supplies.
       U. S, Department of Health, Education,
       and Welfare, Public Health Service
       Publication No. 657,  Superintendent of
       Documents, Washington 25, D. C.

 8  Schwoerbel, J. Methods of Hydrobiology
       (Freshwater Biology).  Pergamon
       Press,   1970.

 9  Weber,  C. I.  Methods of Collection and
       Analysis of Plankton and Periphyton
       Samples in the Water Pollution
       Surveillance System.  App. and Devel.
       Rep.  (AQC Lab.,  1014 Broadway,
       Cincinnati,  OH 45202) 19 pp  1966.

10  Welch, P.S.   Limnological Methods.
       The Blakiston Co., Phila.  Toronto.
       1948.

11  Williams,  L. G.  Plankton Population
       Dynamics, in National Water Quality
       Network, Supplement 2, U. S. PHS
       Pub.  No. 663.   1962.
                                              This outline was prepared by H. W. Jackson,
                                              former Chief Biologist, National Training
                                              Center, and revised by R. M. Sinclair,
                                              Aquatic Biologist, National Training Center,
                                              MOTD. OWPO,  USEPA, Cincinnati, Ohio 45268.

                                              Descriptor: Plankton
                                                                                     19-3

-------
        PREPARATION AND  ENUMERATION  OF PLANKTON IN THE LABORATORY
 I   RECEPTION AND PREPARATION  OF
    SAMPLES

 A  Preliminary sampling and analysis is  an
    essential preliminary to the establish-
    ment of a permanent or semi-permanent
    program.

 B  Concentration or  sedimentation  of  pre-
    served samples may precede analysis.

    1   Batch centrifuge

    2   Continuous centrifuge

    3   Sedimentation

 C  Unpreserved (living) samples should be
    analyzed at once or refrigerated for
    future analysis.

II   PREPARATION OF MERTHIOLATE
    PRESERVATIVE

 A  The Water Pollution Surveillance System
    of the FWPCA  has developed a modified
    merthiolate preservative.   (Williams,
    1967)  Sufficient  stock to make an approx-
    imately  3.5% solution in the bottle when
    filled is placed in the sample bottle in
    the laboratory.    The bottle is then filled
    with water in the field and returned to
    the laboratory for analysis.

 B  .Preparation of  Merthiolate Preservative

    1   Merthiolate  is available from many
        chemical laboratory supply houses;
        one  should specify the water soluble
        sodium salt.

    -2   Merthiolate  stock:  dissolve approxi-
        mately 1. 5  gram of sodium borate
        (borax and approximately 1 gram of
        merthiolate  in 1  liter  of  distilled water.
       The  amount of sodium borate and
       merthiolate may be varied slightly to
       adjust  to  different  waters,  climates,
       and organic contents.

       Prepare a saturated aqueous Lugol' s
       solution as follows:

       a  Add 60 grams of potassium iodide
          (KI) and 40 grams of iodine crystals
          to 1 liter of distilled water.

       Prepare the preservative solution by
       adding approximately  1. 0 ml of the
       Lugol1 s solution to  1  liter of merthi-
       olate stock.
Ill  .SAMPLE ANALYSIS
 A Microscopic examination is most frequently
    employed in the laboratory to  determine
    what plankton organisms are present  and
    how many there are:

    1   Optical equipment  need not  be elaborate
        but should include.

        a   Compound microscope with the
           following equipment:

           1)   Mechanical stage
           2)   Ocular:  10X,  with Whipple  type
               counting eyepiece or reticule
           3)   Objectives:
                 approx.   10X(16mm)
                 approx.   20X(8 mm)
                 approx.   40X(4 mm)
                 approx.   95X(1.8 mm)(optional)

           A 40X objective with a working
           distance  of 12.8 mm and an erect
          image may be obtained as special
          equipment.   A  water immersion
          objective  (in addition to  oil) might
          be  considered for use with water
          mounts.

          Binocular  eyepieces  are  optional.
    BI. MIC.enu. 15f. 6. 76
                                                                                      20-1

-------
Preparation and  Enumeration of Plankton
          Stage micrometer (this may be
          borrowed,  if necessary,  as it is
          usually used only once,  when the
          equipment  is calibrated)

       b  Inverted  microscopes  offer certain
          advantages but are not widely
          available.   The same is  true of
          some of  the newer optical  systems
          such as phase  contrast microscopy.
          These are  often  excellent but ex-
          pensive  for routine plant use.

   2:   Precision made counting chambers
       are required for quantitative work with
       liquid mounts.

       a  Sedgwick-Rafter  cells (hereafter
          referred to as S-R cell)  are used
          for routine  counts of medium and
          larger forms.

       b  Extremely  small forms or  "nanno-
          plankton" may  be counted by use of
          the nannoplankton (or  Palmer) cell,
          a Fisher-Littman cell, a hemacyto-
          meter, the  Lackey drop method,  or
          by use of an'inverted microscope.

   3   Previous to starting serious analytical
       work, the microscope should be cali-
       brated as described elsewhere.  Di-
       mensions of the S-R cell should also
       be checked, especially the depth.

   4   Automatic particle counters  may be
       useful for coccoid organisms.
B  Quantitative Plankton  Counts

   1   All quantitative  counting techniques
       involve the filling  of a standard  cell
       of  known dimensions with either
       straight sample  or a  concentrate or
       dilution thereof.

   2   The organisms in  a predetermined
       number of microscope fields or  other
       known area are  then observed,  and by
       means of a suitable series  of multi-
       plier factors,  projected  to a number or
       quantity per ml  gallon,  etc.
   Direct counting of the  unconcentrated
   sample eliminates manipulation,  saves
   time,  and reduces error.   If frequency
   of organisms is  low,  more area may
   need to be examined or concentration
   of the  sample  may be  in order.

   Conventional techniques employing
   concentration of  the sample provide more
   organisms for observation,  but because
   they involve  more manipulations,  intro-
   duce additional errors and take more
   time.
Several methods of counting plankton are
in general use.

1  The numerical or clump count is
   regarded as  the simplest.

   a   Every organism  observed must be
       enumerated.  If  it cannot be identi-
       fied,  assign a symbol or number
       and make  a sketch of it on the back
       of the record sheet.

   b   Filaments,  colonies  and other
       associations of cells are  counted
       as units,  equal to single  isolated
       cells.  Their identity as  indicated
       on the record sheet  is  the key to
       the significance  of such a count.

2  Individual cell count.   In this method,
   every cell of every colony or clump
   of organisms is counted, as  well  as
   each individual single-celled organism.

3  The areal standard  unit method offers
   certain technical advantages, but  also
   involves certain inherrent  difficulties.

   a   An areal  standard unit  is 400  square
       microns.   This  is the area of one
       of the smallest subdivided squares
       in the center of  the  Shipple eyepiece
       at a  magnification of 100X.

   b  In operation,  the number  of areal
      units  of each species is recorded on
      the record sheet rather than the
      number of individuals.   Average
      areas of the common species are
  20-2

-------
                                                 Preparation  and Enumberation of Plankton
      are  sometimes printed on record
      sheets for a particular plant to
      obviate the necessity of estimating
      the area  of each cell observed
      individually.

   c  The advantage of the method lies  in
      the cognizance taken of the relative
      masses of the various species as
      indicated by the area presented  to
      the viewer.   These  areas,  however,
      are often very difficult to  estimate.

4  The  cubic standard unit method is a
   logical extension  of the areal method,
   but has achieved  less acceptance.

5  Separate field count

   a  In counting separate fields,  the
      question always  arises as to how
      to count organisms touching or
      crossed by the edge of the Whipple
      field.   Some  workers estimate the
      proportion of the organism lying
      inside the field as compared to  that
      outside.   Only those which are  over
      half way  inside are  counted.

   b  Another system  is to  select two
      adjacent sides of the square  for
      reference,  such as the top and left
      boundaries.   Organisms touching
      these lines in any degree,  from
      outside or inside,  are then  counted,
      while organisms touching the opposite
      sides are  ignored.   It is important
      to adopt some such  system  and
      adhere to  it consistently.

   c  It is suggested that  if separate
      microscopic fields are examined,
      a  standard number  of ten  be adopted.
      These should be evenly  spaced in  two
      rows about one-third of the  distance
      down from the top and one-third of
      the distance up from the bottom of
      the S-R cell.

 6  Multiple area count.  This is an ex-
   tension of the separate  field count.
   A  considerable increase in accuracy
   has recently been shown to accrue  by
   emptying and refilling the S-R  cell,.
       after each group of fields are  counted
       and making up to 5  additional such
       counts.   This may not be practical with
       high counts.

       The strip count.  When a rectangular
       slide such as the  S-R cell is used, a
       strip (or  strips) the  entire length (or
       known portion thereof)  of  the  cell may
       be counted instead of separate isolated
       fields.   Marking the bottom of the cell
       by evenly spaced cross  lines  as  ex-
       plained  elsewhere greatly facilitates
       counting.

       a  When the  count obtained  is  multi-
          plied by the  ratio of the width of
          the  strip  counted to the width of
          the  cell,  the product is the esti-
          mated number  of organisms in  the
          cell,  or per ml.

       b  When the  material in the  cell is
          unconcentrated sample water,  this
          count represents the condition of
          the  water being evaluated without
          further calculation.

       Survey count.  A  survey count is an
       examination of the entire  area of a
       volumetric cell  using a  wide field  low
       power microscope.   The objective  is
       to  locate  and record the larger forms,
       especially zooplankton such  as copepods
       or large rotifers which  may be present
       in  size.   Special large capacity cells
       are often employed  for this purpose.
       For still  larger marine forms,  numerous
       special  devices  have been created.

       Once a  procedure for concentration
       and/or counting is adopted by a plant
       or other organization it should be
       used consistently from then on so
       that results from  year to year can be
       compared.
D* Differential or qualitative "counts" are
   essentially lists  of the kinds  of organisms
   found.
                                                                                    20-3

-------
Preparation and Enumeration of Plankton
E   Proportional  or relative counts of special
    groups are often very useful.   For  ex-
    ample, diatoms.   It is best to always
    count  a  standard numbers of cells.

F   Plankton are sometimes measured by
   means other than microscopic counts.

    1  Settled volume of killed plankton in an
      Imhoff cone  may be observed after  a
      standard length of time.   This will
      evaluate primarily only the larger forms.

   2  A gravimetric method  employs drying
      at  60° C for 24 hours  followed by
      ashing at 600° C for 30  minutes.   This
      is  particularly useful for chemical
      and radiochemical analysis.

   3  Chemical and physical  evaluation  of
      plankton populations employing various
      instrumental techniques are coming to
      be widely used.  Both  biomass and
      productivity  rates can be measured.
      Such determinations probably achieve
      their  greatest utility when coordinated
      with microscopic examination.

   4  The membrane (molecular) filter  has
      a great potential,  but a generally
      acceptable  technique has  yet  to be
      perfected.

         a  Bacteriological techniques for
            coliform determination are
            widely accepted.

         b  Nematodes and larger organisms
            can readily be washed off of the
            membrane after filtration.

         c  It is also being used to measure
            ultraplankton that pass treatment
            plant operations.

         d  Membranes  can be cleared and
            organisms deposited thereon
            observed directly,  although
            accessory staining  is desirable.
        e  Difficulties  include a predilec-
           tion  of extremely fine  membranes
           to clog rapidly with silt  or
           increase  in plankton counts,  and
           the difficulty of making observations
           on individual cells when  the
           organisms are piled on top of each
           other.   It is sometimes  necessary
           to dilute  a sample to  obtain  suitable
           distribution.


IV  SUMMARY  AND CONCLUSIONS

A  The field sampling program  should be
    carefully planned to  evaluate  all significant
    locations in the reservoir or  stream,
    giving due consideration to the  capacity
    of the laboratory.

B  Adequate records and notes should be
    made of field conditions  and associated
    with the laboratory analyses  in a
    permanent file.

C  Optical  equipment in the laboratory should
    be calibrated.

D  Once a  procedure for processing plankton
    is  adopted,  it should be  used  exclusively
    by all workers at the plant.

E  Such a procedure  should enable  the  water
    plant operator to prevent plankton troubles
    or at least to anticipate  them and have
    corrective materials or  equipment stockpiled.
REFERENCES

1  Ely  Lilly Company.   Merthiolate as a
      Preservative.   Ely Lilly & Co.
      Indianapolis 6,  Indiana.

2  Gardiner,  A. C.   Measurement of
      Phytoplankton Population by the
      Pigment Extraction Method.   Jour.
      Marine Biol.  Assoc.  25(4):739-744.  1943.
                                                 3  Goldberg,  E. D.,  Baker, M.,  and Fox,
                                                       Microfiltration in Oceanographic
                                                       Research Sears Foundation.   Jour.
                                                       Mar. Res.   11:194-204.  1952.
                                           D. L.
  20-4

-------
                                                Preparation and Enumeration of Plankton
Ingram,  W.  M., and  Palmer,  C. M.
  Simplified Procedures for  Collecting,
  Examining, and Recording Plankton
  in Water.   Jour.   AWWA.  ^4(7):
  617-624.   1952.

Jackson, H. W. Biological Examination
  (of plankton) Part III in  Simplified
  Procedures for Water Examination.
  AWWA Manual M 12.  Am.  Water
  Works Assoc.  N. Y.  1964.

Lund,  J.  W.  G.,  and  Tailing,  J. F.
  Botanical  Limnological Methods with
  Special References  to  the Algae.
  Botanical Review.   ^3(8&9):489-583.
  October,  1957.
7  Weber,  C.  I.  The Preservation of
       Plankton Grab Samples.   Water
       Pollution Surveillance  Systems,
       Applications and Development Report
       No.  26, USDI,  FWPCA,  Cincinnati,
       Ohio.    1967

8  Williams,  L.  G. Plankton Population
       Dynamics.   National Water Quality
       Network Supplement 2.  U. S.  Public
       Health  Service  Publ.  No.  663.   1962

9  Wohlschag,  D. D.,  and Hasler, A. D.
       Some Quantitative  Aspects of Algal
       Growth  in Lake  Mendota.  Ecology.
       32(4):581-593.   1951
                                              'This outline was prepared by H. W. Jackson,
                                              former Chief Biologist, National Training
                                              Center, and revised by R. M. Sinclair,
                                              Aquatic Biologist, National Training Center,
                                              MOTD, OWPO, USEPA, Cincinnati, Ohio 45268

                                              Descriptor:  Plankton
                                                                                   20-5

-------
                                   ATTACHED GROWTHS
                                  (Periphyton or Aufwuchs)
I  The community of attached microscopic
plants and animals is frequently investigated
during water quality studies.  The attached
growth community (periphyton) and suspended
growth community (plankton) are the principal
primary producers in waterways--they con-
vert nutrients to organic living materials and
store light originating energy through the
processes of photosynthesis.  In extensive
deep waters, plankton is probably the pre-
dominant primary producer. In shallow lakes,
ponds, and rivers,  periphyton is the predominant
primary producer.   During the past two
decades, investigators of microscopic
organisms have increasingly placed emphasis
on periphytic growths because of inherent
advantages over the  plankton when interpreting
data from surveys on flowing waters:

A  Blum (1956) "...  .workers are generally
   agreed that no distinctive association of
   phytoplankton is found in streams, although
   there is some evidence of this for individual
   zooplankters (animals) and for a few
   individual algae and bacteria.  Plankton
   organisms are often introduced into the
   current from impoundments, backwater
   areas or stagnant arms of the stream....
   Rivers whose plankton is not dominated by
   species from upstream lakes or ponds are
   likely to exhibit a majority of forms which
   have been derived from the stream bottom
   directly and which are thus merely.
   facultative or opportunistic plankters. "

B  "The transitory nature of stream plankton
   makes it nearly impossible to ascertain at
   which point upstream agents producing
   changes in the algal population were
   introduced,  and whether the changes
   occurred at the sampling site  or at some
   unknown point upstream.  In contrast,
   bottom algae (periphyton) are  true com-
   ponents of the stream biota.  Their
   sessile-attached mode of life subjects
   them to the quality of water continuously
   flowing over them.  By observing the
   longitudinal distribution of bottom algae
   within a stream,  the sources of the agents
   producing the change can be traced
   (back-tracked)" (Keup,  1966).
II   TERMINOLOGY

 A  Two terms are equally valid and commonly
    in use to describe the attached community
    of organisms.   Periphyton literally means
    "around plants" such as the growths over-
    growing pond-weeds; through usage this
    term means  the attached film of growths
    that rely on  substrates as a "place-to-
    grow" within a waterway. The  components
    of this growth assemblage consists of
    plants, animals, bacteria,  etc.  Aufwuchs
    is an equally acceptable term [probably
    originally  proposed by Seligo (1905)].
    Aufwuchs is  a German noun without
    equivalent english translation; it is
    essentially a collective term equivalent
    to the above  American (Latin root) term -
    Periphyton.  (For convenience, only,
    PERIPHYTON,  with its liberal  modern
    meaning will be used in this outline.)

 B  Other terms, some rarely encountered in
    the literature,  that are essentially
    synonymous  with periphyton or  describe
    important  and dominant components  of the
    periphytic community are:  Nereiden,
    Bewuchs,  Laison,  Belag, Besatz,  attached,
    sessile, sessile-attached, sedentary, .
    seeded-on, attached materials, slimes,
    slime-growths, and coatings.

    The academic community occasionally
    employs terminology based on the nature
    of the substrates the periphyton grows on
    (Table 1).

              TABLE  1

      Periphyton Terminology Based
          on Substrate Occupied
 Substrate                Adjective
 various         epiholitic, nereiditic,  sessile
 planta          epiphytic
 animals        epizooic
 wood           epidendritic, epixylonic
 rock           epilithic

I After Srameck-Husek( 1946) and via Sladeckova
 (1962)] Most above listed latin-root adjectives
 are derivatives  of  nouns such as epihola,
 epiphyton, spizoa, etc.
 BI.MIC.enu.
                                      21-1

-------
 Attached Growths (Periphyton or Aufwuchs)
III  Periphyton, as with all other components
 of the environment,  can be sampled quali-
 tatively (what is present) and quantitatively
 (how  much or many  are present).

 A  Qualitative sampling can be performed by
    many methods and may extend from direct
    examination of the growths attached to a
    substrate to unique "cuttings" or scrapings.
    It  may also be a portion of quantitative
    sampling.

 B  Quantitative sampling is difficult because
    it  is nearly impossible to remove the
    entire community from a standardized or
    unit area of substrate.

    1  Areas scraped cannot be determined
       precisely enough when the areas are
       amorphous plants, rocks or logs that
       serve as the principal periphyton
       substrates.
V  ARTIFICIAL SUBSTRATE PLACEMENT

 A Position or Orientation
    1  Horizontal - Includes effects of settled
      materials.

    2  Vertical - Eliminates many effects of
      settled materials.

 B  Depth (light) - A substrate placed in lighted
    waters may not reflect conditions in a
    waterway if much of the natural substrate
    (bottom) does not receive  light or receives
    light at reduced intensity.  (Both  excessive
    light and a  shortage of light can inhibit
    growths and influence the  kinds of organisms
    present.)

 C  Current is  Important
       Collection of the entire community within
       a standard area usually destroys individual
       specimens thereby making identification
       difficult (careful scraping can provide
       sufficient intact individuals of the species
       present to make qualitative determinations); VI
       or the process of collection adds sufficient
       foreign materials (i. e. detritus, sub-
       strate, etc.) so that some commonly         A
       employed quantitative procedures are
       not applicable.
IV  Artificial substrates are a technique
 designed to overcome the problems of direct
 sampling.   They serve their purpose, but
 cannot be used without discretion.  They are
 objects standardized as to surface area,
 texture, position, etc. that are placed  in the
 waterway for pre-selected time periods during
 which periphytic growths accumulate.  They
 are usually made of inert materials, glass
 being most common with plastics second in
 frequency.  Over fifty various devices  and
 methods of support or suspension of the
 substrates have been devised (Sladeckova,
 1962) (Weber,  1966) (Thomas, 1968).
    1  It can prevent the settling of smothering
      materials.

    2  It flushes metabolic wastes away and
      introduces nutrients to the colony.
    THE LENGTH OF TIME THE SUBSTRATE
    IS EXPOSED IS IMPORTANT.

    The growths need time to colonize and
    develop on the recently introduced
    substrate.

    Established growths may intermittently
    break-away from the substrate because
    of current or weight induced stresses, or
    "over-growth" may "choke" the attachment
    layers  (nutrient, light, etc. restrictions)
    which then weaken or die allowing release
    of the mass.

    A minimum of about ten days is required
    to produce sufficient growths on an
    artificial substrate; exposures  exceeding
    a longer time than 4-6 weeks may produce
    "erratic results" because of sloughing or
    the accumulation of senile growths in
    situations where the substrate is
    artificially protected from predation and
    other environmental stresses.
  21-2

-------
                                                      Attached Growths (Periphyton or Aufwuchs)
 VII   Determining the variety of growths present
   is presently only practical with microscopic
   examination. (A few micro-chemical pro-
   cedures for differentiation show promise--
   but, are only in the early  stages of development.)
VIII   DETERMINING THE QUANTITY OF
      GROWTH(S)

   A  Direct enumeration of the growths while
      attached to the substrate can be used, but
      is restricted to the larger organisms
      because (1) the problem of maintaining
      material in an acceptable condition under
      the short working distances of the objective
      lenses on compound microscopes, and
      (2) transmitted light is not adequate
      because of either opaque substrates and/or
      the density of the colonial growths.

   B  Most frequently, periphyton is scraped
      from the substrate and then processed
      according to several available procedures,
      the selection being based on the need, and
      use of the data.

      1  Aliquots of the sample may be counted
        using methods frequently employed in
        plankton analysis.

        a  Number  of organisms

        b  Standardized units

        c  Volumetric units

        d  Others

      2  Gravimetric

        a  Total dry weight of scrapings

        b  Ash-free dry weight (eliminates
           inorganic sediment)

        c  A  comparison of total and ash-free
           dry weights

      3  Volumetric, involving centrifugation of
        the scrapings to determine a packed
        biomass  volume.
    4  Nutrient analyses serve as indices of
       the biomass by measuring the quantity
       of nutrient incorporated.

       a Carbon

         1) Total organic carbon

         2) Carbon equivalents (COD)

       b Organic nitrogen

       c Phosphorus - Has limitations
         because cells can store excess
         above immediate needs.

       d Other

    5  Chlorophyll and other bio-pigment
       extractions.

    6  Carbon-14 uptake

    7  Oxygen production,  or respiratory
       oxygen demand


K  EXPRESSION OF RESULTS

 A  Qualitative

    1  Forms found

    2  Ratios of number per group found

    3  Frequency distribution of varieties
       found

    4  Autotrophic index (Weber)

    5  Pigment diversity index (Odum)
 B  Quantitative

    1  Areal basis--quantity per square
       inch, foot,  centimeter,  or meter.
       For example:

       a 16 mgs/sq. inch

       b 16, 000 ceUs/sq. inch

    2   Rate basis.  For example:

       a 2 mgs/day, of biomass accumulation
       b 1 mg O2/mg of growth/hour
                                                                                     21-3

-------
Attached Growths (Periphyton or Aufwuchs)
REFERENCES

1  Blum,  J. L.  The Ecology of River Algae.
      Botanical Review.  22:5:291.   1956.

2  Dumont,  H. J.  A Quantitative Method for
      the Study of Periphyton.    Ldmnol.
      Oceanogr.   14(2):584~595.

3  Keup, L.E.  Stream Biology for Assessing
      Sewage Treatment Plant Efficiency.
      Water and Sewage Works.  113:11-411.
      1966.

4  Seligo, A.  Uber den Ursprung der
      Fischnahrung.  Mitt.  d.  Westpr.
      Fisch. -V.  17:4:52.   1905.

5  Sladeckova, A.   Limnological Investigation
      Methods for the Periphyton Community.
      Botanical Review.   28:2:286.   1962.

6  Srameck-Husek.  (On the Uniform
      Classification of Animal and Plant
      Communities in our Waters).
      Sbornik MAP 20:3:213.  Orig.  in
      Czech.  1946.
 7  Thomas, N.A.   Method for Slide
       Attachment in Periphyton Studies.
       Manuscript.  1968.

 8  Weber,  C.I.  Methods of Collection and
       Analysis of Plankton and Periphyton
       Samples in the Water Pollution
       Surveillance System.   Water Pollution
       Surveillance System Applications and
       Development Report No. 19, FWPCA,
       Cincinnati.  19+pp. (multilith).  1966.

 9  Weber,  C. I.  Annual Bibliography
       Midwest Benthological Society.
       Periphyton.  1014 Broadway,
       Cincinnati, OH  45202.

10  Hynes, H.B.N.  The Ecology of Running
       Waters.  Univ.  Toronto Press.
       555 pp.  1970.

11  Spoon, Donald M.  Microbial Communities
       of the Upper Potomac Estuary: The
      Aufwuchs in:  The Potomac Estuary,
       Biological  Resources,  Trends and
      Options.  1CPRB  Tech Pub. No. 76-2,
       1976.

 This outline was  prepared by Lowell E. Keup,
 Chief, Technical Studies Branch, Division of
 Technical Support, EPA, Washington,  DC 20242.

 Descriptor:  Periphyton
  21-4

-------
                     DETERMINATION OF PLANKTON PRODUCTIVITY
 I  INTRODUCTION

 Primary production is the  synthesis of organic
 matter from inorganic raw materials. The
 energy required for this process may come
 from light (photosynthesis), or from  chemical
 sources (chemosynthesis).  The primary
 synthesis of organic matter in lakes  and
 streams  is carried on by planktonic and ben-
 thic algae and bacteria, and aquatic
 macrophytes.
 II  PHOTOSYNTHESIS

 The photosynthetic process involves the up-
 take of CO2 and the release of Og.  The
 reactions are enzyme catalyzed and are af-
 fected by the following factors:

 A Temperature

 B Light Intensity

 C Light Quality

 D pH

 E Nutrients

 F Trace Elements


III  MEASURING PRODUCTIVITY

 Methods employed to measure plankton pro-
 ductivity are;

 A Standing Crop

 B Oxygen

 C pH

 D Carbon-14
IV  STANDING CROP METHOD

 The productivity of a body of water is indicated,
 in a general way, by the density of the plankton
 population.  The standing crop of plankton is
 commonly measured by determining one or
 more of the following:

 A Dry  and Ash-free Weight of Seston

 B Cell or Unit Counts

 C Cell Volume

 D Chlorophyll

 E Particulate and Dissolved Carbohydrate

 F Particulate and Dissolved Organic Carbon

 Increases in the standing crop over a period
 of time may be used to determine productivity.
 However, this method provides only .a rough
 approximation of the rate of primary
 production.


 V  OXYGEN METHOD

 The use of dissolved oxygen to determine
 short-term rates of primary production was
 introduced by Gaardner and Gran (1927).
 Estimates of the amount of carbon fixed are
 based on the premise that one molecule of
 oxygen  is given off for each atom of carbon
 assimilated.
C0
             H2°  ~
CH20
    "Light" and "dark" bottles are filled with
    sample and resuspended at various depths
    for 4-24 hours.

    The concentration of dissolved oxygen is
    determined (using the Winkler Method) at
  BI. ECO. pro. la. 6. 76'
                                     22-1

-------
 Determination of Plankton Productivity
    the beginning and end of the incubation
    period.  The values obtained are as
    follows:

    1  Final "light" bottle O2 - initial O2  =
       net photosynthesis

    2  Initial O2 -  Final "dark" bottle C>2  =
       respiration

    3  Net photosynthesis + respiration =
       gross photosynthesis

 This method has some serious disadvantages:

 A The bottles provide an artificial substrate
    for the proliferation of bacteria which
    use up large amounts of O2, resulting in
    erroneously high respiration and low net
    photosynthesis  values.

 B The lower  limit of  sensitivity of the Winkler
    Method is 0.02 mg 02/liter.  This is a
    serious handicap when working in oligo-
    tropic lakes and the open sea.
VI  CARBON-14  METHOD

 The use of carbon-14 for the measurement
 of the rate of carbon assimilation by phyto-
 plankton was pioneered by E.  Steemann
 Nielsen (1952).  The method is simple and
 very sensitive.

 A Carbon-14 labelled sodium bicarbonate
    (4 -  lOjic /liter)  is added to "light" and
    "dark" bottles,  which are resuspended in
    the water for 4-24 hours.

 B An aliquot of the sample is passed through
    a membrane filter (1.2 upore diameter),
    and the  filters are treated with acid to
    remove any inorganic labelled carbon.

 C The (beta)  activity of the filter is deter-
    mined with an end-window Geiger tube,
    or with  gas flow or liquid scintillation
    techniques.

 D The carbon fixed is determined as
    follows:
    There are several important disadvantages
    in this method.

    A  Some of the labelled photosynthesis pro-
       ducts will be broken down immediately by
       respiration, and the liberated carbon-14
       reused in photosynthesis.  Therefore, it
       is generally agreed that the method mea-
       sures only net photosynthesis.

    B  It has been found that the algae rapidly ex-
       crete up to 50% of the photosynthate in the
       form of organic acids, carbohydrates,
       and amino acids.  Since these labelled
       materials are  not retained by the filter,
       they escape detection.

  VII pH METHOD

    The uptake of CC>2 by the algae during photo-
    syntheses results in an increase in the pH of
    the surrounding medium.  Periodic pH measure-
    ments are made of the body of water being
    studied,  and the carbon uptake is determined
    using published nomographs.

    Verduin  (1952) used this method in a study
    of the productivity of Lake Erie.  However,
    the  method has not gained wide acceptance
    because it can be used only in waters with
    low alkalinity.
    REFERENCES

    1  Allen, M. B. Excretion of Organic Com-
          pounds by Chlamydompnas.  Arch.  f.
          Mikrobiol. 24:163-168.  1956.

    2  Curl,  H. Jr.,  and Small,  L. F.  Variations
          in Photosynthetic Assimilation in Natural
          Marine Photoplankton Communities.
          Limnol.  Oceanogr.  10(Suppl.):R67-R73.
          1965.

    3  Gaardner, T.,  and Gran,  H. H.  Investi-
          gations of the Production of the Plankton
          in the Oslo Fjord. Rapp. et Proc. -
          Verb., Con. Internal. Explor.  Mer.
          42:1-48.  1927.
                 carbon _  activity on filter
                 fixed  "  total activity added
X
available
 HCO;
correction for
  isotope
discrimination
   22-2

-------
                                                      Determination of Plankton Productivity
4  Goldman,  C. R.  Molybdenum as a Factor
      Limiting Primary Productivity in
      Castle Lake,  California.  Science 132:
      1016-1017.   1960.

5  Kamen,  M. D.  Primary Processes in
      Photosynthesis.  Academic Press,
      New York.  1963.

6  Marshall,  S.M.,  and Orr, A. P.   Carbo-
      hydrate as a Measure of Photoplankton.
      J. Mar. Biol.  Assoc. U.K. 42:511-519.
      1962.

7  Ryther,  J. H.   Photosynthesis in the Ocean
      as a Function of Light Intensity.
      Limnol. Oceanogr.  1:61-70.  1956.

8  Steemann Nielsen, E.  The Use of Radio-
      active Carbon (C-14) for Measuring
      Organic Production  in the Sea.  J. Con.
      Internat. Explor. Mer. 18:117-140.   1952.

9  Strickland,  J. D. H.  Measuring the
      Production of Marine Phytoplankton.
      Bull. Fish. Res. Bd. Can.  No. 122:
      1-172.   1960.
10  Verduin, J.  Photosynthesis and Growth
      Rates of Two Diatom Communities in
      Western Lake Erie.  Ecology 33(2):
      163-168.  1952.

11  Vernon, L. P.  Bacterial Phytosynthesis. '
      Ann. Rev. Plant.  Physiol.  15:73-100. 1962

12  Wetzel,  R. G.  A Comparative Study of the
      Primary Productivity of Higher Aquatic
      Plants, Periphyton, and Phytoplankton
      in a Large,  Shallow Lake.   Internat.
      Rev.  Hydrobiol. 49:1-61.  1964.

13  Yentsch, Charles S.   The Measurement
      of Chloroplastic Pigments- Thirty
      Years of Progress?  pp.  255-270 in
      Chemical Environment in the Aquatic
      Habitat.  Proc. IBP Symposium.
      Amsterdam.   1967.  (N.V.  Noord-
      Hollandsche Uitgevers Maatschappij.
      Amsterdam, Netherlands. 8. 95)
 This outline was prepared by C. I. Weber,
 Chief, Biological Methods Branch,
 Analytical Quality Control Laboratory,
 NERC, EPA, Cincinnati, OH 45268.

 Descriptors:  Productivity, Plankton
                                                                                22-3

-------
                             ALGAL GROWTH POTENTIAL TEST
 I  INTRODUCTION

 Dense growths of algae in surface waters are
 aesthetically undesirable, cause problems in
 water treatment, produce changes in the aquatic
 environment that are harmful to fish and other
 aquatic life,  and are symptomatic of pollution.
 The density of phytoplankton populations is
 directly related to the concentration of
 nutrients.  This relationship has been well
 documented, and is now embodied in the
 concept of trophic level or trophic status of
 surface waters.  One or more of the following
 parameters are commonly used to describe
 the trophic status:  (a) nutrient concentration -
 principally N and P,  (b) algal count,
 (c) chlorophyll concentration,  (d) primary
 productivity,  (e) particulate organic matter,
 (f) oxygen depletion in the hypolimnion,  and
 (g) phytoplankton species composition or
 indicator species (Rawson 1956; Davis 1964;
 Goldman & Carter  1965; Oglesby &  Edmondson
 1966; Fruh, Steward,  Lee & Rohlich 1966).
 II  EUTROPHICATION

 Three general trophic levels now recognized,
 here arranged in ascending order,  are:
 oligotrophic (low),  mesotrophic (intermediate),
 and eutrophic (high). The addition of nutrients
 to surface waters raises the trophic  level and
 results in an increase in phytoplankton density
 and changes in the  species composition.
 This process, commonly referred to as
 eutrophication,  is greatly accelerated by the
 discharge of nutrient-laden domestic and
 industrial wastes (Hasler 1947),  Edmondson
 & Anderson 1956).
Ill  MEASUREMENTS OF TROPHIC LEVELS

 Although chemical analyses provide information
 on the concentration of nutrients, their
 availability to the algae can be determined
 only by biological assay. Biological assays
 to determine the potential (algal) productivity
 of surface water were first used in the late
 twenties (Schreiber 1927) and early thirties
 (Strom 1933), but until recently had been
 used only infrequently (Potash 1956;
 Skulberg 1964, 1967; Shelef & Halperin 1970).
 In 1967, the  Joint Industry-Government Task
 Force on Eutrophication took steps to develop
 a standardized algal growth potential (AGP)
 test.  Using  this test,  one can:

 A  Evaluate the effectiveness of waste
    treatment processes in removing elements
    that support or stimulate the growth of
    algae.

 B  Determine at what point along the time
    scale of progressing eutrophication the
    water of a given lake or stream happens
    to lie (trophic status).

 C  Anticipate the effect on algal production
    of introducing extraneous nutrients.

 D  Determine the extent to which nutrient
    levels must be reduced in a body of water
    to effect an acceptable remedy.
IV  BASIC STEPS OF ALGAL GROWTH
    POTENTIAL TEST

 A A surface (test) water sample is collected
    and the indigenous microorganisms are
    removed by filtration (0.45 micron
    membrane filter at 15 inches of mercury)
    or ultracentrifugation.

 B The surface water and standard medium
    (Table 1) are inoculated with 1000 cells/ml
    of Selenastrum capricornutum,  or 50, 000
    cells/ml of Anabaena flos-aquae or
    Microcystis aeruginosa.

 C The cultures are prepared in triplicate
    and incubated 7-10 days at 24OC, 200 fc
    (blue-greens) or 400 fc (Selenastrum)
    continuous illumination, with shaking at
    100 oscillations/min (culturing may be by
    flask,  chemostat, or in situ technique).

 D Algal growth is  measured daily by
    (1) cell counts,  (2) determining the
 BI.B1O. alg. lb.6. 76
                                        23-1

-------
Algal Growth Potential Test
                                        TABLE 1

                MAY,  1970 VERSION OF PAAP NUTRIENT BASAL MEDIUM


          (This formula consists of 30% of the concentrations of the macroelements
          listed in the February, 1969, PAAP Booklet.  The Na CO, was replaced by
          NaHCO0, and the EDTA was reduced to 333 Mg/1.)
                O

          MACROELEMENTS: (milligrams per liter)
Compound
NaNO3
K2HP04
MgCl2
MgS04- 7H20
CaCl2-2H20
NaHCO,
O
Final Cone.
25.500
1.044
5.700
14.700
4.410
15.000
Element
Furnished
N
P
K
Mg
Mg
S
Ca
Na
Element
Cone.
4.200
0.186
0.469
1.456
1.450
1.911
1.202
11.001
          If the medium is to be filtered,  add the following trace-element-iron-EDTA
          solution from a single combination stock solution after filtration.  With no
          filtration,  K^HPO. should be added last to avoid iron precipitation.  Stock
          solutions of individual salts may be made up in 1000 X's final cone,  or less.


          MICROSLEMENTS:  (micrograms per liter)
H3B°3
MnCl2
ZnCl2
CoCl2
CuCl2
Na0MoO.-2H0O
242
FeCl3
Na_EDTA-2HnO
185.5
264.3
32.7
0.780
0.009
7.26

96.0
300.0
B
Mn
Zn
Co
Cu
Mo

Fe

32.5
115.4
15.7
0.354
0.004
2.88

33.05

 23-2

-------
                                                                 Algal Growth Potential Test
    chlorophyll content, in vivo fluorescence,
    light scattering or optical density
    (600 nm) of the culture, (3) measuring
    the C-14 uptake, or (4) determining the
    dry weight of the algae at the end of the
    incubation period.  Regardless of the
    parameter used to measure growth
    response, the result should always be
    expressed in terms of the final dry weight
    of the culture.

    The growth response of the alga  in the
    test water is compared to its growth in
    the standard medium.
 V  PHASES OF THE TEST STILL UNDER
    STUDY INCLUDE:

 A  Composition of the standard growth
    medium.

 B  Effects of ventilation and shaking on the
    growth response of batch cultures.

 C  Techniques of measuring growth response.

 D  Techniques of removing indigenous
    microorganisms from test surface waters.
VI  For copies of the Provisional Algal Assay
 Procedure and information on the availability
 of subcultures of the test organism,  contact:

       Dr. A. F. Bartsch, Chairman
       JTF Research Program Group
       Director, Pacific Northwest
       Water Research Laboratory
       Corvallis, Oregon 97330
 REFERENCES

 1  	.  Provisional Algal Assay
       Procedure.  Joint Industry-Government
       Task Force on Eutrophication, P.O.
       Box 3011,  Grand Central Station,
       N.Y.  10017.  1969.

    Davis, C. C.   Evidence for the eutrophication
       of Lake Erie from phytoplanktpn records.
       Limnol. Oceanogr. 9:275.   1964.
 3  Edmondson,  W. T.  and Anderson, G. C.
      Artificial eutrophication of Lake
      Washington.   Limnol.  Oceanogr.
      l(l):47-53.   1956.

 4  Fruh, E.G.,  Stewart, K.M., Lee, G. F.,
      and Rohlich,  G.A.  Measurements of
      Eutrophication and Trends.   JWPCF
      38(8):1237-1258.  1966.

 5  Goldman, C.R.  and Carter, R.C.
      An investigation by rapid C
      bloassay of factors affecting the
      cultural eutrophication of Lake Tahoe,
      California. JWPCF 37:1044-1063.
      1965.

 6  Hasler,  A.D.   Eutrophication of lakes by
      domestic  drainage.  Ecology 28(4):
      383-395.;  1947.

 7  Oglesby,  R.T. and Edmondson, W. T.
      Control of Eutrophication.  JWPCF
      38(9):1452-1460.  1966.

 8  Potash,  M.   A  biological test  for
      determining the  potential productivity
      of water.   Ecology 37(4):631-639.
      1956.

 9  Rawson, D. S.  Algal indicators of lake
      types.  Limnol.  Oceanogr.   1:18-25.
      1956.

10  Schreiber, W.  Der Reinkultur von
      marinem  Phytoplankton und deren
      Bedeutung fur die Erforschung der
      Produktions-fahigkeit des Meerwassers.
      Wissensch.  Meeresunters., N.F.
      16:1-34.   1927.

11  Shelef, G. and Halperin,  R. 1970. Wastewater
      nutrients  and algae growth potential.
      In: H.I. Shuval, ed.,  "Developments
      in Water Quality Research", Proc.
      Jerusalem Internat'l.  Conf. on Water
      Quality and Poll. Res.,  June, 1969.
      Ann Arbor-Humphrey Science Publ.,
      p. 211-228.
                                                                                    23-3

-------
 Algal Growth Potential Test
12  Skulberg, O.M.  Algal problems related
      to the eutrophication of European water
      supplies, and a bioassay method to
      assess fertilizing influences of pollution
      on inland waters.  In:  D.F. Jackson,
      ed., "Algae and Man",  Plenum Press,
      N. Y. p.  262-299.  1964.

13  Skulberg, O.M.  Algal cultures as a means
      to assess the fertilizing incluence of
      pollution.  In:  Advances in Water
      Pollution Research, Volumn 1,
      Pe-gamon Press, Washington, D. C.
      1967.

14  Strom,  K.M. Nutrition of algae.  Experi-
      ments upon; the feasibility of the
      Schreiber method in fresh waters;
      the relative inportance of iron and
      manganese in the nutritive medium;
      the nutritive substance given off by
      lake bottom muds.  Arch. Hydrobiol.
      25:38-47.  1933.

 ADDITIONAL RECENT REPORTS:
                    .  Algal Assay Procedure
                   82 pp. Environmental
                         National Eutrophica-
Bottle Test.
Protection Agency,
tion Research Program,  Corvallis,
Oregon.  1971.
 2	.  Inter-Laboratory
      Precision Test.  An Eight-Laboratory
      Evaluation of the Provisional Algal
      Assay Procedure Bottle Test.  70 pp.
      Environmental Protection Agency,
      National Eutrophication Research
      Program,  Corvallis, Oregon.  1971.
            i
 3 Berge, G.,  Predicted Effects of
      Fertilizers Upon the Algae Production
      in Fern Lake.  Fisk Dir.  Skr. Serv.
      Hav.  Unders.,  15:339-355.  1969.

 4 Johnson,  J.M., T.O. Odlaug, T.A. Olson,
      andO.R. Ruschmeyer. The  Potential
      Productivity of Freshwater Environ-
      ments as Determined by an Algal
      Bioassay Technique.  Water Resources
      Research Center BuDetin  No.  20,
      University of Minnesota, Minneapolis.
      1970.
5  Maloney, T.E.,  W.E. Miller, and T.
      Shiroyama. Algal Responses to
      Nutrient Additions in Natural Waters.
      I. Laboratory Assays.  In:  Special
      Symposia 1:134-140.  Amer. Soc.
      Limnol. Oceanogr.  1972.

6  Miller, W. E., andT.E. Maloney.
      Effects of Secondary and Tertiary
      Wastewater Effluents on Algal Growth
      in a Lake-River System.  JWPCF
      43(12)2361-2365.  1971.

7  Murray, S., J. Scherfig,  andP.S. Dixon.
      Evaluation of Algal Assay Procedures-
      PAAP Batch Test. JWPCF 43(10):
      1991-2003.  1971.

8  Shapiro, J., and R. Riberiro.  Algal
      Growth and Sewage Effluent in the
      Potomac Estuary.  JWPCF  37(7):
      1034-1043.  1965.

9  Toerien, D. F., C. H. Huang, J. Radimsky,
      E.A. Pearson, and J. Scherfig.  Final
      Report, Provisional Algal Assay
      Procedures.  211  pp.  Sanitary Engineer-
      ing Research Laboratory Report No.
      71-6, University of California,
      Berkeley.  1971.
                                           This outline has been prepared by Dr. C. I.
                                           Weber,  Chief, Biological Methods Section,
                                           Analytical Quality Control Laboratory,
                                           NERC, EPA, Cincinnati, OH 45268.

                                           Descriptors:  Plankton,  Productivity
 23-4

-------
                    ALGAE AND ACTINOMYCETES IN WATER SUPPLIES
 I  Water treatment always should include
 detection and control of microorganisms.
 A Two types of microorganisms are involved:

   1  Pathogenic types include such forms as
      the typhoid bacteria, the dysentery
      ameba, and the infectious  hepatitis
      virus.

   2  Interference types include  taste and
      odor organisms, filter-clogging
      organisms,  pipe-infesting organisms,
      and others.
 B Water treatment practices are closely
   associated with these organisms.

   1  For pathogens, practices include
      coliform tests, use of chlorine,  and
      guarding the water supply against fecal
      pollution.

   2  For interference organisms,  practices
      include plankton enumeration, use of
      copper sulfate and the covering of
      reserviors.

   3  Many of the other treatment practices
      have significant effects on the organisms.
B  At Indianapolis,  copepods were present in
   parts of the distribution system in numbers
   sufficient to be visible in the drinking
   water.  The eggs of the copepods were
   found to pass through the filters and to
   hatch in the distribution system.


C  At Oklahoma City, prominent earthy  odors
   have appeared frequently.  The organisms
   blamed for this trouble are the mold-like
   actinomycetes.

D  At Peoria,  white wigglers  up to 3/8"  long
   were  reported in the tap water,  during
   early March,  1956.  These chironomid
   larvae had  hatched in the city's open
   reservoir,  requiring that the reservoir be
   drained,  cleaned and treated with a larvicide.

E  At Chicago, diatoms are a very important
   cause of short filter runs.  The one diatom
   Tabellaria is considered to be more
   responsible than any other organism  for
   this trouble.
   In Ontario, the alga Cladophora often
   grows in large numbers attached to rocks
   on the shoreline of lakes.  When the alga
   is broken loose it collects  near the shore-
   line and gives rise to very offensive odors.
    This discussion will be limited to the inter-
    ference organisms.
II   EXAMPLES OF PROBLEMS CAUSED BY
    INTERFERENCE ORGANISMS

 A  At Chicago,  the alga Dinobryon reappears
    almost every year,  generally in June and
    July in numbers  sufficient to impart a
    prominent fishy odor to the water.  In
    1951,  it required an estimated $70, 500
    worth of activated carbon to control the odor
    of this organism for a period of two months.
G  In a water supply impoundment in Utah the
   plankton algae frequently cause the pH of
   the water to increase to  8. 3 or higher,
   requiring that the water  be treated  with
   acid to obtain the desired pH of 8 or lower.

H  In Texas a water supply  from underground
   sources was  stored in a  large open settling
   basin.  Oscillatoria and  unicellular green
   algae developed in large  numbers in the
   stored  water, turning it  green and pro-
   ducing  a strong odor.

I  Los Angeles  has more than 25 open reser-
   voirs of various sizes and ranging in
   elevation from, almost sea level to over
    BI.MIC. 12c. 6.76
                                                                                      24-1

-------
       Algae and Actinomycetes in Water Supplies
III
       7,000 feet.  Many tons of copper sulfate
       are used every year in these reservoirs
       for rigid control of plankton, chiefly
       diatoms and occassionally blue-green
       algae.  This treatment is carried out to
       improve  the water quality including the
       reduction of tastes and odors.
TYPES OF PROBLEMS CAUSED BY
INTERFERENCE ORGANISMS
 A Tastes and Odors

    1  May be caused by algae, actinomycetes,
       Crustacea, and anaerobic bacteria.

    2  Common algal odors imparted to water
       are ones described as fish,  earthy,
       musty, grassy,  cucumber,  geranium,
       nasturtium, and septic.

    3  Common actinomycete odor is earthy.

    4  Tastes produced in water by algae
       include sweet and bitter.

    5  Other causative  agents of tastes and
       odors may be industrial wastes,  sludge,
       and compounds dissolved from soil and
       rock,  and chemicals used in treatment.
 B Filter Clogging

    1  Both rapid and slow sand filters are
       affected.

    2  Diatoms are the organisms most
       frequently involved but blue-green
       algae,  filamentous  green algae and
       other organisms as well as silt may
       cause it.
  C Other Problems in the Treatment Plant

    1  Algae may cause variation in the pH,
       hardness,  color, and organic  content
       of the water.

    2  Amount of plankton organisms often
       influences the rate and effectiveness
       of coagulation.
     3   Chlorine dosage may depend upon
        amount of plankton organisms present.

     4   Growths of algae may reduce the flow
        through influent channels and screens.

     5   Organisms may be responsible for
        increasing the quantity of sludge to be
        disposed of in sedimentation basins.

     6   Microcrustacea "spot" paper in paper
        mill rolls.
 D  Infestation of Distribution Systems

    1  Attached organisms reduce the rate of
       flow in the pipes.

    2  Iron and sulfur bacteria may initiate
       or stimulate corrosion of pipes.

    3  Organisms may appear as visible
       bodies in tap water.

    4  Tastes and odors may result from
       presence of organisms.

    5  Chlorine residual is difficult to main-
       tain when organic matter is present.

    6  Organisms could theoretically harbor
       and protect  against chlorine certain
       pathogenic bacteria.


 E  Profuse Growths of Organisms in Raw
    Water Supplies

    1  A limited and balanced growth of
       various organisms  is generally an
       asset.

    2  Extensive surface mats, blooms and
       marginal growths often cause troubles
       along the shoreline and eventually in
       the treatment plant.

    3  Some fish kills may be caused by
       profuse growths of  algae by reducing the
     .  DO during the night.

    4  Certain massive growths of blue-green
       algae are deadly poisonous to animals.

IV  ORGANISMS INVOLVED

 A  Animal forms include  protozoa, rotifers,
    crustaceans, worms,  bryozoans, fresh water
     24-2

-------
                                              Algae and Actinomycetes in Water Supplies
    sponges,  water mites and larval stages of
    various insects.

    Plant forms include algae,  actinomycetes
    and other bacteria, molds and larger
    aquatic green plants.
    IMPORTANCE OF BIOLOGICAL
    PROBLEMS

    The increased use of surface water supplies
    increases the problems caused by organ-
    isms.   Biological problems are less
    common with ground water supplies.

    Standards of water quality requested by
    domestic and industrial patrons are rising.

    Procedures for detection, control and
    prevention of problems caused by organisms
    are improving and are receiving more
    extensive use.
VI  A number of methods may be used to
  control the interference organisms or their
  products:

  A Addition to water or an algicide or pesticide
    such as copper sulfate, chlorine dioxide
    or copper-chlorine-ammonia.

  B Mechanical cleaning of distribution lines,
    settling basins,  sand filters,  screens,  and
    reservoir walls.

  C Modification of coagulation, filtration,
    chemical treatment, or location of intake.

  D Use of absorbent,  such as activated
    carbon, for taste and odor substances.

  E Modification of Reservoir to Reduce the
    Opportunities for Massive Growths of
    Algae

    1  By covering treated water reservoir to
       exclude sunlight

    2  By increasing the depth of the water in
       reservoirs
    3  By eliminating shallow marginal areas

    4  By reducing the amount of fertilizing
       nutrients entering the  reservoir.
VII It is generally more satisfactory to
 anticipate and prevent problems due to these
 organisms than it is to cope with them later.


 A Routine biological tests are essential to
    detect the initial development or presence
    of interference organisms.

    1  Control measures can then be used
       before problem becomes acute.

    2  These tests should be applied to the
       raw treatment plant water supply and
       distribution system.


 B In the Reservoir or Other Raw Water Supply

    1  Routine plankton counts should be made
       of water samples from selected loca-
       tions.  Plankton counter should  be
       aware of the particular organisms
       known to be most troublesome.

    2  During the warmer months routine
       surveys of the reservoir, lake or
       stream  should be made to record any
       visible growths of algae and other
       organisms.

    3  Odor  tests of water from  several
       locations should be made  to obtain
       advance notice of potential trouble at
       the treatment plant.

 C In the Treatment Plant

    1  Records of plankton counts and threshold
       odor between each step in treatment
       gives  data on effectiveness of each
       procedure.

    2  Coagulation and  filtration can be
       adjusted to remove up to 95% or more
       of organisms in  water.
                                                                                        24-.S

-------
                  Actinomvcetes in Water Supplies
         Microscopic analysis of samples of
         filter material for organisms can
         supply data useful in modifying sand
         filtration and treatment of finished
         water.
   D  In the Distribution System With Its
      Finished Water

      1  Open reservoirs require constant
        attention especially during summer.

      2  Parts of the system farthest from the
        treatment plant or adjacent to dead
        ends require most frequent sampling
        for organisms and tastes and odors.
VIII   SUMMARY


   A  Interference organisms cause problems
      in distribution systems, treatment plants,
      raw water supplies.

   B  Organisms involved include algae, actino-
      mycetes, other bacteria, and minute
      aquatic animals.

   C  Control is by special chemicals, mechanical
      cleaning, adjustment of chemical or
      mechanical treatment and by  modification
      of reservoirs, intakes,  etc., for the raw
      water supply.

   D  Facilities for detection of problems in
      their early stages are required for  most
      efficient and satisfactory control.
   REFERENCES

   1  Palmer,  C. M.  Algae in Water Supplies.
         An Illustrated Manual on the Identification,
         Significance, and Control of Algae in
         Water Supplies.  U.S. Public Health
         Service Publication No.  657. 1959.
         p.  88.
2  Palmer,  C.M. and Poston, H.W.
      Algae and Other Interference
      Organisms in Indiana Water Supplies.
      Jour.  Amer. Water Works Assn.
      48:1335-1346.   1956.

3  Palmer,  C.M.  Algae and Other Inter-
      ference Organisms in New England
      Water Supplies.  Jour. New England
      Water Works Assn.  72:27-46.  1958.

4  Palmer,  C.M.  Algae and Other Orga-
      nisms in Waters of the Chesapeake
      Area.   Jour. Amer.  Water Works
      Assn.   50:938-950.   1958.

5  Palmer,  C.M.  Algae and Other Inter-
      ference Organisms in the Waters of
      the South Central United States. Jour.
      Amer. Water Works Assn.   52:897-
      914.   1960.

6  Silvey, J.K. and Roach,  A.W.
      Actinomycetes May Cause Tastes
      and Odors in Water Supplies.   Public
      Works 87.   5:103-106,210,212.   1956.

7  Ingram,  W.M. and Bartsch, A.F.
      Operators Identification Guide to
      Animals Associated with Potable
      Water Supplies.  Jour. Amer. Water
      Works Assn.  52:1521-1550.   1960.

8  Otto, N. E. and Bartley,  T.R.   Aquatic
      Pests on Irrigation Systems.
      Identification Guide.   Bur.  of
      Reclamation.   USDI.    72 pp.   1965.

9  Herbst,  Richard P.   Ecological Factors
      and the Distribution of Cladophera
      glomerata in the Great Lakes.
      Amer. Midi. Nat.  82:90-98.   1969.
This outline was prepared by C.M. Palmer,
formerly Aquatic Biologist, In Charge,
Interference Organism Studies,  Microbiology
Activities, Research & Development,
Cincinnati Water Research Laboratory,
FWPCA.
                                                    Descriptors: Algae,
                                                    Actinomycetes
                    Water Supplies,
       24-4

-------
                    Algae and Actinomycetes in Water Supplies
ALGAE  IMPORTANT  IN  WATER  SUPPLIES
            TASTE AND ODOR ALGAE
^•'

£v- • • .
•vV
•'.""*••
• . Y'l
• * \

•'
•,]

*>
I
^
1
Vr .
;*••'
VOLVOX
                  PLATE  I

-------
Algae and Actinomycetes in Water Supplies
                         FILTER CLOGGING ALGAE
                                      CHROOCOCCUS
                                 PLATE 2

-------
        Algae and Actinomycetes in Water Supplies
POLLUTED  WATER ALGAE
        PLATE 3

-------
Algae and Actinomycetes in Water Supplies
                         CLEAN  WATER  ALGAE
                                                             CLADOPHORA
                                PLATE  4

-------
                          Algae and Actinomycetes in Water Supplies
                   SURFACE  WATER ALGAE
STAURONEIS
                          PLATE  5

-------
Algae and Actinomycetes in Water Supplies
               ALGAE  GROWING  ON  RESERVOIR  WALLS
          PHORM1DIUM
                             PLATE 6
  10

-------
                         ALGAE AS INDICATORS OF POLLUTION
 I  LIMITATIONS

 A Algae are only one of a number of types
    of organisms present which could be
    considered.

 B Forms recognized here as algae  are
    comparatively simple, pigmented, aquatic
    organisms,  including blue-greens,  greens,
    diatoms and pigmented flagellates.

 C Various pollutants react differently on
    algae.  Organic pollutants such as house-
    hold sewage will be dealt with here.

 D No algae are intestinal organisms.  They
    therefore are not  indicators of pollution
    in the same way that coliform bacteria
    are.
 B Wastes may have physical effects on
    certain algae.  May cause plasmolysis,
    change in rate of absorption of nutrients,
    etc.

 C Wastes may reduce available light,
    increase the water temperature,  and
    cover up the areas for attachment to
    rocks.

 D Wastes may prevent algal respiration at
    night by reducing the DO of water.

 E Wastes may stimulate other organisms
    at the expense of certain algae.

 F Products  of waste decomposition may
    act as  powerful growth stimulants for
    certain algae.
 II  ALGAE AND ORGANIC POLLUTION

 A Heavy pollution may tend to limit various
    kinds of algae to certain zones in the
    affected area.

 B These zones are distinguished according
    to the degree of change which has
    occurred in the organic wastes. One set
    of names for these zones includes the
    Polysaprobic,  alpha-mesosaprobic, beta-
    mesosaprobic and oligosaprobic. .

 C A  few "pollution" algae are common in
    the first two zones. Many algae are
    common in and often limited to one or
    both of the last two zones.

 D Some workers  have listed separately
    those algae indicative of each of the four
    zones.
Ill  REASONS FOR SELECTIVITY OF
    POLLUTANTS TO ALGAE

 A Certain components of wastes are chemi-
    cals toxic to some algae but not to others.
IV  ALGAE AS INDICATORS OF POLLUTION

 A  Selection of list of "pollution" algae
    follows an evaluation of the kinds re-
    ported in published reports by numerous
    workers as  relatively prominent in, or
    representative of, the polysaprobic and
    alpha-mesosaprobic zones in a stream
    polluted with sewage.  It includes also
    other conditions or areas approximating
    these zones.

 B  A total list of more than 1000 kinds of
    algae has been compiled to date.

    1  In order to tabulate the information,
       an arbitrary numerical value is
       allotted to each author's record of
       each pertinent alga.

    2  The algae are then arranged in order
       of decreasing emphasis by the
       authors as a whole.
  BLIND. lOa. 6. 76
                                                                                  25-1

-------
   Algae as Indicators of Pollution
 VI   SOME GENERA AND SPECIES OF ALGAE
      HIGH ON THE LIST ARE AS FOLLOWS:

   A  Genera: Oscillatoria, Euglena, Navicula,
      Chlorella, Chlamydomonas,  Nitzschia.
      Stigeoclonium, Phormidium,  Scenedesmus,
      Ankistrodesmus, Phacus.

   B  Species:  Euglena viridis,  Nitzschia
      palea, Oscillatoria chlorina,
      Oscillatoria limosa. Oscillatoria tenuis
      Scenedesmus  quadricauda, Stigeoclonium
      tenue. Synedra ulna and Pandorina morum.
 VII   SOME ALGAE REPRESENTATIVE OF
      CLEAN WATER ZONES IN STREAMS:

   Chrysococcus rufescens, Cocconeis
   placentula.  Entophysalis lemaniae, and
   Rhodomonas lacustris.
VIII   RELIABILITY IN USE OF INDICATORS
      DEPENDS IN PART UPON ACCURATE
      IDENTIFICATION OF SPECIMENS

   REPRESENTATIVE LITERATURE

   1   Brinley, F. J.  Biological Studies.   Ohio
         River Pollution Survey.  I.
         Biological Zones in a Polluted Stream.
         II.  Plankton Algae as Indicators of
         the Sanitary Condition of a Stream.
         Sewage Works Journal,  14:147-159.
         1942.

   2   Butcher,  R.W.  Pollution and
         Repurification as Indicated by the
         Algae.  Fourth International
         Congress for Microbiology (held) 1947.
         Report of Proceedings.   1949.

   3   Fjerdingstad,  E.   The Microflora of the
         River Moelleaa with Special Reference
         to the Relation of the Benthal Algae
         to Pollution.   Folia Limnological
         Scandinavia.   No. 5.   1950.

   4   Fjerdingstad,  E.   Taxonomy and Saprobic
         Valency of Benthic Phytomicro-
         Organisms.  Intern. Rev. Ges.
         Hydrobiol.  50:475-604.  1965.
    25-2
 5  Hawkes, H.A.  The Biological Assess-
       ment of Pollution in Birmingham
       Streams.  The Institute of Sewage
       Purification,  Journal and Proceedings.
       177-186.   1956.

 6  Kolkwitz,  R.  Oekologie der Saprobien.
       Schriftenreiche des Vereins fUr
       Wasser-,  Boden-, und Lufthygiene
       Berlin-Dahlem.   Piscator - Verlage,
       Stuttgart.

 7  Lackey, J. B.  The Significance of
       Plankton  in Relation to the Sanitary
       Condition of Streams.  Symposium
       on Hydrobiology.   University of
       Wisconsin.  311-328.   1941.

 8  Liebmann, H.   Handbuch der
       Frischwasser - und Abwasserbiologie.
       R. Oldenbourg, Munchen.

 9  Palmer, C.M.  Algae as Biological
       Indicators of Pollution.   In
       Biological Problems in Water
       Pollution.  Trans,  of 1956 Seminar.
       Robert A. Taft Sanitary Engineering
       Center.   1957.

10  Palmer, C.M.  The Effect of Pollution
       on River Algae.   Annal.  N. Y. Acad.
       Sci.  108:389-395.   1963.

11  Palmer, C.M.  A  Composite Rating of
       Algae Tolerating Organic Pollution.
       Jour. Phycology 5 (l):78-82.   1969.

12  Palmer, C.M.  Algae in Water Supplies
       of the United States. In:  Algae and
       Man,Ch  12, Plenum Press.  N.Y.
       pp. 239-261.   1964.

13  Patrick, R.  Factors Effecting the
       Distribution of Diatoms.   Botanical
       Review.  14:  473-524.  1948.

14  Whipple,  G.C.,  Fair, G.M. and
       Whipple,  M.C.   The Microscopy of
       Drinking  Water,  4th ed.  J. Wiley
       and Sons.   New  York.   1948.

 This outline was prepared by C.M. Palmer,
 Aquatic Biologist, Cincinnati Water Research
 Laboratory, FWPCA.

'Descriptors: Bioindicators,  Algae

-------
                              Algae as indicators ol .Pollution
       POLLUTED  WATER  ALGAE
PHORMIDIUM
                PLATE  3

-------
Algae as Indicators of Pollution
                       CLEAN  WATER ALGAE
                                                              CLADOPHORA
                                PLATE  4

-------
                   ODOR PRODUCTION BY ALGAE AND OTHER ORGANISMS
 I  Most biological odors present in our water
 supplies are derived from algae, actinomycetes,
 and bacteria.

 A  The  odor produced by algae and actino-
    mycetes is generally the result of
    intracellular metabolic activity while
    the odor caused by bacteria usually
    results from extracellular enzymatic
    activity upon other organisms.

 B  The  odors produced by actinomycetes are
    usually earthy while those produced by the
    algae are aromatic, grassy,  and fishy.
 H  SOME SPECIES OF ALGAE CAUSING
    ODORS

 A Diatoms

    1  Asterionella (aromatic, fish)

    2  Cyclotella (aromatic)

 B Pigmented Flagellates

    1  Synura (cucumber)

    2  Dinobryon (fishy)

 C Blue-green Algae

    1  Anabaena (grassy, green corn,
       nasturtium)

    2  Aphanizomenon (grassy,  nasturtium)

 D Green Algae

    1  Chlorococcum (grassy)


IE  RESEARCH ON A LGAE ODORS

 A Growing Algae for Odor Research

    1  Obtaining unialgal bacteria-free
       cultures
       a  Plating out on semi-solid medium

       b  Single cell isolation

       c  Use of antibiotics

       d  Exposure to ultra-violet light

    2  Determining nutritional requirements

       a  Inorganic salts

       b  Organic growth factors

  B Methods of extracting odoriferous
    material from algal cultures

    1  Distillation - steam and vacuum

    2  Solvent extraction

    3  Use of ion exchange resins

    4  Freeze out methods

  C Some Results of Research

    1  Effect of culture age upon odor
       production

    2  Effect of pH on odor intensity

    3  Comparison of odor intensity in intact
       and broken cells

    4  Groups of chemicals which may be
       responsible for causing algal odors


IV  RESEARCH ON ACTINOMYCETE ODORS

  A A number of actinomycetes were isolated .
    from water and muds  of rivers and lakes.
  BI. MIC. to. lOc.6. 76
                                                                                     26-1

-------
Odor Production by Algae^ and Other Organisms
      1  Large numbers were found to
        be present in muds, while there
        were relatively few in the water.

      2  Most species belonged to the
        Streptomyces and a few to the
        Micromonospora.

   B  Extraction of Odoriferous Material

      1  Streptomy_ces griseqluteus was
        used in this work.

        a  Cultured in a defined medium

           (1) Cultures have threshhold
               odor of 20, 000 to 50, 000

      2  Primary extraction was by
        distilling the culture at 100 C
        at atmospheric pressure.

        a  Distillation of 10% of the
           culture volume resulted
           in 90% odor removal.

      3  Odor was further concentrated
        by two methods

        a  Ether extraction of the
           distilling off of the ether
           in vacuo.

           (1) Resulted in yellowish
               brown concentrate
               having a threshold odor
               of approximately 6 billion.

        b  'Absorption on activated carbon
           followed by elution of material
           with chloroform

   C  Effect of Activated Carbon in Re-
      moving the  Earthy Odor
      1  The odor is practically elimi-
        nated by 10 ppm carbon.

   D  Effect of Chlorine on Odor

      1  Chlorine does not eliminate
        the odor but does not intensify
        the odor.

   E  Soil perfusion Tests

      1  Conducted  to determine the
        extent to which actinomycetes
        impart odors to a water environ-
        ment.
REFERENCES

1  Fogg, G.E.,  "The Metabolism of
      Algae", John Wiley and Sons, Inc.,
      New York, N.  Y., 1953.

2  Fox, Leo, "Microscopic Organisms
      in Drinking Water", Taste and Odor
      Journal, Vol. 19, No. 10, 1953.

3  Palmer,  C. M., and Tarzwell, C. M.,
      "Algae of Importance in Water
      Supplies",  Public Works Magazine,
      1955.

4  Whipple,  G.  C., Fair, G. M., and
      Whipale, M. C.,  "The Microscopy
      of Drinking Water", Fourth Edition,
      John Wiley and Sons, Inc.,  New York,
      N.Y., 1948.
This outline was prepared by T. E. Maloney,
Former Research Biologist, Aquatic Biology
Activities, Research and Development,
Cincinnati Water Research Laboratory,  FWPCA.

Descriptor: Odor Producing Algae-
 26-2

-------
                            PLANKTON IN OLIGOTROPHIC LAKES
  I  INTRODUCTION

  The term oligotrophic was taken from the
  Greek words oligos --  small and trophein --
  to nourish,  meaning poor  in nutrients.
  Lakes with  low nutrient levels have low
  standing crops of plankton.  The term is now
  commonly applied to any water which has a
  low  productivity,  regardless of the reason.
 II  PHYSICAL AND CHEMICAL CHARACTER-
    ISTICS OF OLIGOTROPHIC LAKES*

 A Very deep; high volume to surface ratio

 B Thermal stratification common; volume
    of the hypolimnium large compared to the
    volume of the epilimnion

 C Maximum  surface temperature rarely
    greater than 15° C

 D Low concentrations of dissolved minerals
    and organic matter.

    1  Phosphorus, less than 1 microgram
       per liter

    2  NO -Nitrogen, less than 200 micrograms
       per liter

 E Dissolved oxygen near saturation  from
    surface to  bottom

 F Water very transparent, Secchi disk
    readings of 20-40 meters are common

 G Color dark blue,  blue-green,  or green
III  PLANKTON

 A Quantity

    1  Standing crop very low

       a Ash-free weight of plankton, less
         than 0. 1 mg per liter (compared to
         1 mg per liter or more in eutrophic
         lakes).
        b Chlorophyll, 1 mg per M  or less

        c Cells counts,  less than 500 per ml

   2 Zooplankton to phytoplankton volume
     ratio,  19:1.

B  Quality

   1 European biologists have found
     oligotrophic lakes to be dominated by
     Chlorophyta (usually desmids),
     chrysophyta (such as Dinobryon), and  •'
     Diatomaceae (Cyclotella and Tabellaria).
     Eutrophic lakes are dominated by
     Synedea, Fragilaria, Asterionella,
     Melosira, blue-green algae, Ceratium,
     and Pediastrum.  Nygaard devised
     several phytoplankton quotients based
     on these relationships

     a  Simple quotient

        Number of species of

     Chlorococcales _ if <1,  oligotrophic
     Desmidiaceae     if > 1, eutrophic

     b  Compound index


     Myxophyceae+Chlorococcales+Centrales+Eugleniaceae
                     Desmidiaceae

        if <1,  oligotrophic

        if 1-2.5,  mesotrophic

        if > 2. 5, eutrophic

     c  Diatom quotient
   Centrales _ if 0-0.2,  oligotrophic
   Pennales   if 0.2-3.0,  eutrophic
   BI. ECO. mic. 2. 6.76
                                                                                    27-1

-------
Plankton in Oligotrophic Lakes
   2 Several lists of trophic indicators have
     been published:
     Two are listed here
               Teiling,
               Swedish Lakes
                                   Rawson,
                                   Canadian Lakes
      Oligotrophic    Tabelleria flocculosa
                     Dactylococcopsis
                        ellipsbideus
      Mesotrophic    Kirchneriella lunaris
                     Tetraeadon spp.
                     Pediastrum spp.
                     Fragilaria crotonensis
                     Attheya zachariasii
                     Melosira granulata
      Eutrophic
      Pronounced
        Eutrophy
Aphanizomenon spp.
Anabaena flos-aquae
Anabaena circinalis

Microcystis aeruginosa
Microcystis viridis
                           Oligotrophic   Asterionella formosa
                                          Melosira islandica*
                                                Mesotrophic
                                          Tabellaria fenestrata
                                          Tabellaria flocculosa
                                          Dinobryon divergens
                                          Fragilaria capucina
                                          Stephanodiscus niagarae
                                          Staurastrum spp.
                                          Melosira granulata
Fragilaria crotonensis
Ceratium hirundinella
                                                               Pediastrum boryanum
                                                               Pediastrum duplex
Coelosphaerium
  naegelianum
Anabaena spp.
Aphanizomenon flos-aquae
Microcystis aeruginosa
                                                Eutrophic
                                          Microcystis flos-aquae
  2*7-2

-------
                                                        Plankton in Oligotrophic Lakes
Some discrepancies can be seen in the
ranking of species in the lists.  These
may be the result of true differences in
the composition of the plankton, or may
be only apparent differences which
resulted from different sampling methods.
Many studies (e.g. those by Hilliard,
Olive, and Rawson) have been based on
netted samples, which may be highly
biased because they contain little of the
nannoplankton.  Also, it is not uncommon
to characterize populations on the basis
of one or two samples collected during
the summer months.

The dominant plankton in four
oligotrophic North American lakes are
listed below.  The Great Slave Lake
and Karluk Lake data are from netted
samples taken during the summer, and
monthly, respectively.  The  Lake
Superior and Lake Tahoe data are from
grab samples taken twice monthly, and
quarterly, respectively.
The dominant diatoms are generally
similar in the four lakes. Asterionella
formosa and Fragilaria crotonensis
are common to all.  There are also
some obvious differences. Melosira
islandica, the dominant diatom in the
Great Slave Lake and Lake Superior,
is absent from Lake Tahoe and Karluk
Lake.  It was not found in Crater Lake
by Sovereign (1958), in the Mountain
lakes of Colorado by Olive (1955) or
Brinley (1950), and does not occur  in
WPSS samples in streams west of the
Great Lakes.  Tabellaria is also
absent from Lake Tahoe.  It was
reported in Colorado lakes by Olive,
but was not abundant.  Brinley makes
no reference to it, and Sovereign
indicated that it was rare in Crater
Lake samples. It is apparent that the
absence of these two diatoms from
Lake Tahoe is not related to the lake.

Except for the absence of Keratella
cochlearis from Lake Tahoe,  the
rotifer populations are very similar.
Data on other segments of the zoo-
plankton population are insufficient  to
permit comparison.
                                                                               27-3

-------
to
-j
 i
Dominant
Phytoplankton
Rawson,
Great Slave Lake
Melosira islandica
Asterionella formosa
Dinobryon divergens
Ceratium hirundinella
Pediastrum boryanum
Tabellaria fenestrata
Cyclotella meneghiniana
Fragilaria crotonensis
Fragilaria capucina
Synedra ulna
Eunotia lunaris
USPHS,
Lake Superior
Melosira islandica
Tabellaria fenestrata
Cyclotella kutzingiana
Melosira granulata
Melosira ambigua
Asterionella formosa
Synedra nana
Scenedesmus spp.
Ankistrodesmus spp.
Dictyosphaerium spp.

Billiard,
Karluk Lake
Asterionella formosa
Tabellaria flocculosa
Fragilaria crotonensis
Cyclotella bodanica
Cymbella turglda
Dictyosphaerium spp.
Sphaerocystis spp.
Staurastrum spp.

WPSS,
Lake Tahoe
Fragilaria crotonensis
Synedra nana
Fragilaria construens
Fragilaria pinnata
Nitzschia acicularis
Asterionella formosa

                                                                                                                                     I*
                                                                                                                                     <-*•
                                                                                                                                     o
                                                                                                                                     5'
                                                                                                                                     O
                                                                                                                                     i—'
                                                                                                                                     
-------
                                                          Plankton in Oligotrophic Lakes
REFERENCES

1 Brinley, F.J.  1950.  Plankton population
     of certain lakes and streams in the
     Rocky Mountain National Park,
     Colorado.  Ohio J. Sci. 50:243-250.

2 Milliard, O.K., 1959.  Notes on the
     phytoplankton of Karluk Lake,  Kodiak
     Island, Alaska. Canadian Field-
     Naturalist 43:135-143.

3 Jarnefelt, H.,  1952.   Plankton als
     Indikator der Trophiegruppen der seen.
     Ann. Acad.  Sci. Fennicae A. IV: 1-29.

4 Knudson, B.M.,  1955. The distribution of
     Tabellaria in the English  Lake District.
     Proc. Int. Assoc.  Limnol. 12:216-218.

5 Nygaard, G.,  1949.  Hydrobiological studies
     in some  ponds  and lakes II.  The
     quotient  hypothesis and some new or
     little known phytoplankton organisms.
     Klg. Danske Vidensk.  Selsk.  Biol.
     Skrifter  7:1-293.

6 Olive, J.R., 1955. Some aspects of
     plankton associations in the high
     mountains lakes of Colorado.   Proc.
     Int. Assoc.  Limnol. 12:425-435.

7 Rawson, D.S., 1953. The standing crop
     of net plankton in  lakes.  J. Fish. Res.
     Bd.  Can. 10:224-237.
8  Rawson, D. S.,  1956.
     Great Slave Lake.
     Can.  13:53-127.
The net plankton of
J. Fish.  Res. Bd.
                         9 Rawson, D.S.,  1956.  Algal indicators
                              of trophic lake types.  Limnol.
                              Oceanogr.   1:18-25.

                        10 Rodhe,  W., 1948.  Environmental
                              requirements of fresh-water plankton
                              algae.  Symb. Bot. Upsal. 10:1-149.

                        11 Ruttner, F.,  1953.  Fundamentals of
                              Limnology, 2nd ed., Univ. Toronto
                              Press,  Toronto.

                        12 Sovereign, H.E., 1958.  The diatoms of
                              Crater  Lake,  Oregon.  Trans. Amer.
                              Microsc.   Soc.  77:96-134.

                        13 Teiling, E.,  1955.  Some mesotrophic
                              phytoplankton indicators.  Proc.  Int.
                              Assoc.  Limnol. 12:212-215.

                        14 USPHS,  1962. National Water Quality
                              Network, Annual Compilation of Data,
                              PHS Publ.  No. 663.

                        15 Welch,  P.S.,  1952.  Limnology,  2nd ed.,
                              McGraw Hill Book Co.,  New York.
This outline was prepared by C.I. Weber,
Chief,  Biological Methods Section,
Analytical Quality Control Laboratory,
NERCt EPA,. Cincinnati,  OH  45268.

Descriptors: Oligotrophy, Plankton
                                                                                     27-5

-------
                  BIOLOGICAL INTEGRITY OF STREAM COMMUNITIES
 I  BENTHOS ARE ORGANISMS GROWING
    ON OR ASSOCIATED PRINCIPALLY
    WITH THE BOTTOM OF WATERWAYS

    Benthos is the noun.

    Benthonic, benthal and benthic are
    adjectives.

 II  THE BENTHIC COMMUNITY

 A  Composed of a wide variety of life
    forms that are related because they
    occupy "common ground"--the water-
    ways bottom substrates.  Usually
    they are attached or have relatively
    weak powers of locomotion. These
    life  forms are:

    1 Bacteria

       A wide variety of decomposers work
       on organic materials, breaking them
       down to elemental or simple com-
       pounds (heterotrophic).   Other forms
       grow on basic nutrient compounds or
       form more complex chemical com-
       pounds (autotrophic).

    2 Algae

       Photosynthetic plants having no true
       roots,  stems, and leaves.  The basic
       producers of food that nurtures the
       bacterial and animal components of
       the community.
    3 Flowering Aquatic Plants (Pondweeds)

       The largest flora, composed of
       complex and differentiated tis.sues.
       May be emersed, floating, sub-
       mersed according to habit.
    4 Microfauna

       Animals that pass through a U. S.
       Standard Series  No. 30  sieve, but
       are retained on a No. 100 sieve.
       Examples are rotifers and micro-
       crustaceans.  Some forms have
       organs for attachment to substrates,
       while others burrow into soft  materials
       or occupy the interstices between rocks,
       floral or faunal  materials.
   5  Meiofauna

      Meiofauna occupy the interstitial zone
      (like between sand grains) in benthic
      and hyporheic habitats.  They are inter-
      mediate in size between the microfauna
      (protozoa and rotifers) and the macro-
      fauna (insects, etc.).  They pass a No. 30
      sieve (0. 5 mm approximately).  In fresh-
      water they include nematodes, copepods,
      tardigrades, naiad worms, and flat worms.
      They are usually ignored in freshwater studies,
      since they pass the standard sieve and/or
      sampling devices.

   6  Macrofauna (macroinvertebrates)

      Animals that are retained on a No. 30 mesh
      sieve (0. 5 mm approximately).  This group
      includes the insects, worms, molluscs, and
      occasionally fish.  Fish are not normally
      considered as benthos, though there are bottom
      dwellers such as sculpins and darters.

B  It is a  self-contained community, though there
   is  interchange with other communities.  For
   example:  Plankton settles to it, fish prey on
   it and lay their eggs there, terrestrial detritus
   leaves are  added to it, and many aquatic insects
   migrate from it to the terrestrial environment
   for their mating cycles.

C  It is a  stationary water quality monitor.  The
   low mobility of the biotic components requires
   that they "live with" the quality changes of the
   over-passing waters.  Changes imposed in the
   long-lived components remain visible for
   extended periods, even after the cause has
   been eliminated.  Only time will allow  a cure
   for the community by drift,  reproduction, and  re-
   cruitment from the hyporheic zone.

D  Between the benthic zone (substrate/water
   interface)  and the underground water table
   is  the hyporheic zone.   There is considerable
   interchange from one zone to another.

Ill  HISTORY OF BENTHIC OBSERVATIONS

A  Ancient literature records the vermin associ-
   ated with fouled waters.
BI.MET. fm. 8g. 6.76
                                                                                  28-1

-------
 Biological Integrity of Stream Communities
B  500 -year- old fishing literature refers
    to animal forms that are fish food and
    used as bait.

C   The scientific literature associating
    biota to water pollution problems is
    over 100 years old (Mackenthun and
    Ingram,  1964).

D  Early this century,  applied biological
    investigations were initiated.

    1  The entrance of state boards of health
      into water pollution control activities.

    2  Creation of state conservation agencies.

    3  Industrialization  and urbanization.

    4  Growth of limnological programs
      at universities.

E  A decided increase  in benthic  studies
    occurred in the 1950 decade, and much
    of today's activities are strongly influenced
    by developmental work conducted during
    this period.  Some of the reasons for this
    are:

    1  Movement of the  universities from
      "academic biology" to applied
      pollution programs.

    2  Entrance of the federal government
      into enforcement aspects of water
      pollution  control.

    3  A rising economy and the development
      of federal grant systems.

    4  Environmental Protection Programs
      are a current stimulus.

IV  WHY THE BENTHOS?

A  It is a natural monitor

B  The community contains all of the
    components of an ecosystem.

    1  Reducers

    2  Producers
   3  Consumers

      a  Detritivores and bacterial feeders

      b  Herbivores

      c  Predators

 C  Economy of Survey

    1 Manpower

    2 Time

    3 Equipment

 D  Extensive Supporting Literature

 E  Advantages of the Macrobenthos

    1 Relatively sessile

    2 Life history length

    3 Fish food organisms

    4 Reliability of Sampling

    5 Dollars/information

    6 Predictability

    7 Universality

F  "For subtle chemical changes,
   unequivocal data, and observations
   suited to some statistical evaluation will
   be needed. This requirement favors the
   macrofauna as a parameter.  Macro-
   invertebrates are easier to sample
   reproductively than other organisms,
   numerical estimates are possible and
   taxonomy needed for synoptic investi-
   gations is within the reach of a non-
   specialist. "
G  "It is self-evident that for a multitude of
   non-identifiable though biologically active
   changes of chemical conditions in rivers,
   small organisms  with high physiological
   differentiation are most responsive.
   Thus the small macroinvertebrates
   (e.g.  insects) are doubtlessly the most
   sensitive organisms for demonstrating
  28-2

-------
                                             Biological Integrity of Stream Communities
  unspecified changes of water
  chemistry called  'pollution' .
  Progress in knowledge on useful
  autecological properties of
  organisms or of transfer of such
  knowledge into bioassay practice
  has been very small in the past.
  Thus,  the bioassay  concept
  (relation of organisms  in a
  stream to water quality)  in
  water  chemistry has brought not
  much more than visual demon-
  stration of a few overall  chemical
  effects.  Our capability to derive
  chemical conditions from biological
  observations is, therefore,  almost
  on the same level as fifty years ago.
  In the author's opinion it is idle.to
  expect much more in the future because
  of the limitations  inherent to natural bio-
  assay systems (relation of organisms
  in a stream to water quality)."


V  REACTIONS OF THE BENTHIC MACRO-
  INVERTEBRATE COMMUNITY TO
   PERTURBATION

A  Destruction of Organism Types

   1  Beginning with the most sensitive
      forms, pollutants kill in  order of
      sensitivity until the most tolerant form
      is  the last survivor.  This results in a
      reduction of variety or diversity of
      organisms.

   2  The generalized order of macro-
      invertebrate disappearance on a
      sensitivity scale below pollution
      sources is shown in Figure 2.
Water
Quality
Deteriorating



>
Stoneflies *
Mayflies
Caddis flies
Amphipods
Isopods
Midges
r Oligochaetes
Vater
Duality
improving




      As water quality improves, these
      tend to reappear in the same order.

B   The Number of Survivors Increase

    1  Competition and predation are reduced
      between forms.

    2  When the pollutant is a food (plants,
      fertilizers,  animals, organic materials).

C   The Number of Survivors Decrease

    1  The material added is toxic or has no
      food value.

    2  The material added produces toxic
      conditions as a byproduct of decom-
      position (e.g., large organic loadings
      produce an anaerobic environment
      resulting in the  production of toxic
      sulfides, methanes, etc.)

D   The Effects May be Manifest in Com-
    binations

    1  Of pollutants and their effects.

    2  Vary  with longitudinal distribution
      in a stream.  (Figure 1)

E   Tolerance to Enrichment Grouping
    (Figure  2)

    Flexibility must be maintained in the
    establishment  of tolerance lists based
    on the response of organisms to the
    environment because  of complex relation-
    ships among varying environmental
    conditions.  Some  general tolerance
    patterns can be established.  Stonefly
    and  mayfly nymphs, hellgrammites,
    and caddisfly larvae represent a grouping
    (sensitive or intolerant) that is generally
    quite sensitive to environmental
    changes. Blackfly larvae,  scuds, sow-
    bugs,  snails, fingernail clams,  dragon-
    fly and damselfly naiads, and most
    kinds of midge larvae are facultative
    (or intermediate)  in  tolerance.
    Sludge-worms, some  kinds of midge
    larvae (bloodworms),  and some leeches
                                                                                   28-3

-------
Biological Integrity of Stream Communities
                   TIME OR DISTANCE
      	.NUMBER OF  KINDS
      	.NUMBER OF  ORGANISMS
            SLUDGE DEPOSITS

       Four basic responses of bottom animals to pollution.
 A. Organic wastes eliminate the sensitive bottom animals
 and provide food in the form of sludges for the surviving toler-
 ant forms. B. Large quantities of decomposing organic wastes
 eliminate sensitive bottom animals and the excessive quanti-
 ties of byproducts of organic decomposition inhibit the tolerant
 forms; in time, with natural stream purification, water quality
 improves so that the tolerant forms can flourish, utilizing the
 sludges  as food. C.  Toxic  materials eliminate the sensitive
 bottom animals; sludge is absent and food is restricted to that
 naturally occurring in the stream, which limits the number of
 tolerant  surviving forms. Very toxic materials may eliminate
 all organisms below  a waste source. D. Organic sludges with
 toxic materials reduce the number of kinds  by  eliminating
 sensitive forms. Tolerant survivors do not utilize the .organic
 sludges  because the toxicity restricts their growth. •
                       Figure 1
    are tolerant to comparatively heavy loads
    of organic pollutants.  Sewage mosquitoes
    and rat-tailed maggots are tolerant of
    anaerobic environments.

F   Structural Limitations

    1  The morphological structure of a
       species limits the type of environment
       it may occupy.

       a  Species with complex appendages
         and exposed  complicated respiratory
         structures, such as stonefly
         nymphs, mayfly nymphs, and
         caddisfly larvae, that are  subjected
         to a constant deluge of setteable
         particulate matter soon abandon
         the polluted area because of the
         constant preening required to main-
         tain mobility or respiratory func-
         tions; otherwise, they are soon
         smothered.

       b Benthic animals in depositing zones
         may also be  burdened by "sewage
         fungus" growths including stalked
         protozoans.  Many of these stalked
         protozoans are host specific.

     2  Species without complicated  external
       structures,  such as bloodworms and
       sludgeworms,  are not so limited in
       adaptability.

       a  A sludgeworm,  for example, can
          burrow in a deluge of particulate
          organic matter and flourish on the
          abundance of "manna. "

       b  Morphology  also determines the
          species that are found in riffles, on
          vegetation, on the bottom  of pools,
          or in bottom deposits.
 28-4

-------
                                               Biological Integrity of Stream Communities
VI  SAMPLING PROCEDURES

A   Fauna

    1  Qualitative sampling determines the
       variety of species occupying an area.
       Samples may be taken by any method
       that will capture representatives of the
       species present.   Collections from
       such samplings indicate  changes in the
       environment, but generally do not
       accurately reflect the degree of change.
       Mayflies, for example, may be re-
       duced from 100 to 1 per  square meter.
       Qualitative data would indicate the
       presence of both species, but might not
       necessarily delineate the change in pre-
       dominance from mayflies to sludge-
       worms.  The stop net or kick sampling
       technique is often  used.

    2  Quantitative sampling is performed to
       observe changes in predominance.
       The most common quantitative sampling
       tools are the Petersen and Ekman grabs
       and the  Surber stream bottom or square-
       foot sampler.  Of  these, the Petersen
       grab samples the widest variety of sub-
       strates. The Ekman grab is limited to
       fine-textured and soft substrates,  such
       as silt and sludge, unless hydraulically
       operated.
                                              The Surber sampler is designed for
                                              sampling riffle areas; it requires
                                              moving water to transport dislodged
                                              organisms into its net and is limited
                                              to depths of two feet or less.

                                              Kick samples of one minute duration will
                                              usually yield around 1, 000  macroinvert-
                                              ebrates per square meter (10. 5 X a one
                                              minute kick=  organisms/m^).

                                           3  Manipulated substrates (often referred to
                                              as "artificial substrates") are
                                              placed in a stream and left for a specific
                                              time period.  Benthic macroinvertebrates
                                              readily colonize these forming a manipu-
                                              lated community.  Substrates may be con-
                                              structed of natural materials or synthetic;
                                              may be placed in a natural  situation or
                                              unnatural; and may or may not resemble
                                              the normal stream community.   The
                                              point being that a great number of envi-
                                              ronmental variables are standardized and
                                              thus upstream and downstream  stations
                                              may be legitimately compared in terms of
                                              water quality  of the moving water column.
                                              They naturally do not evaluate what may
                                              or may not be happening to  the substrate
                                              beneath said monitor.   The latter could
                                              easily be the more important.
    A
    B
    C

    D
    E
    F
    G
    H
              REPRESENTATIVE BOTTOM-DWELLING MACROANIMALS

          Drawings from Geckler, J., K. M. Mackenthun and W.M. Ingram,  1963.
          Glossary of Commonly Used Biological and Related Terms in Water and
          Waste Water Control, DHEW, PHS, Cincinnati, Ohio, Pub. No. 999-WP-2.
Stonefly nymph   (Plecoptera)          I
Mayfly nymph    (Ephemeroptera)      J
Hellgrammite or                      K
 Dobsonfly larvae (Megaloptera)        L
Caddisfly larvae (Trichoptera)
Black fly larvae  (Simuliidae)          M
Scud             (Amphipoda)          N
Aquatic sowbug   (Isopoda)             O
Snail            (Gastropoda)         P
Fingernail clam   (Sphaeriidae)
Damselfly naiad   (Zygoptera)
Dragonfly naiad   (Anisoptera)
Bloodworm or midge
fly larvae
Leech
Sludgeworm
Sewage fly larvae
Rat -tailed maggot
                                    KEY  TO FIGURE 2
(Chironomidae)
(Hirudinea)
(Tubificidae)
(Psyehodidae)
(Tubifera-Eristalis)
                                                                                  28-5

-------
 Biological Integrity of Stream r^n
                            \
                              B        ^ C
                               SENSITIVE

                          F             G
                           INTERMEDIATE
H
             M
                              TOLERANT
28-6

-------
                                       Biological Integrity of Stream Communities
 Invertebrates which are part of the
 benthos,  but under  certain conditions
 become carried downstream in
 appreciable numbers,  are known as
 Drift.,

 Groups which  have members forming
 a conspicuous part  of the  drift
 include the insect orders  Ephemeroptera,
 Trichoptera,  Plecoptera and the
 crustacean order Amphipoda.

 Drift net studies are widely used and
 have a proven validity in stream
 water quality studies.

 The collected sample is screened with
 a standard sieve to concentrate the
 organisms; these are sorted from
 the retained material, and the number
 of each kind determined.  Data are then
 adjusted to number per unit area,
 usually to number of bottom organisms
 per square meter.

 Independently, neither qualitative not
 quantitative data suffice for thorough
 analyses of environmental conditions.
 A cursory examination to detect damage
 may be made with either method,  but
 a combination of the two gives a more
 precise determination. If a choice must
 be made, quantitative sampling would
 be best, because it  incorporates a
 partial qualitative sample.

 Studies have shown that a  significant
 number and variety  of macroinverte-
brates inhabit the hyporheic zone in streams.
 As much as 80% of the macroinverte-
 brates may be below 5 cm  in this
hyporheic zone.   Most samples and
 sampling techniques do not penetrate
 the substrate below  the 5 cm  depth.
 All quantitative studies must take this
 and other substrate  factors into account
 when absolute figures  are  presented on
 standing crop and numbers per square
 meter, etc.
                                               Flora
      Direct quantitative sampling of natu-
       rally growing bottom algae is difficult.
       It is basically one of collecting algae
       from a standard or uniform area of the
       bottom substrates without disturbing
       the delicate growths and thereby dis-
       tort the sample.  Indirect quantitative
       sampling is the best available method.

       Manipulated substrates, such as wood
       blocks,  glass or plexiglass slides,
       bricks,  etc., are placed in a stream.
       Bottom-attached algae will grow on
       these artificial substrates.  After two
       or more weeks,  the artificial sub-
       strates  are removed for analysis.
       Algal growths are scraped from the
       substrates  and the quantity measured.
       Since the exposed substrate area and
       exposure periods are equal at all of
       the sampling sites, differences in the
       quantity of  algae can be related to
       changes in  the quality of water flowing
       over the substrates.
VII ANALYSES OF MICROFLORA

    A  Enumeration

       1  The quantity of algae on manipulated
          substrates can be measured in several
          ways.   Microscopic counts of algal
          cells and dry weight of a algal mater-
          ial are long established methods.

       2  Microscopic counts involve thorough
          scraping, mixing and  suspension of
          the algal cells.  From this mixture
          an aliquot of cells is withdrawn for
          enumeration under a microscope.
          Dry weight is determined by  drying
          and weighing the algal sample, then
          igniting the sample to burn off the
          algal materials, leaving inert inorganic
          materials that are again weighed.
          The difference between initial weight
          and weight after ignition is attributed
          to algae.

       3  Any organic sediments, however,
          that settle on  the substrate along
          with the algae are processed also.
                                                                            28-7

-------
 Biological Integrity of Stream Communities
    Thus,  if organic wastes are present
    appreciable errors may enter into
    this method.

B   Chlorophyll Analysis

    1  During the past decade,  chlorophyll
       analysis has become a popular method
       for estimating  algal growth.   Chloro-
       phyll is extracted from the algae and
       is used as an index of the quantity of
       algae present.  The advantages of
       chlorophyll analysis are rapidity,
       simplicity, and vivid pictorial results.

    2  The algae are  scrubbed from the
       artificial substrate samples,  ground,
       then each sample is steeped in equal
       volumes, 90%  aqueous acetone, which
       extracts the chlorophyll from the algal
       cells.  The chlorophyll extracts may
       be compared visually.

     3 Because the cholorophyll extracts fade
       with time, colorimetry should be used
        for permanent records.  For routine
        records, simple colorimeters will
        suffice.  At very high cholorophyll
        densities, interference with colori-
        metry occurs, which must be corrected
        through serial dilution of the sample
        or with a nomograph.
C   Autotrophic Index

    The chlorophyll content of the periphytoii
    is used to estimate  the algal biomass and
    as an indicator of the nutrient content
    (or trophic Status) or toxicity of the water
    and the taxonomic composition of the
    community.  Periphyton growing in sur-
    face water relatively free of organic
    pollution consists largely of algae,
    which contain approximately 1 to 2 percent
    chlorophyll a by dry weight.  If dissolved
    or particulate organic  matter is present
    in high concentrations,  large populations
    of filamentous bacteria,  stalked protozoa,
    and other nonchlorophyll bearing micro-
    organisms develop and the percentage
     of chlorophyll is  then reduced.   If the
    biomass-chlorophyll a relationship
     is expressed as a ration (the autotro-
     phic index), values  greater than 100
     may result from  organic pollution
     (Weber and McFarland, 1969; Weber,
     1973).
      ...   , .  ,  ,      Ash-free Wgt (mg/m )
     Autotrophic Index = -=-:	  • .6 ;—^j- o'
                         Chlorophyll a (mg/m^)
VIII  MACROINVERTEBRATE ANALYSES

  A  Taxonomic

     The taxonomic level to which animals are
     identified depends on the needs,  experience,
     and available resources. However, the
     taxonomic level to which identifications are
     carried in each major group should be
     constant throughout a given study.

  B  Biomass

     Macroinvertebrate biomass (weight of
     organisms per unit area) is a useful
     quantitative estimation of standing crop.

  C  Reporting Units

     Data from quantitative samples may be used
     to obtain:

     1 Total standing crop of individuals,  or
       biomass, or both per unit area or unit
       volume or sample unit, and

     2 Numbers of biomass, or both,  of individual
       taxa per unit area or unit volume or sample
       unit.

     3 Data  from devices sampling a unit area
       of bottom will be reported in grams dry
       weight or ashrfree dry weight per square
       meter (gm/m ),  or numbers of indi-
       viduals per square meter,  or both.

     4 Data  from multiplate samplers will be
       reported in terms of the total  surface
       area  of the plates in grams dry weight
       or ash-free  dry weight or numbers of
       individuals per square meter,  or both.

     5 Data  from rock-filled basket samplers
       will be reported as grams dry weight
       or numbers  of individuals per  sampler,
       or both.
  28-8

-------
                                                 Biological Integrity of Stream Communities
IX  FACTORS INVOLVED IN DATA INTER-
    PRETATION

 Two very important factors in data evalua-
 tion are a thorough knowledge of conditions
 under which the data were collected and a
 critical assessment of the reliability of the
 data's representation of the situation.

 A  Maximum-Minimum Values

    The evaluation of physical and chemical
    data to determine their effects on aquatic
    organisms is primarily dependent on
    maximum and minimum observed values.
    The mean is useful only when the data are
    relatively uniform.  The minimum or
    maximum values usually create acute
    conditions in the environment.

 B  Identification

    Precise identification of organisms to
    species requires a specialist  in limited
    taxonomic groups. Many immature
    aquatic forms have not been associated
    with the adult species.  Therefore, one
    who is certain of the  genus but not the
    species should utilize the generic name,
    not a potentially incorrect species name.
    The method of interpreting biological
    data on the basis of numbers of kinds
    and numbers of organisms will typically
    suffice.

 C  Lake and Stream Influence

    Physical characteristics of a body of
    water also affect animal populations.
    Lakes or impounded  bodies of water
    support different faunal associations
    from rivers.   The number of kinds
    present in a lake may be less than that
    found in a stream because of  a more
    uniform habitat.   A lake is all pool,
    but a river is composed of both pools
    and riffles.  The nonflowing water of
    lake exhibits a more complete set-
    tling of particulate organic matter that
    naturally supports a  higher population
    of detritus consumers.  For these
   reasons, the bottom fauna of a lake or
   impoundment, or stream pool cannot be
   directly compared with that of a flowing
   stream riffle.

D  Extrapolation

   How can bottom-dwelling macrofauna data
   be extrapolated to other environmental
   components?  It must be borne in mind
   that a component of the total environment
   is being sampled. If the sampled com-
   ponent exhibits changes,  then so  must the
   other interdependent components of the
   environment.  For example, a clean stream
   with a wide variety of desirable bottom
   organisms would be expected to have a
   wide variety of desirable bottom  fishes;
   when pollution reduces the number of bottom
   organisms,  a comparable reduction would
   be expected in the number of fishes.  More-
   over, it would be logical to conclude that
   any factor that eliminates all bottom organ-
   isms would eliminate most other aquatic
   forms of life. A clean stream with a wide
   variety of desirable bottom organisms
   would be expected to permit a variety of
   recreational,  municipal and industrial uses.

E  Expression of Data

   1  Standing crop and taxonomic composition

      Standing crop and numbers of  taxa (types
      or kinds) in a community are highly
      sensitive to environmental perturbations
      resulting from the introduction of contam-
      inants.  These parameters, particularly
      standing  crop,  may vary considerably in
      unpolluted habitats, where t hey may range
      from the typically high standing crop of
      littoral zones of glacial lakes  to the
      sparse fauna of torrential soft-water
      streams.  Thus,  it is important that
      comparisons are made only between truly
      comparable environments.
                                                                                 28-9

-------
Biological Integrity of Stream Communities
2  Diversity

   Diversity indices are an additional tool
   for measuring the quality of the environ-
   ment and the effect of induced stress on
   the structure of a community of macro-
   invertebrates.  Their use is based on
   the generally observed phenomenon that
   relatively undisturbed environments
   support communities having large
   numbers of species with no individual
   species present in overwhelming
   abundance.  If the species  in such a
   community are ranked on the basis of
   their numerical abundance, there will
   be relatively few  species with large
   numbers of individuals and large
   numbers of species represented by only
   a few individuals. Many forms of stress
   tend to reduce diversity by making the
   environment unsuitable for some species
   or by giving other species a competitive
   advantage.

3  Indicator-organism scheme (rat-tailed
   maggot studies)

      a  For this technique, the individual
        taxa are classified on the basis of
        their tolerance or intolerance to
        various levels of putrescible  wastes.
        Taxa are classified according to
        their presence or absence of
        different  environments as deter-
        mined by field studies.   Some
        reduce data based on the presence
        or absence  of indicator organisms
        to a simple numerical form for ease
        in presentation.
       /(
      b  Biologists are engaging  in fruit-
        less exercise if they intend to make
        any decisions about indicator
        organisms by operating at the
        generic level of macroinvertebrate
        identifications."

4  Reference station methods

   Comparative or control station methods
   compare the qualitative characteristics
   of the fauna in clean water habitats with
   those of fauna in habitats subject to stress.
   Stations are compared on the basis of
   richness of species.
    If adequate background data are avail-
    able to an experienced investigator,
    these techniques can prove quite useful—
    particularly for the purpose of demon-
    strating the effects of gross to moderate
    organic contamination on the macro-
    invertebrate community.  To detect
    more subtle changes in the macroinver-
    tebrate community, collect quantitative
    data on numbers or biomass of organisms.
    Data on the presence of tolerant and
    intolerant taxa and richness of species
    may be effectively summarized for evalu-
    ation and presentation by means of line
    graphs, bar graphs, pie diagrams,
    histograms, or pictoral diagrams.

 X  IMPORTANT ASSOCIATED ANALYSES

 A  The Chemical Environment

    1  Dissolved oxygen

    2  Nutrients

    3  Toxic materials

    4  Acidity and alkalinity

    5  Etc.

 B  The Physical Environment

    1  Suspended solids

    2  Temperature

    3  Light penetration

    4  Sediment composition

    5  Etc.

XI AREAS IN WHICH BENTHIC STUDIES
   CAN BEST BE APPLIED

 A Damage Assessment or Stream Health

   If a stream is  suffering from abuse the
   biota will so indicate.  A biologist can
   determine damages by looking at the
   "critter" assemblage in a matter of
   minutes.  Usually,  if damages are not
   found, it will not be necessary to alert
   the remainder of the agency's staff,
   28-10

-------
                                               Biological Integrity of Stream Communities
   pack all the equipment,  pay travel and per
   diem, and then wait five days before
   enough data can be assembled to begin
   evaluation.

B  By determining what damages have been
   done, the potential cause "list" can be
   reduced to a few items for emphasis and
   the entire "wonderful worlds" of science
   and engineering need not be practiced with
   the result that much data are discarded
   later because they were not applicable to
   the problem being investigated.

C  Good benthic data associated with chemi-
   cal,  physical,  and engineering data can
   be used to predict the direction of future
   changes and to estimate the amount of
   pollutants that need to be removed from
   the waterways to make them productive
   and useful once more.

D  The benthic macroinvertebrates are  an
   easily used index to stream health that
   citizens may use in stream improve-
   ment programs.   "Adopt-a-stream"
   efforts have successfully used simple
   macroinvertebrate indices.

E  The potential for restoring biological
   integrity in our flowing  streams using
   macroinvertebrates has barely been
   touched.

REFERENCES

 1  Hynes, H. B. N.  The Ecology of Running
    Waters.  Univ. Toronto  Press.  1970

 2  Keup,  L. E., Ingram, W. M.  and
    Mackenthun,  K. M.  The  Role of
    Bottom Dwelling Macrofauna in
    Water Pollution Investigations.  USPHS
    Environmental Health Series Publ.  No.
    999-WP-38,  23pp.  1966.

 3   Keup, L. E., Ingram,  W. M. and
     Mackenthun, K. M. Biology of Water
     Populations: A Collection of Selected
     Papers on Stream Pollution, Waste
     Water, and Water Treatment.
     Federal Water Pollution Control
     Administration Pub.  No. CWA-3,
     290 pp.  1967.
4 Mackenthun, K; M.  The Practice of   .
   Water Pollution Biology.  FWQA.
   281pp.  1969.

5 Stewart, R.K., Ingram, W.M. and
   Mackenthun, K.M.  Water Pollution
   Control, Waste Treatment and Water
   Treatment: Selected Biological Ref-
   erences on Fresh and Marine Waters.
   FWPCA Pub.  No. WP-23, 126pp. 1966.

6 Weber,  Cornelius I., Biological Field
    and Laboratory Methods for Measuring
    the Quality of Surface Waters and
    Effluents.  U. S. Environmental Pro-
    tection Agency, NERC,  Cincinnati,
    OH .   Environmental Monitoring Series
    670/4.73.001 July 1973

7 Keup, L. E. and Stewart, R.  K.  Effects
    of Pollution on Biota of the Pigeon River,
   North Carolina and Tennessee.  U. S.  EPA,
   National Field Investigations Center.  35 pp.
    1966.  (Reprinted 1973,  National Training
   Center)

8 Wuhrmann, K., Some Problems and
    Perspectives in Applied Limnology
    Mitt.  Internat.  Verein Limol.  20:324-402.
    1974.

9  Armitag,  P. D., Machale, Angelu M.,  and
   Crisp, Diane  C. A Survey of Stream
   Invertebrates  in the Cow Green  Basin
   (Upper Teesdale) Before Inundation.
   Freshwater  Biol.  4:369-398.  1974.

10 Resh,  Vincent H.  andUnzlcker,  John D.
   Water Quality Monitoring and Aquatic
   Organisms: the JWPCF 47:9-19.  1975.

11 Macan, T. T.  Running Water.  Mitt.
   Internat. Limnol.  20:301-321.   1974.

This outline was  prepared by Lowell E.
Keup, Chief,  Technical Studies Branch,
Div. of Technical Support, EPA, Wash-
ington, D.C. 20460,  and revised by
R. M. Sinclair, National Training Center,
MOTD,  OWPO,  USE PA, Cincinnati,  Ohio
45268.

Descriptors:  Aquatic Life,  Benthos, Water
Quality,  Degradation, Environmental Effects,
Trophic Level, Biological Communities,
Ecological Distributions.
                              28-11

-------
                                    ECOLOGY PRIMER
                    (from Aldo Leopold's A SAND COUNTY ALMANAC)
I  Ecology is a belated attempt to convert
   our collective knowledge of biotic materials
   into a collective wisdom of biotic manage-
   ment.

II The outstanding scientific  discovery of
   the twentieth century is not television or
   radio, but rather the complexity of the
   land organism.

Ill One of the penalties of an ecological ed-
   ucation is that one lives alone in a world
   of wounds.  Much of the damage inflicted
   on land is quite invisible to laymen.  An
   ecologist must either harden his shell and
   make believe that the consequences of
   science are none of his business, or he
   must be the doctor who sees the marks  of
   death in a community that  believes itself
   well and does not want to be told other-
   wise.

IV Ecosytems have been sketched out as
   pyramids, cycles, and energy circuits.
   The concept of land as an energy circuit
   conveys three basic ideas:

A That  land is not merely soil.

B That  the native plants and  animals kept
   the energy circuit open; others  may or
   may not.

C That  man-made changes are of a different
   order than evolutionary changes, and have
   effects more comprehensive than is
   intended or foreseen.

V The process of altering the pyramid for
   human occupation releases stored energy,
   and this often gives rise, during the
   pioneering period, to a deceptive exuber-
   ance  of plant and animal life, both wild
   and tame.  These releases of biotic
   capital tend to becloud or postpone the
   penalties of violence.
  VI A thing is right when it tends to preserve
     the integrity, stability, and beauty of the
     biotic community.  It is wrong when it
     tends otherwise.

 VII Every farm is a textbook on animal ecology;
     every stream is a textbook on aquatic
     ecology; conservation is the translation of
     the book.

VIII There are two spiritual dangers in not
     owning a farm:

  A One is the danger of supposing that break-
     fast comes from the grocery.

  B The other, that heat comes from the
     furnace.

  IX In general, the trend of the evidence
     indicates that in land, just as in the human
     body, the symptoms may lie in one organ
     and the  cause in another.   The practices
     we now  call conservation are, to a large
     extent,  local alleviations  of biotic pain.
     They are necessary,  but they must not be
     confused with cures.

  X An Atom at large in the biota is too free to
     know freedom; an atom back in the sea has
     forgotten it.  For every atom lost to the sea,
     the prairie pulls another out of the decaying
     rocks.  The only certain truth is that its
     creatures must suck hard, live fast,  and die
     often, lest its losses  exceed its gains.
  REFERENCES

  1  Leopold, Luna B.  (ed.).Round River.
       Oxford University Press. 1953.

  2  Leopold, Aldo.  A Sand County Almanac.
       Oxford University Press. 1966.	
  This outline was prepared by R. M.  Sinclair,
  National Training Center, MOTD, OWPO, USEPA.
  Cincinnati, Ohio 45268.

  Descriptor: Ecology
 BI. ECO. 26.6.76
                                      29-1

-------
             GLOBAL DETERIORATION AND OUR ENVIRONMENTAL CRISIS
I  FROM LOCAL TO REGIONAL TO GLOBAL
   PROBLEMS

A Environmental problems do not stop at
   national frontiers, or ideological barriers.
   Pollution in the atmosphere and oceans
   taints all nations,  even those benignly
   favored by geography, climate, or natural
   resources.

   1  The smokestacks of  one country can
      pollute the air and water of another.

   2  Toxic effluents poured into an inter-
      national river can kill fish in a
      neighboring nation and ultimately
      pollute international seas.

B In Antarctica, thousands of miles from
   pollution sources, penguins and fish
   contain DDT in their fat.  Recent layers
   of snow and ice on the white  continent
   contain measurable  amounts of lead.
   The increase can be correlated with the
   earliest days of lead smelting and com-
   bustion of leaded gasolines.

C International cooperation, therefore, is
   necessary on many environmental fronts.

   1  Sudden accidents  that chaotically
      damage the environment - such as oil
      spills from a tanker at sea - require
      international cooperation  both for
      prevention and for cleanup.

   2  Environmental effects cannot be
      effectively treated by unilateral action.

   3  The ocean can no longer be considered
      a dump.

D "One of the penalties of an ecological
   education is that one lives alone in a
   world of wounds.  Much of the  damage
   inflicted on land is quite invisible to
   laymen.  An ecologist must either harden
   his shell and make believe that the conse-
   quences of science are none  of his business,
   or he must be the doctor who sees the marks
    of death in a community that believes
    itself well and does not want to be told
    otherwise." Aldo Leopold

II   CHANGES IN ECOSYSTEMS ARE
    OCCURRING CONTINUOUSLY

 A  Myriad interactions take place at every
    moment of the day as plants and animals
    respond to variations in their  surroundings
    and to each other.  Evolution has produced
    for each species, including man, a genetic
    composition that limits how far that
    species can go in adjusting to  sudden
    changes in its surroundings.   But within
    these limits the several thousand species
    in an ecosystem, or for that matter, the
    millions in the biosphere, continuously
    adjust to outside stimuli,  Since inter-
    actions are so numerous, they form long
    chains of reactions.

 B  Small changes in one part of an ecosystem
    are likely to be felt and compensated for
    eventually throughout the system.
    Dramatic examples of change  can be seen
    where man has altered the course of
    nature.  It is vividly evident in his Well-
    intentioned but poorly thought  out tampering
    with river,  lake, and other ecosystems.

    1   The Aswan High Dam

    2   The St. Lawrence Seaway

    3   Lake Kariba

    4   The Great Lakes

    5  Valley of Mexico

    6  California earthquake (Scientific
      America 3981, p. 333)

    7  Everglades and the Miami,  Florida
      Jetport

    8  Copperhill, Tennessee (Copper Basin)

    9  (You may add others)
BI. ECO. hum. 2f. 6. 76
                                    30-1

-------
Global Deterioration and Our Environmental Crisis
C  Ecosystem Stability

   1  The stability of a particular ecosystem
      depends on its diversity.  The more
      interdependences in an ecosystem,  the
      greater the chances that it will be able
      to compensate for changes imposed
      upon it.

   2  A cornfield or lawn has little natural
      stability.  If they are not constantly
      and carefully cultivated, they will not
      remain cornfields or lawns but will
      soon be overgrown with a wide variety
      of hardier plants constituting a more
      stable  ecosystem.

   3  The chemical elements that make up
      living systems also depend on complex,
      diverse sources to prevent cyclic
      shortages or oversupply.

   4  Similar diversity is essential for the
      continued functioning of the cycle by
      which atmospheric nitrogen is made
      available to allow life to exist.  This
      cycle depends on a wide variety  of
      organisms, including soil bacteria and
      fungi, which are often  destroyed by
      pesticides in the soil.
D  Biological Pollution

   Contamination of living native biotas by
   introduction of exotic life forms has been
   called biological pollution by Lachner et al.
   Some of these introductions are compared
   to contamination as severe as a dangerous
   chemical release.  They also threaten to
   replace known wildlife resources with
   species of little or unknown value.

   1 Tropical areas have especially been
     vulnerable.  Florida is referred to as
     "a biological cesspool of introduced
     life. "
    2  Invertebrates

       a  Asian Clams have a pelagic veliger
          larvae,  thus, a variety of hydro
          installations are vulnerable to sub-
          sequent pipe clogging by the adult
          clams.

       b  Melanian snails are intermediate
          hosts for various trematodes
          parasitic on man.

    3  Vertebrates

       a  At least 25 exotic species of fish
          have been established in North
          America.

       b  Birds,  including starlings and
          cattle egrets.

       c  Mammals, including nutria.

    4  Aquatic plants

       Over twenty common exotic species
       are growing wild in the United States.
       The problem of waterway clogging has
       been especially severe in parts of the
       Southeast.

    5  Pathogens and Pests

       Introduction of insect pests and tree
       pathogens have had severe economic
       effects.

Ill  "LAWS OF ECOLOGY"

 A  Four principles have been enunciated by
    Dr. Barry Commoner.

    1  Everything is connected to everything
       else.

    2  Everything must go somewhere.

    3  Nature knows best.

    4  There is no such thing as a free lunch.

 B  These may be summarized by the principle,
    "you can't do just one thing."
 30-2

-------
                                           Global Deterioration and Our Environmental Crisis
 IV THE THREE PRINCIPLES OF
    ENVIRONMENTAL CONTROL (Wolman)

 A You can't escape.

 B You have to organize.

 C You have to pay.


 V LAND AS AN ENERGY CIRCUIT

 A Tenants  of Leopold

    1  That land is not merely soil

    2  Native plants and animals keep the
       energy circuit open; others may or
       may not.

    3  Man-made  changes are of a different
       order than  evolutionary changes, and
       often  have  effects more comprehensive
       than is intended or  foreseen.

 B Ecosystems are integrated

 Waters,  like soil, are part of the energy
 circuit.  Industry, by polluting waters or
 obstructing them with dams, may exclude
 the plants and animals necessary to keep
 energy in circulation.

 C Tinkering with the pyramid of life

 The process of altering the pyramid for
 human occupation releases  stored energy,
 and this often gives  rise, during the pioneer-
 ing period,  to a deceptive exuberance of
 plant and animal  life,  both wild and tame.
 These releases of biotic capital tend to
 becloud or postpone the penalties of violence.

 D According to Leopold,  the outstanding
 discovery of the twentieth century is not
 radio or television (or the technology capable
 of placing man on the moon's surface),  but
 rather the complexity of the land organism.


VI  POLLUTION COMES IN  MANY PACKAGES

 A The sources of'air, water, and land
 pollution are interrelated and often inter-
 changeable.
  1 A single source may pollute the air with
    smoke and chemicals, the land with solid
    wastes,  and a river or lake with chemical
    and other wastes.

  2 Control of air pollution may produce more
    solid wastes, which then pollute the land
    or water.

  3 Control of wastewater effluent may convert
    it into solid wastes, which must be disposed
    of on land, or by combustion to the air.

  4 Some pollutants - chemicals, radiation,
    pesticides - appear in all media.

  B "Disposal" is as important and as costly
  as purification.
VII  PERSISTENT CHEMICALS IN THE
     ENVIRONMENT

  Increasingly complex manufacturing processes,
  coupled with rising industrialization, create
  greater amounts of exotic wastes potentially
  toxic to humans and aquatic life.

  They may also be teratogenic (toxicants
  responsible for changes in the embryo with
  resulting birth defects,  ex., thalidomide),
  mutagenic (insults which produce mutations,
  ex.,  radiation),  or carcinogenic (insults which
  induce cancer, ex., benzopyrenes) in effect.

  A  Metals - current levels of cadmium, lead,
     and other substances whose effects on
     humans and fish and wildlife are not fully
     understood constitute a mounting concern.
     Mercury pollution, for example,  has
     become a serious national problem, yet
     mercury has been present on earth since
     time immemorial. More research is
     needed, yet we dare not relax our standards
     until definitive answers have been provided.

  B  Pesticides

     1    A pesticide and its metabolites may
         move through an ecosystem in many
         ways.  Hard (pesticides which are
         persistent, having a long half-life  in
         the environment, includes the organo-
         chlorines, ex., DDT) pesticides ingested
         or otherwise borne by the target species
                                                                                     30-3

-------
Global Deterioration and Our Environmental Crisis
      will stay in the environment, possibly
      to be recycled or concentrated further
      through the natural action of food
      chains if the species is eaten.  Most
      of the volume of pesticides do not
      reach their target at all.

   2  Biological magnification

      Initially, low levels of persistent
      pesticides in air, soil,  and water
      may be concentrated at every step
      up the food chain.   Minute aquatic
      organisms and  scavengers,  which
      screen water and bottom mud having
      pesticide levels of a few parts per
      billion,  can accumulate levels
      measured in parts per million -
      a thousandfold increase. The sedi-
      ments including fecal deposits are
      continuously recycled by the bottom
      animals.

      a Oysters,  for instance,  will con-
        centrate DDT 70, 000 times higher
        in their tissures than it's concen-
        tration in surrounding water.
        They can also partially cleanse
        themselves in water free of DDT.

      b Fish feeding on lower organisms
        build up concentrations in their
        visceral fat which may reach
        several thousand parts per million
        and levels in their  edible flesh of
        hundreds  of parts per million.

      c Larger animals, such as fish-
        eating gulls and other birds, can
        further concentrate the chemicals.
        A  survey on organochlorine residues
        in aquatic birds in  the Canadian
        prairie provinces showed that
        California and ring-billed gulls.
        were among the most contaminated.
        Since gulls breed in colonies,
        breeding population changes can
        be detected and related to levels
        of chemical contamination.  Ecolog-
        ical research on colonial birds to
        monitor the effects of chemical
        pollution on the environment is
        useful.
C  "Polychlorinated biphenyls" (PCB's).
   PCB's are used in plasticizers, asphalt,
   ink, paper,  and a host of other products.
   Action has been taken to curtail their
   release to the environment, since their
   effects are similar to hard pesticides.

D  Other compounds which are toxic and
   accumulate in the ecosystem:

   1  Phalate esters - may interfere with
      pesticide analyses

   2  Benzapyrenes

   3  Etc.

E  Metabolic Responses (in humans and animals)
   We and animals are constantly exposed to
   a variety of chemical substances.   Most
   of these we can handle (acceptable tolerances).
   As an example, mercury has always been
   naturally occuring in tuna in low levels.
   This is acceptable because of the low levels
   ingested.  No one would likely eat enough
   tuna to injure their health.  If, as in the
 ""~clTs~e~TH(rftjnirnata, industrial discharges
   are significant, eating exposed fish and shell
   fish can lead to death.   Higher organisms
   are capable of dealing with acceptable
   tolerances by:

   1  Excreting it.unchanged.

   2  Metabolizing it.   Convert it to an
      innocuous state.

   3  Store it.   Like in fat, or bone or some
      other depot.  Thus in some cases it
      would be wise to avoid fatty tissue of
      some fish.

   4  A combination of the above responses.

 VIII EXAMPLES OF SOME EARLY WARNING
      SIGNALS THAT HAVE BEEN DETECTED
      BUT FORGOTTEN,  OR IGNORED.

   A  Magnetic micro-spherules  in lake
      sediments now used to detect changes in
      industrialization indicate our slowness
      to recognize indicators of environmental
      change.
30-4

-------
                                          Global- Deterioration and Our Environmental Crisis
B Salmonid fish kills in poorly buffered
   clean lakes in Sweden.  Over the past
   years there had been a successive
   increase of SO, in the air and precipita-
   tion.  Thus,  air-borne contamination
   from industrialized European countries
   had a great influence on previously
   unpolluted waters and their life.  This
   phenomenon is known as "Acid Rain".

C Minimata,  Japan and mercury pollution.

D Organochlorine levels in commercial and
   sport fishing stocks,  ex., the lower
   Mississippi River fish kills.

E You may complete the following:
   2  etc.

IX SUMMARY

A World Ecosystems are linked through
   biogeochemical cycles which are deter-
   mined by patterns of transfer and con-
   centrations of substances in the biosphere
   and surface rocks.

B Organisms determine or strongly
   influence chemical and physical charac-
   teristics of the atmosphere,  soil, and
   waters.

C The inability of man to adequately predict
   or control his effects on the environment
   is indicated by his lack of knowledge
   concerning the net effect of atmospheric
   pollution on the earth's climate.

D Serious potential hazards for man which
   are all globally dispersed, are radionu-
   clides, organic chemicals, pesticides,
   heavy metals and combustion products.

E Environmental destruction is in lock-step
   with our population growth.

ACKNOWLEDGEMENT:

This outline has been extracted in part from
the first annual report of the Council on
Environmental  Quality:  Environmental
Quality.  USGPO, Washington, DC.
326 pp.  $1.75.   1970.
 REFERENCES

 1  Goldman, Charles R.  Is the Canary Dying?
      The time has come for man,  miner of
      the worlds resources, to surface.
      Calif. Medicine 113:21-26.  1970.

 2  Lachner,  Ernest A., Robins, C. Richard,
      and Courtenay, Walter R., Jr.
      Exotic Fishes and Other Aquatic
      Organisms Introduced into North
      America.   Smithsonian Contrib. to
      Zool.  59:1-29.  1970.

 3  Nriagu, Jerome O. and Bowser, Carl J.
      The Magnetic  Spherules in Sediments
      of Lake Mendota, Wisconsin.  Water
      Res.  3:833-842.   1969.

 4  Hood, Donald W. ed. Impingement of Man
      on the Oceans. Wiley-Interscience.
      738 p.   1971.

 5  Commoner, Barry.  The Closing Circle,
      Nature, Man,  and Technology.  Alfred
      A. Knopf.  326 p.  1971.

 6  Dansereau, Pierre ed.  Challenge for
      Survival.  Land, Air, and Water for
      man in Megalopolis, Columbia Univ.
      .Press.  235 p.  1970.

 7  Wiens,  John A. ed.  Ecosystem Structure
      and Function.  Oregon State Univ.
      Press.  176 p.  1972.

 8  Matthews,  W.H., Smith, F. E., and
      Goldberg,  E. D.  Man's Impact on
      Terrestrial and Oceanic Ecosystems.
      MIT Press.  1971.

 9  Leopold, Aldo.  A Sand County Almanac
      with Essays on Conservation from
      Round River.  Sierra Club/Ballantine
      Books.  295 p. 1970.

10  Sondheimer,  Ernest B. and Simeone,
      John B. Chemical Ecology.  Academic
      Press.  336 p.  1970.

11  Environmental Quality.  Second Annual
      Report of the Council on Environmental
      Quality.  August 1971.  Fourth Annual
      Report  1973.
                                                                                     30-5

-------
Global Deterioration and Our Environmental Crisis
12 Toxic Substances,  Council on
      Environmental Quality.  25 p.
      April  1971.

13 Zinc in Water.  A Bibliography USDI.
      Office Water Resources WRSIC Series
      208.  1971.  Also in this series WRSIC
      201-207,  Mercury, Magnesium,
      Manganese, Copper,  Trace Elements,
      and Strontium.

14 The Changing Chemistry of the oceans;
      Proc.   20th Nobel Symposium.
      Wiley.  1972.

15 Bradley,  Michael D. Human, Ecology
      and Coastal-Zone Pollution.  Water,
      Air, and Soil Pollution. 1 (4): 405-
      414.  1972.

16 Thomas,  William A., Indicators of
      Environmental Quality.  Plenum Press.
      275 p.  1972.

17 Cowell,  E. B.  "Oil Pollution in Perspec-
      tive",  in The Ecological Effects of Oil
      Pollution on Littoral Communities.
      Inst.  of Petroleum.  Appl. Sci. Pub.
      1972.  (Includes a pollution rating
      scale.)
18 Oglesby, Ray T.,  Carlson,  Clarence A.,
      and McCann,  James A. River Ecology
      and Man.  Academic Press.  465 p.
      1972.

19 Owen,  D.F.  What is Ecology?  Oxford
      Univ. Press.  188 p.  1974.
This outline was prepared by R. M. Sinclair,
National Training Center, MOTD, OWPO,
USEPA,  Cincinnati,  Ohio 45268.

Descriptors: Ecology, Environmental
Effects
30-6

-------
                         THE EFFECTS OF POLLUTION ON LAKES
I  INTRODUCTION

The pollution of lakes inevitably results in a
number of undesirable changes in water
quality which are directly or indirectly
related to changes in the aquatic  community.

A  Industrial Wastes may contain the following:

   1  Sewage

   2  Dissolved organics--synthetics,  food
     processing wastes, etc.

   3  Dissolved minerals--salts,  metals
     (toxic and nontoxic), pigments,  acids, etc.

   4  Suspended solids--fibers, minerals,
     degradable and non-degradable organics

   5  Petroleum products--oils,  greases

   6  Waste heat

B  The Materials in Domestic Wastes which
   affect Water Quality are:

   1  Pathogenic fecal microorganisms

   2  Dissolved nutrients:  minerals,  vitamins,
     and other dissolved organic substances

   3  Suspended solids (sludge)--degradable
     .and non-degradable organic materials

C  Pollution and Eutrophication

   The discharge of domestic wastes  often
   renders the receiving water unsafe for
   contact water sports and water supplies.
   For example, some beaches on the eastern
   seaboard and in metropolitan regions of
   the Great Lakes are unfit for swimming
   because of high coliform counts.  Other
   effects of domestic pollution include
   changes in  the abundance and composition
   of populations of aquatic organisms.

   1  As the nutrient level increases, so does
     the rate  of primary production.
    2  Shore-line algae and rooted aquatics
      become more abundant.  For example,
      problems have been experienced with
      Cladophora and Dichotomosiphon along
      the shores of Lakes Ontario, Erie,
      and Michigan.  These growths interfere
      with swimming,  boating, and fishing,
      and cause odors when the organisms
      die and decay.

    3  The standing crop of phytoplankton
      increases, resulting in higher counts  .
      and greater chlorophyll content.
      Increases in phytoplankton abundance
      may result in taste and odor problems
      in water supplies, filter  clogging,
      high turbidity, changes in water color,
      and oxygen depletion in the hypolimnion.

    4  Populations of fish and larger swimming
      invertebrates increase, based on the
      increase in basic food production.

    5  Changes in dominant species

      a  Diatom communities give way to
         blue-greens.  Toxic blue-greens may
         pose a problem.

      b  Zooplankton changes include
         replacement of Bosmina coregoni
         by B_. longirostris.

      c  Trout and whitefish are replaced by
         perch,  bass,  and rough fish.

      d  Hypolimnion becomes  anaerobic in
         summer; bottom sludge buildup
         results in loss of fish  food organisms,
         accompanied by increase in density
         of sludgeworms (oligochaeta).
II   HISTORICAL REVIEW

 The cultural eutrophication of a number of
 lakes in Europe and America has been well
 documented.

 A  Zurichsee,  Switzerland
WP. LK. lc.6. 76
                                                                                      31-1

-------
The Effects of Pollution on Lakes
   1  1896 - sudden increase in Tabellaria
      fenestrata

   2  1898 - sudden appearance of Oscillatoria
      rubescens which displaced Fragilaria
      capucina

   3  1905 - Melosira islandica var. helvetica
      appeared

   4  1907 - Stephanodiscus hantzschii
      appeared

   5  1911 - Bosmina longirostris replaced
      B. coregoni

   6  1920
      1924 - O.  rubescens occurred in great
      quantities

   7  1920 - milky-water phenomenon;
      precipitation of CaCO  crystals (40n)
      due to pH increase resulting from
      photo synth e sis

   8  Trout and whitefish replaced by perch,
      bass, and rough fish
          B Hallwilersee, Switzerland

            1  1897 - Oscillataria rubescens not
               observed up to this time

            2  1898 - O.  rubescens bloomed,
               decomposed, formed H S, killing off
               trout and whitefish

          C Lake Windermere, England (core study)

            1  Little change in diatoms from glacial
               period until recent times

            2  Then Asterionella appeared, followed
               by Synedra

            3  About 200 years ago, Asterionella
               again became abundant

            4  A sterionella abundance ascribed to
               domestic wastes

          D Finnish Lakes

            Aphanizomenon, Coelosphaerium,
            Anabaena, Microcystis,  are the most
            common indication of eutrophy.
                 TABLE 1   CHANGES IN PHYSIO-CHEMICAL PARAMETERS

                                   Zurichsee, Switzerland
               Parameter
               Chlorides
               Dissolved organics
   Date
       1888
       1916

       1888
       1914
        Value

       1.3 mg/1
       4.9 mg/1

       9.0 mg/1
      20.0 mg/1
               Secchi Disk
before 1910
1905 - 1910
1914 - 1928
               Dissolved oxygen, at    1910 - 1930
                 100 M, mid-summer   1930 - 1942
  Max.
  16. 8M
  10. OM
  10. OM
Minimum
   it
    Min.
    3.1M
    2.1M
    1.4M
100% saturation
  9% saturation
 31-2

-------
                                                             The Effects of Pollution on Lakes
E  Linsley Pond, Connecticut

   1 Species making modern appearance
     include Asterionella formosa,
     Cyclotella glomerata,  Melosira
     italica, Fragilaria crotonensis,
     Synedra ulna

   2 A sterionella formosa and Melosira
     italica were considered by Patrick to
     indicate high dissolved organics

   3 Bosmina coregoni replaced by ^.
     longirostris

F  Lake Monona, Wisconsin

   1 Began receiving treated sewage in 1920,
     developed blue-green algal blooms.

G  Lake Washington, Washington

   1 1940 - Bosmina longirostris appeared

   2 1955 - Oscillatoria rubescens seen for
     the first time,  and constituted 96% of
     phytoplankton,  July 1

H  Lake Erie

   1 Phytoplankton counts at Cleveland have
     increased steadily from less than
     500  cells/ml in the 1920's to over
     1500 cells/ml in the 1960's

   2 Abundance of burrowing mayflies
     (Hexagenia spp.)in Western Lake Erie
     decreased from 139/m2 in 1930,  to
     less than  1/m2 in  1961.

I  Lake Michigan

   1 Milky water observed in south end, and
     in limnetic region in mid-1950's and
     again in 1967.

   2 During the period  1965-1967 the Chicago
     water treatment plant has found it
     necessary to increase the carbon dosage
     from 23 Ibs/mil gal to 43 Ibs/mil gal,
     and the chlorine dosage from  20 Ibs/mil
     gal to 25 Ibs/mil gal.
       Phytoplankton counts in the south end
       now exceed 10, 000/ml during the
       spring bloom.
Ill  FACTORS AFFECTING THE RESPONSE
    OF LAKES TO POLLUTION INCLUDE:

 A Depth-surface area ratio:  A large
    hypolimnion will act as a reservoir to
    keep nutrients from recirculating in the
    trophogenic zone during  the summer
    stratification period.  Raw son found an
    inverse relationship between the standing
    crop of plankton, benthos,  and fish,  and
    the mean depth.

 B Climate:  Low annual water temperatures
    may restrict the response  of the
    phytoplankton to enrichment.

 C Natural color or turbidity: Dystrophic
    (brown-water) lakes may not develop
    phytoplankton blooms because of the low
    transparency of the water.
IV  TROPHIC LEVEL

  Except in cases where massive algal blooms
 .occur, the trophic status of lakes is often
  difficult to determine.  Core studies are
  used to determine trends in diatom populations
  which  might indicate changes in nutrient
  levels over an extended period of time.
 V  CONTROL OF POLLUTION

  The success of efforts to arrest the
  eutrophication process,  and where desirable,
  reduce the trophic level of a lake, will
  depend on a thorough knowledge of the
  nutrient budget.

  A Significant quantities of nutrients may
    enter a lake from one or more of the
    following sources:

    1  Rainfall

    2  Ground water
                                                                                  31-3

-------
The Effects of Pollution on Lakes
           TABLE 2  PARAMETERS COMMONLY USED TO DESCRIBE CONDITIONS
         1  Transparency

         2  Phosphorus

         3  NO - Nitrogen
               o
         4  Minimum annual
              hypolimnetic oxygen concentration

         5  Chlorophyll

         6  Ash-free weight of seston

         7  Phytoplankton count

         8  Phytoplankton quotients

            a number of species of Chlorococcales
                 number of species of Desmids
              Oligotrophic Condition

                 >  10 meters

                 <  lug/1
                 <  200 ^g/1

              near 100% saturation

                           3
                 <  1 mg/m

                 <  0. 1 mg/1

                 <  500/ml
                 <1
            b Myxophycease+Chlorococcales+Centrales+Euglenaceae <1
                                  Desmidaceae

            c Centrales                                             0 - 0. 2
              Pennales

         9  Phytoplankton species present (see outline on
            plankton in oligotrophic lakes).
   3 Watershed runoff

   4 Shoreline domestic and industrial outfalls

   5 Pleasure craft and commercial vessels

   6 Waterfowl

   7 Leaves,  pollen,  and other organic
     debris from riparian vegetation

B  The supply of nutrients from "natural"
   sources in  some cases may be greater
   than that from cultural sources,  and be
   sufficient to independently cause a rapid
   rate of eutrophication regardless of the
   level of efficiency of treatment of domestic
   and industrial wastes.
C  Many methods have been employed to
   treat the symptoms, reduce the
   eutrophication rate, or completely
   arrest and even reverse the eutrophication
   process.

   1 Use of copper sulfate, sodium arsenite,
     and organic algicides: It is not
     economically feasible to use algicides
     in large lakes.

   2 Addition of carbon black to reduce
     transparency.  This is likewise
     frequently impractical.

   3 Harvesting algae by foam fractionation
     or chemical precipitation.
 31-4

-------
                                                           The Effects of Pollution on Lakes
      4 Reducing nutrient supply by (a) removal
        of N and P from effluents,  (b) diversion
        of effluents, and (c) dilution with
        nutrient-poor water.

   D  Examples  of lakes where control has been
      attempted  by reducing the nutrient supply,
      are:

      1 Lake Washington, Seattle

        The natural water supply for  this lake
        is nutrient poor
        (Ca = 8  mg/1, P < 5 Mg/1, TDS=76mg/l).
        Since the turnover time of the water in
        this lake is only three years,  it was
        expected that diversion of sewage
        would result in a rapid improvement of
        water quality.  Diversion began in 1963,
        and improvements were noticeable by
        1965 - including an increase in
        transparency,  and a reduction in seston,
        chlorophyll, and epilimnetic phosphorus.
                   TABLE  3
PHOSPHORUS REDUCTION IN LAKE WASHINGTON
    Year

    1963

    1964

    1965
Maximum phosphorus in
   upper 10 meters
       (Mg/D	
         70

         66

         63
      2  Green Lake, Washington

        The lake has a long history of heavy
        blooms of blue-green algae.  Beginning
        in 1959, low-nutrient city water was
        added to the lake, reducing the con-
        centration of phosphorus by 70% in the
        inflowing water.   By 1966, the lake had
        been flushed three times. Evidence of
        improvement in water quality was noted
        in 1965, when Aphanizomenon was
        replaced by Gleotrichia.
                                3  Lake Tahoe

                                   This lake is  still decidedly oligotrophic.
                                   To maintain  its high level of purity,
                                   tertiary treatment facilities were
                                   installed in the major sewage treat-
                                   ment plant, and construction is now
                                   underway to  transport all domestic
                                   wastes out of the lake basin.
                               REFERENCES
                                                                   Eds.
1  Ayers, J. C. and Chandler, D. C.
      Studies on the environment and
      eutrophication of Lake Michigan.
      Special Report No. 30.   Great Lakes
      Research Division, Institute of
      Science and Technology, University
      of Michigan, Ann Arbor.  1967.

2  Brezonik, P.L., Morgan, W.H.,
      Shannon,  E.E., and Putnam, H.D.
      Eutrophication factors in North
      Central Florida Lakes.  University
      of Florida Water Res. Center.
      Pub. #5,  101 pp.   1969.

3  Carr, J.F., Hiltunen,  J.K.  Changes
      in the bottom fauna of Western Lake
      Erie from 1930 to 1961.   Limnol.
      Oceanogr.  10(4):551-569.    1965.

4  Frey, David G.  Remains of animals
      in Quaternary lake and bog sediments
      and their interpretation.
      Schweizerbartsche Verlagsbuchhandlung.
      Stuttgart.   1964.

5  Edmondson, W.T.,  and Anderson,  G.C.
      Artificial eutrophication of Lake
      Washington.   Limnol. Oceanogr.
      l(l):47-53.    1956.

6  Fruh, E.G.   The overall picture of
      eutrophication.   Paper presented
      at the  Texas Water and Sewage
      Works Association's  Eutrophication
      Seminar, College Station,  Texas.
      March 9, 1966.

7  Fruh, E.G., Stewart, K.M.,  Lee, G.F.,
      and Rohlich,  G.A.   Measurements
      of eutrophication and trends.
      J.W.P.C.F.  38(8):1237-1258.   1966.
                                                                                    31-5

-------
 The Effects of Pollution on Lakes
 8  Hasler, A.D.   Eutrophication of lakes
      by domestic drainage.  Ecology
      28(4):383-395.   1947.

 9  Hasler, A.D.   Cultural Eutrophication
      is Reversible.  Bioscience 19(5):
      425-443.   1969.

10  Herbst, Richard P.   Ecological Factors
      and the Distribution of Cladophora
      glomerata in the Great  Lakes.
      Amer. Midi. Nat. 82(l):90-98.   1969.

11  National Academy of Sciences.
      Eutrophication:  Causes, Consequences,
      Correction.  661 pp.   1969.
      (Nat. Acad. Sci. ,2101  Constitution
      Avenue, Washington, DC 20418, 13.50).
12  Neel,  Joe Kendall.  Reservoir
      Eutrophication and Dystrophication
      following Impoundment.   Reservoir
      Fisheries Res. Symp.  322-332.

13  Oglesby,  R. T. and Edmondson, W. T.
      Control of Eutrophication.
      J.W.P.C.F. 38(9):1452-1460.   1966.

14  Stewart,  K.M. and Rohlich,  G.A.
      Eutrophication - A  Review.
      Publication  No. 34, State Water
      Resources Control Board, The
      Resources Agency, State  of California.
      1967.

 This outline was prepared by C.I. Weber,
 Chief, Biological  Methods Section,
 Analytical Quality Control Laboratory,
 NERC,  EPA,  Cincinnati,. OH 45268.

 Descriptor: Eutrophication
 31-6

-------
                               APPLICATION OF BIOLOGICAL DATA
 I  ECOLOGICAL DATA HAS TRADITIONALLY
   BEEN DIVIDED INTO TWO GENERAL
   CLASSES:

 A Qualitative - dealing with the taxonomic
   composition of communities

 B Quantitative - dealing with the population
   density or rates of processes occurring
   in the communities

   Each kind of data has been useful in its own
   way.
II  QUALITATIVE DATA

 A Certain species have been identified as:

   1  Clean water (sensitive) or oligotrophic

   2  Facultative,  or tolerant

   3  Preferring polluted regions
      (see:  Fjerdinstad 1964, 1965; Gaufin
      & Tarzwell 1956; Palmer 1963,  1969;
      Rawson 1956; Teiling 1955)

 B Using our knowledge  about ecological
   requirements the biologist may compare
   the species present

   1  At different stations in the same river
      (Gaufin 1958)  or lake (Holland 1968)

   2  In different rivers or lakes  (Robertson
      and Powers 1967)

   or changes in the species in a river or/lake
   over a period of several years. (Carr
   & Hiltunen 1965; Edmondson & Anderson
   1956; Fruh, Stewart, Lee & Rohlich 1966;
   Hasler 1947).

 C Until comparatively recent times taxonomic
   data were not subject to statistical treat-
   ment.
Ill  QUANTITATIVE DATA;  Typical
    Parameters of this type include:
                                 2
 A Counts - algae/ml; benthos/m ;
    fish/net/day
                 3
 B Volume - mm  algae/liter

 C Weight - dry wgt; ash-free wgt.

 D Chemical content - chlorophyll;
    carbohydrate; ATP; DNA; etc.

 E Calories (or caloric equivalents)

 F Processes -  productivity; respiration
IV  Historically, the chief use of statistics
 in treating biological data has been in the
 collection and analysis of samples for these
 parameters.  Recently, many methods have
 been devised to convert taxonomic data into
 numerical form to permit:

 A Better communication between the
    biologists and other scientific disciplines

 B Statistical treatment of taxonomic data

 C In the field of pollution biology these
    methods include:

    1  Numerical ratings of organisms on the
       basis of their pollution tolerance

       (saprobic valency:  Zelinka & Sladecek
       1964)

       (pollution index: Palmer 1969)

    2  Use of quotients or ratios of species in
       different taxonomic groups (Nygaard
       1949)
  BI.EN.3a. 6. 76
                                                                                     32-1

-------
Application of Biological Data
3  Simple indices of community diversity:

   a  Organisms are placed in taxonomic
      groups which behave similarly under
      the same ecological conditions.  The
      number of species in these groups
      found at "healthy" stations is com-
      pared to that found at "experimental"
      stations.   (Patrick 1950)

   b  A truncated log normal curve is
      plotted on the basis  of the number
      of individuals per diatom species.
      (Patrick, Hohn, & Wallace 1954)

   c  Sequential comparison index.
      (Cairns, Albough, Busey & Chanay
      1968).  In this technique, similar
      organisms encountered sequentially
      are grouped into "runs".
      SCI =
                       runs
             total organisms examined
         Ratio of carotenoids to chlorophyll
         in phytoplankton populations :
                               1968)
         OP435/OD670(Tanaka,  et al 1961)

      e  The number of diatom species present
         at a station is considered indicative
         of water quality or pollution level.
         (Williams  1964)

         number of species (S)
         number of individuals (N)
               number of species (S) _ ____
      °  square root of number of individuals (-/ N)
                                                       j   Information theory:

                                                          The basic equation used for
                                                          information theory applications was
                                                          developed by Margalef (1957).
    _1
    N
                                                                             N!
                                                                       N  !  N.  !. .. N  !
                                                                        a    b      s
where I - information/individual;
N  , N .. .N  are the number of
individuals in species a, b, ...
s,  and N is their sum.

This equation has also been used
with:

1)  The fatty acid content of algae
   (Mclntire,  Tinsley, and Lowry
   1969)

2)  Algal productivity (Dickman 1968)

3)  Benthic biomass (Wilhm 1968)
         S -  1
             N
                (Menhinick 1964)
         d =
             £ n. (n. - 1) (Simpson 1949)
             N  (N -  1)
        where n. = number of individuals
                   belonging to the i-th species,
                   and
               N = total number of individuals
                                              REFERENCES

                                              1  Cairns,  J.,  Jr., Albough,  D.W.,
                                                    Busey, F, and Chaney, M.D.
                                                    The sequential comparison index -
                                                    a simplified method for non-biologists
                                                    to estimate relative differences in
                                                    biological diversity in stream pollution
                                                    studies.  J. Water Poll. Contr. Fed.
                                                    40(9):1607-1613.   1968.

                                              2  Carr,  J. F. and Hiltunen, J.K.  Changes
                                                    in the bottom fauna of Western Lake
                                                    Erie  from 1930 to 1961.   Limnol.
                                                    Oceanogr. 10(4):551-569.   1965.

                                              3  Dickman,  M.  Some indices of diversity.
                                                    Ecology 49(6):1191-1193.   1968.
    32-2

-------
                                                             Application of Biological Data
 4  Edmondson,  W.T. and Anderson, G. C.
      Artificial Eutrophication of Lake
      Washington.   Limnol. Oceanogr.
      l(l):47-53.   1956.

 5  Fjerdingstad, E.  Pollution of Streams
      estimated by benthal phytomicro-
      organisms.  I. A saprobic system
      based on communities of organisms
      and ecological factors.  Internat'l
      Rev.  Ges.  Hydrobiol.  49(1):63-131.1964.

 6  Fjerdingstad, E.   Taxonomy and saprobic
      valency of benthic phytomlcro-
      organisms.  Hydrobiol. 50 (4):475-604.
      1965.

 7  Fruh, E.G., Stewart, K.M.,  Lee,  G.F.
      and Rohlich,  G.A.  Measurements of
      eutrophication and trends.  J. Water
      Poll. Contr.  Fed. 38(8):1237-1258.
      1966.

 8  Gaufin, A.R.   Effects of Pollution on a
      midwestern stream.   Ohio J. Sci.
      58(4):197-208.   1958.

 9  Gaufin, A.R.  and Tarzwell,  C. M.   Aquatic
      macroinvertebrate communities as
      indicators of organic pollution in Lytle
      Creek.   Sew. Ind. Wastes. 28(7):906-
      924.  1956.

10  Hasler,  A.D.   Eutrophication of lakes by
      domestic drainage.  Ecology 28(4):383-
      395. 1947.

11  Holland, R.E.   Correlation of Melosira
      species with  trophic conditions in Lake
      Michigan.   Limnol.   Oceanogr.
      13(3):555-557.   1968.

12  Margalef,  R.   Information theory in
      ecology.  Gen. Syst.   3:36-71.  1957.

13  Margalef,  R.   Perspectives in ecological
      theory.  Univ.  Chicago Press.   1968.

14  Mclntire, C.D., Tinsley,  I.J. and
      Lowry, R.R.   Fatty acids in lotic
      periphyton: another measure of
      community structure.   J. Phycol.
      5:26-32.   1969.
15  Menhinick, E.F.   A comparison of some
       species - individuals diversity indices
       applied to samples of field insects.
       Ecology 45:859.  1964.
16  Nygaard, G.   Hydrobiological studies in
       some ponds and lakes,   n.  The
       quotient hypothesis and some new or
       little-known phytoplankton organisms.
       Klg. Danske Vidensk. Selsk. Biol.
       Skrifter 7:1-293.  1949.

17  Patten, B.C.  Species diversity in net
       plankton of Raritan Bay.   J. Mar.
       Res. 20:57-75.   1962.

18  Palmer,  C.M.  The effect of pollution on
       river algae.  Ann. New  York Acad.
       Sci.   108:389-395.   1963.

19  Palmer,  C.M.   A composite rating of
       algae tolerating organic  pollution.
       J. Phycol.  5(l):78-82.   1969.

20  Patrick,  R.,  Hohn, M.H. and Wallace.
       J.H.  A new method for determining
       the pattern of the diatom flora.   Not.
       Natl. Acad. Sei.,  No. 259,
       Philadelphia.    1954.

21  Rawson,  D. S.  Algal indicators of trophic
       lake types. Limnol. Oceanogr.
       1:18-25.   1956.

22  Robertson, S. and Powers, C.F.
       Comparison of the distribution of
       organic matter in the five  Great Lakes.
       in:  J. C. Ayers and D. C.  Chandler,
       eds.   Studies on the environment and
       eutrophication of Lake Michigan.
       Spec.  Rpt. No.  30,  Great  Lakes Res.
       Div.,Inst. Sci. & Techn.,  Univ.
       Michigan,  Ann Arbor.   1967.

23  Simpson, E.H.  Measurement of diversity.
       Nature (London) 163:688.   1949.

24  Tanaka, O.H., Irie,  S. Izuka, and Koga, F
       The fundamental investigation on the
       biological productivity in the Northwest
       of Kyushu.  I.  The  investigation of
       plankton.  Rec. Oceanogr.  W. Japan,
       Spec.  Rpt. No.  5, 1-57.   1961.
                                                                                       32-3

-------
 Application of Biological Data
25  Telling, E.   Some mesotrophic phyto-
       plankton indicators.   Proc. Intern.
       Assoc.  Umnol.   12:212-215.   1955.

26  Wilhm,  J. L.   Comparison of some
       diversity indices applied to populations
       of benthic macroinvertebrates in a
       stream receiving organic wastes.  J.
       Water Poll. Contr.  Fed.   39(10):1673-1683.
       1967.

27  Wilhm,  J. L.   Use of biomass units in
       Shannon's formula.  Ecology  49:153-156.
       1968.
28  Williams, L. G.  . Possible relationships
       between diatom numbers and water
       quality.   Ecology 45(4):810-823.   1964.
29  Zelinka,  M. and Sladecek,  V.  Hydro-
       biology for water management.
       State Publ. House for Technical
       Literature, Prague.   122 p.   1964.
 This outline was prepared by C.I. Weber,
 Chief,  Biological Methods Section, Analytical
 Quality Control Laboratory, NEKC.  EPA,
 Cincinnati, Ohio, 45268
                                                  Descriptors: Analytical Techniques, Indicators
    32-4

-------
            SIGNIFICANCE OF "LIMITING FACTORS" TO POPULATION VARIATION
 I   INTRODUCTION

 A  All aquatic organisms do not react uniformly
    to the various chemical,  physical and
    biological features in their environment.
    Through normal evolutionary processes
    various organisms have become adapted
    to certain combinations of environmental
    conditions.  The successful development
    and maintenance of a population or community
    depend upon harmonious ecological balance
    between environmental conditions and
    tolerance of the organisms to variations
    in one or more of these conditions.

 B  A factor whose presence  or absence  exerts
    some restraining influence upon a population
    through incompatibility with species
    requirements or tolerance  is said to be a
    limiting factor.  The principle of limiting
    factors is one of the major aspects of the
    environmental control of aquatic organisms
    (Figure 1).
II   PRINCIPLE OF LIMITING FACTORS

 This principle rests essentially upon two basic
 concepts.  One of these relates organisms to
 the environmental supply of materials essential
 for their growth and development.  The second
 pertains to the tolerance which organisms
 exhibit toward environmental conditions.
                /UNLIMITED GROWTH
POPULATION GROWT
/ DECREASE IN
/ x " LTMTfATIOMNS
/ ^*' EQUILIBRIUM WITH
ts' ^ ENVIRONMENT
X' . \v^ INCREASE IN
/ \ "TlMTWTlONS
;/ x POPULATION DECLINE1
                  TIME
Figure 1.
           The relationships of limiting factors
           to population growth and development.
                                                  A  Liebig's Law of the Minimum enunciates
                                                     the first basic concept.  In order for an
                                                     organism to inhabit a particular environ-
                                                     ment, specified levels of the materials
                                                     necessary for growth and development
                                                     (nutrients,  respiratory gases,  etc. ) must
                                                     be present.  If one of these materials is
                                                     absent from the environment or present
                                                     in minimal quantities, a given  species
                                                     will only survive in limited numbers, if
                                                     at all (Figure 2).
                                                                       OPTIMUM
                                                         LOW"
                                                                    ClmlCAT. RANGE
                                                  Figure 2.
      — MAGNITUDE OF FACTOR — HIGH

     Relationships of environmental
     factors and the abundance of organisms.
The subsidiary principle of factor
interaction states that high concentration
or availability of some substance,  or
the action of some factor in the environ-
ment, may modify utilization of the
minimum one. For example:

a  The uptake of phosphorus by the
   algae Nitzchia closterium is influenced
   by the relative  quantities of nitrate
   and phosphate in the environment;
   however, nitrate utilization appears
   to be unaffected by the phosphate
   (Reid,  1961).

b  The assimilation of some algae is
   closely related to temperature.

c  The rate of oxygen utilization by fish
   may be affected by many other sub-
   stances or factors in the environment.
 BI.ECO. 20a. 6.76
                                                                                        33-1

-------
Significance of "Limiting Factors" to Population Variation
     d  Where strontium is abundant, mollusks
        are able to substitute it, to a partial
        extent, for calcium in their shells
        (Odum, 1959).

   2 If  a material is present in large amounts,
     but only a small amount is available for
     use by the organism,  the amount available
     and not the total amount present deter-
     mines whether or not the particular
     material is limiting (calcium in the form
     of CaCOJ.
             O

   Shelford pointed out in his Law of Tolerance
   that there are maximum as well as minimum
   values of most environmental factors which
   can be tolerated. Absence or failure of an
   organism can be controlled by the  deficiency
   or excess of any factor which may approach
   the limits of tolerance for that organism
   (Figure  3).
 u
 z
 o
 z
 ui
 >
Minimum Limit of
Toleration
Absent
Decreasing
Abundance
Range of Optimum
of Factors
Greatest Abundance
Maximum Limit of
Toleration
Decreasing
Abundance
Absent
Figure 3.  Shelford1 s Law of Tolerance.
     Organisms have an ecological minimum
     and maximum for each environmental
     factor with a range in between called
     the critical range which represents the
     range of tolerance (Figure 2).  The
     actual range thru which an organism can
     grow, develop and reproduce normally
     is usually much smaller than its total
     range of tolerance.

     Purely deleterious factors (heavy metals,
     pesticides, etc.) have a maximum
     tolerable value, but no optimum (Figure 4).
       CONCENTRATION

Figure 4.  Relationship of purely harmful
          factors and the abundance of
          organisms.
   3 Tolerance to environmental factors
     varies widely among aquatic organisms.

     a A species may exhibit a wide range
       of tolerance toward one factor and a
       narrow range toward another. Trout,
       for instance,  have a wide range of
       tolerance for  salinity and a narrow
       range for temperature.

     b All stages in the life history of an
       organism do not necessarily have the
       same ranges of tolerance.  The
       period of reproduction is a  critical
       time in the life  cycle of most
       organisms.

     c The range of tolerance toward one
       factor may be modified by another
       factor.   The toxicity of most sub-
       stances increases as the temperature
       increases.

     d The range of tolerance toward a given
       factor may vary geographically within
       the same species.  Organisms that
       adjust to local conditions are called
       ecotypes.

-------
                                   Significance of "Limiting Factors" to Population Variation
     e  The range of tolerance toward a given
        factor may vary seasonally.  In general
        organisms tend to be more sensitive
        to environmental changes in summer
        than in other seasons.  This is
        primarily due  to the higher summer
        temperatures.

   4 A wide range of distribution of a species
     is usually the result of a wide range of
     tolerances.  Organisms with a wide
     range of tolerance for all factors are
     likely to be the most widely distributed,
     although their growth rate may vary
     greatly.  A one-year old carp, for
     instance,  may vary in size  from less
     than an ounce to more than a pound
     depending on the  habitat.

   5 To express the relative degree of
     tolerance for a particular environmental
     factor the prefix  eury (wide) or steno
     (narrow) is added to a term for that
     feature (Figure 5).
                                                Ill
       STENOTHERMAl .,..„.„„.... STENOTHERMAl
       (OLIOOTHERMAI)EUI1T™"MAI (POIYTHERMAL)
                  TEMPERATURE
The law of the minimum as it pertains to
factors affecting metabolism, and the law
of tolerance as it relates to density and
distribution,  can be combined to form a
broad principle  of limiting factors.

1 The abundance, distribution, activity
  and growth of a population are deter-
  mined by a combination of factors,  any
  one of which may through scarcity or
  Overabundance be limiting.

2 The artificial introduction of various
  substances into the environment tends
  to eliminate  limiting minimums for
  some species and create intolerable
  maximums for others.

3 The biological productivity of any body
  of water is the end result of interaction
  of the organisms present with the
  surrounding environment.
VALUE AND USE OF THE PRINCIPLE OF
LIMITING FACTORS

The organism-environment relationship
is apt to be so complex that not all factors
are of equal importance in a given situation;
some links of the chain guiding the organism
are weaker than  others.  Understanding
the broad principle of limiting factors and
the subsidiary principles involved make
the task of ferreting out the weak link in
a given situation  much easier and possibly
less time consuming and expensive.

1  If an organism has a wide range of
   tolerance for a factor which is
   relatively constant in the environment
   that factor  is not likely to be limiting.
   The factor  cannot be completely
   eliminated  from consideration, however,
   because of  factor interaction.
Figure 5.  Comparison of relative limits of
           tolerance of stenothermal and
           eurythermal organisms.
   If an organism is known to have narrow
   limits of tolerance for a  factor which is
   also variable in the environment,  that
   factor merits  careful study since it
   might be limiting.

-------
Significance of "Limiting Factors" to Population Variation
B  Because of the complexity of the aquatic
   environment, it is not always easy to
   isolate the factor in the environment that
   is limiting a particular population.
   Premature conclusions may result from
   limited observations of a particular
   situations. Many important factors may
   be overlooked unless a sufficiently long
   period of time is covered to permit the
   factors to fluctuate within their ranges of
   possible variation.  Much time and money
   may be wasted on control measures without
   the  real limiting factor ever being dis-
   covered or the situation being improved.

C  Knowledge of the principle of limiting
   factors may be used to limit the number
   of parameters that need to be measured or
   observed for a particular study.   Not all
   of the numerous physical,  chemical and
   biological parameters need to be measured
   or observed for each study  undertaken.
   The aims of a pollution survey are not to
   make and observe long lists of possible
   limiting factors but to discover which
   factors are significant, how they bring
   about their effects, the source or sources
   of the problem, and what control measures
   should be taken.
D  Specific factors in the aquatic environment
   determine rather precisely what kinds of
   organisms will be present in a particular
   area.  Therefore, organisms present or
   absent can be used to indicate environ-
   mental conditions.  The diversity of
   organisms provides a better  indication of
   environmental conditions than does any
   single species. Strong physio-chemical
   limiting factors tend to reduce the diversity
   within a community; more tolerant species
   are then able to undergo population growth.
REFERENCES

1 Odum,  Eugene P.  Fundamentals of
     Ecology, W. B. Saunders Company,
     Philadelphia.  (1959)

2 Reid, George K.  Ecology of Inland Waters
     and Estuaries.  Reinhold Publishing
     Corporation, New York. (1961)
This outline was prepared by John E.
Matthews, Aquatic Biologist, Robert S. Kerr
Water Research Center.  Ada.  Oklahoma.
Descriptors:  Population, Limiting Factors
 33-4

-------
                        ALGAE AND CULTURAL EUTROPHICATION
I  INTRODUCTION

This topic covers a wide spectrum of items
often depending upon the individual discussing
the subject and the particular situation or
objectives that he is trying to "prove".
Since the writer is not a biologist,  these
viewpoints are "from the outside-looking in".
Any impression of bias is intentional.

A  Some Definitions are in Order to Clarify
   Terminology:

   1 Eutrophication - a process or action of
     becoming eutrophic,  an enrichment.
     To me,  this is a dynamic progression
     characterized by nutrient enrichment.
     Like many definitions, this one is not
     precise; stages of eutrophicatlon are
     classified as olig-,  meso-, and  eutrophic
     depending upon increasing degree.  Just
     how a given body of water may be
     classified is open to question. It
     depends upon whether you look at quiet
     or turbulent water,  top or bottom
     samples, season of the year, whether
     it is a first impression or seasoned
     judgement. It also depends upon the
     water use in which you are interested,
     such as for fishing or waste discharge.
     The transitional stages are the major
     problems - it is loud and  clear to a
     trout fisherman encountering carp and
    ' scum.

   2 Culture

     Fostering of plant or animal growth;
     cultivation of living material and
     products of such cultivation,  both fit.
     Some degree of control is implied but,
     the  control may have limitations as
     well as  advantages.  Human cultural
     development has fostered human num-
     bers successfully, but, has promoted
     rapid degradation of his natural  environ-
     ment .
    3  Nutrients

       A component or element essential to
       sustain life or living organisms.  This
       includes  many different materials,
       some in gross quantities - others in
       minor quantities.  Deficiency of any
       one essential item make living
       impossible.  Nutrients needed in large
       quantities include carbon,  hydrogen,
       oxygen, nitrogen,  phosphorus, sulfur
       and silica.  N. and P frequently are
       loosely considered as  "the"nutrients
       because of certain solubility,  con-
       version and "known" behavior
       characteristics.

    4  Algae

       A group of nonvascular plants, capable
       of growth on mineralized nutrients with
       the  aid of chlorophyll and light energy -
       known as producer organisms, since
       the  food chain is based directly or
       indirectly upon the organic material
       produced by algae.

 B Now that we have "backed into" the title
    words  via definitions,  some of the
    ramifications of eutrophication, nutrient
    enrichment,  and cultural behavior  are
    possible.
II   NUTRIENTS INTERRELATIONSHIPS

 A All nutrients are interchangeable in form,
    solubility,  availability, etc.  There are
    no "end" products.  We can isolate, cover,
    convert to  gas liquid or solid,  oxidize,
    reduce, complex, dilute,  etc.  -  some
    time, some place, that nutrient may
    recycle as part of cultural behavior.

    1  Water contact is a major factor in
       recycle dynamics just  as water
       represents two-thirds  or more of cell
  BI. ECO. hum. 3. 6.76
                                     34-1

-------
Algae and Cultural Eutrophication
      mass and appears to be the medium in
      which living forms started.  Waste
      disposal interrelationships (Figure 1)
      suggests physical interrelationships of
      soil, air and water.  The wet apex of
      this triangle is the basis for life. It's"
      difficult to isolate water from the soil
      or atmosphere - water contact means
      solution of available nutrients.
                WAST!: DISPOSAL
              INTERRELATIONSHIPS
                    ATMOSPHERE
   2   Figure 2 takes us into the biosphere (1)
      via the soluble element cycle.  This
      refers mainly to phosphorus interchange.
      Phosphorus of geological origin may be
      solubilized in water,  used by plants or
      animals and returned to water.  Natural
      movement is toward the ocean.  Less
      phosphorus returns by water transport.
      Phosphorus does not vaporize; hence,
      atmospheric transport occurs mainly
      as windblown dust. Man and geological
      upheaval, partially reverse the flow of
      phopshorus toward the ocean sink.
      SOLUBLE ELEMENT  CYCLE
 ATMOSPHERE
                                                     UTIIOSPHERE\
                                  HYDROSPHERE
The nitrogen cycle starts with ele-
mental nitrogen in the atmosphere.
It can be converted to combined form
by electrical discharge,  certain
bacteria and algae,  some plants and
by industrial fixation.  Nitrogen gas
thus may go directly into plant form
or be  fixed before entry.  Denitrification
occurs mainly via saprophytes.
(Figure 3)  Industrial fixation is a
relatively new contribution to
eutrophication.
           HITKOGEH CYCLE

-------
                                                        Algae and Cultural Eutrophication
Carbon Conversions (Figure 4) show
most of the carbon in the form of
geological carbonate (1) but bicarbonate
and CO_ readily are converted to plant
cell mass and into other life forms.
Note the relatively small fraction of
carbon in living mass.
               CIRCULATION
                 PHERE
B  Nutrient - Growth Relationships

   Nutrient cycles could go on, but, life
   depends upon a mixture of essential
   nutrients under favorable conditions.
   Too much of any significant item in the
   wrong place may be considered as
   pollution.  Since toxicity is related to
   chemical concentration, time of exposure
   and organism sensitivity, too much
   becomes toxic. If it happens to be too
   much growth, its a result of eutrophication.
   'How much' is generally more important
   than the "what1? Both natural and manmade
   processes lead to biological conversions,
   to pollution, to eutrophication and to
   toxicity.  Man is the only animal that can
   concentrate, speed up, invent, or otherwise
   alter these conversions to make  a collossal
   mess.

   1   Life forms have been formulated in
      terms of elemental or nutrient com-
      ponents many times. The simplest is
      CgHgOJST.  A more complex formula
      i Q I"*    r-f  O  1ST    r^o f"1! "P  ("SiT?
      18 °100H76U80JN20 Ca6CI7  2CUF2
      SiMgMn K NaS ^Zn.  This includes
16 elements.  More than 30 have been
implicated as essential and they still
would not "live", unless they were
correctly assembled.  As a nutrient
Mnemonic H.  COPKINS - - Mg(r)-
CaFe-MoB does fajirly well.  It also
indicates Iodine-I,  Iron-Fe,
Molybdenum-Mo, and Boron-B that
were not included earlier.

The  Law of Distribution states that
"Any given habitat tends to favor all
suitable  species - any given  species
tends to be present in all suitable
habitats. " Selection tends to favor the
most suitable species at a given place
and time.

Liebigs Law  of the  Minimum,  states
that  "The essential material available
in amounts most closely approaching
the critical minimum will tend to be
the limiting growth factor. "

Shelfords law recognizes that there
will  be some low concentration of any
nutrient that  will not support growth.
Some higher  concentration will stimulate
growth.  Each nutrient will have some
still higher concentration that will be
bacteriostatic or toxic.  This has been
discussed earlier but was considered in
a different manner.
                                          Ill  BIOLOGICAL PROGRESSIONS

                                            The biological "balance" appears to be a very
                                            transitory condition in cultural behavior.
                                            Man favors production.  A steady state
                                            "balance" does not persist very long unless
                                            energy of the system is  too low to permit
                                            significant growth.  A progression of species
                                            where each predominent form thrives for a
                                            time, then is displaced by another temporarily
                                            favored group is usual.  Yearly events in the
                                            lawn start with chickweed, then dandelion,
                                            plantain,  crab grass,  ragweed,  etc., in
                                            successive predominence.  Occasionally,
                                            more desirable  grasses may appear on the
                                            lawn.  Grass is a selected unstable  "culture".

-------
Algae and Cultural Eutrophication
A Figure 3 shows a biological progression (2)
   following introduction of wastewater in an
   unnamed stream.  Sewage or slime bacteria
   proliferate rapidly at first followed by
   ciliates, rotifers, etc.
                                                                  THE BIOTA
                                      SEWAGE BACTERIA
                                         NO. PER ml.
           UJ
           H-
              3001-
              200-
           UJ
           0.
           O  100
          1
                      210123456789
                                                 DAYS
                     24   12    0    12   24   36  48   60   72   84    96   108
                                                MILES
              5. Bacteria thrive and finally become prey of the ciliates, which in turn are food for the rotifers and crustaceans.
B  Figure 4 shows another progression of
   bottom dwelling larva.  Here the sequence
   of organisms changes after^wastewater
   introduction from aquatic insects to sludge
   worms, midges, sow bugs  and then to
   re-establishment of insects.
                                                                        THE BIOTA
                                                               SLUDGE WORMS
                                          Figure 6. The population curve of Figure 7 is composed of a seriet of maxima
                                          for individual species, each multiplying and dying off as stream conditions vary.

-------
                                                             Algae and Cultural Eutrophication
    Another progression after waste
    introduction changes the biota from
    an algal culture to sewage moulds with
    later return to  algal predominence.
                                               FMI«AFf"T'M   THE BIOTA
                                2

                               24
    2   3  4
      DAYS
12  24  36  48
     MILES
6789

72  84  96  108
                        Q r IgUre  'Shortly after sewage discharge, the mouldi attain maximum growth.
                        These are associated with sludge deposition shown in the lower curve. The sludge is
                        decomposed gradually; as conditions clear up, algae gain a foothold and multiply.
    Figures 5,  6,  and 7 are shown separately
    only because one visual would be unreadable
    with all possible progressions  on it.   There
    are progressions for fungi, protista,  insect
    larvae, worms,  fish, algae, etc.  Each
    species will perform as it may perform.
    It it cannot compete successfully, it will
    be replaced by those that  can compete
    under prevailing conditions at the time.
    Conditions  shift  rapidly with rapid  growth.
IV  The interactions of bacteria or fungi and
 algae  (Figure 8) are particularly
 significant to eutrophication.

 A The bacteria or the saprophytic group
    among them tend to work on preformed
    organic materials  - pre-existing organics
    from dead or  less  favored organisms.
    Algal cells produce the organics from
    light energy chlorophyll and mineralized
    nutrients.  This is a happy combination
    for both:  The algae release the oxygen
    for use by the bacteria while the bacteria
    release the CO  needed by the algae.
              Since the algae also acquire  CO  from
              the atmosphere, from wastewater and
              from geological sources,  it always ends
              up with more enrichment  of nutrients in
              the water - more enrichment means  more
              growth and growing organisms eventually
              clump and deposit.  The nature of growth
              shifts  from free growth to rooted forms,
              starting in the shallows.  Another
              progression occurs (Figures 9 and 10).

              It is this relationship that favors profuse
              nuisance growth of algae below significant
              waste  discharges.  There is a  tremendous
              pool of carbon dioxide available in
              geological formations and in the air.
              Transfer to the water is significant and
              encourages algal productivity and eventual
              eutrophication of any body of water,  but,
              this does not occur  as rapidly as when the
              water body is super saturated with  CO
              from bacterial  decay of wastewater
              discharges or benthic deposits  from  them.

-------
Algae and Cultural Eutrophicatlon
                              NATION
                     t>»e>

                LITTORAL
                               LIMNETIC
                                      PROFUNDAL
                              PHOTOSYNTHESIS
         DEAD
         ALGAE
        SEWAGE
         DEAD
        BACTERIA
OXIDATION
   BY
  BY
   m
ALGAE
BACTERIA
                                             ^ LIGHT
                           MINERALS

-------
                                                         Algae and Cultural Eutrophication
                                     RAl   Z
                                     SEED  PLANTS

                                         FERNS
   Nitrogen and phosphorus are essential
   for growth.  They also are prominently
   considered in eutrophication control.
   Algal cell mass is about 50% carbon,
   15% nitrogen and approximately 1%
   phosphorus not considering luxury uptake
   in excess of immediate use.  Phosphorus
   is considered as the most  controllable
   limiting nutrient.  It's control is com-
   plicated by the feedback of P from benthic
   sediments and surface wash.  Phosphorus
   removal means solids removal.  Good
   clarification is essential to obtain good
   removal of P.  This also means improved
   removal of other nutrients- a major
   advantage of the P removal route.  Both
   N & P are easily converted from one form
   to another; most forms are water soluble.
V  SUMMARY

 Control of eutrophication is not entirely
 possible.  Lakes must eventually fill with
 benthic sediments,  surface wash and
 vegetation. Natural processes eventually
 cause filling.  Increased nutrient discharges
 from added activities grossly increase filling
 rate.
                                                           CHARAPHYTES
                                                                     LADOPHORA
A  We produce more nutrients per capita per
   day in the United States than in other
   nations and much more today than 100
   years ago.  More people in population
   centers accentuate the problem.

B  Technology is available to remove most
   of the nutrients from the water carriage
   system.

   1  This technology will not be used unless
      water is recognized to be in short
      supply.

   2  It  will not be used unless we place a
      realistic commodity value on the water
      and are willing to pay for cleanup for
      reuse purposes.

C  Removal must be followed by isolation of
   acceptable gases to the atmosphere
   acceptable solids into the soil for reuse
   or storage.  Water contact cannot be
   prevented, but it must be limited or the
   enrichment of the water body is hastened.

-------
 Algae and Cultural Eutrophication
REFERENCES
                                                 This outline was prepared by F. J. Ludzack,
   A collection of articles on the Biosphere        Chemist, National Training Center,
      Sci. Am. 223:(No. 3).  pp.  44-208.           MOTD, OWPO, USEPA, Cincinnati, Ohio
      September 1970.                           45268.

   Bartch,  A.E. and Ingram, W.M.              Descriptors:  Algae,  Eutrophication
      Stream life and the Pollution Environ-
      ment. Public Works 90:(No. 7) 104-
      110.   July 1959.
 34-8

-------
                         CONTROL OF PLANKTON IN SURFACE WATERS
 I  PHILOSOPHICAL CONSIDERATIONS

 A Plankton growths are as natural to aquatic
   areas as green plants are to land areas
   and respond to the same stimuli.
 B  Man is currently harnessing plankton forms
    to accomplish useful work.

    1  For generation of oxygen

      a  Stabilization of waste waters in
         oxidation ponds

      b  Oxygen recovery from CO2 in space
         travel

    2  For augmentation of food supply

      a  Fish ponds

      b  Nitrogen fixation in rice growing

      c  Harvesting of algae for direct use
         as food
    A growing knowledge of the nutrient re-
    quirements of plankton organisms will
    lead to a more enlightened approach to
    ways and means of controlling their growth
    when desirable.
II   CLASSICAL METHODS OF CONTROL

 A  Chemical

    1  Inorganic

      a  Copper sulfate is used most exten-
         sively. It is most effective in pre-
         ventive rather than curative treat-
         ment.  It  has  long lasting effects in
         soft  waters but is  short-lived in hard
         waters due to precipitation of the
         Cu++ as a basic carbonate. The pre-
         cipitated material accumulates in
          bottom muds and is toxic to certain
          benthal forms,  some of which serve
          as important fish food.

          Dosages are normally based on the
          alkalinity of the water.  When alka-
          linity is < 40 mg/1, the recommended
          dosage is 0. 3 mg/1 of CuSO^ 5H2O
          in total volume of water.  When
          alkalinity is > 40 mg/1, recommended
          dosage is 2. 0 mg/1 in surface foot
          of water.

       b  Chlorine is preferable to copper
          sulfate in the control of certain
          forms of algae.  However, it is
          difficult to apply in most instances
          and is very short-lived due to photo
          catalytic decomposition of HC1O —
          HC1 + O.

       Organic - Numerous organic compounds
       have been evaluated,  especially in re-
       lation to control of blue-green algae.
       "Phygon",  2, 3-dichloronaphthoquinone,
       has been field tested but is too specific
       in its action for general application.
Ill  ECOLOGICAL CONTROL

 A  Theory - Ecological control is based upon
    the principle of preventing or restricting
   • growth by limiting one or more of the
    essential requirements.  This is an ap-
    plication of Liebig's Law of the Minimum.
    The logical avenues of control are as
    follows:

    1  Elimination of light

    2  Limiting  nutrient materials

 B  Light - Many cities have solved the prob-
    lem of plankton growths by the use of
    covered reservoirs, underground and
    elevated.  Concurrently, they have solved
    contamination problems created by birds
    and atmospheric fallout. In open reservoirs,
 BL MIC. con. lOb, 6. 76
                                                                                       35-1

-------
Control of Plankton in Surface Waters
   some  success has been obtained by
   limiting light through the use of a film of
   activated carbon.
C  Nutrients - Since phytoplankton (algae)
   serve as the base of the food chain, know-
   ledge concerning their nutrient require-
   ments is required for ecological control,
   when limitation of light is impractical.
   The nutrient requirements of phytoplankton
   are as follows:

   1  Nature of - The major nutrients are:

      a  Carbon dioxide

      b  Nitrogen - ammonia and nitrates
         (also  N2)

      c  Phosphorus - phosphates.

      Minor nutrients are:

      d  Sulfur - sulfates

      e  Potassium

      f   Trace inorganics - magnesium, iron,
         etc.

      g  Trace organics-vitamins,  amino .
         acids

   2  Sources  of - See Fig.  1

      a  Atmosphere

      b  Groundwater - springs

      c  Storm water or  surface runoff

      d  Waste waters -  domestic sewage and
         industrial wastes.

   3  Significance of each major nutrient

      a  Carbon dioxide - See Fig. 2
           Usually present in great abundance.
        Rapidly replenished from atmosphere
         and bacterial decomposition of organ-
         ic matter.   No reasonable possibility
         of human control.   Nature, however,
         does provide some  control through
         elevated pH levels if carbon dioxide
         becomes depleted rapidly.

      b  Nitrogen -Like land plants, certain
         algal forms prefer nitrogen in the
         form of NH3(NH4+) and others prefer
         it in the form of NOs".  Both forms
         often become depleted during the
         growing season and reach maximum
         concentrations during the winter
         season. A level of 0. 30 mg/1 of
         inorganic nitrogen at the time of the
         spring turnover is considered to be
         the maximum permissible level .

         All natural surface waters are
         saturated with nitrogen gas.  This
         serves  as a source of nitrogen for
         bacteria and algae capable of fixing
         it.

      c  Phosphorus - A key element in all
         plant and animal nutrition.  The
         critical level is considered to be
         0.01 mg/1 at the time of the spring
         turnover .     Phosphorus is needed
         to sustain nitrogen fixing forms.
D  Practice Of

   1  Exclusion of  light - Practice well
      established in distribution system
      reservoirs but impractical on large
      storage reservoirs.

   2  Nutrient  limitation

      a  Control of surface run-off quality

        1) Agricultural
        2) Other

      b  Diversion of sewage plant effluents

        1) Madison,  Wisconsin
        2) Detroit Lakes,  Minnesota
        3) Pending - State College,  Pa.


      c  Tertiary treatment of sewage

        1) Nitrogen removal - Because of
           the several forms is very difficult.
 35-2

-------
                      ATMOSPHERE
                        STORM   \/  WASTE
                        WATER   V  WATER
                       (SURFACE  A (DOM. SEW.
                       RUN - OFF)/\JND. WASTE
 GROUND
 WATER
(SPRINGS)
LAKE
OR

RESERVOIR
       FIG. I   SOURCES  OF FERTILIZING
             MATERIALS  OF CONCERN
             IN SURFACE  WATERS
                                                            o
                                                            o_

                                                            o
                                                             o
                                                 a
                                                 w
                                                             o
                                                             (D

                                                             £

                                                             £
                                                             (?

                                                             in

-------
     CO,
CD I
                       ATMOSPHERE
                         WATER
ro + H O ^ 	 H* •+• nr.n~
l^">^"«0
,. x». *
PLANTS
1
ORGANIC
CARBON
FIG. 2 CARBON DIO>
co;
+
H2°
[IDE-

•f H.O , 2 H CO _ +
A
	 w MLU j *
BICARBONATE - CARBONATE
Co
OH
- H'
                                                                o
                                                                o
                                                                3

                                                                O

                                                                O
                                                                P
                                                                O
                                                                D


                                                                c
                                                                o
                                                                (D
         RELATIONSHIPS IN NATURAL WATERS

-------
                                                Control of Plankton in Surface Waters
     Also, may be unsuccessful in
     control unless phosphorus is con-
     trolled, too, because of nitrogen
     fixing forms.

   2) Phosphorus removal - Phosphorus
     can be effectively removed by
     coagulation methods employing
     lime, alum or ferric salts.  It
     is expensive and no one has
     proven its value beyond laboratory
     experiments.

d  By Biological Engineering

   Laboratory studies have shown that
   effluents essentially free  of plant
   fertilizing elements can be produced
   by biological treatment of wastes
   with proper ratios of C to N  and P.
   3  Experiences

      a Madison

      b Detroit Lakes

      c State College

      d Lake Winnisquam, N. H.

E  Practical Aspects

   1  Diversion

   2  Nutrient  control

REFERENCE

Mullican,  Hugh F. (Cornell Univ.)
   Management of Aquatic Vascular Plants
   and Algae,  pp. 464-482.  (in Eutro-
   phication:  Causes,  Consequences, and
   Correction.  Nat. Acad. Sci.)  1969.


This outline was prepared by C. N. Sawyer,
Director of Research,  Metcalf & Eddy
Engineers, Boston, Massachusetts.

Descriptors:  Algicides,  Eutrophication
                                                                            35-5

-------
             CONTROL OF INTERFERENCE ORGANISMS IN WATER SUPPLIES
 I  NECESSITY FOR DATA

 A Information on the number,  kinds, and
   effects of interference organisms in a
   particular water supply is essential for
   determining adequate control measures.

 B Collection of the biological data should be
   on a regular routine basis.

 C Interpretation of data requires information
   on relationship of number and kinds of
   organisms to the effects produced.

 D It is generally more satisfactory to an-
   ticipate and prevent problems due to these
   organisms than it is to cope with them later.
II   CONTROL IN RAW WATER SUPPLY

 A  Use of algicides

    1  Application of an algicide is to prevent
      or  destroy excessive growths of algae
      which occur as  blooms, mats or a high
      concentration of plankton.

    2  Algicide may be applied to control even
      low concentrations of certain algae such
      as  Synura.

    3  Copper sulfate is the only algicide in
      common use at  present.

      a   Application may be by dusting,
          spraying or dissolving from a porous
          container over all or part of the water
          surface, or by continuous feeding
          of the algicide at the intake of the
          reservoir or pre-treatment basin.

      b   Effective dosage depends upon the
          Alkalinity and pH and temperature
          of the water  and the amount and
          kinds of algae to be  controlled.
          Bartch states that the following
          arbitrary dosages have been found
          to be generally effective and safe:

          M.O. alkalinity > 50 p.p. m.  =
          2 p. p. m. in  the surface foot of
          water only (5.4 pounds per acre).
      M.O.  alkalinity < SO p.p. m. =0.3
      p. p. m.  in total volume of water
      (0. 9 pound per acre foot).

   c  Application of copper sulfate should
      be limited to the minimum effective
      dosage because of its corrosive
      properties,  and its toxicity to fish and
      other  aquatic animals.

4  Other algicides

   a  Promising types include  inorganic
      salts,  organic salts, rosin amines,
      antibiotics,  quinones,  substituted
      hydrocarbons, quaternary ammonium
      compounds,  amide derivatives and
      phenols. Cuprichloramine which is
      a combination of copper, chlorine and
      ammonia, and also chlorine dioxide
      have shown promise  as general algi-
      cides.

   b  For domestic water supplies they will
      have to be not only economically fea-
      sible but nontoxic to  animal life and
      to green plants  other than algae.

   c  Due to higher costs they  will prob-
      ably be used only when adequate plank-
      ton and algal records are kept, which
      would permit early localized treat-
      ment.

   d  Algicides selectively toxic to the
      particular algae of greatest signifi-
      cance  would be  useful.

5  Mechanical removal or spreading out
   to permit rapid drying may  be  the sim-
   plest way of handling massive growths
   which are detached and washed ashore.

6  Turbidity due to silt keeps down the
   plankton  population.  In shallow reservoirs,
   fish which stir up the bottom mud will
   aid in keeping turbidity due  to silt high.

7  Provisions for keeping the amounts of
   nutrients to a minimum may be em-
   phasized more  in the future.

8  For new  reservoirs, clearing the site
  BI. MIC. con. 6b. 6. 76
                                                                                       36-1

-------
 Control of Interference Organisms in Water Supplies
       of vegetation and organic debris before
       filling will reduce the algal nutrients.
       Steep rather than gentle  slopes will
       reduce the areas which allow marginal
       growths to occur.
HI  CONTROL IN TREATMENT PLANT

 A Coagulation and sedimentation

    1  When well regulated they often will re-
       move 90 per cent or more  of the plank-
       ton.

    2  With low plankton counts, a coagulant
       aid may be required.

    3  Frequent removal of sludge from the
       basins, especially during the warm
       seasons may help to reduce tastes and
       odors originating from decomposing
       organic sediment.

 B Sand filtration

    1  Both slow and rapid sand filters tend to
       reduce the plankton count of the effluent by
       90 per cent or more, when well regu-
       lated.

    2  For rapid filters,  accumulated plankton
       can be removed or reduced by surface
       scraping and by back washing.

 C Micro-straining

    1  This involves the passing of the water
       through a finely woven fabric of stain-
       less steel.  All but the smaller plankton
       organisms tend to be removed from the
       water.  It is being used in  some treat-
       ment plants in England and elsewhere.

 D Activated carbon

    1  The slightly soluble, organic, taste
       and odor compounds tend to be readily
       adsorbed by the activated carbon.  It
       is probably most often applied prior to
       coagulation, but may be used prior to
       filtration or in the raw water.

 E Chlorination
    1  Treatment with chlorine is practiced
       primarily to destroy pathogenic organ-
       isms.  The dosages commonly used are
       toxic also to many algae and to some of
       the other groups of aquatic organisms.
       However,  dead as well as living organ-
       isms are often capable of causing tastes
       and odors and of clogging filters.

    The  depth and position of the intake for
    entrance of raw water into the treatment
    plant may determine the kinds and amount
    of plankton which will be drawn into the
    plant.  Plankton algae generally are more
    concentrated near the surface of the water
    in lakes and reservoirs.
IV  CONTROL IN DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM

 A Maintenance of a chlorine residual con-
    trols the chlorine sensitive organisms.

 B Other pesticides such as cuprichloramine
    have been used in attempts to control the
    resistant organisms such as worms,
    nematodes and copepod eggs.

 C Flushing of infested portions of the system,
    especially  dead ends may be practiced.

 D Covering of treated water reservoirs to
    prevent the entrance of light will stop the
    growth of algae.

 E Organisms associated with pipe corrosion
    are probably the most active when the water
    itself is corrosive.

 F Mechanical cleaning of  the distribution
    system may be an effective but expensive
    method of reducing infestations of attached
    organisms.
 V  SUMMARY

 A Adequate control is dependent upon ade-
    quate procedures for detecting and record-
    ing of organisms.

 B Control may involve the following:

    1  Use of an algicide or pesticide.
    36-2

-------
                                      Control of Interference Organisms in Water Supplies
2  Mechanical cleaning of distribution
   lines, settling basins, and filters,
   screens, intake channels and reservoir
   margins.

3  Modification of coagulation,  filtration,
   chemical treatment or location of raw
   water intake.

4  Use of adsorbent, such as activated
   carbon,  for taste and odor substances.

5  Modification of reservoir to reduce the
   opportunities for massive growths.

   a  By covering treated water reservoirs

   b  By increasing the depth of the water

   c  By eliminating shallow marginal
      areas
         By reducing the amount of fertilizing
         nutrients entering the reservoir

         By encouraging a balanced develop-
         ment of the aquatic organisms
REFERENCE

Mackenthun,  Kenneth M.   The Practice of
   Water Pollution Biology.   FWPCA.
   U. S. Dept. of Interior,  Washington, DC.
   1969.

Smalls, I.C. and Greaves, G. F., A Survey
   of Animals in Distribution  Systems.
   Water Treat. Exam.  17 (3): 150-186.
   1968.

Houghton, G. U., Observations on the Asellus
   Problem in South Essex.  Water Treat.
   Exam.  17 (2): 127-133.   1968.

Bellinger, B.C., A Key to the Identification of
   the More Common Algae Found in Water
   Undertakings in Britain. Water Treat. Exam.
   18 (2):  106-127.  1969.  (see also 23 (1)
   76-131.  1974)

Bays, L. R., Pesticide Pollution and the
   Effects on the Biota of Chew Valley Lake.
   Water Treat. Exam. 18 (4): 295-326.  1969.

Blogoslawski, Walter J. and Rice,  Rip G.,
Aquatic Applications of Ozone.  International
Ozone Institute. Syracuse Univ.  1975.
                                              This outline was prepared by C. M.  Palmer,
                                              former Aquatic Biologist,  Biological Treat-
                                              ment Research Activities, Cincinnati Water
                                              Research Laboratory, FWPCA, SEC.

                                              Descriptor: Nuisance Organisms
                                                                                 36-3

-------
                    THE BIOLOGY OF PIPES, CONDUITS,AND CANALS
 I   INTRODUCTION

    Water moving in man made structures of
    metal and concrete offers another niche
    for over 100 types of aquatic organisms
    from protozoa,  to five  centimeter clams.

    Unfortunately these  structures are
    planned, constructed, and managed by
    people who are  unaware of the biolog-
    ical potential for  mischief and this be-
    comes translated into often severe
    economic liabilities.

II   CRUSTACEA

 A  Copepods

    Often appear in finished water and clear-
    wells, because  the minute eggs pass
    rapid sand filters.

 B  Isopods

    Are often present in numbers up to  100
    per meter of conduit.  Their presence
    may go undetected unless special
    sampling procedures are used,  such as
    foam plugs sent hydraulically through
    a line with a sieving device at the other
    end to capture the dislodged organisms.

    In England, where the problem appears tc
    be more acute,  it is associated with sur-
    face water sources and rapid sand filters.
    Apparently only a chance introduction of
    an individual is needed, then populations
    propagate within  the mains and smaller
    lines.

Ill  MOLLUSCS

    Bivalves (clams and mussels) are often
    more spectacular when invading a water
    distribution system because of their shell
    size and greater biomass.

 A  Life History

    The problem here relates to the "D"
    stage larvae (see Fig.  1) or veliger
   (around 200 microns in size) which is
   free living and thereby passes screens
   and obstructions along with the water
   mass.  The adults live in or on the
   substrate and during breeding periods
   billions of these tiny veligers are
   discharged into the water currents.
   All hydro installations thereby are
   very vulnerable to an infestation of
   clams.

B  Veliger to Byssiger

   Notice  in figure one how  the larval
   mollusc changes from a  swimming
   and/or floating plankter  to a byssus
   attached benthlc form.  This life
   history (shared by none  of our native
   bivalves) graphically demonstrates
   how the numerous veligers in the
   water are drawn in with  the intake
   water and dispersed through the system.
   The transitional stage, the pediveliger,
   can opt for another substrate if the
   first is unsuitable, for it still retains the
   velum  for free movement while having
   a ciliated notched  foot for climbing and
   exploring the substrate.  When the velum
   is finally lost as development proceeds
   the.byssiger can still explore about by
   foot while retaining elastic anchored life
   lines.  A study of this figure explains
   the severe mechanical problem in stopping
   water by heavy shelled adults.  i

C  Pest Species

   The worst are usually exotic, that is
   imported, and exotics are nearly always
   bad whether it be plants  or animals.

   1  Dreissena polymorpha the Zebra Clam.

      Not yet in North America but has
      created many problems in Europe where
      it took over a century to spread.

   2  Corbicula manilensis  the Asian Clam.
      or Good Luck Clam. (Figures 2  and 3).

      Initially it became a problem in the
      40's in California, and now it is found
 BI. MIC. con. 13.6.76
                                 37-1

-------
VELIGER
                         PEDIVELIGER     BYSSIGER
                                                BENTHIC
                           Figure 1 D-Stage

                   Bivalve Larval Stages (app. 200 microns)
              Figure 2

    Corbicula or Exotic Asian Clam
Approximately 6 cm maximum size. Notice
serrated "teeth".
                                                Figure 3

                                       Corbicula or Exotic Asian Clam
                                  Approximately 6 cm maximum size. Notice
                                  heavy corrugated outer shell.
                                                            37-2

-------
                                             The Biology of Pipes,  Conduits,  and Canals
 D
   in most North American drainage
   systems.  Literature on this species
   is voluminous. It has been a severe
   pest, in TVA steam plants  and numerous
   water diversion schemes.  Most
   probably it was introduced through
   immigrants from Canton,  China.   In
   its native range it is of value as a
   commercial food  species.

3  Limnoperna fortune!

   A serious pest in Hong Kong water
   supplies.

4  Modioius striatulus

   A serious pest in Calcutta water
   supplies.

As Morton points out these species are
problems in water supplies and distribu-
tion systems because they are/or have a
    1  Opportunist
    2  Grow fast
    3  Long breeding season
    4  High reproductive potential
    5  Free swimming larval phase (the
      veliger).
    6  Quick to colonize all available
      substrates.

 E  Treatment and prevention has largely
    (and successfully) been limited to
    chlorine.

IV  Pipe Ecology

    A pipe  is simply a place to live.

 A  Habitat

    Even under great velocities a pipe's inner
    surface offers a place of attachment.
    Rough surfaces afford micro-habitats.

 B  Niche

    Even though potable water may be very
    low in nutrients and particulate organic
    matter, the constant velocity makes it
    a  rich food supply.  Predators may be
    completely absent.
C  It may be dark inside but a link to the
   outside photosynthetic world of food
   plants and decomposing bacteria
   (bacteria are food to a variety of
   pipe dwelling animals) is in constant
   motion.

V  In conclusion it is no surprise
   to a biologist to discover a variety and
   abundance of organisms (micro and
   macro in size) well adapted to living in
   just about any pumped water supply,
   even when lines are subject to
   chlorine.

REFERENCES

1  Morton, Brian.  The  Colonization of
   Hong Kong1 s Raw Water Supply System
   by Limnoperna fortune!.  (Dunker  1857)
   (Bivalvia: Mytilacea)  from China.
   Malacol. Rev. 8:91-105. 1975.

2  Clarke,  K. B.  The Infestation of Water-
   works by Dreissena p olymorpha. a
   freshwater mussel. J. Inst. Water Engrs.
   6:370-379.  1952.

3  Sinclair, Ralph M.  Annotated Bibliography
   of The Exotic Bivalve Corbicula in North
   America.   Sterkiana 43:11-18.   1971.

4  Mattice,  J. S. and Tilly, L. J.  Corbicula
   Newsletter  . Envir.  Sci. Div., Oak Ridge
   National Laboratory,  Oak Ridge,TN 37830.
   Issued irregularly,  names added to mailing
   list by request to Dr. Mattice at address
   above.  Contains  summarys of ongoing
   research on control of Corbicula.

5  Smalls,  I. C. and Greaves,  G. F.  A Survey
   of Animals in Distribution Systems. Water
   Tr. and Exam.  17:150-186.  1968
   (Thirty six water supply systems were
   examined taking flush samples from the
   distribution system.   Over 100 types of
   animals were taken. )
                                               This outline was prepared by R. M.  Sinclair,
                                               National Training Center, MOTD, OWPO,
                                               USEPA, Cincinnati, Ohio 45268.

                                               Descriptors:  Molluscs, Isopods, Fouling,
                                               Nuisance Organisms,  Pipelines
                                                                                      37-3

-------
                SAN FRANCISCO EXPERIENCE WITH NUISANCE ORGANISMS
 I  INTRODUCTION

 In order to have a clear picture of the
 problems in  the San Francisco Water Supply
 system by nuisance organisms an understand-
 ing of the basic system should be helpful.

 The largest quantity of water is produced in
 the Hetch Hetchy watershed, located in
 Yosemite National  Park.  This water is
 transmitted some 150 miles by tunnel and
 pipe to the San Francisco Bay Area, where
 the water not sold enroute is discharged
 into Crystal  Springs Reservoir.  From
 Crystal Springs Reservoir, water either
 flows by gravity to the lower elevations
 of the San Francisco Peninsula and  the City
 proper, or is pumped to nearby San Andreas
 Reservoir.   This latter reservoir supplies
 the higher areas.   The capacity of Hetch
 Hetchy reservoir is 117 billion gallons,
 Crystal Springs 22.5 billion gallons and
 San Andreas 6 billion gallons.  All water
 flowing from the local reservoirs is chlor-
 inated and fluoridated along with the custom-
 ary copper sulphate treatment for algae
 control of surface waters.

 Two other parts of the system should be
 mentioned, although these waters have not
 been involved particularly with nuisance
 organisms.  On the East Side of San Fran-
 cisco Bay the San Francisco Water  Depart-
 ment owns and operates two large reservoirs,
 San Antonio and Calaveras.  The water from
 these reservoirs passes through the 80 m. g. d.
dual media, Sunol Valley Water Filtration
 Plant capable of complete treatment.

 All watersheds tributary to Crystal  Springs
 and San Andreas Reservoirs are owned by
 the Water Department and only seven water-
 shed keepers live on the 25, 000 acres.   The
 other reservoirs are quite remote and human
 activity is small compared to the area
 involved.

 The distribution and transmission system
within San Francisco consists of eighteen
 pressure zones; ten large covered reservoirs
 with capacities ranging from 2. 5 to 176. 7
 million gallons; 1, 163 miles of pipe and the
 usual pumping stations, valves, etc.  The
 goal of this presentation is to describe  the
 problems caused by nuisance organisms in
 the San Francisco  system and briefly relate
 what was done about them, if anything.

 The following described outbreaks of nuisance
 organisms occurred during the period 1934
 to the present.

II  AQUATIC ACTINOMYCETES

 During Spring of 1956 there appeared in the
 distribution system increasing incidents of
 earthy taste and odor complaints, many by
 our staff.  Even the management was of the
 opinion that the water was becoming poorer
 and poorer;  so  a graduate student in micro-
 biology was  hired for the  summer to investi-
 gate the possibility of actinomycetes being the
 source.  Positive results were obtained from
 many samples of water but a definite pattern
 could not be established that would implicate
 any part of the  system.

 Before finite data could be established the
 need to raise our chlorine residuals to  com-
 bat persistant coliforms became our over-
 whelming problem, and in the course of events
 chlorine taste complaints took the place of
 earthy and woody complaints.  No doubt the
 chlorine residuals of lmg/1  and better
 distribution maintenance with regards to
 water quality were responsible for the control
 of these organisms.

 Those having complaints of this nature  are
 referred to the many articles in the Journal
 by Professor J. K. G.  Silvey and his co-
 workers. (1)

III  BRYOZOAN

 This outbreak occurred during the Spring
 of 1956.
 BI. MET. con. 6. 6.76
                                                                                     38-1

-------
 San Francisco Experience With Nuisance Organisms
A routine complaint was turned over to the
Department Laboratory for inspection.  A
customer had complained that little black
specks were caught in her nylons after
washing.  Inspection showed that they were
coming from the tap and flushing of nearby
fire hydrant produced clusters of the black
organisms up to the size of a quarter.

The black specks were identified as
statoblasts of Bryozoan, and Whipples
description of a Brooklyn Water Depart-
ment outbreak in 1897 really shook the staff
up.  His description states,  "In a number
of instances this material  stopped up the
taps, and even large pipes were choked". (2)
Great black masses of these statoblasts
could be imagined blocking our pipes and
valves.

The area for several blocks  around was
flushed until no further statoblasts were
observed.  In spite of a close inspection
of other parts of the system, including
distribution and impounding  reservoirs no
additional organisms were found.  In fact
these Bryozoans have never  been encountered
again.

In the laboratory, attempts were made to
germinate the statoblasts to  no avail and
it was assumed that the organisms were
dead.  Several months later  a test  tube of
statoblasts in water which had laid on a
table formed colonies.

Although the San Francisco Water Supply has
experienced only the one outbreak,  Bryozoans
are a common nuisance in water systems.
Prokopovich and Hebert (3) described a
problem in California's Delta-Mendota
Canal and Whipple also described outbreaks
in Hartford, Connecticut and  Boston,
Massachusetts.

IV  CHLOROPHYTA: BULBOCHAETA AND
    SPIROGRYRA

Although plankton net catches from the large
Hetch Hetchy reservoir contain high counts
of Crustacea the reservoir has never
required copper sulphate treatment.
During November  1964 a number of complaints
from the Department wholesale customers
were received, stating water meters were
clogging with a growth.   At the time both
Hetch Hetchy and Calaveras Reservoirs
were supplying the Bay Division Lines and
Department personnel jumped to the con-
clusion that the growth must be originating
in Calaveras Reservoir which was not
filtered at this time  and routinely needs
copper sulphate treatment.  Accordingly,
Calaveras was shut down and all customers
were supplied from Hetch .-tetchy, but meters
continued to clog.  Further investigations were
made and the trouble traced to the source
which was a short section of the Tuolumne
River where the Hetch Hetchy water ran in
the river a distance  of twelve  miles before
entering the tunnel and pipe system.

As this section of the system was in the
Yosemite National Park, permission to
treat parts of the river with copper sulphate
was requested of the Department of Interior,
and tests were run at the nearby Moccasin
Fish Hatchery.  These tests showed treat-
ment could be effective without killing trout.

Prior to the conclusion of the  above tests a
telegram was received from Washington
which read "Technicians this Service and
Bureau of Sport Fisheries  and Wildlife
consider knowledge about use  of the chem-
ical inadequate at this time to insure pre-
servation of ecological conditions based  on
potential threat to the river's  native aquatic
organisms  and possible fish kill.  We
cannot grant approval for this program. "

As the purpose of the treatment was to kill
some of  the native aquatic  organisms,  the
project to copper sulphate  the river was
abandoned without argument, but two small
regulating reservoirs were treated.

Luckily the organisms disappeared through-
out the system and have not reoccurred.
Since the above incident, this  section of  river
has been by-passed by a tunnel and the water
from Hetch Hetchy Reservoir  enters the pipe
and tunnel system directly.
 38-2

-------
                                             San Francisco Experience With Nuisance Organisms
V HYDROIDES

Within the boundries of the City and County
of San Francisco lies the 2-| billion gallon
Lagana de la Merced or as the Water
Department calls it,  Lake Merced.

Lake Merced,  formerly connected with the
Pacific Ocean by a Channel which was
closed sometime between  1869 and 1894 is
now a freshwater lake and was used for
domestic water purposes from 1895 to 1932
at which time it was placed on a standby
basis.  The lake has characteristic fresh-
water fauna, except for five species of
definitely marine affinities.  The organism
which could give trouble in the system if
this source were ever used again is
Cordylophora lacustris (Allman)
(Coelenterata Hydroidea). (4)

Hydroides were first noticed by the author
when the City's boating concessionaire
complained of  growths  covering the bottoms
of his row boats.  This was solved by  using
a non-fouling paint, but one cannot help
speculating on the problems which would be
encountered if an earthquake severed  the
normal water supply lines to the city,  in
which case Lake Merced would be the sole
source until repairs were made.

An experimental microstrainer was installed
to treat water  from Crystal Springs Reservoir
in conjunction  with coliform investigations in
 1963 and after a number of months of operation
hydroides established themsleves in the tanks.
Although this organism  did not cause opera-
tional difficulties,  it was unsightly and the
tanks had to be manually cleaned.  Strangely,
these organisms have never become
established in  the distribution system even
though there are distribution tanks and
reservoirs in the system with approximately
the same light intensity.  It can only be
assumed that the chlorine residual is  keep-
ing  the hydroides from becoming a problem.

VI MYRIOPHYLLUM OR EURASIAN
   WATERMILFOIL

Over a number of years this fern like plant
growth has been a problem in a 13.5 million
gallon open distribution reservoir within the
City  of San Francisco.  Every two to three
years the growth would be so abundant that
the weed would require harvesting by
dragging large rakes across the reservoir.
Of course, the solution was to  clean.line
and roof the reservoir which was  done in
1960.

Myriophyllum has now thoroughly established
itself in San Andreas Reservoir and because
of its size, 550 acres,  it is impossible to
control it by dragging.  The only effective
control has been  to lower the reservoir  and
let the banks dry out killing the surface
growth but,  of course,  not the  roots and the
following year if  the reservoir water level
remains relatively constant the cycle is
repeated.

With the construction of an 80 m. g. d. water
treatment plant employing coagulation, sedi-
mentation and dual media filtration, problems
are anticipated when the stems fragment
break off and either settle in the basins  or
mat the filters thus shortening the filter runs.
This will at least transfer the problem from
the water consumer to ourselves.  At the
present many consumers find the  small  fern
like leaves in their tap water and  become
most unhappy when told they are not
receiving filtered water and there is nothing
that can be done to resolve the problem;
although if the problem seems  severe and
localized, the mains in the area are flushed.

This summer some experiments are to be
performed utilizing a blanket of air bubbles
rising around the intake structure in an
attempt to keep the floating debris from
being sucked into the intake adits.

San Francisco is not alone with this problem
as the Watermilfoil has established itself in
reservoirs throughout the country.  The
TV A project has fought the problem for
over ten years.  If you are confronted with
this weed and your management asks where
it came from,  Smith of the Vector Control
Branch TVA states, "We suspect that the
original TVA milfoil infestation in Peny
River embayment of Watts Bar Reservoir
started either intentionally or otherwise
from a misplaced fish bowl plant.   From
such a modest beginning, it thrived but
remained unnoticed until its  amazing spread
began to interfere with fishing and boating.
                                                                                  38-3

-------
  San Francisco Experience With Nuisance Organisms
 Within a very short time (probably 3 to 5
 years) it embraced about 1, 500 acres. " (5)

VII PLANKTON

 This group of organisms gives trouble in almost
 any unfiltered surface supply by being observed
 by the consumer as a white swimming speck
 in a glass  of water; by dying off in the dis-
 tribution piping and adding to the organic load
 or, as has been found in San Francisco,
 protecting coliform bacteria from the action
 of chlorine.  The author presented a paper
 before this Association in 1966  detailing this
 problem wherein Cyclops, Daphnia,  etc.  were
 so protecting the coliform bacteria that 5 tubes
 positive could be obtained from  samples which
 had chlorine contact times of 2  hours at a free
 residual of 1.4 mg/1. (6)

 To the present time this problem continues
 and laboratory tests confirm the original
 hypothesis.  Since the publication of  the
 original paper,  discussions with the  operators
 of water systems similar to San Francisco's
 also support this thinking.

VIII SLIME ORGANISMS

 Hetch Hetchy water began to flow into the San
 Francisco  Water System in October  1934,
 carrying a flow  of 45 m. g. d.  Part of this
 flow, 16 m. g. d., was diverted  into a 36-inch
 wrought iron pipe that had been  laid in 1887.

 Three weeks after this diversion the carrying
 capacity started to drop  off at the rate of 0. 2
 m. g. d.  After another three week period the
 flow decreased from 16.2 to 13.6 m. g. d. a
 capacity loss of 16 per cent.  Tests failed to
 indicate any air pockets  or other obstructions
 along the line and in March 1935 the  line was
 opened for inspection. A slimy, gelatinous
 growth was found, light brown in color
 covering the entire inner surface of the pipe
 from 1/8 to 1/4 inch thick.

 Microscopic examination showed this growth
 to contain the iron bacteria Crenothrix
 and the  sulphur bacteria  Beggiatoa.

 Experiments were performed utilizing 4-inch
 pipes,  varying flows and  chemical dosages.
 Hydrated lime to raise the pH of the  water to
 10; and  copper sulphate treatment did not
 produce beneficial results.  Treating the
 water with 1-j Ib. of ammonia and 6 Ib. of
 chlorine per m. g. was effective in controlling
 the growth.

 A large chlorination plant was then built and
 growths have been controlled since by this
 treatment with the only change being the use
 of chlorine alone. (7, 8)  This use of chlorine
 alone has been effective probably  due to the
 higher flows of 100 - 275  m.g. d.  now required
 by consumption.  Generally only a slight
 taste or odor of chlorine is encountered.

 At least once since the initial start of treat-
 ment an outbreak of slime has occurred and this
 was caused by lowering the chlorine  dosage
 below the required level for 100% control.

 A visual inspection was made by shutting
 down the tunnel system.  This inspection
 showed strings of mucoid slime hanging
 from the tunnel ceiling.  Heavy  chlorination
 cleaned the tunnel and maintenance of . 5 to
 .75 mg/1 chlorine residual keeps  the tunnel
 system clean of these  slime organisms.

IX  FRESHWATER SPONGES

 During July 1961 water being withdrawn
 from San Andreas Reservoir through Outlet
 No.  3 had a very objectionable odor. The
 outlet system was drained and visual
 inspection showed large freshwater  sponges
 growing on the walls of the 72-inch bitumastic
 lined steel pipe upstream from the point of
 chlorine injection.  None  of these  growths
 could be found downstream from the point
 of chlorination but numerous growths could
 be found all the way upstream to the adit
 shut-off valve. No growths were  ever found
 on the intake screens.

 Microscopic  examination  showed this growth
 to be a freshwater sponge.  Because growths
 could not be found below the point  of chlorine
 injection the  solution obviously was to move
 the point of chlorine injection as far upstream
 as possible,  namely 1276  feet.  Crews  brushed
 the walls of the pipes free of growths, the
 line was flushed and placed back in service.
 Funds were budgeted for a new chlorine
 station and prior to its being placed into
 service the pipeline was again inspected,  and
 found to have sponge growths, this required
 38-4

-------
                                               San Francisco Experience With Nuisance Organisms
 another cleaning and the new chlorine
 station was then placed in service.  No
 problems have been encountered since.

 Strangely, there are two other outlets from
 this same reservoir and neither of these two
 have ever been found to have a sponge problem
 although all points of chlorine injection
 originally were about the same.   Possibly
 the different velocities in the three lines
 could be a factor, but one line has a
 greater velocity and the other a lower
 velocity.

 The author was interested to learn of a
 similar outbreak which was observed during
 1966 in the St. Louis County Water District.
 Those with a particular interest in fresh-
 water sponges and the resultant problems
 are particularly referred to the article in
 the Journal by King,  Ray and Tuepker. (9)
 This article goes into scientific description
 of the freshwater sponge Trochospongilla
 Leidyi and their methods of control with
 chlorine, and there is no need to repeat
 them here.

X  SUMMARY

 As San Francisco's experience with the
 common blue-green and green algae is typical,
 this paper has not included any discussion of
 these algae.  Although the local impounding
 reservoirs do have growths which are easily
 controlled through the normal bluestone
 treatment, in a few instances the  more
 exotic organisms just vanished before control
 methods were instituted.

 Operators needing assistance in identification
 or additional references are referred to the
 work of Ingram and Bartsch (10) as  excellent
 source material.

 Almost all the nuisance organisms encountered
 in the San Francisco  Water Supply System have
 been susceptible to control by chlorination but
 the resulting complaints of excessive chlorine
 taste must be accepted.   These complaints
 become less numerous as water users become
 accustomed to the chlorinous taste.   The
 ultimate goal,  of course, is filtration and
 judicious use of post  chlorination.
REFERENCES

1  Silvey, J.K. G. and Roach, A. W.
      Laboratory Culture and Odor  Producing
      Aquatic Actinomycetes.  Journal AWWA,
      51:20  (January 1959).

2  Microscopy of Drinking Water, by G. C.
      Whipple.  Revised by G. M.  Fair and
      M. C.  Whipple (4th ed., 1927).

3  Prokopovich, N. P.  and Herbert, D. J.
      Sedimentation in the Delta Mendota
      Canal.  Journal AWWA, 57:375
      (March 1965).

4  Miller, R.C.  The Relict Fauna of Lake
      Merced, San Francisco.  Sears
      Foundation:  Journal of Marine Research.
      17:375 (November 1958)

5  Smith, Gordon  E.  Eurasian Watermilfoil
      (Myriophyllum spicatum) in the
      Tennessee Valley, Paper presented at
      the meeting  of Southern Weed Con-
      vention.  Chattanooga, Tennessee.
      (January 1962).

6  Tracy, H. W. et. al. Coliform Persistance
      in  Highly Chlorinated Waters.  Journal
      AWWA 58:1151 (September 1966).

7  Arnold, G. E. Crenothrix Chokes Conduits.
      Engineering News - Record (May 28,
      1936).

8  Arnold, G. E. Tesla Portal Chloramination
      Station. Water Works and Sewage
      (April 1938).

9  King,  D.  L. et. al.   Freshwater Sponges
      in  Raw-water Transmission Lines.
      Journal AWWA 61:473 (September  1969).

10 Ingram, W. M.  and Bartsch. A.F.
      Operator's Identification Guide to
      Animals Associated with Potable Water
      Supplies.  Journal AWWA 52:1521
      (December 1960).
This outline was prepared by Harry W. Tracy,
Manager Purification Division, San Francisco
Water Department.

Descriptor: Nuisance Organisms
                                                                                 38-5

-------
                      LABORATORY:  IDENTIFICATION OF DIATOMS
 I  OBJECTIVES

 A To become familiar with important
   structural features of diatoms.

 B To learn to recognize some common
   forms at sight.

 C To learn to identify less common forms
   using technical keys.

II  PROCEDURE

 A Transfer a drop of the water sample con-
   taining diatoms to a microscope  slide.
   Cover with cover glass and observe un
-------
Laboratory:  Identification of Diatoms
Raphe - a longitudinal line (cleft) bordered on
both sides of striae.

Septa - a self-like partition in the diatom,
appearing often as a coarse line.

Striae - fine transverse lines especially
evident in the valve view.

Valve view - the top or bottom view,  in which
the diatom has rounded ends,  or is circular
in outline.
REFERENCES

1  Boyer, C. S.  The Diatomaceae of
      Philadelphia and Vicinity.  J. B. Lippin-
      cott Co.  Philadelphia.  1916. p 143.

2  Boyer, C.S.  Synopsis of North America
      Diatomaceae,  Parts I (1927) and II
      (1928).  Proceedings of the Academy
      of Natural Sciences; Philadelphia.

3  Elmo re,  C. J.  The Diatoms of Nebraska.
      University of Nebraska Studies,  21:22-
      215.   1921.

4  Hohn, M. H.  A Study of the Distribution
      of Diatoms in Western New York State.
      Cornell University Agricultural Experi-
      mental Station. Memoir 308,  pp 1-39.
      1951.

5  Pascher, A.  Bacillariophyta (Diatomeae).
      Heft 10 in Die Susswasser-Flora
      Mitteleuropas,  Jena.  1930. p 466.

6  Patrick,  R.  A Taxonomic and Ecological
      Study  of Some Diatoms from the
      Pocono Plateau and Adjucant Regions,
      Farlowia. 2:143-221.  1945.
 7  Smith, G. M.  Class Bacillariophyceae.
      Freshwater Algae of the United States,
      McGraw-Hill Book Co.  New York.
      pp 440-510  2nd Ed.  1950.

 8  Tiffany,  L. H., and Britton, M. E.  Class
      Bacillariophyceae. The Algae of
      Illinois, University of Chicago Press.
      pp 214-296.  1952.

 9  Ward, H. B.,  and Whipple, G. C.  Class I,
      Bacillariaceae (Diatoms).  Freshwater
      Biology, J.  Wiley & Sons.   New York.
      pp 171-189.  1948.

10 Weber, C.I.  A Guide to the Common
      Diatoms at Water  Pollution  Surveillance
      System  Stations.  USDI. FWPCA,
      Cincinnati, OH.  1966.

11 Whipple, G. C., Fair, G. M., and Whipple,
      M. C. Diatomaceae. Microscopy of
      Drinking Water.  Chapter 21, 4th ed.
      J. Wiley and Sons. New York.   1948.
 This outline was prepared by L. G. Williams,
 Aquatic Biologist, Formerly with Research
 and Development, Cincinnati Water Research
 Laboratory. FWPCA, SEC.

 Descriptors:  Diatoms, Analytical Techniques
39-2

-------
                      PREPARATION OF PERMANENT DIATOM MOUNTS
 I   The identification of many diatoms to
 genus and all diatoms to species requires
 that the cells be free of organic contents.
 This is necessary because the taxonomy of
 the diatoms is based on the structure of the
 frustule (shells) of the organisms and many
 features are masked by the presence of
 organic materials which may remain inside.
 It is also necessary that at least 1000X
 magnification (oil immersion) be used to
 detect the structural features used in
 Identification.  No simple procedure for the
 accurate routine counting of diatoms has yet
 been developed.
II   MATERIALS NECESSARY

 A  Sample Concentration

    1  Centrifuge (such as Universal DU)

    2  100 ml centrifuge tubes

    3  Membrane filter apparatus

    4  Vacuum

 B  Slide Preparation

    1  Slides, 1X3 inch,  frosted-end

    2  Cover glasses, circular #1,  18mm,
      0. 13 - . 16 mm thick

    3  Resinous mounting medium (such as
      Harleco microscope mounting medium)

    4  Hot plates

      a  1800 F

      b  7000 F

    5  Disposable pipettes

    6  3 X6 X 1/4 inch steel plate
ID  PROCEDURE

 A The volume of sample needed will vary
    according to the density of diatoms and
    silt, and only with experience can the
    correct sample size be determined.  In
    most cases,  100 ml will be sufficient.

    1  Spin 100 ml at 1000 G for 20 minutes.

    2  Withdraw the supernatant liquid with
       an aspirator, being careful not to
       disturb the concentrate at the bottom
       of the centrifuge tube.  (Draw off all
       but  2-3 ml.)

    3  Transfer the concentrate to a labelled
       10 ml disposable vial.  Label the vial
       with a magic marker, diamond pencil,
       or "time" label.

    4  If the sample has been preserved with
       formalin,  or contains more than
       1.0  gram per liter dissolved solids,
       it will be necessary to wash the
       concentrate with distilled water.  In
       this case,  transfer the entire concen-
       trate to a  15 ml centrifuge tube.
       Dilute to 15 ml with distilled water,
       making certain that the sample is well
       mixed.  Spin for 10 minutes at full
       speed in a clinical centrifuge.  With-
       draw the supernatant liquid, and refill
       with distilled water. Spin again for 10
       minutes.  Withdraw the supernatant
       liquid as before, return the concentrate
       to the rinsed vial in 2-3 ml of distilled
       water and proceed with the mounting.

    5  If more than 200 ml of sample must be
       centrifuged to obtain sufficient material
       to prepare a diatom slide, concentrate
       the  diatoms by filtering the sample
       through a  1.2 micron pore diameter
       membrane filter.   Transfer the filter
       to & 15 ml centrifuge tube,  and dissolve
       with 90% acetone.  Centrifuge  10
       minutes (full speed) and decant with an
       aspirator.  Refill with 90% acetone.
 BI. MIC. enu. lab. 5b. 6. 76
                                     46-1

-------
Preparation of Permanent Diatom Mounts
     agitate, and spin again for 10 minutes.
     Repeat until three fresh acetone washes
     have been used.  Replace the acetone
     with 2-3 ml. of distilled water and
     transfer to a labelled vial as described
     in #4.

B  If the loss of minute forms in supernatant
   is suspected, spin 100 ml at 1000 gs in
   a batch centrifuge for as long as may be
   necessary, then proceed as below.

C  Mounting

   1 Heat the hot plates to the prescribed
     temperatures.

   2 Place one cover glass on the steel plate
     for each sample.

   3 Place the steel plate on the  180OF hot
     plate.

   4 Transfer a drop of sample to a cover
     glass.

   5 Allow the water to evaporate (caution:
     do not allow it to boil.)

   6 Continue to add more sample until a
     thin layer of material is noticeable on
     the dry cover glass, or until all of the
     concentrate has been used.  This step
     is especially critical,  and can be
     learned only by trial and  error.

   7 Transfer the steel plate to the 700° F
     hot plate for 20-30 minutes.  (The
     plate should be hot enough to incinerate
     paper.)

   8 While the material is on the high
     temperature hot plate, label the
     microscope slides (use a #2 pencil
     or a fine point drawing pen); place
     them on the low temperature hot plate,
     which now has been reset to approxi-
     mately 2750 p.
   9 Place a drop of mounting resin on the
     microscope slides and allow the solvent
     to evaporate.

  10 When the incineration of the material
     on the cover glasses  is complete,
     transfer the cover glasses, while still
     hot, to the mounting medium.

  11 Allow the resin to penetrate the
     frustules (1-2 minutes).

  12 Remove the slide, place it on a cool
     desk top, and press the cover glass
     lightly with a pencil eraser for a few
     seconds.  The medium  will harden in
     5-10 seconds.

  13 Scrape off the excess resin with a
     razor blade.

D The preparation is now  ready for exam-
   ination under an oil immersion objective.
ACKNOWLEDGEMENT:

Certain portions of this outline contains
training material from a prior outline by
M.E. Bender.
This outline was prepared by Dr. C.I.
Weber, Chief,  Biological Methods Section,
Analytical Quality Control Laboratory,
1014 Broadway, Cincinnati, OH 45202.
Descriptors-  Diatoms,  Analytical
 Techniques
  40-2

-------
                    LABORATORY:  IDENTIFICATION OF ANIMAL PLANKTON
 I  INTRODUCTION
    The great majority of organisms commonly
    encountered in plankton analysis work are
    plants or at least plant-like (holophytic).
    Animals, however, (holozoic or nonchloro-
    phyll bearing forms) are an important part
    of the community,  and the ability to recog-
    nize them may be quite important.

    Many animals are soft bodied and so are
    best observed in the living condition, as
    they shrink and become otherwise distorted
    on preservation.  There are consequently
    many which will not be available in a
    suitable form for the following exercise.
    Only such forms will be  dealt with as can
    readily be  obtained alive, or which retain
    essential characteristics on preservation.
        Examine your specimen carefully,
        then read the first couplet of
        statements in the key (la and Ib).

        Since the  specimen is large enough
        to see,  it obviously could not be the
        object of statement la.   Therefore
        due to the nature of the key (as
        explained in the second paragraph of
        the introduction) the second alternative
        (Ib) must apply.  This alternative
        instructs  us to proceed to couplet 2.

        From here on, follow from couplet
        to couplet, considering each couplet
        by itself,  until a final selection leads
        to a name.  If this name or couplet
        is, followed by another couplet
        number, this means that the group
        named is  further subdivided.
 II  OBJECTIVES
  A To Study the nature and use of a key for
    identifying organisms

  B To Introduce the Beginners to the Use of
    the Microscope

  C To Learn to Recognize Basic Animal Types

  D To Identify Animal Plankton Species as
    Available, and to Become Familiar with
    the Literature
III  PROCEDURE
 A The Use of the Biological Key

    1  Obtain a "Basic Invertebrate Collection"
       from the instructor.

    2  Select a specimen designated by the
       instructor, and turn to the "Key to
       Selected Larger Groups of Aquatic
       Animals. "
      Identify the other specimens in the
     Basic Invertebrate Collection in  the
      same way.

      Carry the identification further,  to
      genus and species if possible,  in one
      or more of  the more detailed keys
      listed at the end of the  "Key to Selected
      Larger Groups of Aquatic Animals. "
B  The Use of the Microscope

   1 Obtain preliminary information from
     the instructor as to how to set up and
     operate the instrument.

   2 Place a prepared slide of a printed letter
     on the stage and observe it successively
     under low (100X) and high (45X) powers.
     When the letter is right  side up to you,
     how does it appear through the microscope ?

   3 Place a prepared slide of a micro-
     crustacean on the stage  and identify it
     using the "Key to Selected Larger Groups
     of Aquatic Animals. "  Continue your
  BI. MIC. cla. lab. 5c. 6. 76
                                                                                      41-1

-------
Laboratory: Identification of Animal Plankton
     identification as far as possible using
     Eddy and Hodson's "Taxonomic Keys. "

     Prepare a "wet mount" under the
     direction of the instructor and identify
     the organism.  Confirm your identifica-
     tion in one or more of the technical
     reference books available.
   Identify each of the specimens in the
   reference collection as to phylum and
   class, and then genus and species if
   possible (do not spend undue time on the
   species without assistance).
Make a flash card sketch of at least
one organism of each phylum observed
as an example of a type.
Examine the living material provided.
Sketch and identify animal forms
encountered as far as time permits.
Can you draw any conclusions as to the
types of animal life found in the various
habitats indicated?
                                                This outline was prepared by H. W. Jackson,
                                                former Chief Biologist, National Training
                                                Center, and revised by R. M. Sinclair,
                                                Aquatic Biologist, National Training Center,
                                                MOTD, OWPO, USEPA,  Cincinnati, Ohio
                                                45268
                                                 Descriptors:
                                                 Zooplankton
          Analytical Techniques,
41-2

-------
                  LABORATORY: PROPORTIONAL COUNTING OF PLANKTON
 I  OBJECTIVE

 To learn and practice the techniques of
 proportional counting of mixed plankton
 samples.
 H  MATERIALS

 A Several plankton samples, each containing
    a number of plankton forms.

 B Class slides, cover slips, and dropping
    pipets.
in  PROCEDURES

 A Make an ordinary wet mount of the
    sample provided.

 B Scan the slide. Identify and list all types
    of plankton present.

 C Proportional Counting (use clump count)

    1  Field count

       a  Count and tally all individuals of
          each type present in a field.  The
          best way to do this is to list the
          most common types separately and
          record the counts and then enumerate
          the other forms.
       b  Move the slide at random and repeat
          the process.  Do this for 5 or 10
          fields,  or for one or two strips.

       c  Tally the results and compute the
          percent of each type.

    2  Five hundred count

       a  Moving the slide at random count
          and tally all the types of plankton
          as before until a total of 500  cells
          or clumps have been counted.

       b  Tally the results and compute the
          percentage of each type as before.
IV  RESULTS

 A Record your results for both methods
    on the board.

 B Discuss the two methods and the use of
    the proportional count results.
 This outline was prepared by M. E. Bender,
 Biologist, formerly with FWPCA Training
 Activities, SEC.

 Descriptors: Plankton, Analytical Techniques
  BI. MIC. enu. lab. 6a. 6. 76
                                  42-1

-------
               CALIBRATION AND USE OF PLANKTON COUNTING EQUIPMENT
I  INTRODUCTION

A  With the exception of factory-set
   instruments, no two microscopes can
   be counted upon to provide exactly the
   same magnification with any given com-
   bination of oculars and objectives. For
   accurate quantitative studies, it is there-
   fore necessary to standardize or "calibrate"
   each instrument against a known standard
   scale.  One scale frequently used is a
   microscope slide on which two millimeters
   are  subdivided into  tenths, and two addi-
   tional tenths are  subdivided into hundredths.
   Figure  3.

B  In order to provide an accurate measuring
   device in the microscope,  a Whipple
   Plankton Counting Square or reticule
   (Figure 2a) is installed in one ocular
   (there are many different types of reticules).
   This square is theoretically of such a size
   that with a 10X objective, a 10X ocular,
   and a tube length of  160 mm, the image
   of the square covers a square area on the
   slide one mm on  a slide.  Since this
   objective is rarely attained however, most
   microscopes must be standardized or
   "calibrated" as described below in order
   to ascertain the actual size of the Whipple
   Square  as seen through the microscope
   (hereinafter referred to as the "Whipple
   field").   This process is schematically
   represented in Figures 5 and 7.  If the
   Whipple eyepiece is  to be used at more
   than one magnification, it must be recali-
   brated for each.  A basic type  of monocular
   microscope is shown in Figure 1.

C  Microscopes with two eyepieces (binocular)
   are a convenience but not essential.   Like
   modern cars they are not only  great
   "performers, " but also complicated to
   service or, in this instance, calibrate.
   On some instruments,  changing the inter-
   pupillary distance also changes the tube
   length,  on others it does not.   The "zoom"
   feature on certain scopes is also essentially
   a system for changing the tube length.

   The resultant is that in addition to calibra-
   tion at each combination of eyepiece and
   objective, any other factor which may
   affect magnification  must also be  considered.
   In some instances this may mean  setting up
   a table  of calibrations at a series of micro-
   scope settings.
   Another procedure is to select a value
   for each of the variables involved (inter-
   pupillary distance, zoom,  etc.) and
   calibrate the scope at that combination.
   Then each time the scope is to be used for
   quantitative work, re-set each variable to
   the value selected.  A separate multipli-
   cation factor must be calculated for each
   adjustment which changes the magnification
   of the instrument.

   Since the Whipple Square can be used to
   measure both linear dimensions and
   square areas,  both should be recorded on
   an appropriate form.  A suggested format
   is shown in Figure 6.

   (Data written in are used as an illustration
   and are not intended to apply to any
   particular microscope.  An unused form
   is included as Figure 6-A.)
II   THE CALIBRATION PROCEDURE

 A  Installing the Whipple Square or Reticule

    To install the reticule in the ocular
    (usually the right one on a binocular
    microscope), carefully unscrew the upper
    lens mounting and place the reticule on
    the circular  diaphragm or shelf which will
    be found approximately half way down inside
    (Figure 4).   Replace the lens mounting and
    observe the markings on the reticule.  If
    they are not  in sharp focus, remove and
    turn the reticule over.

    On reticules with the markings etched on
    one side of a glass disc,  the etched sur-
    face can usually be recognized by shining
    the disc at the proper angle in a light.
    The markings will usually be in the best
    focus with the etched surface down.  If the
    markings are sandwiched between two glass
    discs cemented together, both sides are
    alike, and the focus may not be quite as
    sharp.

 B  Observation  of the Stage Micrometer

    Replace the ocular in the microscope  and
    observe the stage micrometer as is illus-
    trated schematically in Figure 5:  Calibration
    of the Whipple Square.  On a suitably ruled
    form such as the one illustrated,  Figure 6,
    Calibration Data, record the actual distance
    in millimeters subtended by the image of
 BI. MET.mic. Id. 6. 76
                                                                                      43-1

-------
 Calibration and Use of Plankton Counting Equipment
    the entire Whipple field and also by each
    of its subdivisions.  This should be
    determined for each significant settling of
    the interpupillary distance for a binocular
    microscope, and also for each combination
    of lenses employed.  Since oculars and
    objectives  marked with identical magnifi-
    cation,  and since microscope frames too
    may differ, the serial or other identifying
    number of  those actually calibrated should
    be recorded.  It is  thus apparent that the
    determinations recorded will only be valid
    when used  with the  lenses listed and on that
    particular  microscope.

  C Use of the  2OX Objective

    Due to the  short working distance beneath
    a 46X (4mm) objective, it is impossible
    to focus to the bottom of the  Sedgewick-
    Rafter plankton counting cell with this lens.
    A  10X (16mm) lens on the other hand
    "wastes" space between the front of the
    lens and the coverglass, even when focused
    on the bottom of the cell. In order to make
    the most efficient use possible of this cell
    then, an objective of intermediate focal
    length is desirable.  A lens with a focal
    length of approximately 8 mm, having a
    magnification of 20 or 2IX will meet these
    requirements. Such lenses are available
    from American manufacturers and are
    recommended for this type of work.
HI  CHECKING THE CELL

 The internal dimensions of a Sedgewick-Rafter
 plankton counting cell should be 50 mm long
 by 20 mm wide by 1 mm deep (Figure 8).

 The actual horizontal dimensions  of each new
 cell should be checked with calipers, and the
 depth of the cell  checked at several points
 around the edge using the vertical focusing
 scale engraved on the fine adjustment knob of
 most microscopes.  One complete rotation of
 the knob usually  raises or lowers the objective
 1 mm or 100 microns (and each single mark
 equals  1 micron).  Thus, approximately ten
 turns of the fine  adjustment knob should raise
 the focus from the bottom of the cell to the
 underside of a coverglass resting on the rim.
 Make these measurements on an empty cell.
 The use of a No.  1 or 1-1/2, 24 X 60 mm
 coverglass is recommended rather than the
 heavy coverglass that comes with the S-R
 cell, as the thinner glass will somewhat con-
 form to any irregularities of the cell rim
 (hence, also making a tighter seal and reduc-
 ing evaporation when in actual use).  Do not
 attempt to focus  on the upper surface of the
 rim of an empty cell for the above depth
 measurements, as the coverglass is supported
 by the highest points of the rim only, which
 are very difficult to identify.  Use the average
 of all depth measurements as the "true" depth
 of the cell.  To simplify calculations below, it
 will be assumed that we are dealing with a
 cell with an average depth of exactly 1. 0 mm.
IV  PROCEDURE FOR STRIP COUNTS USING
    THE SEDGEWICK-RAFTER CELL

 A Principles

    Since the total area of the cell is 1000 mm2,
    the total volume is 1000 mm3 or 1 ml.  A
    "strip" the length of the cell thus constitutes
    a volume (Vi) 50 mm long,  1  mm deep,  and
    the width of the Whipple field.
                                    o
    The volume of such a strip in mm  is:

       V1 =  50  X width of field X depth

          =  50  Xw X 1

          =  50  w

    In the example given below on the plate
    entitled Calibration Data, at a magnification
    of approximately 200X with an interpupillary
    setting of "60", the width of the Whipple
    field is recorded as approximately 0. 55 mm
    (or 550 microns).  In this case, the volume
    of the strip  is:

       Vj= 50 w = 50 XO. 55 = 27. 5  (mm3)

 B Calculation  of Multiplier F actor

    In order to convert plankton counts per
    strip to counts per ml, it is simply
    necessary to multiply the count  obtained
    by a factor (F..) which represents the
    number of times  the volume of the strip
    examined (Vj) would be  contained in 1 ml or
    1000 mm3.     Thus in the example given
    above:
                                    3
       p  _     volume of cell in mm
        1 ~   volume examined in mm^
             1000
1000
2775"
                           = 36.36
          = approx. 36
    If more than one strip is to be counted,
    the factor for two, three, etc.,  strips
    could be calculated separately using the
    same relationships outlined above, changing
    only the measurement for the length of
  43-2

-------
                                          Calibration and Use of Plankton Counting Equipment


                       Figure 1.  THE COMPOUND MICROSCOPE
A) coarse adjustment; B) fine adjustment;
C) arm or pillar; D) mechanical stage which
holds slides and is movable in two directions
by means of the two knobs; E) pivot or joint.
This should not be  used or "broken" while
counting plankton; F) eyepiece (or ocular cf:
figure 4);  G) draw tube.  This  will be found
on monocular microscopes only (those having
only one eyepiece).  Adjustment of this tube
is very helpful in calibrating the microscope
for quantitative counting (Sec.  5. 5. 2. 2. ).
H) body tube.   In some makes of microscopes
this can be replaced with a body tube having
two eyepieces, thus making the 'scope into
a  'binocular. " I) revolving nosepiece on
which the objectives are mounted;  J) through
M are objectives, any one of which can be
turned toward the object being studied.  In
this case J is a 40X, K is a 100X, L is a 20X,
and M is a 10X objective.  The product of
the magnification power of the objective being
used times the magnification power of the
eyepiece gives the total magnification of the
microscope.   Different makes of microscopes
employ objectives of slightly different powers,
but all are approximately equivalent.   N) stage
of the microscope; O) Sedgwick-Rafter  cell in
place for observation;  P) substage condenser;
Q) mirror; R) base or  stand; note:  for
information on the optical system,  consult
reference 3.   (Photo by Don Moran. ).

-------
Calibration and Use of Plankton Counting Equipment
                                          Figure 2
Types of eyepiece micrometer discs or
reticules (reticules,  graticules, etc.).
When dimensions are mentioned in the
following description,  they refer to the
markings on the reticule discs and not to
the measurements subtended on the micro-
scope  slide.  The latter must be determined
by calibration procedures  such as those
described elsewhere,  (a) Whipple plankton
counting eyepiece.  The fine rulings in the
subdivided square are sometimes extended to
the margin of the large square to facilitate
the estimation of sizes of organisms in
different parts  of the field,  (b) Quadrant
ruling with 8. 0 mm circle, for counting
bacteria in milk smears for example,   (c)
Linear scale 5. 0 mm divided into tenths.
For measurement of linear dimensions.
(d) Porton reticule for estimating the size
of particles.  The sizes  of the  series of discs
is based on the square root of two so that the
areas of successive discs double as they
progress in size.
43-4

-------
                                     Calibration and Use of Plankton Counting Equipment
   strip counted.  Thus for two strips in the
   example cited above:

      V2=   100W = 100 X 0. 55 = 55 mm3

      F2=   >£2°=1°°°  =18.2

                                    F1
   It will however be noted that F   =  -^ .
                                LI    £

   Likewise a factor Fg for three  strips

               Fl
   would equal -s- or approximately  12, etc.

C  An Empirical "Step-Off" Method

   A simpler but more empirical procedure
   for determining the factor is to consider
   that if a strip 20 mm wide were to be
   counted the length of the cell, that the
   entire 1000 mm3 would be included since
   the cell is 20 mm wide and 1 mm deep.

   This 20 mm strip width can be  equated to
   1000 mm3.  If a strip (or the total of  2 or
   more strips) is less than 20 mm in width,
   the quotient of 20 divided by this width will
   be a multiplier factor for converting from
   count per strip(s) to count per ml.
                                               Thus in the example cited above where at
                                               an approximate magnification of 200X and
                                               with an interpupillary setting of 60,  the
                                               width of the Whipple field is . 55 mm.   Then:
                                                        20
                                                           = 36.36 or approx. 36
                                                  (as above)

                                               If two strips are counted:
                                                  .55
                                               +  . 55
                                                                20
                                                             =  -   =
                                                      andF2 = y-y  = 18. 2 = approx.  18, etc.

                                               This same value could be obtained without
                                               the use of a stage micrometer by carefully
                                               moving the cell sidewise across the  field
                                               of vision by the use of a mechanical stage.
                                               Count the number of Whipple fields in the
                                               width of the cell.  There should be approxi-
                                               mately 36 in the instance cited above.
                                           V  SEPARATE FIELD COUNT USING THE
                                               SEDGEWICK-RAFTER CELL

                                            A  Circumstances of Use

                                               The use of concentrated samples, local
                                               established programs, or other circumstances
                         Figure 3.  STAGE MICROMETER

The type illustrated has two millimeters divided into tenths, plus two additional
tenths subdivided into hundredths.
                           Micrometer Scale
                                Enlargement of Micrometer Scale
                                                                                43-5

-------
Calibration and Use of Plankton Counting Equipment
      Figure 4.  Method of Mounting the Whipple Disc in an Ocular.  Note the upper
         lens of the ocular which has been carefully unscrewed,  held in the left
           hand, and the Whipple disc,  held in the right hand.   (Photo by
                                        Don Moran).

-------
                                             Calibration and Use of Plankton Counting Equipment
                                C A LI BRA Tl ON OF WHIPPLE SQUARE

                              as seen with 10X Ocular and 43X Objective
                                (approximately 430X total magnification)
                 Whipple Square as
                 seen through ocular
                   ("Whipple field")
                                                       "Small squares" subtend
                                                       one fifth of large squares:
                                                       .0052 mm or 5. 2(i
    "Large square" subtends
    one tenth of entire Whipple
    Square: . 026 nun or 26|i
                                                              Apparent lines of sight
                                                              subtend . 26 mm or 260^
                                                              on stage micrometer
                                                              scale
                      . Olmm
                       (lOu)

                    PORTION OF MAGNIFIED IMAGE OF STAGE MICROMETER SCALE
                                             Figure 5

                           CALIBRATION OF THE WHIPPLE SQUARE
The apparent relationship of the Whipple
Square is shown as it is viewed through a
microscope while looking at a stage
micrometer with a magnification of
approximately 430X (10X ocular and 43X
objective).
                                                                                             43-7

-------
Calibration and Use of Plankton Counting Equipment
                                  MICROSCOPE CALIBRATION DATA


                                                  Microscope No. 4,33 79
Approximate
Magnification
Tube
Length, or
Interpupillary
Setting
Linear dimensions of Whipple
squares in millimeters*
Whole
Large
Small
Factor for
Conversion
to count/ ml
100X. obtained with (2 S-R Strips)
Objective
Serial No.
and Ocular
Serial No.
J3<)t>74L(lhJ\


-SO
60
ID


l.iSo
I.I t£
/. 16 0


0.113
0.11 1
o. no


o. ojtaio
6. OA3iA
G.03.A3L


gq
9.0
.3

(Nannoplankton)
(cell- 20 fields )'

/7^?y.
lift,.
/Ss-£.

   Microscope calibration data.  The form
   shown is suggested for the recording of
   data pertaining to a particular microscope.
   Headings could be modified to suit local
situations.  For example,  "Interpupillary
Setting" could be replaced by "Tube Length"
or the "2S-R Strips  could be replaced by
"per field" or "per 10 fields. "
                                          Figure 6
 43-8

-------
                                       Calibration and Use of Plankton Counting Equipment
                            MICROSCOPE CALIBRATION DATA
                                               Microscope No.
Approximate
Magnification
Tube
Length, or
Interpupillary
Setting
Linear dimensions of Whipple
squares in millimeters*
Whole
Large
Small
Factor for
Conversion
to count/ ml
      100X,  obtained with
(2 S-R Strips)
Objective
Serial No.

and Ocular
Serial No.


200X, obtaine
Objective
Serial No.

and Ocular
Serial No.


400X, obtaine
Objective
Serial No.

and Ocular
Serial No.







d with





d with





























































(2 S-R Strips)





(Nannoplankton)
(cell- 20 fields )





     *lmm =  1000 microns
                                                           BI.AQ.pl. 8. 10. 60.
                                     Figure 6-A

                          MICROSCOPE CALIBRATION DATA

Suggested work sheet for the calibration of a microscope.  Details will need to be adapted
to the particular instrument and situation.
                                                                                43-9

-------
Calibration and Use of Plankton Counting Equipment
                     S-R COVER
                       GLASS	1
                        WATER IN  ,MM
                      '  S-R CELL
                                                 L
                                                   THICKNESS S-R SLIDE
                                         Figure 7

      A cube of water as seen through a Whipple square at 100X magnification in
      a Sedgewick-Rafter cell. The figure is drawn as if the microscope were
      focused on the bottom of the cell,  making visible only those organisms lying
      on the bottom of the cell.  The little "bug" (copepod) halfway up, and the
      algae filament at the top would be  out of focus.  The focus must be moved up
      and down in order to study (or  count) the entire cube.
  43-10

-------
                                          Calibration and Use of Plankton Counting Equipment
   may make it necessary to employ the more
   conventional technique of counting one or
   more  separate Whipple fields instead of
   the strip count method. The basic relation-
   ships  outlined above still hold,  namely:
  volume cell in nim
volume examined in
      •p  =
B  Principles Involved

   The volume  examined in this case will
••   consist of one or more squares the dimen-
   sions of the  Whipple field in area and 1 mm
   in depth (Figure 7).  Common practice
   for routine work is to examine 10 fields,
   but exceptionally high or low counts or
   other circumstances may indicate that
   some other  number of fields  should be
   employed.   In this case a "per field"
   factor may be determined to  be subsequently
   divided by the number of fields examined
   as with the strip count.  The following
   description  however is based on an assumed
   count of 10 fields.
   NANNOPLANKTON COUNTING

For counting nannoplankton using the high
dry power (10X ocular and 43X objective)
and the "nannoplankton counting cell"
(Figure 9) which is 0. 4 mm deep,  a minimum
of 20 separate Whipple fields is suggested.
The same general relationships presented
above (Section IV) can be used to obtain a
multiplier or factor (F^) to convert counts
per 20 fields to counts per ml.

To take another example from Figure 4, at
an approximate magnification of 400X and an
interpupillary setting of  70 (see also Figure 3)
we observe that one side of the Whipple field
measures 0. 260 mm.  The volume of the
fields examined is thus obtained as follows:

V5 =   side2 X depth X no. of fields

   =   0. 26 X 0. 26 X 0. 4 X 20 =. 54 mm3
and  F
                                                       = (approx. ) 1850
C  Calculation of Multiplier Factor

   As stated above, the total volume
   represented in the fields examined con-
   sists of the total area of the Whipple fields
   multiplied by the depth.

      V4=   (side of Whipple field)2 X depth

      (1 mm) X no.  of fields counted)

   For example,  let us assume an approxi-
   mate magnification of 100X (see Figures
   6 and 7  and an interpupillary setting of
   "50". The observed length of one side
   of the Whipple field in this case is 1. 13
   mm. The calculation of V. is thus:

      V4 =   side2 X depth X no.  of fields

        =   1.13 X 1.13 X 1 X 10 = 12.8 mm3

      The multiplier factor is obtained as
      above (Section IV A):
                               3
             volume cell in mm
           volume examined in mm"

                 = (approx.) 78
      F4 =
      (If one field were counted, the factor
      would be 781, for 100 fields it would
      be 7.8.)
                                      It should be noted that the volume of the
                                      nannoplankton cell, . 1 ml, is of no significance
                                      in this particular calculation.
                                      REFERENCES

                                      1  American Public Health Association,  et. al.
                                            Standard Methods for the Examination
                                            of Water, Sewage, and Industrial Wastes.
                                            14th Edition. Am. Public Health Assoc.
                                            New York.  1976.

                                      2  Jackson,  H.W. and Williams,  L. G.
                                           The Calibration and Use of Certain
                                           Plankton Counting Equipment.  Trans.
                                           Am. Mic. Soc.   LXXXI(1):96-103.  1962.

                                      3  Ingram, W. M. and Palmer,  C. M.
                                            Simplified Procedures for Collecting,
                                            Examining,  and Recording Plankton in
                                           Water.;  Jour. Am. Waterworks.
                                           Assoc. 44(7): 617-724.   1952.

                                      4  Palmer,  C. M.  Algae in Water Supplies.
                                            U.  S.  D. H.  E.  W.  Public Health Service
                                           Pub.  No. 657.   1959.

                                      5  Palmer,  C. M. and Maloney, T.  E.  A
                                           New Counting Slide for  Nannoplankton.
                                           American Soc. Limnol.  and Oceanog.
                                            Special Publications No. 21. pp.  1-6.
                                            1954.
                                                                                      43-11

-------
Calibration and Use of Plankton Counting Equipment
                         Area
                       Uncounted
             Strip..
            Counted
                                         Figure 8

   Sedgewick-Rafter counting cell showing bottom scored across for ease in counting
   strips.  The "strips" as shown in the illustration simply represent the area counted,
   and are not marked on the slide.  The conventional dimensions are 50 X 20 X 1 mm, but
   these should be checked for accurate work.
                                          Figure 9

   Nannoplankton cell.  Dimensions of the circular part of the cell are 17. 9 mm diameter
   X 0. 4 mm depth.  When covered with a coverglass, the  volume contained is 0. 1 ml.
   The channels for the introduction of sample and the release of air are 2 mm wide and
   approximately 5 mm long.  This slide is designed to be used with the 4 mm or 43X
   (high dry) objective.
6  Welch, Paul S.  Limnological Methods.
      Blakiston Company.  Phila. Toronto.
      1948.

7  Whipple, G. C., Fair, G. M., and
      Whipple, M. C.  The Microscopy of
     Drinking Water.  John Wiley and Sons.
     New York.  1948.
This outline was prepared by H. W. Jackson,
former Chief Biologist, National Training
Center, and revised by R. M. Sinclair,
Aquatic Biologist, National Training Center
MOTD. OWPO. USEPA, Cincinnati. Ohio 45268

Descriptors:  Plankton, Microscopy
 43-12

-------
               LABORATORY:  FUNDAMENTALS OF QUANTITATIVE COUNTING
 I  OBJECTIVE

 To learn and practice the basic techniques of
 quantitative plankton counting
 II  MATERIALS
 A Plankton Samples Containing a Variety of
    Plankton Forms

 B S-R Cells and Coverglasses, Large Bore
    1 ml Pipettes,  Whipple Discs,  Plankton
    Record Form
III  PROCEDURE
C  Starting from one end of the S-R cell and
   preceding to  the opposite (this is called a
   strip count, begin counting (clump counts)
   the plankton forms.  The length of the
   cell may be traversed in several ways.

   1  Count all the forms in the Whipple
      square or in a portion of the  square,
      record the count and move the slide so
      that the square covers the adjoining
      area.

   2  Move  the slide very slowly counting
      and recording the various forms as
      they pass  the leading  edge of the
      Whipple disc.
                                                  IV RESULTS
 A Fill the S-R cell with sample number 1 as
    follows:

       Place the coverglass diagonally across
       the S-R cell.  This leaves the other two
       corners uncovered; one for putting in
       the sample fluid, the other to allow
       air to be driven out as it is replaced
       by the incoming aliquot.   Shake the
       sample to disperse the plankton.  Before
       settling occurs in the sample draw about
       1-1/4 ml of the fluid into  the pipette
       and quickly fill the S-R cell by delivering
       the aliquot into one of the open corners
       of the chamber.
A  Using the conversion factor obtained in
   the previous laboratory compute the
   number of plankton organisms per nil.

B  Record the results on the board.

C  Discussion of Results

D  Refill the slide with a fresh aliquot and
   recount the sample.  Compare results
   with the first count.

E  Count the other samples  of mixed plankton
   as assigned, following the same procedure.
  B Using lOOx focus on the sample.  After
    focus has been obtained switch to 200x.
    Scan the slide and list the plankton forms
    present.
 This outline was prepared by M. E.  Bender,
 Former Biologist,  FWPCA, Water Pollution
 Training Activities, SEC.

 Descriptors:  Plankton,  Analytical Techniques
    BI. MIC. enu. lab. 7. 6. 76
                                                                                     44-1

-------
Laboratory:  Fundamentals of Quantitative Counting
              Body of Water:
                                                 PLANKTON COUNT RECORD
                                                    Date Collected:_
                                                                             . Date Analyzed.







                                                                             . Analyst	

TOTAL COUNT:
Organ Lsma,
Differential
Count 1



















































or Type of Count
















FIELD CONDITIONS

Weather todav ; , ,
Previous Weather- , ,. ,
Turbidity Hetho
Method of Coll«
Total Vol. Coll
Cone ml Condi ti
1; T_ reading-
-tinn.



Pllanentous *lff«e?_,,,
Other Plan
«•••

Dead Fish
Odor of w«
Other Physic


al or Chemical Dat





















LABORATORY
He t bod of Pr«
Departure fr
Significance
Treatment Re


















ANALYSIS
Count
per
ml.

















per
liter

















Group
Totali



















of R.«ilt>.



PLANT OR OTHER DATA, FOR EX:

Other Chcnic
Pesult of Tr


eatment
Taate and Odor:
Filter Runs:
nth«r



                                            SBOCKOTED BASIC FORM fOH PUUKTOH RECORDS
                BI.mC.oiiu.pl.2.4.68

-------
                 KEY TO SELECTED GROUPS OF FRESHWATER ANIMALS
The following key is intended to provide            animal as a member of the group. Phylum
an introduction to some of the more                PROTOZOA.  If you selected "ib", proceed
common freshwater animals.  Technical           to the couplet indicated.  Continue this
language is kept to a minimum.                    process until the selected statement is
                                                 terminated with the name of  a group.
In using this key, start with the first
couplet (la,  Ib), and select the alternative         If you wish more information about the
that seems most reasonable.  If you               group, consult references.   (See reference
selected "la" you have identified the               list.)
 BI.AQ. 21b. 6.76                                                                     45-1

-------
Key to Selected Groups of Freshwater Animals
la
Ib
2a
2b
3a
3b
4a
The body of the organism comprising
a single microscopic independent
cell, or many similar  and indepen-
dently functioning cells associated
in a colony with little or no  differ-
ence between the  cells, i. e., with-
out forming tissues; or body com-
prised of masses of multinucleate
protoplasm.  Mostly microscopic,
single celled animals.

   Phylum PROTOZOA

The body of the organism com-
prised of many cells of different
kinds,  i. e., forming tissues.
may be microscopic or macro-
scopic.

Body or colony usually forming
irregular masses or layers some-
times cylindrical, goblet shaped,
vase shaped, or tree like.   Size
range from barely visible to
large.
Body or colony shows some type
of definite symmetry.

Colony surface rough or bristly
in appearance under microscope
or hand lens.  Grey, green, or
brown.  Sponges.
   Phylum PORIFERA (Fig. 1)

Colony surface relatively smooth,
General texture of mass gelatinous,
transparent.  Clumps of minute
individual organisms variously
distributed.  Moss animals,
bryozoans.
   Phylum Bryozoa (Fig. 2)

Microscopic.  Action of two
ciliated (fringed) lobes at an-
terior (front) end in life often
gives appearance of wheels.
Body often segmented, accordian-
like.  Free swimming or attached.
Rotifers or wheel animalcules.
   Phylum TROCHELMINTHES
   (Rotifera) (Fig. 3)
4b   Larger, wormlike, or having
     strong skeleton or shell.
        5a  Skeleton or shell present.  Skel-
             eton may be external or internal.
15
         5b  Body soft and/or wormlike.
             Skin may range from soft to
             parchment-like.

         6a  Three or more  pairs of well
             formed jointed legs present.
                Phylum ARTHROPODA (Fig.  4)

         6b  Legs or appendages, if present,
             limited to pairs of bumps or hooks.
2            Lobes or tenacles, if present,
             soft and fleshy, not jointed.

         7a  Body strongly depressed or
             flattened in cross section.

3        7b  Body oval,  round,  or shaped like
             an inverted "u" in cross section.

         8a  Parasitic inside bodies of higher
             animals. Extremely long and flat,
             divided into section like a Roman
             girdle.  Life history may involve
4            an intermediate host.  Tapeworms
                Class CESTODA (Fig. 5)

         8b  Body a single unit.  Mouth and
             digestive system present, but no
             anus.

         9a  External or internal parasite of
             higher animals.  Sucking discs
             present for attachment.   Life his-
             tory may involve two or more in-
             termediate  hosts or stages.  Flukes.
                Class TREMATODA

         9b  Free living.  Entire body covered
             with locomotive cilia.  Eye areas
             in head often appear "crossed".
             Free living flatworms.
                Class TURBELLARIA (Fig. 6)

        lOa  Long, slender,  with snake-like
             motion in life.  Covered with glis-
             tening cuticle.  Parasitic or free-
             living.  Microscopic to six feet in
             length.  Round worms.
                Phylum NEMATHELMINTHES
                (Fig. 7)
5
        lOb  Divided into sections or segments
                                                                                          19
                                                                                          10
                                                                                      11
   45-2

-------
                                             Key to Selected Groups of Freshwater Animals
lOc  Unsegmented, head blunt, one
     or two retractile tentacles.
     Flat pointed, tail.

lla  Head a more or less well-formed
     hard, capsule with jaws, eyes,
     and antennae.
        Class INSECTA order DIPTERA
        (Figs.  8A, 8C)

lib  Head structure soft, except
     jaws (if present).  Fig.  8E. )

12a  Head conical or rounded, lateral
     appendages not conspicuous or
     numerous.

12b  Head somewhat broad and blunt.
     Retractile jaws usually present.
     Soft fleshy lobes or tentacles,
     often somewhat flattened,  may be
     present in the head region.  Tail
     usually narrow. Lateral lobes
     or fleshy  appendages on each
     segment unless there is a large
     sucker disc at rear end.
        Phylum ANNELIDA (Fig. 9)

13a  Minute dark colored retractile
     jaws present, body tapering
     somewhat at both ends,  pairs or
     rings of bumps or "legs" often
     present,  even near tail.
        Class INSECTA Order DIPTERA
        (Fig. 8)

13b  No jaws,  sides of body generally
    . parallel except at ends.   Thicken-
     ed area or ring usually present
     if not all the way back on body.
     Clumps of minute bristles on most
     segments. Earthworms, sludge-
     worms.
        Order  OLIGOCHAETA

14a  Segments with bristles and/or fleshy
     lobes or other extensions.  Tube
     builders,  borers, or burrowers.
     Often reddish or greenish in
     color. Brackish or fresh water.
     Nereid worms.
        Order  POLYCHAETA (Fig. 9A)

14b  Sucker disc at each end,  the large
     one posterior.   External blood-
18
12
13
14
     sucking parasites on higher animals,
     often found unattached to host.
     Leaches.
        Class HIRUDINEA (Fig. 9B)

15a  Skeleton internal, of true bone.       40
     (Vertebrates)

15b  Body covered with an external        16
     skeleton or shell.
       (Figs. 10, 13, 17,  18, 24,
        25,  28)

16a  External skeleton jointed, shell      19
     covers legs and other appendages,
     often leathery in nature.
        Phylum ARTHROPODA

16b  External shell entire, not jointed,    17
     unless composed of two clam-
     like halves.
        (Figs.  10,  11, 12)

17a  Half inch or less in length.  Two
     leathery,  clam-like shells.  Soft
     parts  inside include delicate,
     jointed appendages.  Phyllopods
     or branchiopods.
        Class CRUSTACEA,  Subclasses
        BRANCHIOPODA (Fig. 12)
        and OSTRACODA (Fig. 11)

17b  Soft parts covered with  thin          18
     skin,  mucous produced,  no jointed
     legs.
        Phylum MOLLUSCA

18a  Shell single, may be a spiral cone.
     Snails.
        Class GASTROPODA (Fig.  13)

18b  Shell double, two halves, hinged
     at one point.  Mussels,  clams
        Class BIVALVIA (Fig. 10)

19a  Three pairs of regular walking       29
     legs,  or their rudiments. Wings
     present in all adults and rudiments
     in some larvae.
        Class INSECTA (Figs. 22, 24D,
        25,  26,  28, 29)

19b  More  than three pairs of legs         20
     apparently present.

20a  Body elongated,  head broad and flat

                                   45-3

-------
 Key to Selectect Groups of Freshwater Animals
     with strong jaws.  Appendages follow-
     ing first three pairs of legs are round-
     ed tapering filaments.  Up to 3 inches
     long. Dobson fly and fish fly larvae.
        Class INSECTA Order
        MEGALOPTERA  (Fig. 14)
        25 a  Appendages leaflike, flattened,
             more than ten pairs.
2 Ob  Four or more pairs of legs.

2la  Four pairs of legs. Body rounded,
     bulbous,  head minute.  Often brown
     or red. Water mites.

        Phylum ARTHROPODA, Class
        ARACHNIDA, Order ACARI
        (Fig.  15)

2 Ib  Five or more pairs of walking
     or swimming legs; gills, two
     pairs of antennae.  Crustaceans.
        Phylum ARTHROPODA,
        Class  CRUSTACEA

22a  Ten or more pairs of flattened,
     leaflike swimming and respiratory
     appendages.  Many species swim
     constantly in life; some swim
     upside down.  Fairy shrimps,
     phyllopods,  or branchipods.
        Subclass BRACmOPODA
        (Fig.  16)

22b  Less than ten pairs of swimming
     or respiratory appendages.

23a  Body and legs enclosed in bi-
     valve d (2 halves) shell which may
     or may not completely hide them.

23b  Body and legs not enclosed in
     bivalve shell.  May be  large or
     minute.
        Figs.  17,  18, 19)

24a  One pair of branched antennae
     enlarged for locomotion, extend
     outside of shell (carapace).
     Single  eye usually visible.
     "Water fleas"
        Subclass (CLADOCERA (Fig. 12)

24b  Locomotion accomplished by
     body legs, not by antennae.
        25b  Animal less than 3 mm, in length.
             Appendages more or less slender
             and jointed, often used for walking.
             Shells opaque.  Ostracods.
21              (Fig. 11) Subclass OSTRACODA

        26a  Body a series of six or more         27
             similar segments, differing
             mainly in size.

        26b  Front part of body enlarged into      28
             a somewhat separate body unit
             (cephalothorax) often covered
             with a single piece of shall (cara-
22           pace).  Back part (abdomen) may be
             relatively small,  even folded
             underneath  front part. (Fig.  19b)

        27a  Body compressed laterally, i. e.,
             organism is tall and thin.  Scuds.
             amphipods.
                Subclass AMPHIPODA (Fig.  17)

        27b  Body compressed dorsoventrally,
             i. e., organism low and broad.
             Flat gills contained in chamber
             beneath tail.  Sowbugs.
                Subclass ISOPODA (Fig. 18)

23      28a  Abdomen extending straight out
             behind, ending in two small  pro-
             jections.  One or two large masses of
24           eggs are often attached to female.
             Locomotion by means of two enlarged,
             unbranched antennae, the only large
             appendages on the body. Copepods.
26              Subclass COPEPODA (Fig.  19)

        28b  Abdomen extending out behind ending
             in an expanded "flipper" or swim-
             ming paddle.  Crayfish or craw fish.
             Eyes on movable stalks.  Size range
             usually from one to six inches.
                Subclss DECAPODA

        29a  Two pairs of functional wings,        39
             one pair may be more or less hardened
             as protection for the other pair.
25           Adult insects which normally
             live on or in the water.  (Figs.  25, 28)
    45-4

-------
                                              Key to Selected Groups of Freshwater Animals
29b  No functional wings, though           30
     pads in which wings are develop-
     ing may be visible.  Some may
     resemble adult insects  very
     closely, others may differ ex-
     tremely from adults.

30a  External pads or cases in which       35
     wings develop clearly visible.  (Figs.
     24,26,27)

30b  More or less wormlike, or at         31
     least no external evidence of
     wing development.

3 la  No jointed legs present.  Other
     structures such as hooks, sucker
     discs,  breathing tubes may be
     present.  Larvae of flies,
     midget, etc.
        Order DIPTERA (Fig.  8)

31b  Three pairs of jointed thoracic        32
     legs, head capsule well formed.

32a  Minute (2-4mm) living on the
     water surface film. Tail a
     strong organ that can be hooked
     into a "catch" beneath the
     thorax.  When released animal
     jumps into the air.  No wings
     are ever grown.  Adult spring-
     tails.
        Order COLLEMBOLA (Fig. 20)

32b  Larger (usually over 5  mm)           33
     wormlike, living beneath the
     surface.

33a  Live in cases or webs in water.
     Cases or webs have a silk
     foundation to which tiny sticks,
     stones, and/or bits of debris
     are attached.  Abdominal segments
     often with minute gill filaments.
     Generally cylindric in shape.
     Caddisfly larvae.
        Order TRICHOPTERA (Fig. 21)

33b  Free living, build no cases.           34

34a  Somewhat flattened in cross
     section and massive in  appear-
     ance.  Each abdominal  segment
     with rather  stout,  tapering, lateral
     filaments about as long as body
     is wide.  Alderflies, fishflies, and
     dobsonflies.
        Order MEGALOPTERA (Fig. 22, 14)

34b  Generally rounded in cross section.
     Lateral filaments if present tend
     to be long and thin.  A few forms
     extremely flattened, like a suction
     cup.  Beetle larvae.
        Order COLEOPTERA (Fig. 23)
35a  Two or three filaments or other
     structures extending out from
     end of abdomen.
35b
36a
36b
37a
37b
38a
38b
                                     37
Abdomen ending abruptly, unless
terminal segment itself is extended
as single structure.  (Figs. 24A,  24C)
36
Mouth parts adapted for chewing.
Front of face covered by extensible
folded mouthparts often called a
"mask".  Head broad,  eyes widely
spaced.  Nymphs of dragonflies or
darning needles.
   Order ODONATA (Figs.  24A,  24C. 24E)

Mouthparts for piercing and sucking.
Legs often adapted for water locomotion.
Body forms various.  Water Bugs,  .
water scorpions,  water boatment,
backswimmers, electric light bugs,
water striders, water  measurers, etc.
   Order HEMIPTERA (Fig. 25)

Tail extensions (caudal filaments) two.
Stonefly larvae .
   Order PLECOPTERA (Fig.  26)
Tail extensions three, at times
greatly reduced in size.

Tail extensions long and slender.
Rows of hairs may give extensions
a feather-like appearance.
Mayfly larvae
   Order EPHEMEROPTERA

Tail extensions flat, elongated
plates.  Head broad with widely
spaced eyes, abdomen relatively
long and slender.  Damselfly
nymths.
   Order ODONATA (Fig. 24D)
38
                                                                                     45-5

-------
 Key to Selected Groups of Freshwater Animals
39a  External wings or wing covers
     form a hard protective dome over
     the inner wings folded beneath,
     and over the abdomen.  Beetles.
        Order COLEOPTERA
        (Fig. 28)

39b  External wings leathery at base,
     Membranaceous at tip. Wings
     sometimes very short. Mouth-
     parts for piercing and sucking.
     Body form various.  True bugs.
        Order HEMIPTERA (Fig. 25)

40a  Appendage present in pairs.
     (fins, legs, wings).

40b  No paired appendages.  Mouth
     a round suction disc.

4la  Body long and slender. Several
     holes along side of head.
     Lampreys.
        Sub Phylum VERTEBRATA,
        Class CYCLOSTOMATA

41b  Body plump, oval.   Tail extending
     out abruptly.  Larvae of frogs and
     toads.  Legs appear one at a time
     during metamorphosis to  adult
     form.  Tadpoles.
        Class AMPHIBIA
42
41
42a  Paired appendages are legs           43

42b  Paired appendages are fins,
     gills covered by a flap
     (operculum). True fishes.
        Class PISCES

43a  Digits with claws, nails,  or hoofs     44

43b  Skin naked.  No claws or digits
     Frogs, toads, and salamanders.
        Class AMPHIBIA

44a  Warm blooded                       45

44b  Cold blooded.  Body covered
     with horny scales or plates.
        Class REPTILIA

45a  Body covered with feathers.
     Birds.
        Class AVES

45b  Body covered with hair.
     Mammals.
        Class MAMMALIA
   45-6

-------
                                           Key to Selected Groups of Freshwater Animals
REFERENCES - Invertebrates

1  Eddy, Samuel and Hodson, A. C.
      Taxonomic Keys to the Common
      Animals of the North Central States.
      Burgess Pub. Company, Minneapolis.
      162 p. 1961.

2  Edmondson, W. T. (ed.) and Ward and
      Whipple's Freshwater Biology.  John
      Wiley & Sons, New York.  pp.  1-1248.
      1959.

3  Jahn, T. L. and Jahn, F.F.  How to Know
      the Protozoa.  Wm. C.  Brown Company,
      Dubuque, Iowa. pp.  1-234.  1949.

4  Klots, Elsie B.  The New Field Book of
      Freshwater Life.  G. P.  Putnam's Sons.
      398 pp. 1966.

5  Kudo, R.  Protozoology. Charles C.
      Thomas,  Publisher,  Springfield, Illinois.
      pp. 1-778.  1950.

6  Palmer, E.  Lawrence.  Fieldbook of
      Natural History.  Whittlesey House,
      McGraw-Hill Book Company, Inc.
      New York.  1949.

7  Pennak, R. W.   Freshwater Invertebrates
      of the United States.  The Ronald Press
      Company,  New York.  pp. 1-769.   1953.

8  Pimentel,  Richard A. Invertebrate
      Identification Manual. Reinhold
      Publishing Corp.  151 pp.  1967,
REFERENCES - Fishes

1  American Fisheries Society.  A List of
      Common and Scientific Names of Fishes
      from the United States and Canada.
      Special Publication No. 2,  Am.  Fish
      Soc.  Executive Secretary AFS.
      Washington Bid.  Suite 1040, 15th &
      New York Avenue,  N. W. Washington,
      DC  20005.  (Price $4.00 paper,
      $7. 00 cloth).  1970.

2  Bailey,  Reeve M.  A Revised List  of
      the Fishes of Iowa with Keys for
      Identification, IN:  Iowa Fish and
      Fishing.  State of Iowa, Super,  of
      Print.  1956.  (Excellent color
      pictures).

3  Eddy, Samuel.  How to Know the
      Freshwater Fishes. Wm.  C. Brown
      Company, Dubuque, Iowa.   1957.

4  Hubbs, C. L. and Lagler, K. F. Fishes
      of the Great Lakes Regions.  Bull.
      Cranbrook Inst. Science, Bloomfield
      HiUs, Michigan.  1949.

5  Lagler,  K. F.  Freshwater Fishery
      Biology.  Wm. C. Brown Company,
      Dubuque,  Iowa.   1952.

6  Trautman, M. B.  The Fishes of Ohio.
      Ohio  State University Press,'- Columbus.
      1957.  (An outstanding example  of a
      State study).
                                                 This outline was prepared by H. W.  Jackson,
                                                 former Chief Biologist, National Training
                                                 Center, and revised by R. M. Sinclair,
                                                 Aquatic Biologist,  National Training Center,
                                                 MOTD, OWPO,  USEPA, Cincinnati, Ohio
                                                 45268.

                                                 Descriptors: Aquatic Life, Systematics.
                                                                                    45-7

-------
Key to Selected Groups of Freshwater Animals
         1. Spongilla spicules
            Up to . 2 mm. long.
3A. Rotifer. Polyarthra
           ~
                    3B. Rotifer. Keratella
                        Up to . 3 mm.
                                   3C. Rotifer, Philpdina
                                       Up to. 4 mm.
  4A.  Jointed leg
       Caddisfly
                                4B. Jointed leg
                                     Crayfish
                                                                2B.  Bryozoal mass. Up to
                                                                     several, feet diatn.
                                       2A.  Bryozoa.  Plumatella.  Individuals up
                                           to ?. mm.  Intertwined masses maybe
                                          very extensive.
4C. Jointed leg
     Ostracod
                                                                  5. Tapeworm head,
                                                                     Taenia.  Up to
                                                                     25 yds. long
       6A. Turbellaria. Mesostoma
           Up to 1 cm.
                                     6B. Turbellaria. Dugesia
                                          Up to 1.6 cm.
                                                              7. Nematodes.  Free living
                                                                 forms commonly up to
                                                                 1 mm.,  occasionally
                                                                 more.

-------
                                      Key to Selected Groups of Freshwater Animals
                  8B. Diptera, Mosquito
                      pupa. Up to 5mm.
8A.  Dipttra, Mosquito larvae
    Up to 15 mm. long.
                      8C.  Diptera,  chironomid 8E'
                            larvae.  Up to 2 cm.
                                   9D. Diptera, Rattailed maggot
                                      Up to 25 mm. without tube.
9A.  Annelid,
    segmented
    worm, up to
    1/2 meter
                                                    10B. Alasmidonta, end view.
                      IDA. Pelecyopod, Alasmidonta
                           Side view,  up to 18 cm. long.
9B. Annelid, leech up to 20 cm.
                         12A. Branchiopod,
                               Daphnia.  Up
                               to 4mm.
 11A. Ostracod, Cypericus
     Side view, up to 7 mm.
                        11B. Cypericus,  end view.
                                                         12 B.   Branchiopod,
                                                                Bosmina.   Up
                                                                to 2mm.

-------
Key to Selected Groups of Freshwater Animals
     13. Gastropod, Viviparus
         Up to 3 'inches.
                                   14. Megaloptera,
                                       Alder fly larvae
                                       Up to 25 mm.
       16. Fairy Shrimp, Eubranchipus
           Up to 5 cm.
                                                                  15.  Water mite,
                                                                      Up to 3 mm.
                     17. Amphipod, Pontoporeia
                        Up to 25 mm.
                                                               18.  Isopod, Asellus
                                                                   Up to 25 mm.
           20.  Collembola, Podura
               Up to 2 mm. long
19A. Calanoid copepod,   19B< Copepoid copepod.
      Female                 Female
     Up to 3 mm.             Up to 2
    10

-------
                                      Key to Selected Groups of Freshwater Animals
    21A.
                     2 IB.
       2 ID.
        21C.
                              21E.
21.  Tricoptera, Larvae cases, mostly 1-2 cm.
                        22. Megaloptera, alderfly
                            Up to 2 cm.
 23A. Beetle larvae,
      Dytisidae,
      Usually about \ cm.
23B. Beetle larvae,
     Hydrophilidae,
     Usually  about 1 cm.
24A. Odonata, dragonfly
     nymph up to 3 or 4
     cm.
                          24B. Odonata, tail of
                               damselfly nymph
                               (side view)
                                24E. Odonata, front view
                                    of dragonfly nymph
                                    showing  "mask"
                                    partially extended
              24D.  Odonata,  damselfly
                   nymph (top view)
                                                             24C.  Odonata, tail of
                                                                   dragonfly nymph
                                                                   (top view)

-------
Key to Selected Groups of Freshwater Animals
             25A. Hemiptera,
                  Water Boatman
                  About 1 cm.
             2 7 .Epheme ropte ra,
               Mayfly nymph
                Up to 5 cm.
                                              25B.  Hemiptera,
                                                   Water Scorpion
                                                   About 4 cm.
                                26. Plecoptera,
                                    Stonefly nymph
                                    Up to 5 cm.
28A. Coleoptera,
     Water scavenger
     beetle.  Up to 4 cm.
                                                                    2SB. Coleoptera,
                                                                         Dytiscid beetle
                                                                         Usually up to 2j cm.
                29A. Diptera, Crane
                     fly. Up to 2i cm.
                                                      29B.  Diptera, Mosquito
                                                            Up to 20 mm.

-------
II   KEY TO ALGAE OF IMPORTANCE IN WATER POLLUTION

1        Plant  a tube, thread, strand, ribbon,  or membrane; frequently visible to the unaided eye	2
1'        Plants of microscopic cells which are isolated or in irregular,  spherical, or microscopic
         clusters; cells not grouped into threads	123

2 (1)     Plant a tube, strand, ribbon, thread, or membrane composed of cells	3
2'        Plant a branching tube with  continuous protoplasm, not divided into cells	120

3 (2)     Plant a tube, strand, ribbon, thread, or a mat of threads	4
3'        Plant a membrane of cells  one cell thick (and 2 or more cells wide)	116

4 (3)     Cells in isolated or clustered threads or ribbons which are only one cell thick or wide	5
4'        Cells in a tube, strand,  or thread all (or a part) of which is more than one cell thick or
         wide	108

5 (4)     Heterocysts present	6
5'        Heterocysts absent	23

6 (5)     Threads gradually narrowed to a point at one end	7
6'        Threads same width throughout	12
7 (6)     Threads as radii, in a gelatinous bead or mass.
7'        Threads not in a gelatinous bead or mass	
8 (7)    Spore (akinete) present, adjacent to the terminal heterocyst  (Cloeotrichia)	9
8'       No spore (akinete) present (Rivularia)	10

9 (8)    Gelatinous colony a smooth bead	.Gloeotrichia echinulatr.
9'       Gelatinous colony irregular	Gloeotrichia natans

10  (81)   Cells near the narrow end as long as wide	Rivularia dura
10'      Cells near the narrow end twice as long as wide	Rivularia haematites

 11 (71)    Cells adjacent to heterocyst wider than heterocyst	Calothrix braunii
 11'       Cells adjacent to heterocyst narrower than heterocyst	Calothrix parietina

 12 (61)   Branching present	13
 12'      Branching absent	14

 13 (12)   Branches in pairs	Scytonema tolypothricoides
 13'      Branches arising singly.	Tolypothrix tenuis

 14 (121)  Heterocyst terminal only  (Cyclindrospermum)	15
 14'      Hetrocysts intercalary  (within the filament)	16

 15 (14)   Heterocyst round	Cylindrospermum muscicola
 15'      Heterocyst elongate	Cylindrospermum  stagnate

 16 (141)  Threads encased in a gelatinous bead or mass	17
 16'      Threads not encased in  a  definite  gelatinous mass	18

 17 (16)   Heterocysts and vegetative cells rounded	Nostoc pruniforme
 17'      Heterocysts and vegetative cells oblong	Nostoc carneum

 18 (16')  Heterocysts and vegetative cells shorter than the thread width	Nodularia spumigena
18'       Heterocysts and vegetative cells not shorter than the thread width	19

 19 (18') Heterocysts rounded  (Anabaena)	20
 19'     Heterocysts clindric.	Aphanizomenon flos-aquae

 20 (19)   Cells elongate, depressed in the middle; heterocysts rare.	Anabaena constricta
 20'     Cells rounded; heterocysts common	21

21 (201) Heterocysts with  lateral extensions	Anabaena planctonica
21'       Heterocysts without lateral extensions	22
 BLMIC.cla.8b. 6.76                                                                    46-1

-------
 22 (21')  Threads 4-8|» wide .................................................. Anabaena floe- aquae
 22'      Threads 8-140 wide [[[ Anabaena circinalis

 23 (5')   Branching absent .................. .................................................. -24
 23'      Branching (including "false" branching) present ......................................... 84

 24 (23)  Cell pigments distributed throughout the protoplasm ..................................... 25
 24'      Cell pigments limited to plastids ............... . ...................................... 49

 25 (23)  Threads short and formed as an even spiral ........................................... 285
 25'      Threads very long and not forming an even spiral ....................................... 26

 26 (25')  Several parallel threads of cells in one common sheath ............. Microcoleus subtorulosus
 26'      One thread per sheath if present [[[ 27

 27 (26')  Sheath or gelatinous matrix present [[[ 28
 27'      No sheath nor gelatinous matrix apparent  (Oscillatoria) ................................. 35

 28 (27)  Sheath distinct; no gelatinous matrix between threads  (Lyngbyal .......................... 29
 28'      Sheath indistinct  or absent; threads  interwoven with gelatinous matrix between (Phormidium).  . .
         ............................................... . .................................... 32

 29 (28*  Cells rounded [[[ Lyngbya ocracea
 29'      Cells short  cylindric [[[ 30

 30 (29' I  Threads in part forming spirals ...................................... Lyngbya lagerheimii
 30'      Threads straight or bent but not in spirals .......... . .................................... 31

 31 (30'1  Maximum cell length 3. 5|i  ; sheath thin .................................... Lyngbya digueti
 31'      Maximum cell length 6. 5M ; sheath thick ........................... ..... Lyngbya versicolor

 32 (28'>  Ends of some threads with  a rounded swollen "cap" cell ................................. 33
 32'      Ends of all threads without a "cap" cell ................. . ............................... 34

 33 (32)  End of thread (with "cap") abruptly bent ............................ Phormidium uncinalum
 33'      End of thread (with "cap") straight ................................. Phormidium autumnale

  34 (32'i  Threads 3-5M  in width ............................................ Phormidium inundatum
  34'      Threads 5-12u in width ................................................. Phormidium retzii

  35 (27'l  Cells very  short; generally less than 1/3  the thread diameter: ............................  36
  35'      Cells generally 1/2 as long to longer than the thread  diameter ....... .....................  39

  36 (35)   Cross walls constricted ................................ .  .............. Oscillatoria ornata
 36'      Cross walls not constricted : [[[ .... .37

 37 (36')  Ends of thread, if mature,  curved [[[ 38
 37'      Ends of thread straight .......................................... '.,'.. .Oscillatoria limosa

 38 (37)  Threads  10-14,, rhick ............................................. Oscillatoria curviceps
 3fi'      Threads  ]6-6(V  thick ............................................... Oscillatoria princeps

 39 (35')  Threads  appearing red to purplish ................................... Oscillatoria rubescens
 39'      Threads  yellow-green to blue-green [[[ .40

 40 (39')  Threads  yellow-green [[[ 4]
 40'      Threads   blue-green [[[ 43

 41 (40)   Cells 4-7 times as long as tne thread diameter. . . ....................... Oscillatoria putrida
 41'       Cells less than 4 times as long as the thread diameter ................. .......... ......... 42


-------
45 (44')  Ends of thread straight .............................................. Oscillatoria agardhii
45'      Ends of mature threads  curved [[[ 46

46 (45')  Prominent granules present especially at both ends of each cell ............ Oscillatoria tenuis
46'      Cells without prominent granules [[[ 47

47 (46')  Cross walls constricted ............................................. Oscillatoria chalybea
47'      Cross walls not constricted ........................................ . .Oscillatoria formosa

48 (43')  End of thread  long tapering ......................................... Oscillatorla  splendida
48'      End of thread  not tapering ........................................... Oscillatoria amphibia

49 (24')  Cells separate from one another and enclosed in a tube  (Cymbella) ....................... 251'
49'      Cells attached  to one another as a thread  or ribbon ...................................... 50

50 (49')  Cells separating  readily into discs or short cylinders,  their circular face showing radial
         markings [[[ 233
50'      Cells either not separating  readily, or if  so, no circular end wall with radial markings ...... 51

51 (f)OM  (".ells in a ribbon, attached  side by side or by their corners .............................. 52
51'       Cells in a thread, attached  end to end .................................................. 56

52 (51)   Numerous regularly spaced markings in the cell wall .................................... 53
5t'      Numerous markings in the  cell wall absent  (Scenedesmus> .............................. 128

53 (52)   Wall markings of two types, one coarse,  one fine ...................................... 185
53 '      Wall markings all fine (Fragilaria) [[[ 54

54 (531)  Cells attached  at middle portion only ................................ Fragilaria crotonensis
54'      Cells attached  along entire  length [[[ 55

55 (54')  Cell length 25-100|» .................................................. Fragilaria capucina
55'      Cell length 7-25n .........  . ........................................ Fragilaria construens

56 (51')   Plastid in the form of a spiral band  (Spirogyra) ........................................ 57
56'      Plastid not a spiral band [[[ 61
57 (56)   One plastid per cell
57 '       Two or more plastids per cell
58 (57)   Threads 18-26|»wide ................................................. Spirogyra communis
58'      Threads 28-50n wide [[[  59

59 (58')  Threads 28-40p wide .................................................. Spirogyra varians
59'      Thread s40-50|) wide ................................................ Spirogyra porticalis

60 (57')  Threads 30-45M wide; 3-4 plastids per cell ............................ Spirogyra fluviatilis
60'      Threads 50-80* wide; 5-8 plastids per cell ........................... Spirogyra majuscula

61 (56')  Plastids two per cell [[[ 62
61'       Plastids either one or more than two per cell ...................................... .....  66

62 (61)   Cells with knobs or granules on the wall ...............................................  63
62'      Cells with a smooth outer wall [[[ 64

63 (62)   Each cell with two central knobs on the wall .................. ......... Desmidium grevillii
63'      Each cell with a ring of granules  near one end ........................... Hyalotheca mucosa

64(62')   Cells dense green,  each plastid reaching to the wall ........................ Zygnema sterile

-------
   t:7 it bi  Threads with occasional "knee-joint" brnds .	Mougeotia genuflexa
   i-.l'      Threads straight	,	^8

   {•H it>7'i  Threads 19-24(1 wide; pyrenoids 4-lb per cell	Mougeotia  sphacrocarpa
   i.fs'      Threads 20-34v wide; pyrenoids 4-10 per cell	Mougeoiia scalaris

   '..'I ii'-n'l  Occasional cells with one to several transverse wall lines near one end (Oedogoniuml	70
   I.-Q'      Occasional terminal transverse wall lines  not present	73

   70 <69)  Thread diameter less than 24»i	"1
   70'      Thread diameter 23n or more	?2

   71 i~0>   Thread diameter 1-14^	Oedogonium suecicum
   71'       Thread diameter 14-23p	Oedogonium boscii

   72 i7(H  Dwarf male plants attached to normal thread,  when reproducing. .Oedogonium idioandroaporum
  .7?.'      No dwarf male plants produced	Oedogonium grande

   73 iri3'l  Cells with-one  plastid which has a smooth surface/	74
   73'      Cells with several plastids  or with one nodular plastid	78

   74 (73)  Cells with rounded ends	Stichococcus baciilaris
   74'      Ct/lls with flat  ends  (Ul.othrix)	"'

   75 <74'i  Threads lOp or less in diameter	"6
  •75'      Threads more  than 10(i  in diameter	"7

   76 i7=i>  Threads i-6f   in diameter	Ulothrix variabilis
   76'      Threads 6-lOy  in diameter	.Ulothrix tenerrima

   77 175 )  Threads ll-17ji in diameter	Ulothrix aequalis
   77'      Threads 20-60*1 in diameter	Ulothrix Zonata

   78 i73'l Iodine lest for starch positive;  one nodular plastid per cell. . .	.7P
   78'      Iodine test for starch negative;  several plastids per cell	80

   79  i'78t  Thread when broken, forming "H'' shape segments	Microspora amoena
   79'      Thread when fragmented,  separating irregularly or between cells (Rhizoclonium)	100

   HO  (7ij'i Side walls  of cells straight, not bulging.  A pattern of fine lines or dots present in the wall
           bvit often indistinct  (Melosira)	81
   HO1      Side walls of cells slightly  bulging.   Pattern of wall markings  not present (Tribonemal	83

   81 (80)   Spine-like teeth at margin of end walls	g2
   81'      N'o  spine-like  teeth present	Melosira varians

   82 '811   Wall with fine  granules. arranged obliquely	Melosira crenulata
   82'      Wall with coarse granules,  arranged parallel to sides	Melosira sranulata

   83 (80')  Plastids 2-4 per cell	Tribonema minus
   .S3'      Plastids more  than 4 per cell	Tribonema bombycinum

   84 i23'l  Plastids present; branching 'true"	ST
   84'      Pla.stids absent; branching  "false	 Plectonema tomasiniana

   85 (841  Branches reconnected, forming  a net	Hydrodictyon reliculatum
   85'      Branches not forming a distinct  net	g(,

   Rfj (K5'l  Each  cell in a  conical  sheath open at the broad end ipinobtyonl	87
   8'V      N'o conical  sheath around each cell	
-------
8'3 (88)      Narrow end drawn out into a stalk	Dinobryon stipitatum
BO'          Narrow enddiveraingatthebase	Dinobryon  sociale

nO I8ii')     Short branches on the main thread in whorls of 4 or more (Nitella)	11
90'          Branching commonly  single or in pairs	92

•'.'I 190)      Short branches on the main thread rebranched once	Nilelia flcxilis
Q!'          Short branches on the main thread rebranched two to four times	Nitelia gracilis

92 (90')     Terminal cell each with a colorless  spine having an abruptly swollen base (Bulbochaetc). . .93
92'          No terminal spines with abruptly swollen bases	94

93          Vegetative cells 20-48y long	Bulbochaete mirabilis
93'          Vegetative cells 48-88|j long	Bulbochaete insignis

94(92')     Celle red, brown, or  violet	Audouinella violacea
94'          O!ls green	95
95 (94')     Threads enclosed in a gelatinous bead or mass
95'          Threads not surrounded by a gelatinous mass . .
            Abrupt change in width from main thread to branches (Draparnaldia)	97
            Gradual change in width from main thread to branches (Chaetophora)	 .98

'<7 (96)      Branches (from  the main thread) with a central, main axis	Draparnaldia plumosa
97'         Branches diverging and with no central main axis	Draparnaldia glomerata

98(96')     End cells long-pointed,  with colorless tips	Chaetophora attenuata
98'         End cells abruptly pointed,  mostly without long colorless tips	Chaetophora elegans

99(95')     Light and dense  dark  cells intermingled in the thread	Pithophora oedogogonia
99'         Most of the cells essentially alike in density	100

 100 (99')    Branches few in number,  and short, colorless	  Rhizoclonium hieroglyphicum
 100'        Branches numerous and green	101

 101 (1001)    Terminal attenuation'gradual,  involving two or more cells  (StiBeocloniuml	102
 101'         Terminal attenuation absent or abrupt, involving only one cell  (Cladophora)	104

 102 (101)    Branches frequently in  pairs	  103
 102'        Branches mostly single	Stigeoclonium stagnatilc

 103 (102)    Cells in main th read  l-2times as long as wide	Stigeoclonium lubricum
 103'        Cells in main thread  2-3 times as long as wide	Stigeoclonium tenue

 104 (1011)    Branching often appearing forked,  or in threes	Cladophora aegagropila
 104'        Branches distinctly lateral	105

 105 1104')   Branches forming acute angle  with main thread, thus forming clusters..Cladophora glomerata
 105'        Branches forming wide angles with  the main thread	106

 106 (10 5')   Threads  crooked and  bent	Cladophora fracta
 106'        Threads  straight	'. .  107

 107 (I061)   Branches few,  seldom rebranching	Cladophora insignis
 107'        Branches numerous,  often rebranching	Cladophora crispata

 108 (4')     Plant or tube with a tight  surface layer of cells and with regularly spaced swellings (nodes).
            	 Lemanea annulata
 108'        Plant not a tube that has both a tight layer of surface cells and nodes	  109

 109 (1081)   Cells spherical  and loosely arranged in a gelatinous matrix	Tetraspora  gelatinosa
 109'        Cells not as loosely arranged spheres	110

 110 (109')    Plants branch	Ill
 110'         Plants not branched	Schizomeris leiblcinii

 111 (110)     Clustered branching	1U
 111'         Branches single	115
                                                                                             46-5

-------
 112 (ill)     Threads embedded in gelatinous matrix (Batrachospermum)	113
•112'        No gelantinous matrix (Chara)	114

 113 (112)    Nodal masses of branches touching one another	Batrachospermum vagum
 113'        Nodal masses of branches separated by a narrow space	Batrachospermum moniliforme

 114 (1121)   Short branches with 2 naked cells at the tip	Chara globularis
 114'        Short branches with 3-4 naked cells at the tip . . .	Chara vulgaris

 115 (1111)    Heterocysts present; plastids absent	Stigonema minutum
 115'        Heterocysts absent; plastids present	Compsopogon coeruleua

 116 (3')     Red eye spot and two flagella present for  each  cell	 .. .	125
 116'        No eye spots nor flagella present	117

 117 (116')   Round to oval cells, held together by a flat gelatinous matrix  (Agmenellum)	131
 117'        Cells not round and not enclosed in a gelatinous matrix . . .	118

 118(117')   Cells regularly arranged to an unattached disc.  Number of cells 2, 4,  8, 16, 32; 64,  or
            128	133'
 118'        Cells numerous; membrane attached on one surface	119

 119 (US')   Long hairs extending from upper surface  of cells	 Chaetopeltis megalocystis
 119'        No hairs extending from cell surfaces	Htldenbrandia rivularis

 120 (21)     Constriction at the base of every branch	Dichotomosiphon tuberosus
 120'        No constrictions present in the tube  (Vaucheria)	121

 121 (120')   Egg sac attached directly, without a stalk, to the main vegetative tube. . . Vaucheria sessilis
 121'        Egg sac attached to an abrupt,  short,  side branch	122

 122 (121')   One egg sac per branch	Vaueheria terrestris
 122'        Two or more egg sacs per branch	Vaucheria geminata

 123 (!')     Cells in colonies generally of a definite form or  arrangement	124
 123'        Cells isolated, in pairs or in loose, irregular  aggregates	173

 124 (123)   Cells with many transverse rows of markings on the wall	185
 124'        Cells without transverse rows of markings	125

 125 (124')   Cells arranged as a layer one cell thick	126
 125'        Cell cluster more than one cell  thick and  not a flat plate	137

 126 (125)   Red eye spot and two flagella present for  each  cell	Gonium pectorale
 126'        No red eye spots nor flagella present	127

 127 (126')   Cells elongate, united side by side  in 1 or 2 rows (Scenedesmus)	128
 127'        Cells about as long as wide	 131

 128 (127)   Middle cells without spines but with pointed ends	Scenedesmus dimorphus
 128'        Middle cells with rounded ends	'.	129

 129 (128")  Terminal cells with spines	130
 129'        Terminal cells without spines	Scenedesmus bijuga

 130 (129)   Terminal cells with two spines each		Scenedesmus quadricauda
 130'        Terminal cells with three or more  spines each	Scenedesmus abundans

 131 (117)    Cells in regular  rows, immersed in colorless  matrix  (Agmenellum quadriduplicatum). . .132
 131'        Cells not immersed in colorless matrix	133

 132 (131)    Cell diameter 1. 3 to 2. 2p	Agmenellum quadriduplicatum , tenuisstma type
 132'        Cell diameter 3-5|»	Agmenellum quadriduplicatum,   glauca type

 133 (1311)   Cells without spines,  projections, or incisions.	Crucigenia quadrata
 133'        Cells with spines, projections,  or incisions	 134
 46-6

-------
134 (133')    Cells rounded	Micractinium pusillum
134'         Cells angular   (Pediastrum)	135

135 (134')    Numerous spaces between cells	Pediastrum duplex
135'        Cells fitted tightly together	136

136 (1351)    Cell incisions deep and narrow	Pediastrum tetras
136'        Cell incisions shallow and wide	Pediastrum boryanum

137 (1251)    Cells sharp-pointed at both ends; often arcuate	138
137'        Cells not sharp-pointed at both ends; not arcuate	 141

138 (137)    Cells embedded in a gelatinous matrix	Kirchneriella lunaris
138'        Cells not embedded in a gelatinous matrix	 139

139 (13B'l    Cells all arcuate; arranged  back to back	•	Selenastrum gracile
139'        Cells straight or bent in various ways; loosely arranged or twisted together	
            	(Ankistrodesmus)	140

140 (139')    Cells bent	Ankistrodesmus falcatus
140'        Cells straight	Ankistrodesmus falcatus var. acicularis

141 (137')    Flagella present; eye spots often present	142
141'         No flagella nor eye spots  present	152

142 (141)    Each cell in a conical sheath open at the wide end  (Dinobryon)	86
142'        Individual cells not in conical sheaths	143

143 (142')    Each cell with 1-2 long  straight rods extending	Chrysosphaerella longispina
143'        No long straight rods extending from the cells	144

144 (143')    Cells touching one another in a dense colony	145
144'        Cells embedded separately in a colorless matrix	 149

145 (144)    Cells arranged radially,   facing outward .	  146
145'        Cells all facing in one direction	 147

146 (145)    Plastids brown;  eye spot absent	Synura uvella
146'        Plastids green; eye spot present in each cell	Pandorlna morum

147 (1451)    Each cell with 4 flagella	Spondylomorum quaternarium
147 '        Each cell  with 2 flagella  (Pyrobotrys)	148

148 (1471)    Eye spot in the wider (anterior) end of the cell	Pyrobotrys stellata
148'        Eye spot in the narrower  (posterior) end of the cell	Pyrobotrys gracilis

149 (1441)    Plastids brown	Uroglenopsis americana
149'        Plastids green	150

150 (1491)    Cells 16, 32, or 64 per colony	Eudorina elegans
150''        Cells more than 100 per colony	: ... 151

151 (ISO1)    Colony spherical; each  cell with an eye spot	Volvox aureus
151'         Colony tubular or irregular; no eye  spots  (Tetraspora)	'	 109

152 (141')    Elongate cells, attached together at one end; arranged radially (Actinastrum)	  153
152'        Cells not elongate,  often spherical	  154

153 (152)    Cells cylindric	Actinastrum  gracillimum
153'        Cells distinctly bulging	Actinastrum hantzschii

154 (1521)    Plastids present	.155
154'        Plastids absent; pigment throughout each protoplast	168

155 (154)    Colonies,  including the outer matrix, orange to  red-brown	Botryococcus braunii
155'        Matrix, if any, not bright  colored;  cell plastids green . . .	 156
                                                                                           46-7

-------
 156 (155')   Colonies round to oval	  160
 156'        Colonies not round, often irregular in form	  157

 157 (1561)   Straight (flat) walls between adjacent  cells   (Phytoconis)	278
 157'        Walls between neighboring cells rounded	  158

 158 (157')   Cells arranged as a surface layer in a large gelatinous tube  (Tetrasoora)	109
 158'        Colony not a tube;  cells in irregular  pattern	  159

 159 (158')   Large cells more than twice the diameter of the small cells (Chlorococcum)	280'
 159'        Large cells not  more than twice the diameter of the small cells (Palmella)	281

 160 (156)    Cells touching one  another; tightly grouped	Coelastrum microporum
 160'        Cells loosely grouped	161

 161 (1601)   Colorless threads extend from center of colony to cells	162
 161'         No colorless threads attached to cells in colony	  164

 162 (161)    Cells rounded or straight, oval  (Dictyosphaerium)	  163
 162'        Cells elongate,  some cells curved	Dimorphococcus lunatus

 163 (162)    Cells rounded	Dictyosphaerium pulchellum
 163'        Cells straight, oval	Dictyosphaerium ehrenbergianum

 164 (161')   Cells rounded	  165
 164'        Cells oval	Oocystis borgei

 165 (164)    One plastid per  cell	166
 165'        Two to four plastids per cell	Gloeococcus schroeteri

 166 (165)    Outer matrix divided into layers   (Gloeocystis)	  167
 166'        Outer matrix homogeneous	Sphaerocystis schroeteri

 167 (166)    Colonies angular	Gloeocystis planctonica
 167'        Colonies rounded	Gloeocystis  gigas

 168 (154')   Cells equidistant from center of colony   (Gomphosphaeria)	  169
 168'        Cells irregularly distributed  in the colony	172

 169 (168)    Cells with  pseudovacuoles	  Gomphospaeria wichurae
 169'        Cells without pseudovacuoles	 170

 170 (169')   Cells 2-4)iin diameter  (Gomphosphaeria lacustris)	171
 170'        Cells ovate	Gomphosphaeria aponina

 171 (170)    Cells spherical	  	Gomphosphaeria lacustris, kuetzingianum type
 171'         Cells 4-15   in diameter  	Gomphosphaeria lacustris, collinsii type

 172 (168')   Cells ovid; division plane perpendicular to long axis  (Coccochlorls)	286
 172'        Cells rounded; or division plane perpendicular to short axis (Anacystis)	286'

 173 (123')   Cells with an abrupt median transverse  groove or incision	174
 173'        Cells without an abrupt transverse median groove or  incision	184

 174 (173)    Cells brown; flagella present (armored flagellates)	175
 174'        Cells green; no  flagella (desmids)	  178

 175 (174)    Cell with 3 or more long horns	Ceratium hirundinella
 175'        Cell without more than 2 horns	176

 176 (175')   Cell wall of very thin smooth plates	Glenodinium palustre
 176'        Cell wall of very thick rough plates   (Peridinium)	177

 177 (176')   Ends of cell pointed	Peridinium wisconsinense
 177'        Ends of cell rounded	Peridinium cinctum

.178 (174')   Margin of cell with sharp pointed , deeply cut lobes or long spikes	179
 178'        Lobes, if present,  with rounded ends	  182
  46-8

-------
179 (178)   Median incision narrow,  linear	Micrasterlas truncata
179'        Median incision wide, "V" or "U" shaped (Staurastrum)	180

180 (179)   Margin of cell with long spikes. . . . '.	Staurastrum paradoxum
180'        Margin of cell without long spikes	181

181 (180")   Ends of lobes with short  spines	Staurastrum polymorphum
181"        Ends of lobes without spines	Staurastrum punctulatum

182 (178')   Length of cell about double the width	Euastrum  oblongum
182'        Length of cell one to one and one-half times the width  (Cosmarium)	183

183 (182')   Median incision narrow linear	Cosmarium botrytis
183'        Median incision wide, "U" shaped	Cosmarium portianum

184 (173')   Cells triangular	Tetraedron muticum
184'        Cells not triangular	185

185 (1Z4)    Cells with one end distinctly different from the other	 186
185'        Cells with both ends essentially alike	225

186 (185)    Numerous transverse (not  spiral) regularly spaced wall markings  present (diatoms)	187
186'        No transverse regularly spaced wall markings	193

187 (186)    Cells curved (bent)  in girdle view	Rhoicosphenia curvata
187'        Cells not curved in  girdle view	188

188 (187')   Cells with both fine and coarse transverse line*	Meridion circulare
188'        Cells with transverse lines  all alike in  thickness	189

189 (188')   Cells essentially linear to rectangular; one terminal swelling larger than the other. . .'	
            	(Asterionella)	190
189'        Cells wedge-shaped; margins  sometimes wavy  (Gomphonema)	 191

190 (189)    Larger terminal swelling 1-1/2 to 2 times wider than the other	Asterionella formosa
190'        Larger terminal swelling less than 1-1/2 times wider than the  other. .Asterionella gracillima

191 (1891)    Narrow end enlarged in valve  view	Gomphonema geminatum
191'         Narrow end not enlarged in  valve view	192

192 (191')    Tip of broad end about as wide as tip of narrow end in valve view. . . .Gomphonema parvulum
192'        Tip of broad end much wider than tip of .narrow end in valve view. . jGomphonema  olivaceum

193 (186')   Spine present  at  each end of cell	Schroederia setigera
193'        No spine on both ends of cell	194

194 (193')   Pigments in one  or  more plastids	195
194'       No plastid; pigments throughout the protoplast	Entophysalis lemaniae

195 (194)    Cells in a conical sheath (Dinobryon)	  86
19.5'        Cells not in a conical sheath . ,	196

196 (195')  Cell covered with scales and long spines	Mallomonae caudata
196'        Cells  not covered with  scales and long spines	197

197 (1961)   Protoplasts separated by a space from  a rigid sheath (lorica)	198
197'       No loose sheath around the cells	202

198 (197)    Cells compressed (flattened)	Phacotus lenticularis
198'        Cells not compressed	199

199 (198')   Lorica opaque; yellow  to reddish or brown	Trachelomonas crebea
199'        Lorica transparent; colorless to brownish  (Chrysococcue)	200

200 (199')   Outer membrane (lorica) oval	Chrysococcus ovalia
200'        Outer membrane (lorica) rounded	201
                                                                                         46-9

-------
 201 (EDO1)   Lorica thickened around opening	Chrysococcus rufescens
 201'        Lorica not thickened around opening	Chrysococcus     major

 202 (197')   Front end flattened diagonally	203
 202'        Front end not flattened diagonally	:	206

 203 (202) .  Plastids bright blue-green (Chroomonas)		204
 203'        Plastids brown, red,  olive-green,  or yellowish	205

 204 (203)   Cell pointed at  one end	Chroomonas nordstetii
 204'        Cell not pointed at one end	Chroomonas setoniensis

 205 (203')   Gullet present; furrow absent	Cryptomonas erosa
 205'        Furrow present; gullet absent	Rhodomonas lacustris

 206 (202')   Plastids yellow-brown	Chromulina rosanoffi
 206'        Plastids not yellow-brown; generally green	• • • •	 207

 207 (2061)   One plastid per cell	208
 207'        Two to several plastids per cell	Zll

 208 (207)   Cells tapering at each end	'. '.	Chlorogonium  euchlorum
 208'        Cells rounded  to oval	,	209

 209 (208')   Two flagella per cell  (Chlamydomonas)	210
 209'        Four flagella per cell	Catefia multifilis

  210 (209)   Pyrenoid angular; eye spot in front third of cell	Chlamydomonas reinhardi
  210"        Pyrenoid circular; eye spot in middle third of cell	.Chlamydomonas globes a

  211 (207')   Two plastids per cell . . . -.	Cryptoglena pigra
  211"        Several plastids per cell  :.....	212

  212 (2111)   Cell compressed (flattened)  (Phacus)	 213
  212'        Cell not compressed	'.	214.

  213 (212)    Posterior spine short, bent	Phacus pleuronectes
  213'         Posterior spine long, .straight	Phacus  longicauda

 214 (212)
  214'

 215 (214)    Cell margin with spiral ridges	.Phacus  pyrum
 215'        Cell margin without ridges, but may have spiral lines  (Lepocinclis)	 216

 216 (215')   Posterior end  with an abrupt, spine-like tip	Lepocinclis ovum
 216'        Posterior end  rounded	Lepocinclis texta

 217 (214')   Green plastids  hidden by a red pigment in the cell	Euglena sanguinea
 217'        No red pigment except for the eye spot	218

 218 (217')   Plastids at  least 1/4 the length of the cell	219
 218'        Plastids discoid or at least shorter than 1/4 the length  of the cell	  220

 219 (218)    Plastids two per cell	Euglena agilis
 219'        Plastids several per cell, often extending radiately from the center	Euglena viridia

 220 (218')   Posterior end  extending as an abrupt colorless spine	 221
 220'        Posterior end  rounded or at least with no colorless spine	222

 221 (220)    Spiral markings very prominent and granular	Euglena spirogyra
 221'        Spiral markings fairly prominent,  not granular	Euglena oxyuris

 222 (220')   Small;  length 35-55(.	Euglena gracilis
 222'        Medium to large; length 65(i  or more	  223

 223 (2221)   Medium in size; length 65-200ji 	224
 223'        Large in size; length  250-290(1	Euglena ehrenbergii


46-10

-------
224 (223)   Plastids with irregular edge; flagellum 2 times as long as cell	Euglena polymorpha
224'        Plastids with smooth edge; flagellum about 1/2 the length of the cell	Euglena deses

225 (1851)   Cells distinctly bent (arcuate); with a spine or narrowing to a point at both ends	226
225'        Cells not arcuate	w	:	230

226 (225)   Vacuole with particles showing Brownian movement at each end of cell.  Cells not in
            clusters.   (Closterium)	227
226'        No terminal vacuoles.  Cells may be in clusters or  colonies	228

227 (226)   Cell wide; width 3.0-70(i	Closterium moniliferum
227'        Cell long and narrow; width up to Sy	Closterium aciculare

228 (226')   Cell with a narrow abrupt spine at each blunt end	Ophiocytium capitatum
228'        No blunt ended cells with abrupt terminal spines	229

229 (2281)   Sharp pointed ends as separate colorless spines	193
229'        Sharp pointed ends as part of the green protoplast	137

230 (225)   One  long spine at each end of cell	231
230'        No long terminal spines	232

231 (230)    Cell gradually narrowed to the spine	137
231'         Cell abruptly narrowed to the spine	Rhizosolenia gracilis

232         A regular pattern of fine lines or dots  in the wall  (diatoms)	233
232'        No regular pattern of fine lines or dots in the  wall	 276

233 (50,    Cells circular in one (valve) view; short rectangular or  square in other (girdle) view. . . . 234
     232)
233'        Cells not circular in one view.		240

234 (233)   Valve surface with an inner and outer (marginal) pattern of striae   (Cyclotella)	 235
234'        Valve surface with one  continuous pattern of striae  (Stephanodiscua)	238

235 (234)    Cells small;  4-10(* in diameter	Cyclotella glomerata
235'         Cells medium to large; 10-80 in diameter  	236

236 (235')   Outer half of valve with two types of lines, one long,  one short	237
236'         Outer half of valve with radial lines all alike	Cyclotella meneghiniana

237 (236)    Outer valve  zone constituting  more than 1/2 the diameter	Cyclotella bodanica
237'         Outer valve  zone constituting  more than 1/2 the diameter	  Cyclotella compta

238 (234')   Cell  4-25|i  in diameter	239
238'         Cell  25-65)i  in diameter	Stephanodiscus niagarae

239 (238)    Cell  with two transverse bands, in girdle view	Stephanodiscus binderanus
239'         Cell  without two transverse bands, in girdle view	Stephanodiscus hantzschii

240 (233')   Cells flat, oval (Cocconeis)	 241
240'         Cells neither flat nor oval	'.	242

241 (240)    Wall markings (striae)  18-20  in 10|i	Cocconeis pediculus
241'         Wall markings (striae) 23-25  in 10M	Cocconeis placentula

242 (240')   Cell  sigmoid in one view .'	 243
242'         Cell  not sigmoid in either  round or point ended (valve) or square ended (girdle) surface
            view	244

243 (242)    Cell  sigmoid in valve surface view	Gyrosigma attenuatum
243'         Cell  sigmoid in square ended  (girdle) surface view	Nitzschia acicularis

244 (2421)   Cell  longitudinally unsymmetrical in at least one view	 245
244'         Cell  longitudinally symmetrical	254

245 (244)    Cell  wall with both fine  and coarse transverse lines  (striae and costae)	246
245'         Cell  wall with fine transverse lines  (striae) only	247


                                                                                             46-11

-------
246 (245)    Valve face about as wide at middle as  girdle face	Epithemia turgida
246'        Valve face 1/2 or less as wide at middle as girdle face	Rhopalodia gibba

247 (245)    Line of pores and raphe located at edge of valve  face	248
247'        Raphe not at extreme edge of valvo face	250

248 (247)    Raphe of each valve adjacent to the same girdle surface	Hantzschia amphioxya
248'        Raphe of each valve adjacent to different girdle surfaces  (Nitzschia)	249

249 (248M   Cell 20-65y  long	Nitzschia palea
249'        Cell 70-180u long	Nitzschia linearis

250 (247')    Cell longitudinally unsymmetrical in valve view	251
250'        Cell longitudinally unsymmetrical in girdle view	Achnanthes microcephala

251 (250)    Raphe bent toward one side at the  middle	Amphora ovalis
251'         Raphe a smooth curve throughout  (Cymbella)	252

252 (2511)    Cell only slightly unsymmetrical	Cymbella cesati
    (246)
252'        Cell distinctly unsymmetrical	  253

253 (252')   Striations distinctly cross  lined;  width 10-30(»	Cymbella prostrata
253'        Striations indistinctly cross lined;  width 5-12|i	Cymbella ventricosa

254 (244')   Longitudinal line (raphe) and prominent marginal markings near both edges of valve	255
254'        No marginal longitudinal line (raphe) nor keel; raphe or pseudoraphe median	257

255 (254)    Margin of girdle face wavy	Cymatopleura solea
255'        Margin of girdle face straight  (Surirella)	  256

256 (255')   Cell width 8-23u	Surirella ovata
25i'.'        Cell width 40-60(1	:	Surirella splendida

257 (254)    Gridle face generally in view and with two or more prominent longitudinal lines.  In valve
            view,  swollen centra' oval portion bounded by a line. . (Tabellaria)	  258
257'        Girdle face with less than two prominent longitudinal lines.  In valve view, whole central
            portion not bounded by a line	259

258 (257)    Girdle face less than 1/4 as wide as long	Tabellaria fenestrata
258'        Girdle face more than 1/2  as wide as long	Tabellaria flocculosa

259 (257')   Valve face with both coarse and fine transverse  lines	 . Diatoma vulgare
259'        Valve face with transverse lines,  if visible, alike in thickness	260

2C.O (259')   Valve face naviculoid; true raphe  present	261
2f>0'        Valve face linear to linear-lanceolate; true raphe absent	270

261 (260)    Valve face with wide transverse lines  (costae)   (Plnnulariaj	262
261'        Valve face with thin transverse  lines (striae)	263

262 (261)    Cell 5-6(j broad	Pinnularia subcapitata
2d2'        Cell 34-50fi  broad	Pinnularia  nobilis

J''..} (26D   Transverse  lines (striae) absent across transverse axis  of valve face	
            	Stauroneis phoenicenteron
263'        Transverse  lines (striae) present across transverse axis of valve face.	264

264 (263')   Raphe strictly median (Navicula)	265
264'        Raphe located slightly to one side	252

265 (264)    Ends of valve face abruptly narrowed  to a beak	Navicula exigua var.  capitata
265'        Ends of valve face gradually narrowed	266

266 (265')   Most of Striations strictly transverse	Navicula   gracilis
266'        Most of Striations radial  (oblique)	267


    46-12

-------
267 (266')   Striae distinctly composed of dots (punctae)	Navicula lancrolata
267'        Striae essentially as continuous lines	2t>8

268 (267')   Central clear area on valve face rectangular	Navirula graciloides
268'        Central clear area on valve face oval	 2n9

269 (2681)   Cell length 29-40p; ends slightly capitate	Navicula cryptocephala
269'        Cell length 30-120(i; ends not capitate	Navicula radiosa

270 (2601)   Knob at one end larger than at the other  (Asterionella)	189
270'        Terminal knobs if present equal in size  (Synedra)	  271

371 (2701)   Clear space  (pseudonodule) in central area	Synedra pulchella
271'        No pseudonodule in central area	272

272 (271')   Sides parallel in valve view;  each  end with an enlarged nodule	Synedra capitata
272'        Sides converging to the ends in valve view	273

273 (2721)   Valve linear to lanceolate-linear;  8-12 striae per 10)j	Synedra ulna
273'        Valve narrowly linear-lanceolate;  12-18  striae per 10^	274

274
274'

275 (2741)   Cells up to 65 times as long  as wide;  central area absent to small oval	
            	Svneara  acus  var.  radians
275'        Cells 90-120 times as long as wide; central area rectangular
                                                                     .Synedra acus var. augustissima
276 (232')   Green to brown pigment in one or more plastids	277
276'        No plastids;  blue and green pigments throughout protoplast	284

277 (276)   Cells long and narrow or flat	 233
277'        Cells rounded	278

278 (277')   Straight, flat wall between adjacent cells in colonies	Phytoconis botryoides
278'        Rounded wall between adjacent cells in colonies	279

279 (278')   Cell either with 2 opposite wall knobs or colony of 2-4 cells  surrounded by distinct mem-
            brane or both	164
279'        Cell without 2 wall knobs;  colony not  of 2-4 cells surrounded by distince membrane	280

280 (279')   Cells essentially similar in size within the colony	281
280'        Cells of very different sizes within the colony	Chlorococcum humicola

281 (159')   Cells embedded  in an extensive gelatinous matrix	Palmella mucosa
281'         Cells with little or no gelatinous matrix around them (Chlorella)	282

282 (281')   Cells rounded	283
282'        Cells ellipsoidal  to ovoid	Chlorella ellipsoidea


283 (282)   Cell 5-10|» in diameter; pyrenoid indistinct	Chlorella vulgaris
283'        Cell 3-5u  in diameter; pyrenoid distinct	Chlorella  pyrpnoidosa

284 (276')   Cell a spiral  rod	285
284'        Cell not a spiral  rod. . .	 286
285 (25)     Thread septate (with crosswalls)	Arthrospi
                                                                                          lira jenneri
285'        Thread non-septate (without crosswalls)	Spirulina nordstcdtii

286 (172)    Cells dividing in a plane at right angles to the  long axis	Coccochloris  stagnipa
    (284')
286' (172')   Cells sperical or dividing in a plane parallel to the long axis  (Anacystis)	287

287 (286')  . Cell containing pseudovacuoles	Anacystis cyanea
287'        Cell not containing pseudovacuoles	288
                                                                                        46-13

-------
288 (2871)  Cell 2-6B in diameter; sheath often colored	Anacyetis montana
288'      Cell 6-50|» in diameter; sheath colorless	289

289 (288')  Cell 6-12n in diameter; cells in colonies are mostly spherical	Anacystis thermalis
289'      Cell 12-SO|i in diameter;  cells in colonies are often angular.	Anacystis dimidiata
This outline was prepared by C.M. Palmer, former Aquatic Biologist,
Biological Treatment Research Activities,  Cincinnati Water Research
Laboratory,  FWPCA.

Descriptors:  Algae, Identification Keys
46-14

-------
             A KEY FOR  THE INITIAL SEPARATION OF SOME  COMMON
                                PLANKTON  ORGANISMS
1.  No chlorophyll present,  unless through ingestion	.8
1.  At least some chlorophyll present	2

    2.  Pigments not in plastids	;	Cyanophyta
    2.  Pigments in one or  more  plastids	3

3.  Cell wall of over-lapping halves and distinctly sculptured   ......  Bacillariophyta
3.  Cell wall not of over-lapping halves,  or if so,  then not sculptured	4

    4.  Pyrenoids present; color usually bright green	Chlorophyta
    4.  Pyrenoids absent;  color green, yellow-green  or yellow-brown	5

5.  Bright green, motile,  usually  with one anterior flagellum	Euglenophyta
5.  Yellowish to brownish,  motile or not	6

    6.  With a distinct lateral  groove,  motile	. Pyrrophyta
    6.  Without  a lateral groove	7

7.  Seldom motile;  unicellular,  colonial or filamentous	Xanthophyta
7.  Motile, unicellular or  colonial	Chrysophyta

    8.  Unicellular; naked or enclosed in a smooth or  sculptured  shell	   9
    8.  Multicellular; body usually with a  distinct exoskeleton	11

9.  Amoeboid; sometimes  with  shell, no cilia  or  flagella	Ameoboid  Protozoa
9.  Actively motile; never with shell;  cilia or flagella obvious  . .	10

    10.  Body more or less covered by short cilia;
         movement "darting"	  Ciliate  Protozoa
    10.  Body with one or more flexible whip-like falgella;
          movement  "continous"	Flagellate Protozoa

11.  Shell bivalved  (clam-like)	12
11.  Shell not composed of two halves	   13

    12.  With distinct head anterior to valves	Cladocera
    12.  No head anterior to valves	Ostracoda

13.  Usually microscopic;  body extended into  a tail or  foot with one
     or more toes	Rotifera
13.  Usually macroscopic  if mature	14

    14.  Appendages bilateral;  head  not prominent	Copepoda
    14.  Appendages unilateral; head prominent	Phyllopoda
 BI.AQ. 33. 6. 76                                                                      47-1

-------
                                      CHLOROPHYTA

                   A Key to Some of the Common Filamentous Genera
1.  Filaments unbranched	2
1.  Filaments branched (sometimes parenchymatous)	12

    2.  Chloroplast single, parietal band .  .  .  .	3
    2.  Chloroplast one or more,  if parietal  not  a  band	   5

3.  Chloroplast encircling  more  than half the  cell (Napkin-ring like)	Ulothrix
3.  Chloroplast encircling  less than half the cell	  4

    4.  Filaments of  indefinite length; cells with  square ends  .	Hormidium
    4.  Filaments usually  short,  of 3-8 cells, with ends  round	Stichococcus

5.  Cell wall of H pieces; pyrenoids lacking	Microspora
5.  Cell wall not of H pieces	6

    6.  Some  cells with apical caps	Oedogonium
    6.  Cells  without apical caps	7

7.  Chloroplast (s)  parietal	8
7.  Chloroplast (s)  axial	   9

    8.  Chloroplast one or more,  spiral bands	Spirogyra
    8.  Chloroplast several, longitudinal bands	 Sirogonium

9.  Cell walls without a median  constriction		.10
9.  Cell walls with a median constriction	11

    10.  Chloroplast  stellate	Zygnema
    10.  Chloroplast  an axial band	Mougeotia

11.  Filaments cylindrical	Hyalotheca
11.  Filaments triangular,  twisted	Desmidium

    12.  Coenocytic dichotomously branched,  with constrictions	 Dichotomosiphon
    12.  Filaments with regular  cross walls	13

13.  Parenchymatous,  discoid, epiphytic .	Coleochaete
13.  Not parenchymatous	14

    14.  Main axis cells much broader than branch cells	Draparnaldia
    14.  Main axis and branch cells approximately  the  same breadth	16

15.  Main  axis and lateral branches  attenuated into  long multicellualr hairs	16
15.  Axis  and branches not attenuated  into long multicellular hairs	  17

    16.  Sparsely or  loosely branched	Stigeoclonium
    16.  Densely and compactly  branched	  . Chaetophora
  47-2

-------
17.  Cells bearing swollen or bulbous-based setae	   18
17.  Cells without setae	19

    18.   Swollen-based setae on dorsal surface of  cells; prostrate
         epiphytes; little or  not al all branched	Aphanochaete
    18.   Bulbous-based setae terminal on branches; not
          prostrate epiphytes	Bulbochaete

19.  With terminal and/or intercalary akinites	Pithophora
19.  Without distinctive akinites	20

    20.   Cells of erect filaments becoming shorter and broader toward
          filament apex; usually growing on back of turtles; branching only
          from base	Basicladia
    20.   Thallus not as above	21

21.  Filaments irregularly branched; branches  short  1  -  or few celled .  .  . Rhizoclonium
21.  Filaments repeatedly branched; branches narrowed toward tips	Cladophora
                                                                                     47-3

-------
                                      CHLOROPHYTA

                  A Key to Some Common Non-Filamentous  Genera
1.  Unicellular	    2
1.  Colonial	27

    2.  Motile in  vegetative state,  flagella 2-4	3
    2.  Non-motile in vegetative state	5

3.  Cells with  2 flagella	   4
3.  Cells with  4 flagella	Carteria

    4.  Cell enclosed by bicovex shell	Phacotus
    4.  Cell not enclosed by a shell	Chlamydomonas

5.  Cells with  median constriction  (often slight), or of chloroplast only	6
5.  Cells without a median constriction	. .  .  .  .	15

    6.  Cells  lunate	Closterium
    6.  Cells  not  lunate  in any  degree	7

7.  Cells cylindrical,  noticeably longer than broad	8
7.  Cells almost never cylindrical; flattened or  triangular in apical view	9

    8.  Length 2-3 times the  breadth,  contriction nearly lacking	Cylindrocystis
    8.  Length much greater than breadth, nodulose at constriction ....  . Pleurotaenium

9.  Cells triangular in end view	 . Staurastrum
9.  Cells not triangular in end view	10

    10.   Semicells with lateral  incisions,  appearing lobed	11
    10.   Semicells without lateral incisions	12

11.   Lateral incisions few, shallow,  lobes rounded	Euastrum
11.   Lateral incisions many,  deep,  lobes  angular	Micrasterias

    12.   Semicells with radiating arms	Staurastrum
    12.   Semicells without arms; spines,  granules,  or teeth may be present	13

13.   Semicells without  spines	Cosmarium
13.   Semicells with  spines	  14

    14.   Spines few,  usually at  the  apical  corners	Arthrodesmus
    14.   Spines numerous, scattered	Xanthidium

15.   Cells elongate,  sometimes  needle-like	16
15.   Cells spherical, ovid, angular; not needle-like	18

    16.   Cells with terminal setae	 Schroederia
    16.   Cells without terminal  setae	    17
   47-4

-------
17.  Cells acicular,  without a row  of pyrenoids	Ankistrode smus
17.  Cells acicular,  very long, with a  row of 10-12 pyrenoids	Closteropsis

    18.   Cells without spines or processes	   19
    18.   Cells with spines  or  processes	23

19.  Cells embedded in a gelatinous matrix	20
19.  Cells without a gelatinous matrix	21

    20.   Gelatin obvious, lamellate; chloroplast  cup-shaped	Gloeocystis
    20.   Gelatin sometimes obvious, chloroplast, star-like	.Asterococcus

21.  Cells spherical	22
21.  Cells angular	Tetraedron

    22.   Cell wall smooth	Chlorella
    22.   Cell wall sculptured	Trochiscia

23.  Cells angular	24
23.  Cells spherical or oval, with spines	23

    24.   Angles with furcated processes	Tetraedron
    24.   Angles with spines	Polyedriopsis

25.  Cells spherical, spines delicate	Golenkinia
25.  Cells oval, spines evident	26

    26.   Spines localized at ends of cell	Lagerheimii
    26.   Spines distributed  over cell	Franceia

27.  Motile, each  cell with 2 equal-length  flagella	28
27.  Non-motile invegetative state	33

    28.   Colony a "flat" plate	29
    28.   Colony spherical  or ovid	30

29.  Colony "horse-shoe" shaped	Platydorina
29. . Colony quadriangular  or circular	Gonium

    30.   Cells  8-16,  crowded-pyriform	Pandorina
    30.   Cells  more than 16, not crowded,  spherical or nearly so	31

31.  Cells more than 300 in number	Volvox
31.  Cells less than 300 in number	32

    32.   Cells  (16) - 32 in number	Eudorina
    32.   Cells  64-128 -  (256) in number	 .   Pleodorina

33.  Cells of colony lying  in one  plane	34
33.  Cells not in a conspicuous single plane	.37

    34.   Colony circular (rarely cruciate)	Pediastrum
    34.   Colony not  circular	~'.'.  [ 735
                                                                                     47-5

-------
35.  Colony a flat strip;  cells side by side	.  .  Scenedesmus
35.  Colony quadriangular	36

    36.   Colony usually large,  cells  in  4's, no spines	Crucigenia
    36.   Colony of 4 cells,  each with 1 or  2  marginal spines	Tetrastrum

37.  Cells acicular (needle-like)	Ankistrodesmus
37.  Cells not acicular	38

    38.   Colony without a gelatinous  envelope	39
    38.   Colony with a more or  less conspicuous gelatinous envelope	47

39.  2-8  oval enclosed by a distinct sheath	Oocystis
39.  Cells not enclosed by a sheath	40

    40.   Cells  with  long  spines  or setae	41
    40.   Cells  without  spines or setae	42

41.  Colony pyramidate,  cell spherical,  long spines	Errerella
41.  Colony quadrate,  or a tetrahedron, long  setae	Micractinium

    42.   Cells  linear,  radiating from a  common center	Actinastrum
    42.   Cells  no linear	43

43.  Cells strongly lunate,  often "back-to-back"	Selena strum
43.  Cells not lunate	44

    44.   Cells  arranged in a hallow sphere	45
    44.   Cells  not arranged in  a hallow sphere	46

45.  Cells spherical, sometimes joined  by processes	   Coelastrum
45.  Cells not spherical,  outer angles extended into stout,  blunt
     teeth or spines	Sorastrum

    46.   Cells  uniform, spherical, in groups  of  4 - 8	We Stella
    46.   Cells  not uniform,  ellipsoid (oblong)  or reniform  ....... Dimorphococcus

47.  Cells curved to strongly lunate .	48
47.  Ceils not curved or  lunate	49

    48.   Cells  lunate,  loosely arranged  in colony	Kirchneriella
    48.   Cells  curved or reniform,  colony compact,  distinct	Nephrocytium

49.  Cells connected by branching central strands	Dictyosphaerium
49.  Cells not connected by  stands	50

    50.   Cells  cylindrical or fusiform	51
    50.   Cells  spherical  or  slightly ovoid	.	52

51.  Cells in parallel "bundles" of 2  -  8	Quadrigula
51.  Cells longitudinally arranged,  not grouped laterally	Elakatothrix

-------
    52.   Cells  ellipsoid or ovoid,  envelope lamellated	Gloeocystis
    52.   Cells  spherical,  or nearly so	53

53.  Chloroplast axial,  star-shaped	Asterococcus
53.  Chloroplast parietal,  not star-shaped	54

    54.   Cells  enclosed by lamellated sheaths	Gloeocystis
    54.   Cells  in homogenous envelopes	Sphaerocystis
                                                                                      47-7

-------
                                    EUGLENOPHYTA
1.  Vegetative cells sessile	 Colacium
1.  Vegetative cells motile	2
    2.   Cells with  chlorophyll	3
    2.   Cells without chlorophyll	8
3.  Protoplast within a lorica or test	Trachelomonas
3.  Protoplast naked, no lorica	4
    4.   Body strongly metabolic	Euglena
    4.   Body rigid	5
5.  With two laminate,  longitudinal chloroplasts	Chryptoglena
5.  With numerous  chloroplasts	6
    6.   Body conspicuously flattened, sometimes twisted	Phacus
    6.   Body not compressed, radially  symmetrical	6
7.  Body broadly ellipsoid to ovoid	Lepocinclis
7.  Body elongate,  narrow	Euglena
    8.   Cells with  one  flagellum	Astasia
    8.   Cells with  two  flagella	Peranema
 47-8

-------
        KEY TO SOME COMMON  DIATOM GENERA (BACILLARIOPHYTA)  OF
                                        MICHIGAN
Diatoms in  Valve View

1.  Valves  without a  dividing line  or cleft; markings of  valve  radiate about a  central
    point,   (centric diatom genera)	  .  2

    2.   Frustules usually  in filaments or  zig-zag  chains; rectangular in girdle
         view; valve round, oblong, triangular or elongate	   3

         3.   Frustules cylindrical; markings prominent on  girdle; sulcus
             present;  seldom seen  in valve view	Melosira

         3.   Frustule  not cylindrical	4

             4.   Valve ovate to oblong; two horns  or processes present on  valve  face,
                 scatter  small spines often present	  Biddulphia

             4.   Valve not ovate to oblong, horns  or processes absent	5

                 5.  Valve face appearing as two; three  sided pieces giving the
                     appearance of six processes	Hydrosira

                 5.  Valve face three to several times  longer than broads; margins
                     undulate:   "costae" evident	Terpsinoe

    2.   Frustules usually  solitary (sometimes forming short  chains)	6

         6.   Frustules usually  elongated; many  intercalary bands, frustules
             cylindrical	7

             7.   Each valve with a single  long  spine	 Rhizosolenia

             7.   Each valve with two long spines	Attheya

         6.   Valves discoid; cylindrical;  or spherical; somtimes with spines or
             processes	8

             8.   Ornamentation of  valves in two concentric  parts  of  unlike
                 pattern	Cyclotella

             8.   Ornamentation of  valves radiate;  continuous from center  to
                 margin  of valves	l;	9

                 9.  Ornamentation of valves distinctly  radiate; rows of punctae
                     single at  center becoming multiseriate at the margin;  margin
                     of valve  with recurved spines	Stephanodiscus

                 9.  Ornamentation of valves not distinctly  radiate or becoming
                     multiseriate  at margin	10
                                                                                      47-9

-------
             10.   Isolated large punctum evident at the  margin  spines
                  not evident	 Thalassiosira

             10.   Isolated punctum not evident at the  margin, short
                  spines present	Cascinodiscus

1.   Valve with a  dividing line or  cleft; marking of wall bilaterally
    disposed to an axial or excentric line  (pennate diatom genera)	11

    11.  Both valves with  a pseudoraphe	12

         12.  Valves asymetrical to one axis	13

               13.   Valve asmetrical to longitudinal axis,  striae present  .  .  Ceratoneis

               13.   Valve asymetrical  to transverse axis	14

                    14.  Valves clavate	15

                    14.  Valves not  clavate; striae present;  valves with unequal
                         capitate  ends; often  forming star like  colonies .  . Asterionella

                         15.   "Costae" present, frustules may  be joined  face
                               to face to form fan like  filaments	Meridion

                         15.   "Costae: present, frustules  single (appears
                               as  asymetrical Fragilaria)	Opephora

         12.  Valves symetrical to both axes	16

               16.   Frustules  septate or "costate"; often appearing in
                    zig-zag chains	  17

                    17.  Septae present; usually many partially septate
                         intercalary bands; valves triundulate	Tabellaria

                    17.  Septae absent; prominant "costae" on valve  . .   .  Diatoma

              16.   Frustules occuring free or  attached in filaments;
                    sometimes forming fascicles	18

                    18.   Frustules typically forming long  filaments; usually
                         not more than 5  or 6 times  longer  than broads;
                         often appearing costate	  Fragilaria

                    18.   Frustules usually  solitary  or forming fascicles;
                         usually many  times longer than broad	Synedra
                         (note: the above two  genera are actually seperated
                         only on the  basis  of  growth habit)

    11.  At least one valve with a pseudoraphe	19
 47-10

-------
19.  One valve with a true raphe the other valve with a pseudoraphe	20

     20.   Valve asymetrical to the transverse axis; partial terminal septae;
           bent about  the transverse  axis	Rhoicosphenia

     20.   Valves symetrical to both axes	21

           21.   Valve elliptical; valves with a  marginal and/or  submarginal
                hyaline  ring; often loculiferous; bent about the longitudinal
                axis	.	Cocconeis

           21.   Valves usually lanceolate  or  linera  lanceolate; bent
                around the transverse axis	Achnanthes
                (Those  with a  sigmoid raphe are sometimes put in
                Achnanthidium  or  Eucocconeis)

19.  Both valves  with a raphe	22

     22.   Raphe median or nearly so, never completely marginal;
           not  in a  canal	23

           23.   Valves sigmoid in outline	24

                24.   Raphe sigmoid; punctae in two series; one transverse
                     and one longitudinal  row forming a 90° angle .... Gyrosigma

                24.   Raphe sigmoid; punctae in three series forming
                     angles of other than 90°	Pleurosigma

           23.   Valve not sigmoid in outline	25

                25.   Valves symetrical to both  axes	26

                     26.   Frustules  with  septate intercalary bands	27

                     27.   Intercalary bands with marginal loculi, punctae
                           distinct	Mastagloia

                     27.   Intercalary bands with two  large faramen  along
                           apical axis,  punctae indistinct	Diatomella

                     26.   Frustules  without septate intercalary bands	28

                           28.   Valve face with a sigmoid  saggital keel;
                                "hourglass" shape outline, in girdle view .  .  . Amphiprora

                           28.  Valve face without a sigmoid saggital keel	29

29.  Valve with undulate or zig-zag  irregular logitudinal lines or
     blank  spaces	 Anomoeneis

29.  Valve without  undulate or zig-zag irregular logitudinal lines or
     blank  spaces	30
                                                                                     47-11

-------
 30.   Valve with thickened,  non-punctate central area; (stauros)
    .   pseudoseptae sometimes present,  longitudinal lines and blank               .
       spaces lacking	 Stauroneis

 30.   Valve with or without stauros, septal absent	31

       31.   Valve with longitudinal lines or blank spaces	32

            32.  Proximal ends  of raphe usually  curved in  opposite
                 directions; "defaut regularier" toward valve  apices;
                 longitudinal blank spaces	Neidium

            32.  Proximal ends  of raphe straight; valves with fine
                 striae that  appear as costae; longitudinal line
                 near margin	Caloneis

       31.   Valves without longitudinal lines or blank spaces	33

            33.  Valves  with  siliceous ribs along each side of the raphe	    34

                 34.  Raphe bisects siliceous  ribs  on valve;  central
                      area  small and orbicular; striae and punctae
                      very  distinct	Diploneis

                 34.   Raphe short;  less  than  1/2  length of valve; central
                      area  long  and narrow; terminal  nodules evident,
                      elongate	35

                      35.   Raphe short; 1/4 or less the length of the valve;
                            striae not evident	 Amphipleura

                      35.   Raphe longer; usually  about 1/3 the length of
                            the valve; striae usually fine but evident . . . Frustulia

            33.  Valve without siliceous ribs	36

                 36.  Valves with smooth transverse costae;  raphe
                      often ribbon like;	Pinnularia
                 36.   Valves with transverse striae .	37

                       37.   Raphe  sigmoid	Scoliopleura

                       37.   Raphe  straight	38

 38.   Raphe in straight  and raised keel	 .  Tropodoneis

 38.   Raphe straight and not in a keel	39

       39.   Striae  daubly punctate,  central area  long and narrow  .  .  . Brebessonia

       39.   Striae  single to lineate,  central area variable  ....  Navicula
47-12

-------
25.  Valves symetical to one axis only	„	40

     40.   Valves symetrical to the longitudinal axis	41

           41.   Punctae  in one series; longitudinal line  absent	Gomphonema

           41.   Punctae  in two series; longitudinal line  present	Gpmphoneis

     40.   Valves symetrical to transverse axis	42

           42.   Raphe  short; vestigial  terminal;  with evident terminal nodules,
                central nodule  lacking	,  . 43

                43.   Colonial;  forming tree like  colonies; valves usually with
                     evident spines	Desmogonium

                43.   Usually not in colonies  or if  colonial,  forming only
                     short chains or stellate  clumps	44

                     44.   Cells  shaped like the  femur of a chicken .  . .  . Actinella

                     44.   Valves various shaped; lunate to  nearly  straight;
                           valve  often  with undulate dorsal and/or  ventral
                           margin; raphe  prominant in girdle  view	45

                           45.   Dorsal margin convex, ventral margin slightly
                                concave, both margins sinvate-dentate  .  .  . Amphicampa

                           45.   Dorsal margin convex, ventral margin straight
                               to  concave,  one, both or neither margin wavy,
                               pseudoraphe often present on  ventral margin . .  . Eunotia

           42.   Raphe not vestigial; usually as nearly as long as the valve;
                valves usually  cymbiform	46

                46.   Valves  convex;  central nodule  usually lies very close to the
                     ventral margin; both raphe visible in girdle view .... Amphora

                46.   Valves  flat  or nearly so; raphe a smooth curve with the same
                     curvature as  the  axial field; raphe not visible in girdle
                     view	Cymbella

22.  Raphe marginal and in  a  canal	47

     47.   Valves with a single canal that is usually marginal but may appear
           to be  somewhat central	48

           48.   Valves symetrical  to both axes	49

                49.   Transverse internal  septae  that appear as "costae";  canal
                     nearly median	Denticula

                49.   Transverse "costae" lacking;  carnial dots present  .  .  .  Nitzschia
                                                                                    47-13

-------
       48.  Valves  asymetrical to longitudinal axis	50

            50.   "Costae" quite  evident		.51

                  51.   Axial field forming an acute angle at the central nodule;
                       raphe along the ventral margin  of valve	Ephithernia

                  51.   Axial field forming a  less  acute angle at the central
                       nodule; raphe along the  dorsal margin of the valve .  .  Rhopalodia

            50.   "Costae" not evident; carnial dots along the  raphe	52

                  52.   Raphe  of one valve diagonally opposite  the  raphe on
                       the  other  valve	Nitzschia
                  52.   Raphe of one valve  directly opposite  the  raphe on the
                       other  valve	Hantzschia
   47.   Valves with a canal next to both lateral margins	53

        53.  Valve face transversely undulate; band of short costae along each
             lateral margin appearing  like a row  of beads	.Cymatopleura

        53.  Valve face not transversely undulate	54

             54.  Valve  shaped like a  saddle	Campylodiscus

             54.  Valve  face  flat;  either isopolar or heteropolar; sometimes
                  the frustule is slightly spiral in shape	Surirella
47-14

-------
                                        CHRYSOPHYTA
                       A Key to Some More or Less  Common Genera
1.  Filamentous,  branched	Phaeothamnion
1.  Not filamentous	   2
    2.  Unicellular	   3
    2.  Colonial	7
3.  Protoplast enclosed by a lorica	4
3.  Protoplast not enclosed  by a lorica	6
    4.  Epiphytic or  epizooic	5
    4.  Motile; cells with siliceous  scales  many of -which have long,
        siliceous spines	Mallomonas
5.  Epiphytic; lorica  flask-shaped	Lagynion
5.  Epiphytic or  epizooic; lorica cylindrical	.Epipyxis(= Hyalobryon)
    6.  Motile; protoplast naked	Ochromonas (and assoc.)
    6.  Non-motile; protoplast with  long delicate, pseudopodia	Rhizochrysis
7.  Sessile; each cell in  a long,  cylindrical lorica	       Epipyxis  (Hyalobryon)
7.  Motile	8
    8.  Each cell within  a companulate,  basally  pointed lorica	Dinobryon
    8.  Lorica absent	9
9.  Colony bracelet-shaped	Cyclonexis
9.  Colony spherical	10
   10.  Colony bristling with long siliceous rods	Chrysosphaerella
   10.  Colony without siliceous  rods from each cell	11
11.  Colonies not enclosed by a gelatinous  sheath .	  Synura
11.  Colonies enclosed by a distinct  gelatinous sheath	12
   12.  Shorter flagellum  more than 1/2 length  of  longer  flagellum	Uroglenopsis
   12.  Shorter flagellum  less than  1/2  length of longer flagellum	Uroglena
                                                                                       47-15

-------
                                       CYANOPHYTA
                       A Key to Some of the Common Genera
 1.  Cells not in trichomes; unicellular or colonial .  ,	2
 1.  Cells in trichomes	10

     2.  Colony with some  regular  arrangement  of cells	3
     2.  Colony amorphous, no definite form ...    	6

 3.  Colony  a flat plate	4
 3.  Colony  spherical, cells peripheral	   5

     4.  Cells regularly arranged .	Merismopedia
     4.  Cells irregularly arranged	.Holopedium

 5.  Colony  with  a central branching system	Gomphosphaeria
 5.  Colony  without a central branching system	 Coelosphaerium

     6.  Colony many celled	.7
     6.  Colony mostly few celled	9

 7.  Cells elongate	Aphanothece
 7.  Cells spherical	8

     8.  Cells close together	Microcystis
     8.  Cells more than 2-3 diameters apart  .	Aphanocapsa

 9.  Cells usually hemispherical,  with or without definite gelatinous sheaths .  . Chroococcus
 9.  Cells spherical or  ovaod,  gelatinous sheaths very distinct	  .  .  Gloeocapsa

     10.  Trichomes  without sheath (not filamentous) .  .  .  .	11
     10.  Trichomes  in  a sheath (filamentous)	20

11.  Heterocysts  absent	12
11.  Heterocysts  present	14

     12.  Trichomes  straight	Oscillatoria
     12.  Trichomes  regulary spiraled	13

13.  Cross walls  distinct	Arthrospira
13.  Cross walls  lacking	  .  Spirulina

     14.  Heterocysts terminal	 15
     14.  Heterocysts intercalary	  18

15.  Trichomes cylindrical	  Cylindrospremum
15.  Trichomes attenuate	.16

     16.  Trichomes  solitary	Calothrix
     16.  Trichomes  in masses	17
   47-16

-------
17.  TrichOmes without akinetes	Rivularia
17.  Trichomes with akinetes	Gloeotrichia

     18.   Trichomes  straight, parallel in bundles	Aphanizomenon
     18.   Trichomes  solitary, or if in masses,  not  parallel	19

19.  Trichomes solitary,  or if numerous,  then not in a firm gelatinous
     matrix	Anabaena
19.  Trichomes entangled in a firm  gelatinous matrix	Nostoc

     20.   Many parallel trichomes in a sheath	Microcoleus
     20.   A single  trichome or row of trichomes in a sheath	21

21.  Filaments not  branched	22
21.  Filaments branched	23

     22.   Sheath  obvious firm	  Lyngbya
     22.   Sheath  indistinct, delicate	Phormidium

23.  Filaments with false branching	24
23.  Filaments with true branching	26

     24.   Without heterocysts	Fleet one ma
     24.   With heterocysts	25

25.  False branches arising single	Tolypothrix
25.  False branches in pairs	Scytonema

     26.   Trichomes  always uniseriate	 Haplosiphon
     26.   Trichomes  wholly or  in  part nultiseriate		 Stigonema
                                                                                     47-17

-------
                                      XANTHOPHYCEAE

                             A Key to  Some  Common Genera
 1.   Filamentous	  .  .  .	2
 1.   Not filamentous	.  .  .  .	4

     2.  Filaments branched,  siphonaceaous	 Vaucheria
     2.  Filaments not branched	3

 3.   Cell wall of stout H pieces,  cells sometimes barrel-shaped	Tribonema
 3.   Cell wall of delicate H pieces,  cells  short and cylindrical	Bumilleria

     4.  Cells embedded in  a  gelatinous matrix	5
     4.  Cells not embedded in a gelatinous matrix	7

 5.   Colonial gelatinous envelope  dichotomously branched	Mischococcus
 5.   Colonial gelatinous envelope  not  branched	6

     6.  Colonial envelope,  tough  "heavy" cartilaginous	Botryococcus
     6.  Colonial envelope watery; colonies small, free floating	Chlorobotrys

 7.   CeUs epiphytic	8
 7.   Cells not epiphytic	11

     8.  Stipe long,  seta-like	Stipitococcus
     8.  Stipe short;  or cell-sessile		Peroniella

 9.   Cell vase-like,  apex flattened	  .Stipitococcus
 9.   Cell oval or spherical	Peroniella

     10.  Cells  cylindrical,  ends broadly rounded	 . Ophiocytium
     10.  Cells  not cylindrical	Characiopsis

11.   Cells cylindrical,  straight or contorted .	Ophiocytium
11.   Cells globose, with rhyzoids, on soil	Botrydium
   47-18

-------
Acicular:  needle-like  in  shape.   (Ankistrodesmus)

Aerial:  algal habitat on moist soil,  rocks, trees, etc.;  involving a thin film  of water;
         sometimes only somewhat aerial.

Akinete:  A type of spore formed by the transformation of a vegetative cell into  a thick-
          walled resting cell, containing a concentration of food material.  (Pithophora)

Amoeboid:  like  an amoeba;  creeping  by extensions  of highly plastic  protoplasm
            (pseudopodia).   (Chry samoeba)

Amorphous:  without definite shape; without regular form.

Anastomose:  to separate and come together again;  a meshwork.

Antapical:   the posterior  or  rear pole or region of  an organism,  or of a colony  of cells.

Anterior:  the  forward end; toward the top.

Antheridium:  a  single cell or a series of  cells  in which  male gametes are produced; a
              multicellular,  globular  male organ in the Characeae, more properly called
              a  globule (a complicated and specialized branch  in which antheridial cells
              are  produced.

Antherozoid:  male sex cell; sperm.

Apex:   the summit, the terminus,  end of a projection,  of an incision,  or of a filament
        of cells.

Apical:  Forward tip.

Aplanospore:  non-motile,  thick-walled spore  formed many within an unspecialized
              vegetative cell; a  small resting spore.

Arbuscular:  branched or growing like a tree or bush.

Armored:  See theca.

Attenuate:   narrowing to a point  or becoming  reduced in diameter.  (Gloeotrichia)

Autospores:  spore-like bodies cut out of the  contents of a cell which are small  replicas
             of the parent cell and which only enlarge to  become mature plants.   (Coelastrum)

Axial:   along a  median line bisecting  an  object either transversely or longitudinally
        (especially the later, e.g. an  axial chloroplast).

Bacilliform:  rod-shaped.

Bilobed:  with two lobes or extensions.
                                                                                    47-19

-------
Bipapillate:  with two small protrusions; nipples.

Biscuit-shaped:  a thickened pad; Pillow-shaped.

Bivalve (wall):   wall of cell which is in two sections,  one usually slightly larger
                 than the others.

Blepharoplast:  a granular body  in a swimming organism from which a flagellum arises.

Bristle:   a stiff hair; a nee die-like spine.   (MaUomonas)

Capitate:   with an enlargement or  a  head at one end.  (as in some species of Oscillatoria)

Carotene:  Orange-yellow plant  pigment of which there are four kinds  in algae; a
            hydrocarbon, C,  H.

Chlorophyll:   a green pigment of which there are five  kinds  in the algae chlorophyll-a
              occurring in  all of the algal  divisions.

Chloroplast:   a body of various shapes  within the cell  containing the pigments  of which
              chlorophyll is the predominating  one.

Chromatophore:  body within  a  cell contining  the pigments  of which some other tan
                 chlorophyll is  the predominating one;  may be red, yellow, yellow-green
                 or brown.

Chrysolaminarin:  See  leucosin.

Coenobium:  a colony with 2N number  of cells.  (Scenedesmus)

Coenocytic:  with multinucleate  cells, or cell-like units; a multinucleate,  non-cellular
             plant.   (Vaucheria)

Collar:  A thickened ring or neck  surrounding the opening in a shell or lorica through
         which a flagellum projects from the inclosed organism.   (Trachelomonas)

Colony:  a group or  closely  associated  cluster of cells,  adjoined or  merely inclosed by a
       .  a common investing mucilage or sheath; cells not arranged in a  linear  series to
         form a filament;  either aggregate or  coenobium.

Constricted:   cut in or  incised,   usually form two opposite points on  a  cell so  that an
              isthmus is formed between two parts  or  cell halves;  indented as.at the
              joints between cells  of a  filament.  (Cosmarium)

Contractile vacuole:  a  small vacuole (cavity) which is bounded by  a membrane that
                     pulsates,  expanding and contracting.

Crenulate:  wavy with small scallops; with small crenations.

Crescent:  an arc of a circle; a curved figure  tapering to horn-like points from a  wider,
           cylindrical midregion.

Cross wall:   a cross partition.
  47-20

-------
Cup-shaped:   a more or less complete plate (as a chloroplast) which lies just within
              the  cell wall, open  at one  side to form a cup.

Cylindrical:   a  figure, round in cross section,  elongate with parallel lateral margins
              when seen from the  side, the  ends square or  truncate.  (Hyalotheca)

Daughter  cells:  cells produced directly  from the division of a primary or parent cell;
                 cells produced from  the same  mother cell.

Dichotomous:   dividing or  branched by repeated forkings,  usually into two  equal portions
               or segments.

Disc; Disc-shaped:   a flat (usually circular) figure: a circular plate.

Distal:  the forwar  or anterior end or region as opposed  to the basal end.

Ellipsoid:  an ellipse,  a plane figure  with curved margins,  the poles more  sharply
           rounded than the lateral margins of an elongate figure.

Epiphyte:   living upon a plant, sometimes living internally also.

Euplankton;  true or openwater plankton  (floating) organisms.

Eye-spot:  a  granular or  complex of  granules (red or brown) sensitive to light  and
           related to responses to light  by  swimming organisms of spores.   (Pandorina)

False Branch:  a branch formed by lateral  growth of one or both ends of a broken
                filament; a branch not formed by  lateral division of  cells in an unbroken
                filament.   (Tolypothrix)

Filament:  a  thread  of cells;  one  or more rows of cells;  in the blue-green  algae the
           thread of cells together with  a sheath  that may be present, the thread of
           cells alone referred to as  a trichome.

Flagellum (flagella):   a relatively coarse, whip-like organ of locomotion,  arising from
                      a special granule,  the blepharoplast,  within a  cell.  (Euglena)

Fucoxanthin:  a brown pigment predominant  in the Phaeophyta and Chrysophyta. (Synura)

Fusiform: a  figure  broadest  in the midregion and gradually tapering to both  poles which
           may be acute  or  bluntly rounded; shaped  like a  spindle.   (Closterium)

Gamete:  a sex cell; cells which  unite to produce a fertilized egg or zygospore.

Gas  vacuole:   See pseudovacuole.

Gelatin  (gelatinous):  a mucilage-like  substance.

Glycogen:  a  starch-like  storage product  questionably  identified in food granules  of the
           Cyanopjyta.  (Chroococcus)

Gregarious:   an association;  groupings of individuals  not necessarily joined together but
             closely  associated.
                                                                                   47-21

-------
Gullet:   a canal leading from the  opening of flagellated cells into the reservoir in the
         anterior end.   (Euglena)

Gypsum:  granules  of calcium sulphate which occur in the vacuoles of  some
          desmids.   (Closterium)

Haematochrome:  a red or  orange pigment, especially in some  Chlorophyta and
                  Euglenophyta, which masks  the  green chlorophyll.

Heterocyst:  an enlarged cell in some of the  filamentous blue-green algae, usually
             empty  and different in shape from the vegetative cells,   (Anabeana)

Hold-fast cell:  a basal cell of a filament or  thallus, differentiated to  form an
                an  attaching organ.   (Oedogonium)

H-pieces:  wall of overlapping H-shaped structures.   (Tribonema)

Intercalary:  arranged in the same  series, as spores or heterocysts which occur in
             series with the vegetative  cells  rather than being terminal or lateral.
             (heterocyst of Anabeana)

Laminate: plate-like; layered.

Lateral groove:  a  groove  in Dinoflagellates encircling the cell.  (Ceratium)

Leucosin:  a whitish food reserve characteristic of many of the Chrysophytam especially
           the Heterokontae; gives a  metallic lustre  to cell contents.   (Dinobryon)

Lorica:  a shell-like structure of varying shapes which houses an organism,  has an
         opening through which organs of locomotion are extended.    (Dinobryon)

Lunate:   crescent-shaped; as of the new  moon in  shape.   (Selenastrum)

Median construction:  See constricted.

Metabolic:  plastic,  changing shape  in motion as in many Euglena.

Micron:   a unit of microscopical measurement; one 1/1000 of a millimeter,  determined
          by  using a micrometer in the eyepiece of the microscope which  has been
          calibrated with a standard stage micrometer; expressed the symbol.

Moniliform:  arranged like  a string of beads; beadlike; lemon-shaped.  (Anabeana)

Mother Cell:  the cell which by mitosis  or by internal cleavage gives rise to
              other cells  (usually spores).

Multinucleate:  with many nuclei.

Multiseriate:  cells  arranged in more than one  row;  a filament two or  more  cells in
              diameter.   (Stigeonema)

Motile:  motion caused by  cilia or flagella.  (Volvox)

Oblong:  a curved figure,  elongate with the ends broadly rounded but more sharply  curved
         than the lateral margins.


 47-22

-------
Obovate:  an  ovate figure, broader  at the anterior end than at the  posterior.

Oogonium:  a female  sex organ,  usually an enlarged cell; an  egg case.

Oval:  an elongate,  curved figure with convex margins and with ends broadly  and
       symmetrically curved but more sharply so than the lateral  margin.

Ovoid:  shaped  like an egg; a  curved figure  broader at one end than at the other.

Paramylum:  a solid,  starch-like storage product in the Euglenophyta.  (Euglena)

Parietal:  along the wall; arranged  at the circumference;  marginal as opposed to
          central or  azial in location.

Pellicle:  a thin membrane.   (Euglena)                             .  •

Peridinin:   a  brown pigment characteristic  of the Dinoflagellata.   (Ceratium)

Periplast:   bounding membrane  of cells in Euglenoids and Chrysophytes.

Phycocyanin:  a blue  pigment found  in the Cyanophyta, and in some Rhodophyta.

Phycoerythrin:  a red pigment found in  the  Rhodophta, and in some Cyanophyta.

Plankton:  organisms srifting in  the water,  or if swimming,  not able  to move
           against  currents.

Plastid:   a  body or organelle of  the cell, either containing pigments or in some
          instances colorless.

Plate;  sections, polygonal in shape,  composing  the cell wall  of  some Dinoflagellata
        (the thecate or armored  dinoflagellates).

Posterior:  toward the rear; the end opposite the forward (anterior) end of a  cell
            or of an organism.

Protoplast:  the living part  of the cell;  the  cell membrane and its  contents usually
            enclosed by a cell wall of dead material.

Pseudocilia:  meaning false cilia; flagella-like structures not used  for locomotion  as
              in Apiocystis and Tetraspora.

Pseudoparenchymatious:  a false cushion; a  pillow like mound of cells (usually attached)
                         which actually is a compact  series of short, often branched
                         filaments.   (Coleochaete)

Pseudovacuole:   meaning a false  vacuole; a  pocket in  the cytoplasm of many blue-green
                 algae which  contains  gas or mucilage; is  light refractive.  (Microcystis)

Pyrenoid:   a  protein body around which starch or paramylum  collects in a cell, usually
            buried in a chloroplast but sometimes free within the cytoplasm.   (Oedogonium)

Pyiform:  pear-shaped. • (Pandorina)
                                                                                     47-23

-------
Reniform:   kidney-shaped; bean-shaped.   (Dimorphocacus)

Replicate:   infolded; folded back as in the cross walls of some species of Spirogyra; not
            a plane or straight  wall.

Reticulate:  netted,  arranged to form a  network; with openings.

Scale:  siliceous or inorganic material covering the cell.   (Mallomonas)

Semicell:  a cell-half, .as  in the Placoderm desmids  in which the  cell has two parts
           that  are mirror images  of one  another,  the two parts often  connected by a
           narrow  isthmus.  (Staurastrum)

Septum:  a cross-partition, cross wall or  a membrane complete or incomplete through
         the  short diameter of a cell, sometimes parallel  with the long axis.

Setae:  a hair,  usually arising  from within a cell wall; or  a  hair-like extension
        formed  by  tapering of a filament of cells to a fine  point.

Sheath:  a covering, usually of mucilage,  soft or firm; the covering of a colony
         of cells,  or an envelope about one or more  filaments  of cells.

Siphonous:   a tube; a thallus without cross partitions.  (Vaucheria)

Solitary:  unicellular;  solitary.   (Chlamydomonas)

Spine:  a sharply-pointed projection from the cell wall.   (Mallomonas)

Sproangium:  a cell (sometimes an  unspecialized vegetative cell) which  gives rise to
              spores; the case which  forms about the zygospores in the Zygne mat ales.

Star-shaped:  See  stellate

Stellate:   with radiating  projections  from a common center; star-like.   (Zygnema)

Stigma:  see  eyespot.

Suture:  a  groove  between plates, as  in  some Dinoflagellata;  a cleft-like crack or line
         in some zygospores of the  Zygnemataceae.   (Ceratium)

Thallus:   a plant body which is not  differentiated into root, stem and leal organs; a
          frond; the  algal plant.

Theca; Thecate: a firm outer wall; a shell, sometimes  with  plates as  in the
                 Dinoflagellata.   (Peridinium)

Test:  a shell or covering external  to the  cell itself.  See  Lorica.

Transverse furrow (groove):  a groove extending around  the cell as in the
                              Dinoflagellata. (Ceratium)

Trichrome:  in blue-greens, a  series of cells  joined  end to end.   (Oscillatoria)
 47-24

-------
True Branch:  a branch formed by means of lateral division of  cells in a main filament.
               Includes all branched algae except those blue- green  algae  with  false
               branching.

Tychoplankton;  the plankton of waters near  shore;  organisms floating and entangled
                among  weeds and  in algal mats,  not in the  open water of a lake
                or  stream.

Undulate:  regularly wavy.

Unicellular:   See  solitary.

Vegetative:  referring to  a non- reproductive stage,  activity,  or  cell as opposed to
             activities and stages involved in reproduction,  especially  sexual reproduction.
Xanthophyll:  a yellow pigment  of  several kinds  associated with  chlorphyll,

Zoospore:   an animal- like spore equipped with flagella  and usually with  an  eye- spot.
                                                 This key was prepared by Dr. Matthew H. Hohn,
                                                 Professor of Biology, Central Michigan
                                                 University,  Mt.  Pleasant,  Michigan.
                                                  Descriptors:  Plankton, Identification Keys
                                                                                     47-25

-------
                           CLASSIFICATION - FINDER
                                     for
                         NAMES OF AQUATIC ORGANISMS
                                     in               -
                     WATER SUPPLIES AND POLLUTED WATERS

                     Part I.   The System of Classification
I  INTRODUCTION

A  Every type of living creature
   has a favorite place to live.
   There are few major groups that
   are either exclusively terres-
   trial or aquatic.  The following
   remarks will therefore apply in
   large measure to both, but pri-
   mary attention will be directed
   to aquatic types.

B  One of the first questions usu-
   ally posed about an organism is:
   "What is it?", usually meaning
   "What is it's name?".  The nam-
   ing or classification of bio-
   logical organisms is a science
   in itself (taxonomy).  Some of
   the principles involved need to
   be understood by anyone working
   with organisms however.

   1  Names are the "key number",
      "code designation", or "file
      references" which we must
      have to find information
      about an unknown organism.

   2  Why are they so long and why
      must they be in Latin and
      Greek?  File references in
      large systems have to be long
      in order to designate the
      many divisions and subdivi-
      sions.  There are over a
      million and a half items (or
      species) included in the
      system of biological nomen-
    •  clature (very few libraries
      have a million books).

   3  The system of biological no-
      menclature is regulated by
      international congresses.

      a  It is based on a system of
         groups and super groups,
         of which the foundation
         (which actually exists in
         nature) is the species.
         Everything else has been
         devised by man and is sub-
         ject to change and revision
         as man's knowledge and
         understanding increase.
b  The basic categories em-
   ployed are as follows:

   (1)  Similar species are
        grouped into genera
        (genus)

   (2)  Similar genera are
        grouped into families

   (3)  Similar familes are
        grouped into orders

   (4)  Similar orders are
        grouped into classes

   (5)  Similar classes are
        grouped into phyla
        (phylum)

   (6)  Similar phyla are
        grouped into kingdoms

The scientific name of an or-
ganism is its genus name plus
its species name.   This is ana-
logous to our" system of sur-
names (family names) and given
names (Christian names).

a  The generic (genus) name
   is always capitalized and
   the species name written
   with a small letter.  They
   should also be underlined
   or printed in italics when
   used in a technical sense.
   For example:

   Homo sapiens - modern man

   Homo neanderthalis -
   neanderthal man

   Esox niger - Chain pickerel

   Esox lucius - northern pike

   Esox masquinongy -
   muskellunge

b  Common names do not exist
   for most of the smaller and
   less familiar organisms.
   For example, if we  wish to
   refer to members of the
BI.AQ. 24.6.76

-------
                        RELATIONSHIPS 8£ I WEEN LIVI-lRM:£ttT'<3/%AWLn^
                                  HIGHER PROTISTA
                                           PROTOZOA  82
                       AMOEBOID PROTOZOA 86         CILLIATED PROTOZOA  92
                          FLAGELLATED PROTOZOA 85       SPOROZOA 98
                         (COLORLESS FLAGELLATES 85      SUCTORIA 97
                          DEVELOPMENT OF ANUCLE.AR MEMBRANE
                            LOWER PROTISTA (OR MONERA )
DIATOMS  38

PIGMENTED FLAGELLATES
                   12
BLUE GREEN ALGAE 7
       PHOTOTROPIC
       BACTERIA  252
CHEMOTROPIC BACTERIA
                 252
    NOTE:   NUMERALS REFER TO PARAGRAPHS IN PARTS 2 AND 3.

    W.  B. COOKE AND H. W. JACKSON, AFTER WHITTAKER
LOWER PHYCOMYCETES
               261
                                                                             ACTINOMYCETES 253

                                                                             SPIROCHAETES 255

                                                                             MYXOBACTERIA 254

                                                                             PARASITIC
                                                                             BACTERIA  251
                                                                             AND VIRUSES
                                                                                                  6
                                                                             SAPROBIC BACTERIA 251
    BI.ECO.pl.2b.4.66
 48-2

-------
                                                          Classification - Finder
          genus Anabaena  (an alga),
          we must  simply  use the
          generic  name, and:

          Anabaena planctonica,

          Anabaena constricta, and

          Anabaena flos-aquae

          are three distinct species
          which have  different signi-
          ficances to water  treatment
          plant operations.

      A complete  list of the various
      categories  to  which an organism
      belongs is  known as its "classi-
      fication".   For example, the
      classification of  a type of
      frog spittle,  a common fila-
      mentous alga,  and  a crayfish
      or  crawdad  are shown  side by
      side below.  Their scientific
      names are Spirogyra crassa and
      Cambarus sciotensis.

      a   Examples of the classifica-
          tion of  an  animal  and a
          plant:
  (Frog Spittle)

Plantae
Chlorophyta
Chlorophyceae
Zygnematale s
Zygnemataceae
Spirogyra
crassa
Kingdom
Phylum
Class
Order
Family
Genus
Species
(Crayfish)
Animalia
Arthropoda
Crustacea
Decapoda
Palaemonidae
Cambarus
sciotensis
         These  seven basic  levels  of
         organization  are often  not
         enough for the  complete de-
         signation of  one species
         among  thousands; however,
         and  so additional  echelons
         of terms are  provided by
         grouping the  various cate-
         gories into "super..."
         groups and subdividing  them
         into "sub..." groups as:
         Superorder, Order,  Suborder,
         etc.   Still other  category
         names  such as "tribe",  "di-
         vision", "variety", "race",
         "section", etc. are used on
         occasion.
II
   c  Additional accuracy is gained
      by citing the name of the
      authority who first described
      a species (and the date) im-
      mediately following the spe-
      cies name.  Authors are also
      often cited for genera or
      other groups.

   d  A more complete classification
      of the above crayfish is as
      follows:

      Kingdom Animalia

      Phylum Arthropoda      :

      Class Crustacea

      Subclass Malacostraca

      Order Decapoda

      Section Nephropsidea

      Family Astacidae

      Subfamily Cambarinae

      Genus Cambarus

      Species sciotensis Rhoades
      1944

   e  It should be emphasized that
      since all categories above
      the species level are essen-
      tially human concepts,! there
      is often divergence of opin-
      ion in regard to how certain
      organisms should be grouped.
      Changes result as  knowledge
       grows.
   f  The most appropriate or cor-
      rect name for a given species
      is also sometimes disputed,
      and so species names too are
      changed.  The species itself,
      as an entity in nature, how-
      ever, is relatively timeless
      and so does not change to
      man's eye.

THE GENERAL RELATIONSHIPS OF
LIVING ORGANISMS           |

Living organisms (as contrasted to
fossil types) have long been group-
ed into two kingdoms:  Plant King-
doms and Animal Kingdoms.  Modern
developments however have made this
                                                                           43-3

-------
Classification - Finder
    simple  pattern technically unten-
    able.   It has become evident that
    there  are as great and fundamental
    differences between certain other
    groups  and these (two),  as there
    are between the traditional "plant"
    and "animal".  The accompanying
    chart  consequently shows the
    Fungi  as a third kingdom.

 B  The three  groups  are  essentially
    defined as follows  on the  basis
    of their nutritional  mechanisms:

    1  Plantae:   photosynthetic;
       synthesizing their own  organic
       substance  from inorganic min-
       erals.  Ecologically known as
       PRODUCERS.

    2  Animalia:   ingest  and digest
       solid particles  of organic food
       material.   Ecologically known
       as CONSUMERS.

    3  Fungi:  extracellular digestion
       (enzymes  secreted  externally).
       Food  material  then taken in
       through cell membrane where it
       is metabolized and reduced to
       the mineral condition.  Ecolo-
       gically known  as REDUCERS.

 C  Each of  these  groups  includes
    simple,  single celled representa-
    tives, persisting at  lower levels
    on the evolutionary stems of the
    higher organisms.

    1  These groups span  the gaps be-
       tween the higher kingdoms with
       a multitude of transitional
       forms.  They are collectively
       called PROTISTA.

    2  within  the protista, two prin-
       ciple sub-groups can be defined
       on the basis of relative com-
       plexity of structure:

       a  The bacteria and blue algae,
          lacking a nuclear membrane,
          may be considered as the
          lower protista or MONERA.

       b  The single celled algae and
          protozoa having a nuclear
          membrane, are best referred
          to simply as the higher
          protista.
 48-4

-------
                                                         Classification - Finder
                        Part II.  Biological Classification
 I  INTRODUCTION

 A  What is it?

 B  Policies

 C  Procedures

II  PLANT KINGDOM

 A  "Algae" defined
 1

 2

 3

 4

 5

 6
 B  PHYLUM CYANOPHYTA - blue-green   7
    algae

    CLASS Myxophyceae                8

     Order Chroococcales             9

     Order Hormogonales             10

      Suborder Hetercystineae       11

 C  PHYLUM CHLOROPHYTA - green      12
    algae

    CLASS Chlorophyceae             13

     Order Volvocales               14

     Order Ulotrichales               15

     Order Chaetophorales           16

     Order Chlorococcales           17

     Order Siphonales               18

     Order Zygnematales             19

     Order Tetrasporales            20

     •Order Ulvales                  21

     Order Schizogoniales             22

     Order Oedogoniales             23

     Order Cladophorales            24

    CLASS Charophyceae              25

     Order Charales                 26

 D  PHYLUM CHRYSOPHYTA - yellow-    27
    green algae or yellow-brown
    algae
    CLASS Xanthophyceae             28
     Order Rhizochloridales
29
    Order Heterocapsales          30

    Order Heterococcales          31

   CLASS Chrysophyceae -          32
   yellow-green algae

    Order Chrysomondales          33

    Order Rhizochrysidales        34

    Order Chrysosphaerales        35

    Order Chrysocapsales          36

    Order Chrysotrichales         37

   CLASS Bacillariophyceae -      38
   Diatoms

    Order Pennales - pennate      39
    diatoms

    Order Centrales - centric     40
    diatoms

E  PHYLUM EUGLENOPHYTA - eugle-   41
   noid algae

F  PHYLUM PYRRHOPHYTA - yellow    42
   brown algae

   CLASS Desmokontae              43

    Order Desmomonadales          44

   CLASS Dinophyceae -            45
   dinoflage Hates

    Order Gymnodiniales           46

    Order Peridiniales            47

    Order Dinocapsales            48

    Order Chloromonadales         49

   CLASS Cryptophyceae            50

G  PHYLUM CHLOROMONADOPHYTA       51

H  PHYLUM RHODOPHYTA - red algae  52

   CLASS Rhodophyceae             53

    Order Bangiales               54

    Order Nemalionales            55

    Order Gelidiales              56
                                                                             48-5

-------
  Classification - Finder
      Order Cryptonemiales

      Order Gigartinales

      Order Rhodymeniales

      Order Ceramiales
57

58

59

60
  I  PHYLUM PHAEOPHYTA - brown algae 61

     CLASS Phaeophyceae              62

      Order Ectocarpales             63

      Order Sphacelariales           64

      Order Tilopteridales           65

      Order Chordiales               66

      Order Desmarestiales           67

      Order Punctariales             68

      Order Dictyosiphonales         69

      Order Laminariales             70

      Order Fucales                  71

      Order Dictyotales              72

  J  PHYLUM BRYOPHYTA                73

     CLASS Hepaticae - liverworts    74

     CLASS Musci - mosses            75

  K  VASCULAR PLANT GROUP            76

     Emergent vegetation             77

     Rooted plants - floating leaves 78

     Submerged vegetation            79

     Free floating plants            80

III  ANIMAL KINGDOM                  81

  A  PHYLUM PROTOZOA - protozoa      82

     CLASS Mastigophora              83

      Subclass phytomastigina        84

      Subclass zoomastigina          85

     CLASS Sarcodina - amoeboid      86
     protozoa
Order Amoebina

Order Foraminifera

Order Radiolaria

Order Heliozoa
87

88

89

90
             Order Mycetozoa (Myxomycetes)  91

            CLASS Ciliophora - ciliates    92

             Order Holotricha              93

             Order Spirotricha             94

             Order Peritricha              95

             Order Chonotricha             96

            CLASS Suctoria - suctoria      97

            CLASS Sporozoa                 98

         B  PHYLUM PORIFERA - sponges      99

            CLASS Calcispongea            100

            CLASS Hyalospongea            101

            CLASS Demospongea             102

         C  PHYLUM COELENTERATA           103

            CLASS Hydrozoa - hydroids     104

            CLASS Scyphozoa - jellyfish   105

            CLASS Actinozoa (Anthozoa)  -  106
            corals

         D  PHYLUM CTENOPHORA - comb      107
            jellies

         E  PHYLUM PLATYHELMINTHES -      108
            flatworms

            CLASS Turbellaria - turbella- 109
            rians

            CLASS Trematoda - fluke       110

            CLASS Cestoidea - tapeworms   111

         F  PHYLUM NEMERTEA - proboscis    112
            worms

         G  PHYLUM NEMATODA - threadworms,113
            roundworms
   48-6

-------
                                                      Classification - Finder
H  PHYLUM NEMATOMORPHA -
   Horsehair worms
                                  114
I  PHYLUM ACANTHOCEPHALA - thorny 115
   headed worms

J  PHYLUM ROTIFERA - rotifer,     116
   wheel animalcules

K  PHYLUM GASTROTRICHA - gastro-  117
   trichs
L  PHYLUM KINORHYNCHIA

M  PHYLUM PRIAPULIDA

N  PHYLUM ENDOPROCTA
118

119

120
O  PHYLUM ANNELIDA - segmented    121
   worms

   CLASS Polychaeta - polychaet   122
   worms

   CLASS Oligochaeta - bristle    123
   worms

   CLASS Hirudinea - leeches      124

   CLASS Archiannelida            125

   CLASS Echiuroidea              126

   CLASS Sipunculoidea - peanut   127
   worms

P  PHYLUM ARTHROPODA - jointed    128
   legged animals

   CLASS Crustacea - crustaceans  129

    Subclass Branchiopoda         130

     Order Anostraca - fairy      131
     shrimps

     Order Notostraca - tadpole   132
     shrimps

     Order Conchostraca - clam    133
     shrimps

     Order Cladocera - water fleas!34

    Subclass Ostracoda - seed     135
    shrimps, ostracodes

    Subclass Copepoda - copepods  136

    Subclass Branchiura - fish    137
    lice
              Subclass Cirripedia -
              barnacles

              Subclass Malacostraca

               Order Leptostraca
                            138


                            139

                            140
               Order Hoplocardia           141
               (Stomatopoda)  - mantis shrimps
Order Syncarida

Order Peracarida

 Suborder Mysidacea

 Suborder Cumacea

 Suborder Tanaidacea
142

143

144

145

146
                Suborder Isopoda - sowbugs,147
                 pillbugs

                Suborder Amphipoda - scuds 148

               Order Eucarida              149

                Suborder Euphausiacea -    150
                krill

                Suborder Decapoda - shrimp,151
                lobster, crab

                Macrurous group (4 tribes) 152
                shrimps,prawns, lobsters,
                crayfish

                Brachyurous group          153
                (2 tribes)  - crabs and hermit
                crabs

             CLASS Insecta - the insects   154

              Orders represented by imma-  155
              ture stages only.

              Order Plecoptera - stone-    156
              flies
              Order Ephemeroptera -
              mayflies
                            157
              Order Odonata - dragon and   158
              damselflies

              Order Megaloptera - alder-   159
              flies, dobsonflies, flshflies

              Order Neuroptera - spongilla-160
              flies
                                                                            48-V

-------
Classification - Finder
    Order Trichoptera - caddis-    161
    flies

    Order Lepidoptera - aquatic   162
    caterpillars

    Order Diptera - two winged    163
    flies
    Orders including aquatic
    adults
164
    Order Coleoptera - beetles    165

    Order Hemiptera - true bugs   166

   CLASS Arachnoidea - spiders,   167
   scorpions, mites

    Order Xiphosoura - horse-     168
    shoe or king crabs

    Order Hydracarina - aquatic   169
    mites

    Order Pantopoda (Pycnogonida)-170
    pycnogonids

    Order Tardigrada              171

Q  PHYLUM MOLLUSCA                172

   CLASS Amphineura - chitons     173

   CLASS Gasteropoda - snails     174

    Order Prosobranchiata         175

    Order Opisthobranchiata       176

    Order Pulmonata - air breath- 177
    ing snails
   CLASS Scaphopoda - tusk
   sheljs

   CLASS Bivalvia
   (Pelecypoda)
178


179
   CLASS Cephalopoda - squid,     180
   octipus, nautilus

R  PHYLUM BRYOZOA (Ectoprocta) -  181
   Moss animals
S  PHYLUM BRACHIOPODA - lamp
   shells
182
T  PHYLUM CHAETOGNATHA - arrow    183
   worms
         U  PHYLUM PHORONIDEA - tufted    184
            worms
          V  PHYLUM ECH1NODERMATA -
             echinoderms
                                 185
   CLASS Asteroidea - starfishes 186

   CLASS Ophiuroidea - brittle   187
   stars

   CLASS Echinoidea - sea urchins  188

   CLASS Holothuroidea - sea     189
   cucumbe rs

   CLASS Crinoidea - sea lilies  190

W  PHYLUM CHORDATA - chordates   191

   Subphylum Hemichordata -      192
   Acorn worms

   Subphylum Urochordata -       193
   tunicates, sea squirts

   Subphylum Cephalochordata -   194
   lancelets

   Subphylum Vertebrata          195
   (Craniata) - vertebrates

    CLASS Agnatha - jawless      196
    fishes

     Order Myxiniformes -        197
     hagfishes

     Order Petromyzontiformes -  198
     lampreys
              CLASS Chrondrichthys  -
              cartilage  fishes
                                 199
     Order Squaliformes - sharks 200

     Order Rajiformes - skates,  201
     rays

     Order Chimaeriformes -      202
     chimaeras

    CLASS Osteichthys (Pisces) - 203
    bony fishes

     Order Acipenseriformes -    204
     sturgeons
              Order Polyodontidae  -
              paddle  fishes
                                 205
  48-8

-------
                                                   Classification - Finder
Order Semionoteformes - gars  206

Order Amliformes - bowfins    207

Order Clupeiformes - soft     208
rayed fishes

 Family Clupeidae - herrings  209

 Family Salmonidae - trouts,  210
 salmon

 Family Esocidae - pikes,     211
 pickerels
Order Myctophiformes -
lizard fishes

Order Cypriniformes -
212
213
 Family Cyprinidae - minnows, 214
 carps

 Family Catostomidae - suckers215

 Family Ictaluridae - fresh-  216
 water catfishes

Order Anguilliformes - eel-   217
like fishes
Order Notacanthiformes -
spiny eels
218
Order Beloniformes - needle-  219
fishes, flying fishes

Order Cyprinodontiformes -    220
 klllifishes, livebearers

Order Gadiformes - cods and   221
hakes

Order Gasterosteiformes -     222
stickelbacks

Order Lampridiformes - Opahs, 223
ribbon fishes

Order Beryciformes - beard-   224
fishes

Order Percopsiformes - trout  225
and pirate perches
Order Zeiformes - dory
226
Order Perciformes - spiny-    227
rayed fishes
      Family Serranidae - sea     228
      basses

      Family Centrarchidae -      229
      sunfishes, freshwater
      basses

      Family Percidae - perch     230

      Family Sciaenidae - drum    231

      Family Cottidae - sculpins  232

      Family Magilidae - mullets  233

     Order Pleuronectiformes —    234
     flounders

     Order Echeneiformes - remoras235
              Order Gobiesociformes -
              clingfishes
                                  236
              Order Tetraodontiformes  -    237
              spikefishes

              Order Batrachoidiformes -    238
              toadfishes
              Order Lophiiformes -
              goosefishes
                                  239
    CLASS Amphibia - frogs, toads,240
    salamanders

    CLASS Reptilia - turtles,     241
    snakes, lizards

    CLASS Aves - birds            242

    CLASS Mammalia - whales,      243
    seals, walrusses

IV  FUNGUS KINGDOM                250

 A  Bacteria                      251

    Eubacteria                    252

    Actinomycetes                 253

    Myxobacteria                  254

    Splrochaetes                  255

    Other bacterial types         256

 B  FUNGI                         260

    "Phycomycete" group           261
                                                                       48-9

-------
Classification - Finder
    CLASS Chytridiomycetes

    CLASS Oomycetes

    CLASS Zygomycetes

    CLASS Ascomycetes

    CLASS Basidiomycetes

    CLASS Fungi Imperfect!
262
263

264
265
266
267
This outline was prepared by H. W.
Jackson,  former Chief Biologist,
National Training Center, and revised by
R. M. Sinclair, Aquatic Biologist, National
Training Center, MOTD, OWPO,  USEPA,
Cincinnati,  Ohio 45268.

Descriptors:  Aquatic Organisms,
Classification
48-10

-------